DNS: do not skip initial two components of SRV & TLSA lookups before checking name...
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
... / ...
CommitLineData
1. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2. This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3. converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printable and online
4. formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5. The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6.
7. WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8. adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9. unwanted vertical space.
10. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12.include stdflags
13.include stdmacs
14
15. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16. This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19.docbook
20
21. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22. These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23. Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24. PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25. processors.
26. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28.literal xml
29<?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34?>
35.literal off
36
37. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38. This generates the outermost <book> element that wraps the entire document.
39. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41.book
42
43. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44. These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45. Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48.set previousversion "4.92"
49.include ./local_params
50
51.set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52.set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54.macro copyyear
552018
56.endmacro
57
58. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59. Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60. provided in the xfpt library.
61. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62
63. --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name.
64
65.flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66
67. --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68. --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be in Roman.
69
70.flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
71.flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
72
73. --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74. --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75. --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
76. --- index entry.
77
78.macro option
79.arg 5
80.oindex "&%$5%&"
81.endarg
82.arg -5
83.oindex "&%$1%&"
84.endarg
85.itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86.row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87.endtable
88.endmacro
89
90. --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91. --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92. --- a small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93
94.macro table2 196pt 254pt
95.itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
96.endmacro
97
98. --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99. --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100. --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101
102.macro irow
103.arg 4
104.row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105.endarg
106.arg -4
107.arg 3
108.row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
109.endarg
110.arg -3
111.row "&I;$1" "$2"
112.endarg
113.endarg
114.endmacro
115
116. --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117. --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118. --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119. --- ID that ties them together.
120
121.macro cindex
122&<indexterm role="concept">&
123&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124.arg 2
125&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
126.endarg
127&</indexterm>&
128.endmacro
129
130.macro scindex
131&<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132&<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133.arg 3
134&<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
135.endarg
136&</indexterm>&
137.endmacro
138
139.macro ecindex
140&<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141.endmacro
142
143.macro oindex
144&<indexterm role="option">&
145&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146.arg 2
147&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
148.endarg
149&</indexterm>&
150.endmacro
151
152.macro vindex
153&<indexterm role="variable">&
154&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155.arg 2
156&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
157.endarg
158&</indexterm>&
159.endmacro
160
161.macro index
162.echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163.endmacro
164. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165
166
167. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168. The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for ASCII
169. output formats.
170. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171
172.literal xml
173<bookinfo>
174<title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175<titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
176<date>
177.fulldate
178</date>
179<author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180<authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181<revhistory><revision>
182.versiondatexml
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184</revision></revhistory>
185<copyright><year>
186.copyyear
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188</bookinfo>
189.literal off
190
191
192. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193. This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194. "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195. at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
197
198.chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199.literal xml
200
201<indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
204</indexterm>
205<indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
209</indexterm>
210<indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
213</indexterm>
214<indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
217</indexterm>
218<indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
221</indexterm>
222<indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
225</indexterm>
226<indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
230</indexterm>
231<indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
234</indexterm>
235<indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
238</indexterm>
239<indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242</indexterm>
243<indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
246</indexterm>
247<indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
251</indexterm>
252<indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
255</indexterm>
256<indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
259</indexterm>
260<indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
263</indexterm>
264<indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
267</indexterm>
268<indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
271</indexterm>
272<indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
275</indexterm>
276<indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
279</indexterm>
280<indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
283</indexterm>
284<indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
287</indexterm>
288<indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
291</indexterm>
292<indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
295</indexterm>
296<indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
299</indexterm>
300<indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
303</indexterm>
304<indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
308</indexterm>
309<indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
312</indexterm>
313<indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
316</indexterm>
317<indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
320</indexterm>
321
322.literal off
323
324
325. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326. This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327. we can't have the .chapter line here.
328. chapter "Introduction"
329. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
330
331Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
335
336Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and UnixWare.
341Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
343
344There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
347
348The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
351
352The use, supply, or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of Exim,
354which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
357
358Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
363
364Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367&_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
368contributors.
369
370
371.section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372. Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
373
374.cindex "documentation"
375This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
376Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
377renditions of this document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
378capable of showing a change indicator.
379
380This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
381is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
382with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
383and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
384it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
385Furthermore, this manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
386a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
387very wide interest.
388
389.cindex "books about Exim"
390An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
391introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
392SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
393(&url(https://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
394
395The book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
396Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
397with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
398published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
399
400.cindex "Debian" "information sources"
401If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
402Debian-specific features in the file
403&_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
404The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
405information.
406
407.cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
408.cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
409.cindex "change log"
410As Exim develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
411yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
412digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
413new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
414&_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
415
416Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
417incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
418they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
419can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
420
421All changes to Exim (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
422change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
423
424.cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
425This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
426that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
427directory are:
428
429.table2 100pt
430.row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
431.row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
432.row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
433.row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
434.row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
435.row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
436.row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
437.row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
438.endtable
439
440The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
441available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
442&<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
443
444
445
446.section "FTP site and websites" "SECID2"
447.cindex "website"
448.cindex "FTP site"
449The primary site for Exim source distributions is the &%exim.org%& FTP site,
450available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP. These services, and the &%exim.org%&
451website, are hosted at the University of Cambridge.
452
453.cindex "wiki"
454.cindex "FAQ"
455As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim website contains a number of
456differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
457online information is the Exim wiki (&url(https://wiki.exim.org)),
458which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
459examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
460The wiki site should always redirect to the correct place, which is currently
461provided by GitHub, and is open to editing by anyone with a GitHub account.
462
463.cindex Bugzilla
464An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
465this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
466first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
467Please do not ask for configuration help in the bug-tracker.
468
469
470.section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
471.cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
472The following Exim mailing lists exist:
473
474.table2 140pt
475.row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
476.row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
477.row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
478.row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
479.endtable
480
481You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
482or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
483.cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
484If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
485the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
486via this web page:
487.display
488&url(https://alioth-lists.debian.net/cgi-bin/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
489.endd
490Please ask Debian-specific questions on that list and not on the general Exim
491lists.
492
493.section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
494.cindex "bug reports"
495.cindex "reporting bugs"
496Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
497via the Bugzilla (&url(https://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
498whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
499message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
500
501
502
503.section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
504.cindex "FTP site"
505.cindex "HTTPS download site"
506.cindex "distribution" "FTP site"
507.cindex "distribution" "https site"
508The master distribution site for the Exim distribution is
509.display
510&url(https://downloads.exim.org/)
511.endd
512The service is available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP.
513We encourage people to migrate to HTTPS.
514
515The content served at &url(https://downloads.exim.org/) is identical to the
516content served at &url(https://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim) and
517&url(ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim).
518
519If accessing via a hostname containing &'ftp'&, then the file references that
520follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at these sites.
521If accessing via the hostname &'downloads'& then the subdirectories described
522here are top-level directories.
523
524There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
525the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
526
527Within the top exim directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
528previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
529distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
530subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
531.display
532&_exim-n.nn.tar.xz_&
533&_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
534&_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
535.endd
536where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The three
537files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
538The &_.xz_& file is usually the smallest, while the &_.gz_& file is the
539most portable to old systems.
540
541.cindex "distribution" "signing details"
542.cindex "distribution" "public key"
543.cindex "public key for signed distribution"
544The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
545Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
546&'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
547other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
548PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from the Exim Maintainer's
549PGP keys, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
550&_Exim-Maintainers-Keyring.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
551such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
552
553At the time of the last update, releases were being made by Jeremy Harris and signed
554with key &'0xBCE58C8CE41F32DF'&. Other recent keys used for signing are those
555of Heiko Schlittermann, &'0x26101B62F69376CE'&,
556and of Phil Pennock, &'0x4D1E900E14C1CC04'&.
557
558The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
559.display
560&_exim-n.nn.tar.xz.asc_&
561&_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
562&_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
563.endd
564For each released version, the log of changes is made available in a
565separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
566find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
567
568.cindex "documentation" "available formats"
569The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
570documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
571inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
572.display
573&_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
574&_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
575&_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576&_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577.endd
578These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
579distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& and &_.xz_& forms.
580
581
582.section "Limitations" "SECID6"
583.ilist
584.cindex "limitations of Exim"
585.cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
586Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
587RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
588simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
589configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
590UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
591.next
592.cindex "domainless addresses"
593.cindex "address" "without domain"
594Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
595local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
596configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
597systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
598arrival.
599.next
600.cindex "transport" "external"
601.cindex "external transports"
602The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
603and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
604transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
605and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
606to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
607handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
608.next
609Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
610such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
611(that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
612other means.
613.next
614Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
615are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
616are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
617compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
618a number of common scanners are provided.
619.endlist
620
621
622.section "Runtime configuration" "SECID7"
623Exim's runtime configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
624into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
625values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
626file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
627distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
628
629
630.section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
631.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
632Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
633can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
634&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
635about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
636Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
637example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages in the queue) do so in Exim's own
638format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
6393, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
640documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
641made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
642
643Control of messages in the queue can be done via certain privileged command
644line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
645which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
646interface to Exim's command line administration options.
647
648
649
650.section "Terminology" "SECID9"
651.cindex "terminology definitions"
652.cindex "body of message" "definition of"
653The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
654It is the last part of a message and is separated from the &'header'& (see
655below) by a blank line.
656
657.cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
658When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
659delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
660&'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
661called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
662failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
663message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
664rise to further bounce messages.
665
666The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
667value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
668also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
669otherwise.
670
671The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
672destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
673down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
674until a later time.
675
676The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
677host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
678the part of an email address following the @ sign.
679
680.cindex "envelope, definition of"
681.cindex "sender" "definition of"
682A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
683body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
684be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
685sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
686envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
687messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
688
689.cindex "message" "header, definition of"
690.cindex "header section" "definition of"
691The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
692of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
693&'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
694indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
695line.
696
697.cindex "local part" "definition of"
698.cindex "domain" "definition of"
699The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to the
700part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
701@ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
702
703.cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
704.cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
705The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
706delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
707TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
708host it is running on are &'remote'&.
709
710.cindex "return path" "definition of"
711&'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
712message's envelope.
713
714.cindex "queue" "definition of"
715The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery
716because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
717Exim's case, the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
718normally no ordering of waiting messages.
719
720.cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
721The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
722and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
723is used by other MTAs and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
724the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
725
726.cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
727The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
728messages in its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
729delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
730mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
731the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
732
733
734
735
736
737
738. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
739. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
740
741.chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
742.cindex "incorporated code"
743.cindex "regular expressions" "library"
744.cindex "PCRE"
745.cindex "OpenDMARC"
746A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
747
748.ilist
749Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
750Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
751&copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
752Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
753or obtain and install the full version of the library from
754&url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
755.next
756.cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
757Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
758contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
759Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
760It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
761following statements:
762
763.blockquote
764Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
765
766This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
767the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
768Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
769version.
770This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
771the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
772&url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
773some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
774restrictions applied to it).
775.endblockquote
776.next
777.cindex "SPA authentication"
778.cindex "Samba project"
779.cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
780Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
781by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
782Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
783under the Gnu GPL.
784.next
785.cindex "Cyrus"
786.cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
787.cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
788Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
789by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
790Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
791conditions expressed therein.
792
793.blockquote
794Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
795
796Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
797modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
798are met:
799
800.olist
801Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
802notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
803.next
804Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
805notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
806the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
807distribution.
808.next
809The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
810endorse or promote products derived from this software without
811prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
812details, please contact
813.display
814 Office of Technology Transfer
815 Carnegie Mellon University
816 5000 Forbes Avenue
817 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
818 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
819 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
820.endd
821.next
822Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
823acknowledgment:
824
825&"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
826at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(https://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
827
828CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
829THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
830AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
831FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
832WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
833AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
834OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
835.endlist
836.endblockquote
837
838.next
839.cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
840.cindex "X-windows"
841.cindex "Athena"
842The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
843modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
844This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
845below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
846
847.blockquote
848Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
849and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
850
851All Rights Reserved
852
853Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
854documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
855provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
856both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
857supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
858used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
859software without specific, written prior permission.
860
861DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
862ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
863DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
864ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
865WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
866ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
867SOFTWARE.
868.endblockquote
869
870.next
871.cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
872The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
873The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
874derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
875license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
876source code.
877
878.next
879Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
880not covered by any specific license requirements. It is assumed that the
881contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
882.endlist
883
884
885
886
887
888. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
889. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
890
891.chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
892 "Receiving and delivering mail"
893
894
895.section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
896.cindex "design philosophy"
897Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
898to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
899most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
900maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
901it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
902has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
903
904
905.section "Policy control" "SECID11"
906.cindex "policy control" "overview"
907Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
908Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs from being abused as
909&"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
910unsolicited junk and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
911facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
912
913.ilist
914.cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
915Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
916incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
917series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
918several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
919host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
920very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
921rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
922two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
923error code.
924.next
925An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
926case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
927.next
928When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
929provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
930spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
931which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
932.next
933When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
934host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
935function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
936whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
937is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
938.next
939Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
940software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
941Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
942.next
943After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
944the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
945runs at the start of every delivery process.
946.endlist
947
948
949
950.section "User filters" "SECID12"
951.cindex "filter" "introduction"
952.cindex "Sieve filter"
953In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
954setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
955chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
956configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
957&'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
958of filtering are available:
959
960.ilist
961Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
962by RFC 3028.
963.next
964Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
965powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
966.endlist
967
968User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
969
970
971
972.section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
973.cindex "message ids" "details of format"
974.cindex "format" "of message id"
975.cindex "id of message"
976.cindex "base62"
977.cindex "base36"
978.cindex "Darwin"
979.cindex "Cygwin"
980Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
981characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
982example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
983normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
984system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
985(avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
986id is used to construct filenames, and the names of files in those systems are
987not always case-sensitive.
988
989.cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
990The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
991Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
992within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
993be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
994the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
995somewhat eccentric:
996
997.ilist
998The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
999started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1000contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1001way of representing the date and time of day).
1002.next
1003After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1004received the message.
1005.next
1006There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1007.olist
1008.oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1009If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1010time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1011that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1012systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1013.next
1014If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1015the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1016(1/100) of a second.
1017.endlist
1018.endlist
1019
1020After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1021appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1022received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1023pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1024will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1025
1026
1027.section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1028.cindex "receiving mail"
1029.cindex "message" "reception"
1030The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1031TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1032SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1033there are several possibilities:
1034
1035.ilist
1036If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1037non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1038command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1039.next
1040If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1041non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1042the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1043command. This is called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1044but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1045envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1046.next
1047If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1048interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1049passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1050This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1051example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1052.next
1053A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1054(127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1055does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1056in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1057.endlist
1058
1059
1060.cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1061.cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1062In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1063constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1064qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1065option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1066SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1067certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender addresses
1068unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1069address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1070different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1071users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1072users to change sender addresses.
1073
1074Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1075checking by the non-SMTP ACL if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1076(either over TCP/IP or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1077number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1078individual recipients or the entire message can be rejected if local policy
1079requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1080&<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1081
1082Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1083received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1084connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1085queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1086configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1087message is received.
1088
1089
1090
1091
1092
1093.section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1094.cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1095.cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1096When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1097first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1098the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1099the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1100file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1101
1102.cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1103By default, all these message files are held in a single directory called
1104&_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1105not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1106improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1107used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1108whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1109processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1110overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1111affect file system performance.
1112
1113The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1114the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1115any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1116a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1117first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1118
1119.cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1120Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1121(see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1122both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1123If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1124example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1125generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1126rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1127different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1128addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1129delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1130&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1131
1132
1133
1134.section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1135.cindex "message" "life of"
1136.cindex "message" "frozen"
1137A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1138its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1139administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1140cannot proceed &-- for example when a message can neither be delivered to its
1141recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1142spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1143
1144.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1145.cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1146An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1147corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1148addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1149to be sent.
1150
1151.oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1152.oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1153There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1154&%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1155The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to all frozen messages.
1156
1157.cindex "message" "log file for"
1158.cindex "log" "file for each message"
1159While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1160attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1161delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1162lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1163These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator and are normally
1164deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1165The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1166&%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1167systems.
1168
1169.cindex "journal file"
1170.cindex "file" "journal"
1171All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1172spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1173address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1174message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1175addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1176is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1177Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1178minimize the possibility of data loss.
1179
1180Should the system or Exim crash after a successful delivery but before
1181the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1182time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1183updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1184deliveries caused by crashes.
1185
1186
1187
1188.section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1189.cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1190.cindex "router" "definition of"
1191.cindex "transport" "definition of"
1192The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1193&'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1194number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1195specify which ones are included in the binary. Runtime options specify which
1196ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1197
1198.cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1199Each driver that is specified in the runtime configuration is an &'instance'&
1200of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1201you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1202option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1203instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1204instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1205configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1206the driver's features in general.
1207
1208A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1209its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1210converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1211alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1212to be bounced.
1213
1214A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1215spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1216transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1217&'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1218to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1219several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1220
1221.cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1222An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1223turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1224specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1225detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1226address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1227
1228To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1229routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1230routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1231configuration.
1232
1233The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1234addresses in domains that are not recognized specifically by the local host.
1235Typically these are addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1236is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1237its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1238match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1239find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1240assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1241configured to fail the address.
1242
1243The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1244&"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1245aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1246original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1247router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1248address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1249
1250The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1251address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1252see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1253local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1254the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1255the address is bounced.
1256
1257
1258
1259.section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1260.cindex "router" "for verification"
1261.cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1262As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1263are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1264one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1265sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1266&%-bvs%& command line options.
1267
1268When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1269does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1270detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1271when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1272sends all messages to a message-scanning program unless they have been
1273previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1274checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1275would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1276
1277
1278
1279
1280.section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1281.cindex "router" "running details"
1282.cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1283.cindex "router" "result of running"
1284As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1285running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1286passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1287the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1288the following:
1289
1290.ilist
1291&'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1292transport or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1293original address ceases
1294.oindex "&%unseen%&"
1295unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1296can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1297for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1298passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1299end of routing.
1300
1301Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1302starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1303setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1304child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1305&%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1306.next
1307&'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1308requests that the address be passed to another router. By default, the address
1309is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1310&%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1311must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1312.next
1313&'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1314recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1315this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1316set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1317&'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1318.next
1319&'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1320the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1321original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1322.next
1323&'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1324database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1325processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1326next time the message is considered for delivery.
1327.next
1328&'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1329its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1330.endlist
1331
1332If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1333any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1334situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1335making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1336router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1337
1338Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1339met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1340You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1341when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1342facility for this purpose.
1343
1344
1345.section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1346.cindex "case of local parts"
1347.cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1348.cindex "duplicate addresses"
1349Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1350and remote transports and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1351check, local parts are treated case-sensitively. This happens only when
1352actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1353routed addresses are shown.
1354
1355
1356
1357.section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1358.cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1359.cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1360The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1361order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1362described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1363
1364.ilist
1365.cindex affix "router precondition"
1366The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1367the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1368suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1369skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1370removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1371of any other conditions.
1372.next
1373Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1374only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1375&%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1376address.
1377Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1378&%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1379sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1380you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1381Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1382.next
1383If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1384run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1385when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1386makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1387having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1388.next
1389Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1390opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1391Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1392.next
1393Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1394check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1395.next
1396If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1397of domains that it defines.
1398.next
1399.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1400.vindex "&$local_part$&"
1401.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1402.cindex affix "router precondition"
1403If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1404the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1405&%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1406part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1407that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1408that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1409&$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1410.next
1411.vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1412.vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1413.vindex "&$home$&"
1414If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1415an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1416local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1417user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1418remaining preconditions.
1419.next
1420If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1421because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1422later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1423subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1424could lead to confusion.
1425.next
1426If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1427set of addresses that it defines.
1428.next
1429If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1430specified files is tested.
1431.next
1432.cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1433If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1434uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1435Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1436.endlist
1437
1438
1439Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1440it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1441part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1442&%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1443&%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1444going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1445example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1446
1447
1448
1449.section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1450.cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1451When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1452
1453.ilist
1454If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1455filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1456message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1457fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1458files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1459filtering'&.
1460.cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1461(&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1462
1463Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1464&<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1465filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1466if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1467be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1468condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1469filter.
1470.next
1471Each recipient address is offered to each configured router, in turn, subject to
1472its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1473address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1474can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1475processed entirely independently of each other.
1476.next
1477.cindex "routing" "loops in"
1478.cindex "loop" "while routing"
1479A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1480transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1481is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1482Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1483from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1484process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1485which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1486.next
1487When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1488handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1489doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1490local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1491collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1492addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1493address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1494addresses to the same domain.
1495.next
1496Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1497non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1498deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1499to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1500run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1501one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1502The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1503deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1504.next
1505.cindex "queue runner"
1506When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1507database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1508address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1509Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1510reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1511queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1512follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1513better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1514causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1515.next
1516.cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1517Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1518deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1519retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1520reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1521not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1522.next
1523If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1524appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1525for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1526messages to other addresses.
1527.next
1528.cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1529If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1530the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1531&'deferred'&.
1532.next
1533When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1534handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1535deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1536.endlist
1537
1538
1539
1540
1541.section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1542.cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1543.cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1544.cindex "queue runner"
1545Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1546attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1547uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1548intervals or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1549not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1550first attempt will remain in your queue forever. A queue runner process works
1551its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1552passed its retry time.
1553You can run several queue runners at once.
1554
1555Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1556address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1557should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1558bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1559error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1560as permanent.
1561
1562
1563
1564.section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1565.cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1566There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1567particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1568connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1569detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1570Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1571is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1572impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1573also apply.
1574
1575If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1576waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1577connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1578deferred,
1579.cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1580Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1581SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1582for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1583connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1584one connection.
1585
1586
1587
1588.section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1589.cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1590.cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1591When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1592bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1593errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1594delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1595many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1596attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1597message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1598See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1599
1600.cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1601Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1602failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1603automatically.
1604
1605.cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1606A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1607obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1608address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1609forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1610failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1611&<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1612of the list.
1613
1614
1615
1616.section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1617.cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1618If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1619itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left in the queue,
1620but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1621that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1622for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1623&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1624
1625
1626
1627
1628
1629. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1630. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1631
1632.chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1633.scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1634
1635.section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1636Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1637creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1638&_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1639
1640.table2 140pt
1641.irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1642.irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1643 documented"
1644.irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1645.irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1646.irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1647.irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1648 instructions"
1649.endtable
1650
1651Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1652following subdirectories are created:
1653
1654.table2 140pt
1655.irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1656.irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1657.irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1658.irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1659.irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1660.irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1661.irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1662.endtable
1663
1664The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory and are built
1665with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1666that may be useful to some sites.
1667
1668
1669.section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1670.cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1671The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1672a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1673source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1674Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1675system.
1676.cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1677Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1678the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1679architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1680overridden if necessary.
1681.cindex compiler requirements
1682.cindex compiler version
1683A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1684
1685
1686.section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1687.cindex "PCRE library"
1688Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1689modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need to
1690install the PCRE package or the PCRE development package for your operating
1691system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1692process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1693headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1694and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1695or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1696If your operating system has no
1697PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1698from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1699More information on PCRE is available at &url(https://www.pcre.org/).
1700
1701.section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1702.cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1703.cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1704Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1705DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1706databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1707different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1708
1709.cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1710.cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1711.cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1712.cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1713If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1714Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1715may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1716you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1717
1718.cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1719Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1720via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1721versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1722some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1723distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1724versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1725Berkeley DB library.
1726
1727Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1728use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1729possibilities:
1730
1731.olist
1732A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1733Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1734.next
1735.cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1736The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1737compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1738&_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1739filename is used unmodified.
1740.next
1741.cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1742The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1743operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1744programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1745.next
1746If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1747file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1748the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1749.next
1750To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1751Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
17522.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions when Exim last revamped support were numbered 4.&'x'&.
1753Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All versions of
1754Berkeley DB could be obtained from
1755&url(http://www.sleepycat.com/), which is now a redirect to their new owner's
1756page with far newer versions listed.
1757It is probably wise to plan to move your storage configurations away from
1758Berkeley DB format, as today there are smaller and simpler alternatives more
1759suited to Exim's usage model.
1760.next
1761.cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1762Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1763&url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/tdb/files/). It has its own interface, and also
1764operates on a single file.
1765.endlist
1766
1767.cindex "USE_DB"
1768.cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1769Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1770to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1771USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1772&_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1773.code
1774USE_DB=yes
1775.endd
1776Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1777error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1778
1779At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1780thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1781configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1782Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1783configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1784&_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1785
1786As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1787necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1788in one of these lines:
1789.code
1790DBMLIB = -ldb
1791DBMLIB = -ltdb
1792.endd
1793Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1794place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1795the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1796file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1797this example:
1798.code
1799INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1800DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1801.endd
1802There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1803file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1804
1805
1806
1807.section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1808.cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1809.cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1810.cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1811.cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1812Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1813independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1814&_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1815&_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1816therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1817building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1818&_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1819
1820There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1821without them. They are the location of the runtime configuration file
1822(CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1823(BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1824maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1825a colon-separated list of filenames; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1826
1827There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1828at runtime, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1829machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1830directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1831you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at runtime, so that errors
1832detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1833be logged.
1834
1835.cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1836Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1837access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1838facilities, you need to set
1839.code
1840WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1841.endd
1842in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1843chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1844
1845
1846.cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1847.cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1848If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1849required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1850your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1851happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1852&_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1853
1854This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1855operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1856to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1857configuration files, for example, to change the C compiler, which
1858defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1859do this.
1860
1861
1862
1863.section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1864.cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1865.cindex "RFC 2047"
1866The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1867described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1868in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1869character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1870mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1871(default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1872supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1873
1874However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1875very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1876&url(https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1877systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1878&[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1879.code
1880HAVE_ICONV=yes
1881.endd
1882to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1883
1884
1885
1886.section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1887.cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1888.cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1889.cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1890.cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1891.cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1892Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1893command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1894start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1895&%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1896line option).
1897
1898If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1899OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1900implementing SSL.
1901
1902If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1903.code
1904SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1905TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1906.endd
1907in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1908OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1909.code
1910SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1911TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1912TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1913.endd
1914.cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1915If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1916.code
1917SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1918USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1919.endd
1920.cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1921If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1922.code
1923SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1924USE_GNUTLS=yes
1925TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1926.endd
1927in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1928library and include files. For example:
1929.code
1930SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1931USE_GNUTLS=yes
1932TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1933TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1934.endd
1935.cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1936If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1937.code
1938SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1939USE_GNUTLS=yes
1940USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1941.endd
1942
1943You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1944specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1945given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1946
1947
1948
1949
1950.section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1951
1952.cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1953.cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1954.cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1955.cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1956Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1957SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1958alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1959already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1960should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1961&_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1962&_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1963EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1964you might have
1965.code
1966USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1967CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1968EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1969.endd
1970in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1971files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1972.code
1973exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1974.endd
1975in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1976the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1977All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1978can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1979&_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1980configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1981further details.
1982
1983
1984.section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1985.cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1986Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1987&`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1988it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1989where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1990library files.
1991
1992Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1993defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1994currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1995as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1996over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
1997Exim used to
1998have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
1999withdrawn.
2000
2001
2002
2003.section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
2004.cindex "lookup modules"
2005.cindex "dynamic modules"
2006.cindex ".so building"
2007On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2008the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2009on demand.
2010This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2011library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2012dependencies.
2013Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2014
2015Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2016installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2017measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2018for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2019Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2020see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2021
2022Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2023&`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2024For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2025on demand:
2026.code
2027LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2028LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2029LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2030.endd
2031
2032
2033.section "The building process" "SECID29"
2034.cindex "build directory"
2035Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2036created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2037operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2038For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2039&_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2040.cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2041Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2042
2043If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2044a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2045&_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2046&'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2047then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2048number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2049makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2050directory, should this ever be necessary.
2051
2052If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2053&_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2054FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2055
2056
2057
2058.section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2059The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2060unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2061output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2062appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2063each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2064get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2065.code
2066FULLECHO='' make -e
2067.endd
2068The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2069command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2070given in addition to the short output.
2071
2072
2073
2074.section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2075.cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2076The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2077consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2078values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2079more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2080convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2081order:
2082.display
2083&_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2084&_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2085&_Local/Makefile_&
2086&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2087&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2088&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2089&_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2090.endd
2091.cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2092.cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2093.cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2094where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2095architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2096process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2097and are often not needed.
2098
2099The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2100called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2101the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2102values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2103Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2104fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2105of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2106that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2107to find out what values are being used on your system.
2108
2109
2110&_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2111therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2112needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2113file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2114default values are.
2115
2116
2117.cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2118If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2119or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2120need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2121putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2122.cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2123when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2124formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2125compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2126called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2127Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2128default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2129containing the lines
2130.code
2131CC=cc
2132CFLAGS=-std1
2133.endd
2134If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2135these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2136
2137Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2138files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2139the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2140
2141
2142.cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2143.cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2144.cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2145.cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2146Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2147lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2148not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2149and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2150which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2151case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2152.code
2153LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2154LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2155LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2156.endd
2157and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2158&_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2159libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2160.cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2161However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2162the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2163files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2164binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause runtime configuration
2165errors.
2166
2167.cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2168.cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2169Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2170about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2171being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2172makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2173variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2174name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2175&'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2176with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2177syntax. For instance:
2178.code
2179LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2180LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2181AUTH_GSASL=yes
2182AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2183AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2184AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2185.endd
2186
2187.cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2188Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2189subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2190.code
2191EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2192.endd
2193must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2194chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2195
2196.cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2197The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2198operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2199with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2200monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2201The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2202.code
2203X11=/usr/X11R6
2204XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2205XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2206.endd
2207These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2208example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2209.code
2210X11=/usr/openwin
2211XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2212XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2213.endd
2214If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2215definition of all three of these variables into your
2216&_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2217
2218.cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2219If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2220variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2221default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2222command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2223
2224.cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2225There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2226use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2227EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2228binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2229libraries.
2230
2231.cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2232The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2233files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2234necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2235&_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2236
2237
2238.section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2239.cindex "&_os.h_&"
2240.cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2241The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2242&_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2243normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2244recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2245are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2246
2247
2248
2249.section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2250.cindex "building Eximon"
2251A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2252where the files that are involved are
2253.display
2254&_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2255&_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2256&_Local/eximon.conf_&
2257&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2258&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2259&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2260.endd
2261.cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2262As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2263&_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2264&_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2265variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2266EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2267LOG_DEPTH at runtime.
2268.ecindex IIDbuex
2269
2270
2271.section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2272.cindex "installing Exim"
2273.cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2274The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2275arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2276whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2277.cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2278The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2279going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2280&'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2281install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2282some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2283it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2284chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2285
2286.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2287Exim's runtime configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2288in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2289exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2290by the installation script. If a runtime configuration file already exists, it
2291is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2292alternative files, no default is installed.
2293
2294.cindex "system aliases file"
2295.cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2296One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2297default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2298The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2299SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2300If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2301and outputs a comment to the user.
2302
2303The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2304aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2305kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2306&_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2307Exim's configuration if necessary.
2308
2309The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2310and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2311running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2312directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2313other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2314over SMTP.
2315
2316It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2317distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2318command such as
2319.code
2320make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2321.endd
2322This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2323paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2324configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2325For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2326but this usage is deprecated.
2327
2328.cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2329Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2330&'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2331upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2332directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2333INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2334
2335For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2336to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2337installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2338for example, &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2339called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2340of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2341from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2342
2343.cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2344If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2345real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2346command:
2347.code
2348make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2349.endd
2350The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2351script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2352the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2353directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2354command:
2355.code
2356(cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2357.endd
2358.cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2359There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2360
2361.ilist
2362&%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2363to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2364.next
2365&%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2366installed binary.
2367.endlist
2368
2369INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2370.code
2371make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2372.endd
2373The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2374to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2375without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2376.code
2377make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2378.endd
2379
2380
2381
2382.section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2383.cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2384Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2385reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2386distribution. Instead it is available separately from the FTP site (see section
2387&<<SECTavail>>&).
2388
2389If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2390source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2391install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2392
2393
2394
2395.section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2396.cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2397When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2398exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2399directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2400necessary.
2401
2402
2403
2404
2405.section "Testing" "SECID34"
2406.cindex "testing" "installation"
2407Having installed Exim, you can check that the runtime configuration file is
2408syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2409Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2410.code
2411exim -bV
2412.endd
2413If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2414Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2415the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2416other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2417Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2418example,
2419.display
2420&`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2421.endd
2422should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2423.display
2424&`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2425.endd
2426a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2427This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2428user agent. For example:
2429.code
2430exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2431From: user@your.domain.example
2432To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2433Subject: Testing Exim
2434
2435This is a test message.
2436^D
2437.endd
2438The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2439In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2440arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2441
2442.cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2443If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2444&'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2445of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2446&%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2447with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2448.display
2449&`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2450.endd
2451You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2452produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2453For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2454relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2455&<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2456
2457.cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2458.cindex "lock files"
2459One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2460local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2461&"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2462writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2463is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2464directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2465that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2466&(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2467approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2468&[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2469agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2470see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2471
2472One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2473the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2474&%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2475port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2476&'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2477incoming SMTP mail.
2478
2479Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2480be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2481within the runtime configuration, all other file and directory names
2482that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2483production version.
2484
2485
2486.section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2487.cindex "replacing another MTA"
2488Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2489general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2490is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2491operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2492binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2493normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2494or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2495.cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2496a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2497privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2498and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2499
2500.cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2501.cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2502Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2503example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2504&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2505described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2506as follows:
2507.code
2508sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2509send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2510mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2511newaliases /usr/bin/true
2512.endd
2513Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2514your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2515favourite user agent.
2516
2517You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2518have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2519various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2520command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2521use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2522&'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2523
2524
2525
2526.section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2527.cindex "upgrading Exim"
2528If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2529version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2530call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2531.cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2532.cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2533to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2534new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2535version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2536configuration file.
2537
2538
2539
2540
2541.section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2542.cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2543The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2544.code
2545/etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2546.endd
2547If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2548fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2549for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2550(that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2551solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2552.code
2553pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2554.endd
2555to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2556
2557Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2558still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2559(the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2560
2561
2562
2563
2564. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2565. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2566
2567.chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2568.scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2569.scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2570Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2571each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2572options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2573some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2574combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2575The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2576
2577
2578.section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2579.cindex "&'mailq'&"
2580If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2581were present before any other options.
2582The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2583standard output.
2584This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2585that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2586&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2587
2588.cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2589If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2590were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2591&%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2592format.
2593
2594.cindex "&'rmail'&"
2595If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2596&%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2597Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2598
2599.cindex "&'runq'&"
2600.cindex "queue runner"
2601If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2602were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2603option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2604
2605.cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2606.cindex "alias file" "building"
2607.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2608If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2609&%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2610This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2611the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2612command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2613
2614
2615.section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2616Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2617available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2618user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2619EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2620&%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2621
2622.ilist
2623.cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2624.cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2625The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2626&%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2627supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2628configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2629
2630.cindex '&"From"& line'
2631.cindex "envelope from"
2632.cindex "envelope sender"
2633Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2634&"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2635Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2636See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2637users to set envelope senders.
2638
2639.cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2640.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2641.cindex "header lines" "From:"
2642.cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
2643For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2644header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2645&'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2646
2647Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2648protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2649locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2650have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2651users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2652that are available to trusted users.
2653.next
2654.cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2655.cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2656The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2657Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2658The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2659
2660Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2661operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2662necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2663the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2664
2665By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2666Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2667However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2668option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2669
2670Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2671is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2672false.
2673.endlist
2674
2675
2676&*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2677edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2678getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2679&<<CHAPconf>>&.
2680
2681
2682
2683
2684.section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2685Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2686of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2687a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2688format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2689on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2690with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2691outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2692
2693. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2694. Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2695. options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2696. creates a man page for the options.
2697. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2698
2699.literal xml
2700<!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2701.literal off
2702
2703
2704.vlist
2705.vitem &%--%&
2706.oindex "--"
2707.cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2708This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2709therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2710rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2711
2712.vitem &%--help%&
2713.oindex "&%--help%&"
2714This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2715The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2716no arguments.
2717
2718.vitem &%--version%&
2719.oindex "&%--version%&"
2720This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2721displayed.
2722
2723.vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2724 &%-Am%&
2725.oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2726.oindex "&%-Am%&"
2727These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2728ignored by Exim.
2729
2730.vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2731.oindex "&%-B%&"
2732.cindex "8-bit characters"
2733.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2734This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2735clean; it ignores this option.
2736
2737.vitem &%-bd%&
2738.oindex "&%-bd%&"
2739.cindex "daemon"
2740.cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2741.cindex "queue runner"
2742This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2743the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2744that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2745
2746The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2747(debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2748disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2749stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2750
2751By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2752all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2753ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2754&<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2755
2756When a listening daemon
2757.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2758.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2759is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2760configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2761in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2762PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2763running as root.
2764
2765When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2766process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2767used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2768
2769The SIGHUP signal
2770.cindex "SIGHUP"
2771.cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2772.cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2773.cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2774.cindex signal "to reload configuration"
2775.cindex daemon "reload configuration"
2776.cindex reload configuration
2777can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2778whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2779means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2780of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2781referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2782because these are reread each time they are used.
2783
2784.vitem &%-bdf%&
2785.oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2786This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2787from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2788
2789.vitem &%-be%&
2790.oindex "&%-be%&"
2791.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2792.cindex "expansion" "testing"
2793Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2794prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2795files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2796of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2797
2798If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2799to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2800used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2801function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2802test data. A line history is supported.
2803
2804Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2805continuations. As in Exim's runtime configuration, white space at the start of
2806continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2807string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2808configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2809message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2810is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2811
2812&*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2813files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2814the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2815of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2816
2817Macro processing is done on lines before string-expansion: new macros can be
2818defined and macros will be expanded.
2819Because macros in the config file are often used for secrets, those are only
2820available to admin users.
2821
2822.vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2823.oindex "&%-bem%&"
2824.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2825.cindex "expansion" "testing"
2826This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2827of a file. For example:
2828.code
2829exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2830.endd
2831The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2832message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2833variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2834no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2835recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2836&$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2837line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2838&%-be%&).
2839
2840.vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2841.oindex "&%-bF%&"
2842.cindex "system filter" "testing"
2843.cindex "testing" "system filter"
2844This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2845tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2846system filters are recognized.
2847
2848.vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2849.oindex "&%-bf%&"
2850.cindex "filter" "testing"
2851.cindex "testing" "filter file"
2852.cindex "forward file" "testing"
2853.cindex "testing" "forward file"
2854.cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2855This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2856to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2857there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2858supplied.
2859
2860If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2861can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2862filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2863.code
2864exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2865.endd
2866This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2867variables that are used by the user filter.
2868
2869If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2870.code
2871# Exim filter
2872# Sieve filter
2873.endd
2874it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2875that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2876&<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2877redirection lists.
2878
2879The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2880detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2881with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2882separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2883
2884When testing a filter file,
2885.cindex "&""From""& line"
2886.cindex "envelope from"
2887.cindex "envelope sender"
2888.oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2889the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2890or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2891that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2892can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2893options).
2894
2895.vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2896.oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2897.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2898This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2899tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2900&$qualify_domain$&.
2901
2902.vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2903.oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2904This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2905tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2906process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2907suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2908actually being delivered.
2909
2910.vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2911.oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2912.cindex affix "filter testing"
2913This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2914file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2915prefix.
2916
2917.vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2918.oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2919.cindex affix "filter testing"
2920This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2921file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2922suffix.
2923
2924.vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2925.oindex "&%-bh%&"
2926.cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2927.cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2928.cindex "testing" "relay control"
2929.cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2930.cindex "policy control" "testing"
2931.cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2932This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2933standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2934after a full stop. For example:
2935.code
2936exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2937exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2938.endd
2939When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2940of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2941conversion to the canonical form is
2942&`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2943
2944Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2945include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2946This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2947messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2948test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2949
2950&*Warning 1*&:
2951.cindex "RFC 1413"
2952You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2953information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2954an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2955connection.
2956
2957&*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2958are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2959occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2960
2961Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2962written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2963lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2964can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2965and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2966session were authenticated.
2967
2968The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2969output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2970acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2971
2972Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2973plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2974specialized SMTP test program such as
2975&url(https://www.jetmore.org/john/code/swaks/,swaks).
2976
2977.vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2978.oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2979This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2980verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2981updating the callout cache database.
2982
2983.vitem &%-bi%&
2984.oindex "&%-bi%&"
2985.cindex "alias file" "building"
2986.cindex "building alias file"
2987.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2988Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2989Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2990this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2991tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2992recognized.
2993
2994If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2995configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2996the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2997The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2998use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2999if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
3000&%-bi%& is a no-op.
3001
3002. // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
3003.vitem &%-bI:help%&
3004.oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
3005.cindex "querying exim information"
3006We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
3007information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
3008consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
3009synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
3010options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
3011
3012.vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
3013.oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
3014.cindex "DSCP" "values"
3015This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
3016recognised DSCP names.
3017
3018.vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
3019.oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
3020.cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
3021This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
3022Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3023useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3024&`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3025compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3026way to guarantee a correct response.
3027
3028.vitem &%-bm%&
3029.oindex "&%-bm%&"
3030.cindex "local message reception"
3031This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3032locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3033command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3034argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3035default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3036if no other conflicting option is present.
3037
3038If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3039qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3040options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3041suppressing this for special cases.
3042
3043Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3044the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3045
3046.cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3047The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3048action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3049
3050The format
3051.cindex "message" "format"
3052.cindex "format" "message"
3053.cindex "&""From""& line"
3054.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3055.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3056of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3057compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3058.code
3059From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3060From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3061.endd
3062(with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3063is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3064authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3065matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3066option, which can be changed if necessary.
3067
3068.oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3069The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3070&%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3071preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3072trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3073
3074.vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3075.oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3076.cindex "testing", "malware"
3077.cindex "malware scan test"
3078This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3079(depending on the used scanner interface),
3080using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3081this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3082the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3083not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3084will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3085
3086Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3087using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3088user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3089This option requires admin privileges.
3090
3091The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3092there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3093administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3094
3095.vitem &%-bnq%&
3096.oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3097.cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3098By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3099without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3100is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3101envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3102&%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3103defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3104
3105Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3106being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3107content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3108header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3109syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3110
3111The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3112messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3113addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3114unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3115
3116
3117.vitem &%-bP%&
3118.oindex "&%-bP%&"
3119.cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3120.cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3121If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3122main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3123of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3124arguments, for example:
3125.code
3126exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3127.endd
3128.cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3129.cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3130.cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3131However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3132configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3133users, the output is as in this example:
3134.code
3135mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3136.endd
3137If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3138output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3139
3140If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the runtime
3141configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3142backward compatibility.)
3143If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3144is the name of the file that was actually used.
3145
3146.cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3147If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3148name will not be output.
3149
3150.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3151.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3152If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3153directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3154respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3155sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3156written directly into the spool directory.
3157
3158If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3159.code
3160exim -bP +local_domains
3161.endd
3162it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3163local part) and outputs what it finds.
3164
3165.cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3166.cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3167.cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3168If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3169followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3170that driver are output. For example:
3171.code
3172exim -bP transport local_delivery
3173.endd
3174The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3175options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3176using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3177&%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3178settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3179&%authenticators%&.
3180
3181.cindex "environment"
3182If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3183variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3184variables.
3185
3186.cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3187If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3188are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3189for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3190The output format is one item per line.
3191For the "-bP macro <name>" form, if no such macro is found
3192the exit status will be nonzero.
3193
3194.vitem &%-bp%&
3195.oindex "&%-bp%&"
3196.cindex "queue" "listing messages in"
3197.cindex "listing" "messages in the queue"
3198This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3199standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3200just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3201admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3202to allow any user to see the queue.
3203
3204Each message in the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3205.code
320625m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3207 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3208 <other addresses>
3209.endd
3210.cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3211.cindex "size" "of message"
3212The first line contains the length of time the message has been in the queue
3213(in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3214identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3215envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3216&"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3217the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3218before the sender address.
3219
3220.cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3221If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3222&"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3223
3224The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3225displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3226been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3227expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3228displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3229complete.
3230
3231
3232.vitem &%-bpa%&
3233.oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3234This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3235that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3236alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3237of just &"D"&.
3238
3239
3240.vitem &%-bpc%&
3241.oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3242.cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3243This option counts the number of messages in the queue, and writes the total
3244to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3245&%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3246
3247
3248.vitem &%-bpr%&
3249.oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3250This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3251chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3252lots of messages in the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3253going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3254
3255.vitem &%-bpra%&
3256.oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3257This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3258
3259.vitem &%-bpru%&
3260.oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3261This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3262
3263
3264.vitem &%-bpu%&
3265.oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3266This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3267addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3268forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3269router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3270
3271
3272.vitem &%-brt%&
3273.oindex "&%-brt%&"
3274.cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3275.cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3276This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3277arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3278and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3279.code
3280exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3281Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3282.endd
3283See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3284argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3285&'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3286contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3287retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3288with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3289rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3290sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3291used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3292.code
3293exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3294Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3295.endd
3296
3297.vitem &%-brw%&
3298.oindex "&%-brw%&"
3299.cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3300.cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3301This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3302a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3303complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3304would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3305&<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3306
3307.vitem &%-bS%&
3308.oindex "&%-bS%&"
3309.cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3310.cindex "batched SMTP input"
3311This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3312for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3313submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3314input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3315input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3316&%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3317believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3318
3319The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3320dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3321provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3322
3323As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3324messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3325Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3326&%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3327
3328Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3329as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3330QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3331
3332.cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3333If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3334error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3335was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3336was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3337
3338More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3339&<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3340
3341.vitem &%-bs%&
3342.oindex "&%-bs%&"
3343.cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3344.cindex "local SMTP input"
3345This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3346on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3347policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3348Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3349messages to the MTA.
3350
3351In
3352.cindex "sender" "source of"
3353this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3354set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3355Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3356the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3357&%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3358&%-bnq%& option is used.
3359
3360.cindex "inetd"
3361The
3362&%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3363using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3364whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3365&'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3366above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3367Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3368the listening daemon.
3369
3370.vitem &%-bt%&
3371.oindex "&%-bt%&"
3372.cindex "testing" "addresses"
3373.cindex "address" "testing"
3374This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3375as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3376written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3377user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3378sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3379
3380If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3381right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3382
3383Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3384&[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3385security issues.
3386
3387Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3388(compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3389written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3390&%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3391genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3392program.
3393
3394.cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3395The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3396failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3397code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3398
3399.cindex "duplicate addresses"
3400&*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3401addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3402This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3403always shown.
3404
3405&*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3406routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3407message,
3408.oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3409you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3410&%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3411default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3412whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3413those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3414doing such tests.
3415
3416.vitem &%-bV%&
3417.oindex "&%-bV%&"
3418.cindex "version number of Exim"
3419This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3420number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3421It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3422specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3423name of the runtime configuration file that is in use.
3424
3425As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3426configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3427values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3428detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3429alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3430realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3431dynamic testing facilities.
3432
3433.vitem &%-bv%&
3434.oindex "&%-bv%&"
3435.cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3436.cindex "address" "verification"
3437This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3438taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3439not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3440happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3441(see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3442including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3443
3444If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3445failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3446usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3447
3448If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3449right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3450
3451Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3452&[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3453security issues.
3454
3455Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3456that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3457router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3458verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3459address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3460
3461If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3462address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3463latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3464causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3465addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3466and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3467to succeed.
3468
3469When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3470and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3471considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3472
3473The
3474.cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3475return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3476failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3477code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3478
3479If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3480address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3481sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3482calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3483
3484.vitem &%-bvs%&
3485.oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3486This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3487than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3488might happen.
3489
3490.vitem &%-bw%&
3491.oindex "&%-bw%&"
3492.cindex "daemon"
3493.cindex "inetd"
3494.cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3495This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3496similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3497and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3498
3499In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3500listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3501inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3502each port only when the first connection is received.
3503
3504If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3505which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3506
3507.vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3508.oindex "&%-C%&"
3509.cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3510.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3511.cindex "alternate configuration file"
3512This option causes Exim to find the runtime configuration file from the given
3513list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3514compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single filename,
3515but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3516file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3517proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3518
3519When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3520from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3521runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3522However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3523file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3524which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3525listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3526CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3527not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3528
3529Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3530configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3531even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3532running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3533delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3534test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3535in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3536
3537If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3538prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3539must start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3540However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3541CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3542usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3543unset, any filename can be used with &%-C%&.
3544
3545ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3546to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3547broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3548configuration file.
3549
3550The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3551syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3552caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3553require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3554specified by this option.
3555
3556
3557.vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3558.oindex "&%-D%&"
3559.cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3560This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3561(see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3562unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3563If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3564completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3565
3566If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3567colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3568supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3569not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3570the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3571to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3572regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3573
3574The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3575command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3576string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3577synonymous:
3578.code
3579exim -DABC ...
3580exim -DABC= ...
3581.endd
3582To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3583quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3584example:
3585.code
3586exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3587.endd
3588&%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3589Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3590
3591
3592.vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3593.oindex "&%-d%&"
3594.cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3595.cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3596This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3597error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3598database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3599filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3600writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3601return code.
3602
3603When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3604standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3605some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3606made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3607of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3608debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3609no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3610are:
3611.display
3612&`acl `& ACL interpretation
3613&`auth `& authenticators
3614&`deliver `& general delivery logic
3615&`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3616&`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3617&`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3618&`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3619&`filter `& filter handling
3620&`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3621&`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3622&`ident `& ident lookup
3623&`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3624&`lists `& matching things in lists
3625&`load `& system load checks
3626&`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3627 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3628&`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3629&`memory `& memory handling
3630&`noutf8 `& modifier: avoid UTF-8 line-drawing
3631&`pid `& modifier: add pid to debug output lines
3632&`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3633&`queue_run `& queue runs
3634&`receive `& general message reception logic
3635&`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3636&`retry `& retry handling
3637&`rewrite `& address rewriting
3638&`route `& address routing
3639&`timestamp `& modifier: add timestamp to debug output lines
3640&`tls `& TLS logic
3641&`transport `& transports
3642&`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3643&`verify `& address verification logic
3644&`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3645.endd
3646The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3647for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3648tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3649is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3650generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3651turn everything off.
3652
3653.cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3654.cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3655The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3656with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3657unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3658rather than stderr.
3659
3660The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3661&`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3662However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3663daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3664automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3665run in parallel.
3666
3667The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3668of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3669in processing.
3670
3671.cindex debugging "UTF-8 in"
3672.cindex UTF-8 "in debug output"
3673The &`noutf8`& selector disables the use of
3674UTF-8 line-drawing characters to group related information.
3675When disabled. ascii-art is used instead.
3676Using the &`+all`& option does not set this modifier,
3677
3678If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3679any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3680
3681.vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3682.oindex "&%-dd%&"
3683This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3684starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3685subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3686behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3687
3688.vitem &%-dropcr%&
3689.oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3690This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3691handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3692described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3693
3694.vitem &%-E%&
3695.oindex "&%-E%&"
3696.cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3697This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3698failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3699and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3700generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3701could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3702follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3703new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3704
3705.vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3706.oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3707There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3708called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3709example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3710form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3711
3712.vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3713.oindex "&%-F%&"
3714.cindex "sender" "name"
3715.cindex "name" "of sender"
3716This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3717message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3718entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3719their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3720between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3721
3722.vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3723.oindex "&%-f%&"
3724.cindex "sender" "address"
3725.cindex "address" "sender"
3726.cindex "trusted users"
3727.cindex "envelope from"
3728.cindex "envelope sender"
3729.cindex "user" "trusted"
3730This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3731message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3732by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3733users to use it.
3734
3735Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3736trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3737options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3738of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3739domain.
3740
3741There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3742can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3743never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3744string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3745examples of shell commands:
3746.code
3747exim -f '<>' user@domain
3748exim -f "" user@domain
3749.endd
3750In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3751with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3752&%-bv%& options.
3753
3754Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3755it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3756refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3757though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3758
3759White
3760.cindex "&""From""& line"
3761space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3762given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3763locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3764&"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3765if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3766
3767.vitem &%-G%&
3768.oindex "&%-G%&"
3769.cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3770This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3771.code
3772control = suppress_local_fixups
3773.endd
3774for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3775bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3776in future.
3777
3778As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3779this option.
3780
3781.vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3782.oindex "&%-h%&"
3783.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3784This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3785Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3786headers.)
3787
3788.vitem &%-i%&
3789.oindex "&%-i%&"
3790.cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3791.cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3792This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3793line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3794no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3795command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3796
3797.vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3798.oindex "&%-L%&"
3799.cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3800This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3801file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3802Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3803read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3804effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3805
3806The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3807
3808.vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3809.oindex "&%-M%&"
3810.cindex "forcing delivery"
3811.cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3812.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3813This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3814any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3815delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3816and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3817
3818Retry
3819.cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3820hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3821the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3822to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3823which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3824for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3825
3826The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3827not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3828produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3829use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3830
3831.vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3832.oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3833.cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3834.cindex "recipient" "adding"
3835This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3836message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3837id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3838active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3839can be used only by an admin user.
3840
3841.vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3842 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3843.oindex "&%-MC%&"
3844.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3845.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3846.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3847This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3848by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3849an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3850given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3851must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3852
3853.vitem &%-MCA%&
3854.oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3855This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3856by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3857connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3858
3859.vitem &%-MCD%&
3860.oindex "&%-MCD%&"
3861This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3862by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3863remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3864
3865.vitem &%-MCG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>
3866.oindex "&%-MCG%&"
3867This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3868by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3869alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3870
3871.vitem &%-MCK%&
3872.oindex "&%-MCK%&"
3873This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3874by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that a
3875remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3876
3877.vitem &%-MCP%&
3878.oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3879This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3880by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3881which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3882
3883.vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3884.oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3885This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3886by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3887started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3888together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3889signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3890messages through the same SMTP connection.
3891
3892.vitem &%-MCS%&
3893.oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3894This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3895by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3896SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3897connection.
3898
3899.vitem &%-MCT%&
3900.oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3901This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3902by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3903host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3904
3905.vitem &%-MCt%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
3906.oindex "&%-MCt%&"
3907This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3908by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3909connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
3910The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
3911
3912.vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3913.oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3914.cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3915.cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3916This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message, in turn,
3917but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3918that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3919provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3920order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3921However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3922respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3923overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3924If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3925&%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3926and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3927
3928.vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3929.oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3930.cindex "message" "changing sender"
3931.cindex "sender" "changing"
3932This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3933given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3934&"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3935be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3936is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3937This option can be used only by an admin user.
3938
3939.vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3940.oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3941.cindex "freezing messages"
3942.cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3943This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3944prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3945either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3946However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3947attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3948user.
3949
3950.vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3951.oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3952.cindex "giving up on messages"
3953.cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3954.cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3955This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3956including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3957their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3958is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3959Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3960user.
3961
3962.vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3963.oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3964.cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3965This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3966as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3967message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3968altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3969
3970.vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3971.oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3972.cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3973.cindex "recipient" "removing"
3974.cindex "removing recipients"
3975This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3976(&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3977the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3978addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3979(in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3980can be used only by an admin user.
3981
3982.vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3983.oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
3984.cindex "removing messages"
3985.cindex "abandoning mail"
3986.cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3987This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3988bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3989the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3990only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3991placed in the queue.
3992
3993. .new
3994. .vitem &%-MS%&
3995. .oindex "&%-MS%&"
3996. .cindex REQUIRETLS
3997. This option is used to request REQUIRETLS processing on the message.
3998. It is used internally by Exim in conjunction with -E when generating
3999. a bounce message.
4000. .wen
4001
4002.vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4003.oindex "&%-Mset%&"
4004.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
4005.cindex "expansion" "testing"
4006This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
4007string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
4008the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
4009&$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
4010available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
4011make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
4012user. See also &%-bem%&.
4013
4014.vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4015.oindex "&%-Mt%&"
4016.cindex "thawing messages"
4017.cindex "unfreezing messages"
4018.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
4019.cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
4020This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
4021&"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
4022messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
4023by an admin user.
4024
4025.vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4026.oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
4027.cindex "listing" "message body"
4028.cindex "message" "listing body of"
4029This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
4030written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4031
4032.vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4033.oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
4034.cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
4035.cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
4036This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
4037be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
4038only by an admin user.
4039
4040.vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4041.oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
4042.cindex "listing" "message headers"
4043.cindex "header lines" "listing"
4044.cindex "message" "listing header lines"
4045This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
4046written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4047
4048.vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4049.oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
4050.cindex "listing" "message log"
4051.cindex "message" "listing message log"
4052This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4053the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4054
4055.vitem &%-m%&
4056.oindex "&%-m%&"
4057This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
4058treats it that way too.
4059
4060.vitem &%-N%&
4061.oindex "&%-N%&"
4062.cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4063.cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4064This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4065level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4066it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4067had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4068database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4069than &"=>"&.
4070
4071Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4072user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4073words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4074which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4075address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4076routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4077the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4078for that message.
4079
4080.vitem &%-n%&
4081.oindex "&%-n%&"
4082This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4083For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4084When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4085option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4086
4087.vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4088.oindex "&%-O%&"
4089This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4090Exim.
4091
4092.vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4093.oindex "&%-oA%&"
4094.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4095This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4096alternative alias filename. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4097description above.
4098
4099.vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4100.oindex "&%-oB%&"
4101.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4102.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4103.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4104This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4105be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4106transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4107
4108.vitem &%-odb%&
4109.oindex "&%-odb%&"
4110.cindex "background delivery"
4111.cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4112This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4113including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4114messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4115delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4116processes to finish.
4117
4118When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4119leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4120and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4121This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4122
4123If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4124(&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4125overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4126setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4127
4128.vitem &%-odf%&
4129.oindex "&%-odf%&"
4130.cindex "foreground delivery"
4131.cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4132This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4133accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4134&%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4135and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4136
4137The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4138process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4139during deliveries.
4140
4141However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4142false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4143
4144If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4145message is left in the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4146process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4147restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4148
4149
4150.vitem &%-odi%&
4151.oindex "&%-odi%&"
4152This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4153Sendmail.
4154
4155.vitem &%-odq%&
4156.oindex "&%-odq%&"
4157.cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4158.cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4159.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4160This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4161including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4162not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4163are placed in the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4164process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4165&%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4166conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4167forces queueing.
4168
4169.vitem &%-odqs%&
4170.oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4171.cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4172This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4173However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4174&%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4175configuration file is in effect.
4176
4177When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4178message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4179also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4180in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4181done at this time, so the message remains in the queue until a subsequent queue
4182runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4183messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4184host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4185configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4186&%-qq%& option.
4187
4188.vitem &%-oee%&
4189.oindex "&%-oee%&"
4190.cindex "error" "reporting"
4191If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4192example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4193message.
4194
4195.cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4196Provided
4197this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4198exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4199is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4200This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4201
4202.vitem &%-oem%&
4203.oindex "&%-oem%&"
4204.cindex "error" "reporting"
4205.cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4206This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4207return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4208This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4209
4210.vitem &%-oep%&
4211.oindex "&%-oep%&"
4212.cindex "error" "reporting"
4213If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4214error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4215.cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4216The return code is 1 for all errors.
4217
4218.vitem &%-oeq%&
4219.oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4220.cindex "error" "reporting"
4221This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4222effect as &%-oep%&.
4223
4224.vitem &%-oew%&
4225.oindex "&%-oew%&"
4226.cindex "error" "reporting"
4227This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4228effect as &%-oem%&.
4229
4230.vitem &%-oi%&
4231.oindex "&%-oi%&"
4232.cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4233This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4234line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4235single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4236lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4237&'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4238
4239.vitem &%-oitrue%&
4240.oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4241This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4242
4243.vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4244.oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4245.cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4246A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4247with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4248over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4249&%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4250other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4251
4252The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4253number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4254.code
4255exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4256.endd
4257An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4258followed by a colon and the port number:
4259.code
4260exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4261.endd
4262The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4263port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4264are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4265whichever one is last.
4266
4267.vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4268.oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4269.cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4270See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4271option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4272name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4273This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4274authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4275
4276.vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4277.oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4278.cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4279See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4280option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4281This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4282where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4283&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4284
4285.vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4286.oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4287.cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4288See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4289option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4290overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4291messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4292default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4293specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4294&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4295
4296.vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4297.oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4298.cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4299See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4300option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4301using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4302&$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4303
4304.vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4305.oindex "&%-oMm%&"
4306.cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4307See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4308option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4309delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4310messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4311abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4312running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4313
4314The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4315The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4316is sending the bounce.
4317
4318.vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4319.oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4320.cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4321.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4322See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4323option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4324&$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4325or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4326SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4327&<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4328one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4329be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4330
4331.vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4332.oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4333.cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4334See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4335option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4336present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4337uses the name it is given.
4338
4339.vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4340.oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4341.cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4342See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4343option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4344local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4345used, when there is no default.
4346
4347.vitem &%-om%&
4348.oindex "&%-om%&"
4349.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4350In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4351message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4352expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4353
4354.vitem &%-oo%&
4355.oindex "&%-oo%&"
4356.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4357This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4358whatever that means.
4359
4360.vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4361.oindex "&%-oP%&"
4362.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4363.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4364This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4365value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4366written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4367without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4368because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4369
4370.vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4371.oindex "&%-or%&"
4372.cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4373This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4374set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4375by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4376described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4377
4378.vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4379.oindex "&%-os%&"
4380.cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4381.cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4382This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4383applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4384the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4385for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4386
4387.vitem &%-ov%&
4388.oindex "&%-ov%&"
4389This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4390
4391.vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4392.oindex "&%-oX%&"
4393.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4394.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4395.cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4396This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4397is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4398of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4399in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4400file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid filename.
4401
4402.vitem &%-pd%&
4403.oindex "&%-pd%&"
4404.cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4405This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4406chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4407option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4408needed.
4409
4410.vitem &%-ps%&
4411.oindex "&%-ps%&"
4412.cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4413This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4414chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4415option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4416started.
4417
4418.vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4419.oindex "&%-p%&"
4420For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4421.display
4422&`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4423.endd
4424It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4425host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4426Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4427to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4428or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4429Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4430
4431.vitem &%-q%&
4432.oindex "&%-q%&"
4433.cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4434This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4435configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4436relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4437and &%-S%& options).
4438
4439.cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4440If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4441the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4442waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4443for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4444process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4445have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4446
4447If
4448.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4449.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4450.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4451the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4452passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4453proceeding.
4454
4455When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4456process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4457mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4458this to be repeated periodically.
4459
4460Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4461random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4462If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4463MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4464
4465It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4466order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4467&%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4468
4469.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4470The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4471behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4472appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4473
4474.vitem &%-qq...%&
4475.oindex "&%-qq%&"
4476.cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4477.cindex "queue" "routing"
4478.cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4479An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4480stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4481every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4482transports are run.
4483
4484.cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4485The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4486is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4487complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4488place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4489delivered down a single SMTP
4490.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4491.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4492.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4493connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4494This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4495intermittently.
4496
4497.vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4498.oindex "&%-qi%&"
4499.cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4500If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4501those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4502delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages in the queue using
4503&%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4504
4505.vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4506.oindex "&%-qf%&"
4507.cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4508.cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4509If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4510message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4511their retry times are tried.
4512
4513.vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4514.oindex "&%-qff%&"
4515.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4516If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4517frozen or not.
4518
4519.vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4520.oindex "&%-ql%&"
4521.cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4522The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4523be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains in the queue
4524for later delivery.
4525
4526.vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4527.oindex "&%-qG%&"
4528.cindex queue named
4529.cindex "named queues"
4530.cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4531If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4532queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4533The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4534For a periodic queue run (see below)
4535append to the name a slash and a time value.
4536
4537If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4538will specify a queue to operate on.
4539For example:
4540.code
4541exim -bp -qGquarantine
4542mailq -qGquarantine
4543exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4544.endd
4545
4546.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4547When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4548lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4549starting message id. For example:
4550.code
4551exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4552.endd
4553Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4554second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4555are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4556.code
4557exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4558.endd
4559just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4560&%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4561that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4562mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4563are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4564queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4565
4566.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4567.cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4568.cindex "periodic queue running"
4569When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4570starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4571(whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4572&%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4573single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4574combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4575.code
4576/usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4577.endd
4578Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4579process every 30 minutes.
4580
4581When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4582pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4583
4584.vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4585.oindex "&%-qR%&"
4586This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4587compatibility.
4588
4589.vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4590.oindex "&%-qS%&"
4591This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4592
4593.vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4594.oindex "&%-R%&"
4595.cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4596.cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4597.cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4598The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4599is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4600which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4601<&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4602
4603This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4604perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4605queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4606address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4607way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4608regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4609
4610If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4611you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4612.code
4613exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4614.endd
4615This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4616every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4617applied to each queue run.
4618
4619Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4620are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4621information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4622means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4623existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4624address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4625will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4626information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4627address will be skipped.
4628
4629.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4630If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4631all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4632&'ff'& is present.
4633
4634The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4635to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4636command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4637effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4638an arbitrary command instead.
4639
4640.vitem &%-r%&
4641.oindex "&%-r%&"
4642This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4643
4644.vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4645.oindex "&%-S%&"
4646.cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4647.cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4648This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4649message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4650conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4651has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4652
4653.vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4654.oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4655This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4656recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4657&"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4658
4659.vitem &%-t%&
4660.oindex "&%-t%&"
4661.cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4662.cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4663.cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4664.cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4665When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4666input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4667from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4668from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4669takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4670
4671.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4672If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4673is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4674the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4675and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4676Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4677Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4678argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4679Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4680instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4681&%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4682
4683.cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4684If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4685recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4686lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4687with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4688&%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4689
4690RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4691message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4692added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4693not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4694nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4695In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4696are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4697once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4698&%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4699
4700.vitem &%-ti%&
4701.oindex "&%-ti%&"
4702This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4703compatibility with Sendmail.
4704
4705.vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4706.oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4707.cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4708.cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4709This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4710incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4711&%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4712&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4713
4714
4715.vitem &%-U%&
4716.oindex "&%-U%&"
4717.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4718Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4719documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4720syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4721set. Exim ignores this option.
4722
4723.vitem &%-v%&
4724.oindex "&%-v%&"
4725This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4726describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4727receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4728dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4729the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4730selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4731unconditional.
4732
4733.vitem &%-x%&
4734.oindex "&%-x%&"
4735AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4736National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4737It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4738this option.
4739
4740.vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4741.oindex "&%-X%&"
4742This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4743to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4744
4745.vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4746.oindex "&%-z%&"
4747This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4748Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4749Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4750under most shells.
4751.endlist
4752
4753.ecindex IIDclo1
4754.ecindex IIDclo2
4755
4756
4757. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4758. Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4759. line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4760. creates a man page for the options.
4761. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4762
4763.literal xml
4764<!-- === End of command line options === -->
4765.literal off
4766
4767
4768
4769
4770
4771. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4772. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4773
4774
4775.chapter "The Exim runtime configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4776 "The runtime configuration file"
4777
4778.cindex "runtime configuration"
4779.cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4780.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4781.cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4782.cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4783.cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4784Exim uses a single runtime configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4785binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4786because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4787control.
4788
4789If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4790writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4791The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4792errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4793not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4794actually alter the string.
4795
4796The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4797reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4798most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4799give a colon-separated list of filenames, in which case Exim uses the first
4800existing file in the list.
4801
4802.cindex "EXIM_USER"
4803.cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4804.cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4805.cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4806.cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4807.cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4808The runtime configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4809specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4810configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4811group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4812CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4813
4814&*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4815to root, anybody who is able to edit the runtime configuration file has an
4816easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4817CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4818who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4819
4820Up to Exim version 4.72, the runtime configuration file was also permitted to
4821be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4822since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4823compromise the Exim user account.
4824
4825A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4826is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4827defines just one filename, the installation process copies the default
4828configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4829CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4830&<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4831configuration.
4832
4833
4834
4835.section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4836.cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4837A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4838option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4839&%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4840unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4841CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4842is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4843is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4844installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4845specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4846
4847Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4848with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4849listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4850testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4851delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4852Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4853the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4854can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4855message in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4856&%-M%&).
4857
4858If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4859prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4860start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4861There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any
4862filename can be used with &%-C%&.
4863
4864One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4865option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4866configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4867non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4868If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4869completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4870
4871The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4872to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4873necessarily be discarded.
4874WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4875considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4876values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4877is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4878transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4879values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4880
4881Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4882share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4883If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4884looks for a file whose name is the configuration filename followed by a dot
4885and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4886file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4887each filename in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4888
4889In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4890different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4891help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4892
4893
4894
4895.section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4896.cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4897.cindex "format" "configuration file"
4898Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4899option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4900are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4901is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4902space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4903
4904.ilist
4905&'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4906&<<CHAPACL>>&).
4907.next
4908.cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4909&'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4910are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4911.next
4912&'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4913addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4914&<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4915.next
4916&'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4917define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4918&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4919.next
4920&'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4921If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4922defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4923are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4924&<<CHAPretry>>&.
4925.next
4926&'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4927when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4928chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4929.next
4930&'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4931want to use this feature, you must set
4932.code
4933LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4934.endd
4935in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4936facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4937.endlist
4938
4939.cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4940.cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4941.cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4942Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4943
4944Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4945leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4946# character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4947and does not introduce a comment.
4948
4949Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4950the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4951backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4952lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4953appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4954
4955A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4956default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4957change settings as required.
4958
4959The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4960described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4961respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4962items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4963onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4964described.
4965
4966
4967
4968.section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4969.cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4970.cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4971.cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4972.cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4973You can include other files inside Exim's runtime configuration file by
4974using this syntax:
4975.display
4976&`.include`& <&'filename'&>
4977&`.include_if_exists`& <&'filename'&>
4978.endd
4979on a line by itself. Double quotes round the filename are optional. If you use
4980the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4981second form does nothing for non-existent files.
4982The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
4983the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute filename
4984is required.
4985
4986Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4987configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4988If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4989because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4990
4991The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4992comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4993for example:
4994.code
4995hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4996 .include /some/file
4997.endd
4998Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4999process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
5000inclusion appears.
5001
5002
5003
5004.section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
5005.cindex "macro" "description of"
5006.cindex "configuration file" "macros"
5007If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
5008&"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
5009definition, and must be of the form
5010.display
5011<&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
5012.endd
5013The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
5014in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
5015continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
5016space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
5017a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
5018
5019Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
5020definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
5021ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
5022
5023.section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
5024Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
5025files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
5026scanned for each, in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
5027replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
5028for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
5029the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
5030define
5031.display
5032&`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
5033&`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
5034.endd
5035but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
5036error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
5037before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
5038consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
5039line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
5040comment line or a &`.include`& line.
5041
5042
5043.section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
5044Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
5045(or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5046&'='&. For example:
5047.code
5048MAC = initial value
5049...
5050MAC == updated value
5051.endd
5052Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5053subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5054the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5055Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5056.code
5057MAC = initial value
5058...
5059MAC == MAC and something added
5060.endd
5061This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5062from a number of other files.
5063
5064.section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5065The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5066&%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5067used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5068using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5069file to be ignored.
5070
5071
5072
5073.section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5074As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5075up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5076strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5077.code
5078ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5079 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5080.endd
5081This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5082.code
5083data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5084.endd
5085In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5086address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5087section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5088
5089
5090.section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5091Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5092differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5093All of these macros start with an underscore.
5094They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5095(see below).
5096
5097The following classes of macros are defined:
5098.display
5099&` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5100&` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5101&` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5102&` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5103&` _LOG_* `& log_selector values
5104&` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5105&` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5106&` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5107&` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5108&` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5109&` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5110&` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5111.endd
5112
5113Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5114
5115
5116.section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5117.cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5118.cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5119You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5120&`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5121portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5122read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5123
5124The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5125be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5126that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5127line. Thus:
5128.code
5129.ifdef AAA
5130message_size_limit = 50M
5131.else
5132message_size_limit = 100M
5133.endif
5134.endd
5135sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5136(or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5137otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5138is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5139obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5140
5141Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5142it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5143in this line"& will always be true.
5144
5145Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5146to clarify complicated nestings.
5147
5148
5149
5150.section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5151.cindex "common option syntax"
5152.cindex "syntax of common options"
5153.cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5154For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5155each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5156lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5157these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5158space) and then the value. For example:
5159.code
5160qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5161.endd
5162.cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5163.cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5164.cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5165Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5166accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5167line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5168word &"hide"&. For example:
5169.code
5170hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5171.endd
5172For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5173.code
5174mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5175.endd
5176If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5177all instances of the same driver.
5178
5179The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5180that are found in option settings.
5181
5182
5183.section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5184.cindex "format" "boolean"
5185.cindex "boolean configuration values"
5186.oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5187.oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5188Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5189different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5190the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5191if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5192boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5193&"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5194the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5195.code
5196queue_only
5197queue_only = true
5198.endd
5199The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5200.code
5201no_queue_only
5202queue_only = false
5203.endd
5204You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5205
5206
5207
5208
5209.section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5210.cindex "integer configuration values"
5211.cindex "format" "integer"
5212If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5213hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5214number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5215with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5216hexadecimal number.
5217
5218If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5219it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5220if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5221When the values
5222of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
52231024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5224and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5225used.
5226
5227
5228.section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5229.cindex "integer format"
5230.cindex "format" "octal integer"
5231If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5232interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5233Such options are always output in octal.
5234
5235
5236.section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5237.cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5238.cindex "format" "fixed point"
5239If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5240integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5241
5242
5243
5244.section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5245.cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5246.cindex "format" "time interval"
5247A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5248the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5249
5250.table2 30pt
5251.irow &%s%& seconds
5252.irow &%m%& minutes
5253.irow &%h%& hours
5254.irow &%d%& days
5255.irow &%w%& weeks
5256.endtable
5257
5258For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5259intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5260is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5261
5262
5263
5264.section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5265.cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5266.cindex "format" "string"
5267If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5268or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5269consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5270the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5271removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5272Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5273appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5274therefore equivalent:
5275.code
5276trusted_users = uucp:mail
5277trusted_users = uucp:\
5278 # This comment line is ignored
5279 mail
5280.endd
5281.cindex "string" "quoted"
5282.cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5283If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5284double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5285continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5286
5287.table2 100pt
5288.irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5289.irow &`\n`& "newline"
5290.irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5291.irow &`\t`& "tab"
5292.irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5293.irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5294 character"
5295.endtable
5296
5297If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5298character, that character replaces the pair.
5299
5300Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5301insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5302trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5303current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5304in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5305and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5306
5307
5308.section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5309.cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5310Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5311by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5312circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5313is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5314strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5315However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5316backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5317within a quoted configuration string.
5318
5319
5320.section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5321.cindex "user name" "format of"
5322.cindex "format" "user name"
5323.cindex "groups" "name format"
5324.cindex "format" "group name"
5325User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5326above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5327either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5328&[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5329
5330
5331.section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5332.cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5333.cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5334.cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5335The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5336default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5337the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5338&"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5339are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5340particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5341&<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5342
5343In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5344input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5345&<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5346in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5347on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5348start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5349example, the list
5350.code
5351local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5352.endd
5353contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5354
5355&*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5356list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5357colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5358be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5359
5360.section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5361.cindex "list separator" "changing"
5362.cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5363Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5364introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5365with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5366character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5367above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5368.code
5369local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5370.endd
5371This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5372&%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5373confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5374
5375.cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5376.cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5377It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5378code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5379must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5380are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5381sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5382interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5383generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5384.code
5385domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5386.endd
5387This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5388to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5389expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5390the value in quotes. For example:
5391.code
5392local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5393.endd
5394Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5395doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5396set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5397enclosing an empty list item.
5398
5399
5400
5401.section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5402.cindex "list" "empty item in"
5403An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5404separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5405.code
5406senders = user@domain :
5407.endd
5408contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5409in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5410items, the second of which is empty:
5411.code
5412senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5413.endd
5414&*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5415are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5416would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5417just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5418.code
5419senders = :
5420.endd
5421In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5422is at the end of the list.
5423
5424
5425
5426
5427.section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5428.cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5429There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5430and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5431instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5432a sequence of lines like this:
5433.display
5434<&'instance name'&>:
5435 <&'option'&>
5436 ...
5437 <&'option'&>
5438.endd
5439In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5440followed by three options settings:
5441.code
5442localuser:
5443 driver = accept
5444 check_local_user
5445 transport = local_delivery
5446.endd
5447For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5448setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5449settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5450deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5451a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5452described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5453
5454You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5455the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5456
5457The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5458passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5459transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5460authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5461them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5462server.
5463
5464.cindex "generic options"
5465.cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5466Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5467and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5468same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5469&%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5470.cindex "private options"
5471The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5472they all have default values.
5473
5474The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5475precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5476this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5477
5478Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5479elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5480with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5481a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5482instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5483confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5484configuration lines:
5485.code
5486remote_smtp:
5487 driver = smtp
5488.endd
5489create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5490&(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5491different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5492instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5493thus:
5494.code
5495special_smtp:
5496 driver = smtp
5497 port = 1234
5498 command_timeout = 10s
5499.endd
5500The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5501these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5502lines.
5503
5504Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5505list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5506defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5507option.
5508
5509
5510
5511
5512
5513
5514. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5515. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5516
5517.chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5518.scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5519.cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5520The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5521is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5522the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5523configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5524of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5525itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5526initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5527mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5528
5529
5530
5531.section "Macros" "SECTdefconfmacros"
5532All macros should be defined before any options.
5533
5534One macro is specified, but commented out, in the default configuration:
5535.code
5536# ROUTER_SMARTHOST=MAIL.HOSTNAME.FOR.CENTRAL.SERVER.EXAMPLE
5537.endd
5538If all off-site mail is expected to be delivered to a "smarthost", then set the
5539hostname here and uncomment the macro. This will affect which router is used
5540later on. If this is left commented out, then Exim will perform direct-to-MX
5541deliveries using a &(dnslookup)& router.
5542
5543In addition to macros defined here, Exim includes a number of built-in macros
5544to enable configuration to be guarded by a binary built with support for a
5545given feature. See section &<<SECTbuiltinmacros>>& for more details.
5546
5547
5548.section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5549The main (global) configuration option settings section must always come first
5550in the file, after the macros.
5551The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is the line
5552.code
5553# primary_hostname =
5554.endd
5555This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5556to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5557can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5558it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5559
5560The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5561.code
5562domainlist local_domains = @
5563domainlist relay_to_domains =
5564hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5565.endd
5566These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5567domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5568domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5569configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5570
5571The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5572later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5573on the local host.
5574
5575.cindex "@ in a domain list"
5576There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5577of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5578called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5579be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5580the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5581
5582The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5583list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5584controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5585domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5586domain is permitted.
5587
5588The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5589used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5590that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5591loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5592submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5593hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5594
5595Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5596we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5597and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5598
5599The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5600.code
5601acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5602acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5603.endd
5604These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5605during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5606command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5607respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5608&'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5609section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5610accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5611to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5612contents of a message to be checked.
5613
5614Two commented-out option settings are next:
5615.code
5616# av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5617# spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5618.endd
5619These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5620content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5621scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5622details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5623
5624Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5625.code
5626# tls_advertise_hosts = *
5627# tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5628# tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5629.endd
5630These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5631support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5632first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5633connecting to this server; in this case, the wildcard means all clients. The
5634other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5635key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5636More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5637
5638Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5639.code
5640# daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5641# tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5642.endd
5643.cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5644.cindex "port" "for message submission"
5645.cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5646.cindex "submissions protocol"
5647.cindex "smtps protocol"
5648.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5649.cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
5650.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5651.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5652These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5653server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5654TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5655more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&).
5656Mail submission from mail clients (MUAs) should be separate from inbound mail
5657to your domain (MX delivery) for various good reasons (eg, ability to impose
5658much saner TLS protocol and ciphersuite requirements without unintended
5659consequences).
5660RFC 6409 (previously 4409) specifies use of port 587 for SMTP Submission,
5661which uses STARTTLS, so this is the &"submission"& port.
5662RFC 8314 specifies use of port 465 as the &"submissions"& protocol,
5663which should be used in preference to 587.
5664You should also consider deploying SRV records to help clients find
5665these ports.
5666Older names for &"submissions"& are &"smtps"& and &"ssmtp"&.
5667
5668Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5669.code
5670# qualify_domain =
5671# qualify_recipient =
5672.endd
5673The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5674complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5675receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5676the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5677you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5678addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5679
5680.cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5681The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5682addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5683(an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5684.code
5685# allow_domain_literals
5686.endd
5687The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5688Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5689quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5690try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5691people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5692&'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5693
5694The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5695.code
5696never_users = root
5697.endd
5698It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5699convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5700setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5701The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5702list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5703FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5704contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5705FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5706
5707When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5708Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5709line,
5710.code
5711host_lookup = *
5712.endd
5713specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5714in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5715information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5716or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5717Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5718because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5719unreachable.
5720
5721The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
57221413 (hence their names):
5723.code
5724rfc1413_hosts = *
5725rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5726.endd
5727These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5728Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5729terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5730of an incoming SMTP connection.
5731If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5732information, you can change this.
5733
5734This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5735and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5736.code
5737prdr_enable = true
5738.endd
5739
5740When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5741be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5742if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5743find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5744.code
5745# sender_unqualified_hosts =
5746# recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5747.endd
5748show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5749and recipient addresses, respectively.
5750
5751The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5752over the default:
5753.code
5754log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5755 +tls_certificate_verified
5756.endd
5757
5758The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5759.code
5760# percent_hack_domains =
5761.endd
5762It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5763This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5764anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5765
5766The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5767concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5768message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5769occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5770address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5771bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5772are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5773always bounce messages.
5774.code
5775ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5776timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5777.endd
5778The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5779discarded after 2 days in the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5780message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5781after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5782bounce message ever lasts a week.
5783
5784Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5785large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5786directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5787many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5788Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5789not often needed).
5790.code
5791# split_spool_directory = true
5792.endd
5793
5794In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5795messages RFC 2047 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5796characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5797violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5798In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5799problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5800check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5801.code
5802# check_rfc2047_length = false
5803.endd
5804
5805If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
58068BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5807that are not 8-bit clean.
5808.code
5809# accept_8bitmime = false
5810.endd
5811
5812Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5813imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5814&%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5815&%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5816Note that TZ is handled separately, by the $%timezone%$ runtime
5817option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5818.code
5819# keep_environment = ^LDAP
5820# add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5821.endd
5822
5823
5824.section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5825.cindex "default" "ACLs"
5826.cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5827In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5828It starts with the line
5829.code
5830begin acl
5831.endd
5832and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5833&'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5834and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5835
5836.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5837The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5838RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5839are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5840rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5841result of the ACL processing.
5842.code
5843acl_check_rcpt:
5844.endd
5845This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5846ACL, and names it.
5847.code
5848accept hosts = :
5849.endd
5850This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5851But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5852names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5853list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5854host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5855important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5856
5857What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5858messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5859input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5860manner.
5861.code
5862deny message = Restricted characters in address
5863 domains = +local_domains
5864 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5865
5866deny message = Restricted characters in address
5867 domains = !+local_domains
5868 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5869.endd
5870These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5871characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5872Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5873&"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5874in Internet mail addresses.
5875
5876The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5877addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5878option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5879in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5880programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5881at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5882characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5883policy of being as safe as possible.
5884
5885The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5886to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5887first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5888&'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5889reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5890&'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5891
5892The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5893block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5894or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5895have to modify this rule.
5896
5897Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5898allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5899common convention of local parts constructed as
5900&"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5901the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5902with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5903filename (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5904that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5905is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5906
5907The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5908allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5909and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5910with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5911local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5912and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5913(or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5914.code
5915accept local_parts = postmaster
5916 domains = +local_domains
5917.endd
5918This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5919local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5920&'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5921reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5922&'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5923
5924The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5925by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5926in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5927.code
5928require verify = sender
5929.endd
5930This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5931ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5932address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5933see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5934addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5935used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5936discusses the details of address verification.
5937.code
5938accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5939 control = submission
5940.endd
5941This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5942hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5943verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5944that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5945second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5946is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5947messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5948&'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5949probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5950.code
5951accept authenticated = *
5952 control = submission
5953.endd
5954This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5955Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5956likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5957authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5958examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5959fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5960.code
5961require message = relay not permitted
5962 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5963.endd
5964This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5965one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5966.code
5967require verify = recipient
5968.endd
5969This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5970fails, the address is rejected.
5971.code
5972# deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5973# is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5974# $dnslist_text
5975# dnslists = black.list.example
5976#
5977# warn dnslists = black.list.example
5978# add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5979# a black list at $dnslist_domain
5980# log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5981.endd
5982These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5983sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5984from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5985line.
5986.code
5987# require verify = csa
5988.endd
5989This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5990authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5991records.
5992.code
5993accept
5994.endd
5995The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5996address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5997.code
5998acl_check_data:
5999.endd
6000This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
6001of this ACL are commented out:
6002.code
6003# deny malware = *
6004# message = This message contains a virus \
6005# ($malware_name).
6006.endd
6007These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
6008viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
6009suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
6010virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
6011.code
6012# warn spam = nobody
6013# message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
6014# X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
6015# X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
6016# X-Spam_report: $spam_report
6017.endd
6018These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
6019SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
6020and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
6021&`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
6022series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
6023whatever the spam score.
6024.code
6025accept
6026.endd
6027This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
6028
6029
6030.section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
6031.cindex "default" "routers"
6032.cindex "routers" "default"
6033The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
6034by the line
6035.code
6036begin routers
6037.endd
6038Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
6039messages. An address is passed to each router, in turn, until it is either
6040accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
6041matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
6042manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
6043.code
6044# domain_literal:
6045# driver = ipliteral
6046# domains = !+local_domains
6047# transport = remote_smtp
6048.endd
6049.cindex "domain literal" "default router"
6050This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
6051support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
6052you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
6053&%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
6054
6055Which router is used next depends upon whether or not the ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6056macro has been defined, per
6057.code
6058.ifdef ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6059smarthost:
6060#...
6061.else
6062dnslookup:
6063#...
6064.endif
6065.endd
6066
6067If ROUTER_SMARTHOST has been defined, either at the top of the file or on the
6068command-line, then we route all non-local mail to that smarthost; otherwise, we'll
6069perform DNS lookups for direct-to-MX lookup. Any mail which is to a local domain will
6070skip these routers because of the &%domains%& option.
6071
6072.code
6073smarthost:
6074 driver = manualroute
6075 domains = ! +local_domains
6076 transport = smarthost_smtp
6077 route_data = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6078 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0.0.0.0 ; 127.0.0.0/8 ; ::1
6079 no_more
6080.endd
6081This router only handles mail which is not to any local domains; this is
6082specified by the line
6083.code
6084domains = ! +local_domains
6085.endd
6086The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
6087exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
6088that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
6089the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
6090indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
6091passed on to the following routers.
6092
6093The name of the router driver is &(manualroute)& because we are manually
6094specifying how mail should be routed onwards, instead of using DNS MX.
6095While the name of this router instance is arbitrary, the &%driver%& option must
6096be one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6097
6098With no pre-conditions other than &%domains%&, all mail for non-local domains
6099will be handled by this router, and the &%no_more%& setting will ensure that no
6100other routers will be used for messages matching the pre-conditions. See
6101&<<SECTrouprecon>>& for more on how the pre-conditions apply. For messages which
6102are handled by this router, we provide a hostname to deliver to in &%route_data%&
6103and the macro supplies the value; the address is then queued for the
6104&(smarthost_smtp)& transport.
6105
6106.code
6107dnslookup:
6108 driver = dnslookup
6109 domains = ! +local_domains
6110 transport = remote_smtp
6111 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
6112.ifdef _HAVE_DNSSEC
6113 dnssec_request_domains = *
6114.endif
6115 no_more
6116.endd
6117The &%domains%& option behaves as per smarthost, above.
6118
6119The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6120and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6121the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6122instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6123one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6124
6125The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6126DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6127router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6128specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6129in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6130the address fails and is bounced.
6131
6132The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6133be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6134encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6135whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6136Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6137email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6138continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6139out.
6140.code
6141system_aliases:
6142 driver = redirect
6143 allow_fail
6144 allow_defer
6145 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6146# user = exim
6147 file_transport = address_file
6148 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6149.endd
6150Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6151domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6152alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6153data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6154the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6155the next router.
6156
6157&_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6158often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6159file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6160&_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6161.code
6162userforward:
6163 driver = redirect
6164 check_local_user
6165# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6166# local_part_suffix_optional
6167 file = $home/.forward
6168# allow_filter
6169 no_verify
6170 no_expn
6171 check_ancestor
6172 file_transport = address_file
6173 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6174 reply_transport = address_reply
6175.endd
6176This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6177redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6178individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6179local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6180router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6181namely:
6182.code
6183# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6184# local_part_suffix_optional
6185.endd
6186.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6187show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6188is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6189by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6190variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6191presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6192the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6193
6194When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6195home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6196declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6197redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6198
6199.cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6200Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6201files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6202is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6203of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6204filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6205separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6206
6207The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6208verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6209There are two reasons for doing this:
6210
6211.olist
6212Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6213checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6214unnecessary work.
6215.next
6216More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6217command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6218The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6219It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6220this time.
6221.endlist
6222
6223The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6224address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6225works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6226forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6227
6228The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6229forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6230auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6231.code
6232a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6233.endd
6234the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6235transport.
6236.code
6237localuser:
6238 driver = accept
6239 check_local_user
6240# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6241# local_part_suffix_optional
6242 transport = local_delivery
6243.endd
6244The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6245part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6246the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6247routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6248same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6249
6250
6251.section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6252.cindex "default" "transports"
6253.cindex "transports" "default"
6254Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6255only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6256not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6257.code
6258begin transports
6259.endd
6260Two remote transports and four local transports are defined.
6261.code
6262remote_smtp:
6263 driver = smtp
6264 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6265.ifdef _HAVE_DANE
6266 hosts_try_dane = *
6267.endif
6268.ifdef _HAVE_PRDR
6269 hosts_try_prdr = *
6270.endif
6271.endd
6272This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6273The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6274The &%message_size_limit%& usage is a hack to avoid sending on messages
6275with over-long lines. The built-in macro _HAVE_DANE guards configuration
6276to use DANE for delivery;
6277see section &<<SECDANE>>& for more details.
6278
6279The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is
6280negotiated between client and server and not expected to cause problems
6281but can be disabled if needed. The built-in macro _HAVE_PRDR guards the
6282use of the &%hosts_try_prdr%& configuration option.
6283
6284The other remote transport is used when delivering to a specific smarthost
6285with whom there must be some kind of existing relationship, instead of the
6286usual federated system.
6287
6288.code
6289smarthost_smtp:
6290 driver = smtp
6291 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6292 multi_domain
6293 #
6294.ifdef _HAVE_TLS
6295 # Comment out any of these which you have to, then file a Support
6296 # request with your smarthost provider to get things fixed:
6297 hosts_require_tls = *
6298 tls_verify_hosts = *
6299 # As long as tls_verify_hosts is enabled, this won't matter, but if you
6300 # have to comment it out then this will at least log whether you succeed
6301 # or not:
6302 tls_try_verify_hosts = *
6303 #
6304 # The SNI name should match the name which we'll expect to verify;
6305 # many mail systems don't use SNI and this doesn't matter, but if it does,
6306 # we need to send a name which the remote site will recognize.
6307 # This _should_ be the name which the smarthost operators specified as
6308 # the hostname for sending your mail to.
6309 tls_sni = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6310 #
6311.ifdef _HAVE_OPENSSL
6312 tls_require_ciphers = HIGH:!aNULL:@STRENGTH
6313.endif
6314.ifdef _HAVE_GNUTLS
6315 tls_require_ciphers = SECURE192:-VERS-SSL3.0:-VERS-TLS1.0:-VERS-TLS1.1
6316.endif
6317.endif
6318.ifdef _HAVE_PRDR
6319 hosts_try_prdr = *
6320.endif
6321.endd
6322After the same &%message_size_limit%& hack, we then specify that this Transport
6323can handle messages to multiple domains in one run. The assumption here is
6324that you're routing all non-local mail to the same place and that place is
6325happy to take all messages from you as quickly as possible.
6326All other options depend upon built-in macros; if Exim was built without TLS support
6327then no other options are defined.
6328If TLS is available, then we configure "stronger than default" TLS ciphersuites
6329and versions using the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option, where the value to be
6330used depends upon the library providing TLS.
6331Beyond that, the options adopt the stance that you should have TLS support available
6332from your smarthost on today's Internet, so we turn on requiring TLS for the
6333mail to be delivered, and requiring that the certificate be valid, and match
6334the expected hostname. The &%tls_sni%& option can be used by service providers
6335to select an appropriate certificate to present to you and here we re-use the
6336ROUTER_SMARTHOST macro, because that is unaffected by CNAMEs present in DNS.
6337You want to specify the hostname which you'll expect to validate for, and that
6338should not be subject to insecure tampering via DNS results.
6339
6340For the &%hosts_try_prdr%& option see the previous transport.
6341
6342All other options are defaulted.
6343.code
6344local_delivery:
6345 driver = appendfile
6346 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6347 delivery_date_add
6348 envelope_to_add
6349 return_path_add
6350# group = mail
6351# mode = 0660
6352.endd
6353This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6354traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6355local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6356directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6357under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6358show how this can be done.
6359
6360Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6361&'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6362similarly-named options above.
6363.code
6364address_pipe:
6365 driver = pipe
6366 return_output
6367.endd
6368This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6369redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6370option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6371be returned to the sender.
6372.code
6373address_file:
6374 driver = appendfile
6375 delivery_date_add
6376 envelope_to_add
6377 return_path_add
6378.endd
6379This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6380redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6381&(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6382.code
6383address_reply:
6384 driver = autoreply
6385.endd
6386This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6387filter files.
6388
6389
6390
6391.section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6392.cindex "retry" "default rule"
6393.cindex "default" "retry rule"
6394The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6395Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6396introduced by the line
6397.code
6398begin retry
6399.endd
6400In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6401errors:
6402.code
6403* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6404.endd
6405This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
64062 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
64071.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6408is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6409measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6410
6411If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6412if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6413temporary errors into permanent errors.
6414
6415
6416.section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6417The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6418.code
6419begin rewrite
6420.endd
6421contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6422rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6423
6424
6425
6426.section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6427.cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6428The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6429.code
6430begin authenticators
6431.endd
6432defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6433configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6434which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6435standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6436mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6437to support most MUA software.
6438
6439The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6440.code
6441#PLAIN:
6442# driver = plaintext
6443# server_set_id = $auth2
6444# server_prompts = :
6445# server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6446# server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6447.endd
6448And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6449.code
6450#LOGIN:
6451# driver = plaintext
6452# server_set_id = $auth1
6453# server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6454# server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6455# server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6456.endd
6457
6458The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6459in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6460&%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6461that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6462i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6463when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6464when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6465need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6466
6467The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6468password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6469To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6470expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6471
6472Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6473usercode and password are in different positions.
6474Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6475
6476.ecindex IIDconfiwal
6477
6478
6479
6480. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6481. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6482
6483.chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6484
6485.cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6486.cindex "PCRE"
6487Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6488uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6489matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6490regular expressions is discussed in
6491online Perl manpages, in
6492many Perl reference books, and also in
6493Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6494O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6495. --- the http: URL here redirects to another page with the ISBN in the URL
6496. --- where trying to use https: just redirects back to http:, so sticking
6497. --- to the old URL for now. 2018-09-07.
6498
6499The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6500are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6501description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6502the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6503the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6504case-insensitive.
6505
6506In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6507it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6508or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6509second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6510.code
6511domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6512.endd
6513The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6514precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6515of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6516regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6517backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6518normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6519matched.
6520
6521There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6522recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6523string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6524these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6525it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6526match anywhere in the subject string.
6527
6528In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6529you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6530.code
6531domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6532.endd
6533matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6534You need to use:
6535.code
6536domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6537.endd
6538if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6539$ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6540
6541
6542
6543. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6544. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6545
6546.chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6547.scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6548.scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6549.cindex "lookup" "description of"
6550Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6551messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6552
6553.olist
6554A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6555cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6556lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6557can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6558&<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6559The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6560.next
6561Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6562way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6563returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6564succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6565chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6566The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6567.endlist
6568
6569String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6570that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6571involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6572if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6573time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6574chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6575
6576.section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6577It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6578lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6579processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6580Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6581.code
6582domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6583domains = lsearch;/some/file
6584.endd
6585The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6586No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6587defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6588The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6589file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6590.code
6591192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6592192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6593.endd
6594When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6595possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6596
6597In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6598Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6599in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6600.code
6601domain1:
6602domain2:
6603.endd
6604Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6605matches the list item.
6606
6607It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6608Consider a file containing lines like this:
6609.code
6610192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6611.endd
6612If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6613first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6614causes a second lookup to occur.
6615
6616The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6617available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6618lookup is permitted.
6619
6620
6621.section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6622.cindex "lookup" "types of"
6623.cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6624Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6625
6626.ilist
6627The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6628and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6629lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6630.next
6631.cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6632The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6633key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6634Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6635.endlist
6636
6637The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6638the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6639default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6640.code
6641LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6642LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6643.endd
6644which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6645For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6646libraries and header files before building Exim.
6647
6648
6649
6650
6651.section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6652.cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6653.cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6654The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6655
6656.ilist
6657.cindex "cdb" "description of"
6658.cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6659.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6660&(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6661string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6662indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6663re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6664aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb and
6665tools for building the files can be found in several places:
6666.display
6667&url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html)
6668&url(http://www.corpit.ru/mjt/tinycdb.html)
6669&url(https://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb)
6670&url(https://github.com/philpennock/cdbtools) (in Go)
6671.endd
6672. --- 2018-09-07: corpit.ru http:-only
6673A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6674because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6675However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6676you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6677.next
6678.cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6679.cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6680.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6681&(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6682DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6683zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6684&<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6685
6686.cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6687For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6688when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6689using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6690the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6691that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6692other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6693.next
6694.cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6695.cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6696.cindex "sasldb2"
6697.cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6698&(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6699interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6700ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6701authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6702&_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6703&(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6704.next
6705.cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6706.cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6707.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6708.cindex "Courier"
6709.cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6710.cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6711&(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6712is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6713if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6714other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6715use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6716calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6717utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6718by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6719.next
6720.cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6721.cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6722&(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6723whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6724contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6725the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6726symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6727lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6728&<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6729.next
6730.cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6731.cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6732&(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6733terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6734file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6735IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6736being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6737.code
67381.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6739192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6740"abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6741"abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6742.endd
6743The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6744file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6745key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6746&"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6747&(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6748
6749&*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6750&(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6751lookup types support only literal keys.
6752
6753&*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6754the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6755&<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6756
6757.new
6758&*Warning 3*&: Do not use an IPv4-mapped IPv6 address for a key; use the
6759IPv4, in dotted-quad form. (Exim converts IPv4-mapped IPv6 addresses to this
6760notation before executing the lookup.)
6761.wen
6762.next
6763.new
6764.cindex lookup json
6765.cindex json "lookup type"
6766.cindex JSON expansions
6767&(json)&: The given file is a text file with a JSON structure.
6768An element of the structure is extracted, defined by the search key.
6769The key is a list of subelement selectors
6770(colon-separated by default but changeable in the usual way)
6771which are applied in turn to select smaller and smaller portions
6772of the JSON structure.
6773If a selector is numeric, it must apply to a JSON array; the (zero-based)
6774nunbered array element is selected.
6775Otherwise it must apply to a JSON object; the named element is selected.
6776The final resulting element can be a simple JSON type or a JSON object
6777or array; for the latter two a string-representation os the JSON
6778is returned.
6779For elements of type string, the returned value is de-quoted.
6780.wen
6781.next
6782.cindex "linear search"
6783.cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6784.cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6785.cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6786&(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6787line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6788end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6789letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6790in the file is used.
6791
6792White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6793line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6794continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6795space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6796junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6797colon, for example:
6798.code
6799baduser: :fail:
6800.endd
6801Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6802middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6803that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6804wildcarding of any kind.
6805
6806.cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6807.cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6808In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6809characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6810If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6811matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6812contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6813quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6814quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6815
6816.next
6817.cindex "NIS lookup type"
6818.cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6819.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6820&(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6821the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6822&(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6823reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6824aliases; the full map names must be used.
6825
6826.next
6827.cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6828.cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6829.cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6830.cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6831&(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6832&(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6833the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6834that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6835used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6836
6837.cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6838Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6839file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6840&`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6841
6842. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6843. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6844
6845.olist
6846The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6847.code
6848 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6849 *fish data for anythingfish
6850.endd
6851.next
6852The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6853example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6854.code
6855 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6856.endd
6857Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6858expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6859string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6860.code
6861 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6862.endd
6863The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6864expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6865For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6866.code
6867 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6868.endd
6869
6870If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6871either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6872ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6873colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6874escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6875
6876&*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6877match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6878is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6879takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6880&((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6881
6882.next
6883Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6884is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6885lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6886example:
6887.code
6888 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6889.endd
6890The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6891.endlist olist
6892
6893Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6894continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6895be followed by optional colons.
6896
6897&*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6898&((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6899lookup types support only literal keys.
6900
6901.next
6902.cindex "lookup" "spf"
6903If Exim is built with SPF support, manual lookups can be done
6904(as opposed to the standard ACL condition method.
6905For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
6906.endlist ilist
6907
6908
6909.section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
6910.cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6911.cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6912The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6913many of them are given in later sections.
6914
6915.ilist
6916.cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6917.cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6918&(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6919are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6920records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6921.next
6922.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6923.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6924&(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6925.next
6926.cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6927.cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6928&(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6929returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6930that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6931called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6932any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6933.next
6934.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6935.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6936&(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6937MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6938.next
6939.cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6940.cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6941&(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6942the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6943.next
6944.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6945.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6946&(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6947Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6948.next
6949.cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6950.cindex "passwd lookup type"
6951.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6952&(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6953lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6954success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6955lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6956password value. For example:
6957.code
6958*:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6959.endd
6960.next
6961.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6962.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6963&(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6964PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6965
6966.next
6967.cindex "Redis lookup type"
6968.cindex lookup Redis
6969&(redis)&: The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
6970passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6971
6972.next
6973.cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6974.cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6975&(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a filename followed by an SQL statement
6976that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6977
6978.next
6979&(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6980not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6981.next
6982.cindex "whoson lookup type"
6983.cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6984. --- still http:-only, 2018-09-07
6985&(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6986allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6987address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6988obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6989at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6990superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6991&"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6992.code
6993require condition = \
6994 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6995.endd
6996The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6997the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6998this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6999one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
7000.endlist
7001
7002
7003
7004.section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
7005.cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
7006Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
7007completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
7008reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
7009options such as a list of local domains.
7010
7011When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
7012of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
7013temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
7014or may give up altogether.
7015
7016
7017
7018.section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
7019.cindex "wildcard lookups"
7020.cindex "lookup" "default values"
7021.cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7022.cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
7023.cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
7024In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
7025that is to be used if a lookup fails.
7026
7027&*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
7028lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
7029specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
7030
7031If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
7032and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
7033provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
7034
7035.cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
7036.cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
7037.cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
7038Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
7039&%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
7040character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
7041by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
7042that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
7043take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
7044For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
7045.code
7046data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
7047.endd
7048Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
7049looks up these keys, in this order:
7050.code
7051jane@eyre.example
7052*@eyre.example
7053*
7054.endd
7055The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
7056&(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
7057complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
7058Exim move on to try the next key.
7059
7060
7061
7062.section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
7063.cindex "partial matching"
7064.cindex "wildcard lookups"
7065.cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
7066.cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7067.cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
7068The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
7069match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
7070being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
7071information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
7072domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
7073a key in a DBM file is
7074.code
7075*.dates.fict.example
7076.endd
7077then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
7078&'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
7079by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
7080file.
7081
7082&*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
7083also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
7084&<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
7085
7086Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
7087keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
7088be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
7089partial matching keys
7090beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
7091Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
7092unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
7093
7094Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
7095the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
7096is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
7097is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
7098fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
7099start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
7100remains.
7101
7102A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
7103by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
7104&%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
7105modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
7106subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
7107up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
7108.code
71092250.dates.fict.example
7110*.2250.dates.fict.example
7111*.dates.fict.example
7112*.fict.example
7113.endd
7114As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
7115finishes.
7116
7117.cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
7118.cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
7119The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
7120changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
7121formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
7122parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
7123.code
7124domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
7125.endd
7126In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7127&`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
7128components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
7129other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
7130.code
7131domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
7132.endd
7133For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7134&`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
7135
7136If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
7137just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
7138down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
7139
7140.ilist
7141If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
7142.next
7143If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
7144example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
7145.next
7146Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
7147remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
7148for &"*"& on its own.
7149.next
7150Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
7151.endlist
7152
7153
7154If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
7155&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
7156this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
7157specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
7158prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
7159lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
7160&"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
7161
7162The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
7163in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
7164dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
7165in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
7166subject key is always followed by a dot.
7167
7168
7169
7170
7171.section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
7172.cindex "lookup" "caching"
7173.cindex "caching" "lookup data"
7174Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
7175lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
7176of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
7177single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
7178
7179For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
7180another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
7181many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
7182the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
7183closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
7184own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
7185
7186The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
7187strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
7188complete.
7189
7190
7191
7192
7193.section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
7194.cindex "lookup" "quoting"
7195.cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
7196When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
7197is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
7198the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
7199.code
7200[name=$local_part]
7201.endd
7202will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
7203For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
7204.code
7205[name="$local_part"]
7206.endd
7207but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
7208NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
7209rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
7210of the following form is provided:
7211.code
7212${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
7213.endd
7214For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
7215.code
7216[name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
7217.endd
7218See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
7219operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
7220lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
7221
7222
7223
7224
7225.section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
7226.cindex "dnsdb lookup"
7227.cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7228.cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7229The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7230of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7231an expansion string could contain:
7232.code
7233${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7234.endd
7235If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7236is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7237&`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7238&<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7239
7240The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7241and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7242If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7243
7244For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7245concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7246depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7247between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7248by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7249.code
7250${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7251.endd
7252It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7253white space is ignored.
7254For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7255an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7256separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7257
7258.cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7259When the type is PTR,
7260the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7261&%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7262.code
7263${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7264.endd
7265If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7266altered and nothing is added.
7267
7268.cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7269.cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7270For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7271each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7272port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7273The field separator can be modified as above.
7274
7275.cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7276.cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7277For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7278unless a field separator is specified.
7279To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7280For SPF records the
7281default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7282.code
7283${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7284${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7285${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7286.endd
7287It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7288white space is ignored.
7289
7290.cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7291For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7292successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7293Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7294specified.
7295.code
7296${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7297.endd
7298
7299.section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
7300.cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7301.cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7302.cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7303Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7304each followed by a comma,
7305that may appear before the record type.
7306
7307The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7308temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7309a defer-option modifier.
7310The possible keywords are
7311&"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7312With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7313whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7314ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7315With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7316error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7317succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7318.code
7319${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7320${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7321.endd
7322Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7323yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7324
7325.cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7326Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7327The possible keywords are
7328&"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7329With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7330with the lookup.
7331With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7332is not labelled as authenticated data
7333is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7334The default is &"never"&.
7335
7336See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7337
7338.cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7339.cindex "DNS" timeout
7340Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7341The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7342(e.g. &"5s"&).
7343The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7344
7345Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7346The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7347The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7348
7349.cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7350.cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7351.cindex DNS TTL
7352Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7353The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7354value of the set of returned DNS records.
7355
7356
7357.section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7358.cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7359By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7360each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7361the pseudo-type MXH:
7362.code
7363${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7364.endd
7365In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7366returned.
7367
7368.cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7369Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7370records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7371component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7372records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7373error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7374but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7375top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7376.code
7377${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7378${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7379.endd
7380Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7381the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7382the name servers for &%edu%&.
7383
7384You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7385top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7386sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7387given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7388for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7389such a list.
7390
7391.cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7392A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7393records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7394&<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7395not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7396result of a successful lookup such as:
7397.code
7398${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7399.endd
7400has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7401The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7402authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7403
7404.cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7405The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7406and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7407(see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7408.code
7409${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7410.endd
7411
7412
7413.section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7414In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7415However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7416&(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7417the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7418.code
7419${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7420${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7421${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7422.endd
7423In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7424the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7425to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7426case, it does not treat it as a list.
7427
7428The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7429in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7430different separator can be specified, as described above.
7431
7432
7433
7434
7435.section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7436.cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7437.cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7438.cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7439The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7440become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7441implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7442contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7443the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7444it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7445indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7446your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7447.code
7448LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7449LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7450LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7451LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7452LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7453.endd
7454If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7455same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7456
7457There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7458the way they handle the results of a query:
7459
7460.ilist
7461&(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7462gives an error.
7463.next
7464&(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7465Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7466.next
7467&(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7468from all of them are returned.
7469.endlist
7470
7471
7472For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7473Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7474the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7475First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7476
7477
7478.section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7479.cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7480An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7481the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7482.code
7483data = ${lookup ldap \
7484 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7485 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7486.endd
7487.cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7488The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7489secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7490encrypted TLS connection is used.
7491
7492With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7493LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7494See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7495
7496Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7497controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7498&_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7499your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7500&_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7501certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7502running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7503methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7504&_exim.conf_&.
7505
7506
7507.section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7508.cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7509Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7510and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7511within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7512reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7513
7514The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7515filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7516the string:
7517.code
7518* => \2A
7519( => \28
7520) => \29
7521\ => \5C
7522.endd
7523in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7524to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7525.code
7526! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7527.endd
7528are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7529.code
7530${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7531.endd
7532yields
7533.code
7534%20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7535.endd
7536Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7537.code
7538a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7539.endd
7540The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7541base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7542by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7543.code
7544, + " \ < > ;
7545.endd
7546It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7547before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7548is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7549.code
7550${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7551.endd
7552yields
7553.code
7554%5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7555.endd
7556Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7557.code
7558\ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7559.endd
7560There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7561authentication below.
7562
7563
7564.section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7565.cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7566The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7567is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7568an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7569by starting it with
7570.code
7571ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7572.endd
7573If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7574used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7575taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7576colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7577handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7578returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7579are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7580Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7581failures, and timeouts.
7582
7583For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7584of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7585&%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7586doubled. For example
7587.code
7588ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7589.endd
7590If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7591to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7592the local host) is used.
7593
7594If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7595a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7596&`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7597to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7598not available.
7599
7600For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7601for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7602can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7603the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7604.code
7605ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7606.endd
7607When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7608&`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7609.code
7610${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7611.endd
7612When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7613a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7614specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7615socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7616&%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7617or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7618the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7619backup host.
7620
7621If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7622specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7623&%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7624
7625.ilist
7626Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7627interface.
7628.next
7629Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7630.endlist
7631
7632
7633Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7634&%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7635
7636
7637
7638.section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7639.cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7640The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7641information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7642be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7643spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7644when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7645them. The following names are recognized:
7646.display
7647&`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7648&`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7649&`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7650&`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7651&`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7652&`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7653&`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7654&`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7655.endd
7656The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7657&"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7658must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7659library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7660
7661.cindex LDAP timeout
7662.cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7663The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7664backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7665enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7666network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7667&'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7668LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7669if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7670SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7671Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7672
7673The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7674set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7675
7676The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7677to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7678default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7679server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7680different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7681different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7682alternate list (colon-separated).
7683
7684Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7685values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7686.code
7687${lookup ldap
7688 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7689 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7690 {$value}fail}
7691.endd
7692The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7693any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7694which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7695non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7696
7697The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7698connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7699on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7700
7701When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7702removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7703some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7704quoting has two advantages:
7705
7706.ilist
7707It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7708DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7709.next
7710It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7711.endlist
7712
7713For example, a setting such as
7714.code
7715USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7716.endd
7717should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7718
7719Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7720expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7721field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7722does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7723.code
7724PASS=${quote:$3}
7725.endd
7726The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7727SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7728&<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7729
7730
7731
7732.section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7733.cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7734The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7735as a sequence of values, for example
7736.code
7737cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7738.endd
7739The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7740search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7741the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7742values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7743you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7744directory.
7745
7746In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7747result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7748has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7749part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7750
7751If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7752strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7753quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7754backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7755Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7756(permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7757Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7758output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7759same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7760
7761Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7762LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7763&%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7764&%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7765(they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7766
7767.code
7768ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7769value1.1,value1,,2
7770
7771ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7772value two
7773
7774ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7775value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7776
7777ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7778attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7779
7780ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7781objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7782.endd
7783You can
7784make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7785results of LDAP lookups.
7786The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7787individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7788The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7789of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7790The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7791comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7792
7793
7794
7795
7796.section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7797.cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7798.cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7799NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7800and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7801contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7802of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7803values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7804.code
7805[name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7806.endd
7807might return the string
7808.code
7809name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7810home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7811.endd
7812(split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7813.code
7814[name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7815.endd
7816would just return
7817.code
7818Martin Guerre
7819.endd
7820with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7821for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7822operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7823
7824
7825
7826.section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7827.cindex "SQL lookup types"
7828.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7829.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7830.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7831.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7832.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7833.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7834.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7835.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7836.cindex "Redis lookup type"
7837.cindex lookup Redis
7838Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
7839and SQLite
7840databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7841might be
7842.code
7843${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7844 {$value}fail}
7845.endd
7846If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7847field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7848.code
7849${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7850 {$value}}
7851.endd
7852might be
7853.code
7854home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7855.endd
7856Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7857quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7858field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7859.code
7860Mister X
7861.endd
7862If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7863with a newline between the data for each row.
7864
7865
7866.section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" "SECID72"
7867.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7868.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7869.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7870.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7871.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7872.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7873.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7874.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7875.cindex "Redis lookup type"
7876.cindex lookup Redis
7877If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
7878&%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
7879or &%redis_servers%&
7880option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7881information.
7882(For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
7883queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7884&<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
7885For all but Redis
7886each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7887items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7888Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7889name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7890.code
7891hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7892.endd
7893Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7894&"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7895option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7896.code
7897hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7898 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7899.endd
7900For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7901because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7902query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7903a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7904found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7905servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7906
7907For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
7908own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
7909If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7910information.
7911Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
7912host, database number, and password.
7913.olist
7914The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
7915port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
7916higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
7917.next
7918The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
7919.next
7920The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
7921.endlist
7922
7923The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7924convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7925respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7926itself are escaped with backslashes.
7927
7928The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
7929escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
7930
7931.section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7932For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7933it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7934done by starting the query with
7935.display
7936&`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7937.endd
7938Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7939.olist
7940If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7941global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7942of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7943taken from there.
7944.next
7945If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7946.endlist
7947The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7948Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7949successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7950
7951This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7952are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7953master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7954like this:
7955.code
7956mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7957 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7958 master/db/name/pw
7959.endd
7960In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7961.code
7962${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7963.endd
7964That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7965the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7966option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7967.code
7968${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7969.endd
7970
7971
7972.section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7973For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7974causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7975socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
7976An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
7977the default value is &"exim"&.
7978The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7979.display
7980<&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
7981 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7982.endd
7983Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7984the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7985
7986No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7987the queries.
7988
7989If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7990or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7991
7992&*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7993anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7994is zero because no rows are affected.
7995
7996
7997.section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7998PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7999This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
8000However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
8001database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
8002looks like this:
8003.code
8004hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
8005.endd
8006In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
8007given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
8008visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
8009
8010If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
8011update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
8012affected.
8013
8014.section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
8015.cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
8016.cindex "sqlite lookup type"
8017SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a filename is required in
8018addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
8019daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
8020of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
8021separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
8022contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
8023.code
8024${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
8025 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
8026.endd
8027In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
8028.code
8029domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
8030 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
8031.endd
8032The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
8033quote, which it doubles.
8034
8035.cindex timeout SQLite
8036.cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
8037The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
8038internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
8039update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
8040are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
8041waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
8042to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
8043option.
8044
8045.section "More about Redis" "SECTredis"
8046.cindex "lookup" "Redis"
8047.cindex "redis lookup type"
8048Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
8049Examples:
8050.code
8051${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
8052${lookup redis{get keyname}}
8053.endd
8054
8055As of release 4.91, "lightweight" support for Redis Cluster is available.
8056Requires &%redis_servers%& list to contain all the servers in the cluster, all
8057of which must be reachable from the running exim instance. If the cluster has
8058master/slave replication, the list must contain all the master and slave
8059servers.
8060
8061When the Redis Cluster returns a "MOVED" response to a query, Exim does not
8062immediately follow the redirection but treats the response as a DEFER, moving on
8063to the next server in the &%redis_servers%& list until the correct server is
8064reached.
8065
8066.ecindex IIDfidalo1
8067.ecindex IIDfidalo2
8068
8069
8070. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8071. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8072
8073.chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
8074 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
8075 "Domain, host, and address lists"
8076.scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
8077A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
8078email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
8079contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
8080are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
8081arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
8082
8083Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
8084host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
8085different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
8086general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
8087
8088Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
8089support all the complexity available in
8090domain, host, address and local part lists.
8091
8092
8093
8094.section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
8095.cindex "expansion" "of lists"
8096Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used.
8097
8098&'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
8099splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
8100
8101The result of
8102expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
8103into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
8104but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
8105&<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
8106discusses the way to specify empty list items.
8107
8108
8109If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
8110testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
8111expansion failures cause temporary errors.
8112
8113If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
8114other special characters in the expression must be protected against
8115misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
8116the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
8117expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
8118.code
8119deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
8120 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
8121.endd
8122The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
8123&`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
8124senders based on the receiving domain.
8125
8126
8127
8128
8129.section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
8130.cindex "list" "negation"
8131.cindex "negation" "in lists"
8132Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
8133leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
8134defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
8135it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
8136(respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
8137
8138The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
8139subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
8140subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
8141subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
8142was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
8143.code
8144domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
8145.endd
8146matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
8147neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
8148list is positive. However, if the setting were
8149.code
8150domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
8151.endd
8152then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
8153list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
8154as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
8155
8156Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
8157the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
8158item.
8159
8160
8161
8162.section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
8163.cindex "list" "filename in"
8164If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute
8165filename (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
8166processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
8167filenames are not allowed,
8168and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
8169Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
8170lines:
8171
8172.ilist
8173For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
8174file, it and all following characters are ignored.
8175.next
8176Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
8177address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
8178white space or the start of the line. For example:
8179.code
8180not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
8181.endd
8182.endlist
8183
8184Putting a filename in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
8185file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
8186is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
8187so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
8188
8189If a filename is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
8190within the file is inverted. For example, if
8191.code
8192hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
8193.endd
8194and the file contains the lines
8195.code
8196!a.b.c
8197*.b.c
8198.endd
8199then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
8200any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
8201
8202
8203
8204.section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
8205As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
8206to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
8207confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
8208an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
8209sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
8210non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
8211always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
8212
8213If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
8214list, just give the filename on its own, without a search type, as described
8215in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
8216&(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
8217
8218
8219
8220
8221.section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
8222.cindex "named lists"
8223.cindex "list" "named"
8224A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
8225which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
8226particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
8227places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
8228the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
8229a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
8230locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
8231.code
8232domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
8233.endd
8234Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
8235for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
8236configured with the line
8237.code
8238domains = +local_domains
8239.endd
8240The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8241except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8242.code
8243dnslookup:
8244 driver = dnslookup
8245 domains = ! +local_domains
8246 transport = remote_smtp
8247 no_more
8248.endd
8249The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8250the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8251respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8252equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8253.code
8254hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8255addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8256.endd
8257A named list may refer to other named lists:
8258.code
8259domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8260domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8261domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8262.endd
8263&*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8264effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8265out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8266.code
8267domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8268domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8269.endd
8270The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8271list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8272means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8273.code
8274domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8275.endd
8276where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8277referenced lists if you can.
8278
8279Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8280address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8281lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8282.code
8283domains = +local_domains
8284.endd
8285on several of your routers
8286or in several ACL statements,
8287the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8288if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8289references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8290the same each time they are referenced.
8291
8292By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8293extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8294is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8295hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8296
8297
8298
8299.section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
8300.cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8301.cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8302At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8303configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8304write
8305.code
8306ALIST = host1 : host2
8307auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8308.endd
8309it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8310.code
8311auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8312.endd
8313Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8314list, and write
8315.code
8316hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8317auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8318.endd
8319the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8320.code
8321auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8322.endd
8323
8324
8325.section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
8326.cindex "list" "caching of named"
8327.cindex "caching" "named lists"
8328While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8329it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8330the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8331that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8332an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8333message. For example:
8334.code
8335domainlist special_domains = \
8336 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8337.endd
8338This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8339address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8340in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8341cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8342same list each time.
8343
8344By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8345cache the result anyway. For example:
8346.code
8347domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8348.endd
8349If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8350the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8351
8352
8353
8354.section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8355.cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8356.cindex "list" "domain list"
8357Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8358The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8359
8360.ilist
8361.cindex "primary host name"
8362.cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8363.oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8364.cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8365.cindex "@ in a domain list"
8366If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8367as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8368possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8369differ only in their names.
8370.next
8371.cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8372.cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8373.cindex "domain literal"
8374If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8375in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8376only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8377&%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8378control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8379In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
8380.next
8381.cindex "@mx_any"
8382.cindex "@mx_primary"
8383.cindex "@mx_secondary"
8384.cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8385If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8386has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8387.oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8388&%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8389are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8390local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8391but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8392preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8393
8394The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8395performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8396example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8397resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8398options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8399
8400Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8401patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8402list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8403ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8404on a router). For example:
8405.code
8406domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8407.endd
8408This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8409the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8410
8411The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8412host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8413contain negative items.
8414
8415Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8416be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8417list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8418.code
8419domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8420 an.other.domain : ...
8421.endd
8422so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8423involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8424.code
8425domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8426 an.other.domain ? ...
8427.endd
8428.next
8429.cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8430.cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8431.cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8432If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8433are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8434domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8435list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8436matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8437list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8438&'cipher.key.ex'&.
8439
8440.next
8441.cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8442.cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8443If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8444expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8445function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8446Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8447default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8448with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8449are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8450
8451&*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8452must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8453use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8454it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8455expression by expansion, of course).
8456.next
8457.cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8458.cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8459If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8460semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8461must be a filename in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8462&"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8463.code
8464domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8465.endd
8466The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8467key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8468only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8469is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8470or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8471&$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8472other statements in the same ACL.
8473
8474.next
8475Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8476&`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8477.code
8478domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8479.endd
8480This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8481works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8482
8483.next
8484.cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8485Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8486a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8487original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8488select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8489value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8490expansion variable.
8491.next
8492If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8493semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8494pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8495chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8496.code
8497hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8498 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8499.endd
8500In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8501example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8502whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8503&%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8504variable and can be referred to in other options.
8505.next
8506.cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8507If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8508between the pattern and the domain.
8509.endlist
8510
8511Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8512.code
8513domainlist funny_domains = \
8514 @ : \
8515 lib.unseen.edu : \
8516 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8517 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8518 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8519 nis;domains.byname : \
8520 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8521.endd
8522There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8523an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8524explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8525but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8526patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8527patterns earlier.
8528
8529
8530
8531.section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8532.cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8533.cindex "list" "host list"
8534Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8535example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8536may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8537two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8538pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8539You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8540involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8541
8542
8543.section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8544.cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8545.cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8546If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8547involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8548process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8549not used.
8550
8551.cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8552The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8553the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8554
8555
8556
8557.section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8558.cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8559If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8560the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8561&`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8562list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8563systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8564concerns.)
8565
8566The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8567inspecting its IP address:
8568
8569.ilist
8570If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8571with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8572to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8573&[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8574This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8575with the IP address of the subject host.
8576
8577If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8578lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8579ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8580temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8581what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8582
8583.next
8584.cindex "@ in a host list"
8585If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8586domain name, as just described.
8587
8588.next
8589If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8590subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8591IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8592be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8593separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8594without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8595IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8596that can never match a client host.
8597
8598.next
8599.cindex "@[] in a host list"
8600If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8601the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8602interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8603.code
8604accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8605accept hosts = @[]
8606.endd
8607.next
8608.cindex "CIDR notation"
8609If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8610example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8611host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8612included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8613specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8614significant end of the address.
8615
8616&*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8617of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8618address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8619addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8620.code
8621192.168.23.236/31
8622.endd
8623matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
862432 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8625matches.
8626
8627Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8628.code
8629recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8630 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8631.endd
8632The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8633appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8634For example:
8635.code
8636recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8637.endd
8638could make use of a file containing
8639.code
8640172.16.0.0/12
86413ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8642.endd
8643to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8644addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8645changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8646.code
8647recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8648 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8649.endd
8650The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8651list.
8652.endlist
8653
8654
8655
8656.section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8657 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8658.cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8659When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8660address, the pattern takes this form:
8661.display
8662&`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8663.endd
8664For example:
8665.code
8666hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8667.endd
8668The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8669IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8670letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8671&(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8672quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8673returned by the lookup is not used.
8674
8675.cindex "IP address" "masking"
8676.cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8677Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8678patterns of this form:
8679.display
8680&`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8681.endd
8682For example:
8683.code
8684net24-dbm;/networks.db
8685.endd
8686The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8687length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8688mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8689is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8690&"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8691
8692When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8693of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8694terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8695to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8696recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8697(notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8698For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8699converted using colons and not dots.
8700.new
8701In all cases except IPv4-mapped IPv6, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8702addresses are always used.
8703The latter are converted to IPv4 addresses, in dotted-quad form.
8704.wen
8705
8706Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8707colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8708However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8709configurations.
8710
8711&*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8712IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8713the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8714case the IP address is used on its own.
8715
8716
8717
8718.section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8719.cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8720.cindex "unknown host name"
8721.cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8722There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8723remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8724complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8725address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8726above.)
8727
8728If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8729patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8730Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8731DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8732Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8733effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8734Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8735
8736Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8737against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8738
8739By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8740if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8741&[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8742are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8743security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8744for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8745Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8746discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8747found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8748
8749There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8750found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8751
8752.cindex "host" "alias for"
8753.cindex "alias for host"
8754As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8755of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8756
8757.ilist
8758.cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8759If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8760the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8761&'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8762requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8763expression.
8764.next
8765.cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8766.cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8767If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8768matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8769expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8770case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8771syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8772example,
8773.code
8774^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8775.endd
8776is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8777&'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8778that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8779string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8780part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8781.code
8782sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8783.endd
8784&*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8785&`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8786example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8787required.
8788.endlist
8789
8790
8791
8792
8793.section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8794.cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8795While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8796name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8797from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8798behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8799
8800&*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8801apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8802
8803.cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8804.cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8805Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8806lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8807Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8808does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8809To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8810&`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8811not recognized in an indirected file).
8812
8813.ilist
8814If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8815cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8816.code
8817host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8818.endd
8819rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8820any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8821
8822.next
8823If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8824be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8825example:
8826.code
8827accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8828 192.168.4.5
8829.endd
8830accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8831whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8832name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8833.endlist
8834
8835Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8836list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8837list.
8838
8839.section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8840 "SECTmixwilhos"
8841.cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8842
8843This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8844as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8845wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8846
8847.ilist
8848If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8849IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8850addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8851.code
8852accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8853.endd
8854The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8855left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8856without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8857a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8858pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8859&%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8860if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8861
8862.next
8863If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8864address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8865.code
8866accept hosts = *.friend.example
8867accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8868.endd
8869If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8870&<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8871&`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8872this section.
8873.endlist
8874
8875
8876.section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8877 "SECTtemdnserr"
8878.cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8879.cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8880.cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8881A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8882&%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8883host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8884&`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8885section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8886host lists such as whitelists.
8887
8888
8889
8890.section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8891 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8892.cindex "unknown host name"
8893.cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8894If a pattern is of the form
8895.display
8896<&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8897.endd
8898for example
8899.code
8900dbm;/host/accept/list
8901.endd
8902a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8903lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8904is not used.
8905
8906&*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8907keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8908addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8909&<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8910two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8911lookup, both using the same file.
8912
8913
8914
8915.section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8916If a pattern is of the form
8917.display
8918<&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8919.endd
8920the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8921data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8922&$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8923.code
8924hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8925 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8926.endd
8927The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8928can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8929use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8930operator.
8931
8932If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8933looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8934&<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8935
8936Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8937host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8938&`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8939still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8940effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8941See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8942
8943
8944
8945
8946
8947.section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8948.cindex "list" "address list"
8949.cindex "address list" "empty item"
8950.cindex "address list" "patterns"
8951Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8952is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8953always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8954list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8955using this option setting:
8956.code
8957senders = :
8958.endd
8959The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8960data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8961detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8962and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8963
8964Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8965example:
8966.code
8967senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8968.endd
8969A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8970character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8971semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8972subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8973with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8974the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8975wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8976.code
8977deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8978 *@+hostile_domains:\
8979 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8980 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8981.endd
8982.cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8983.cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8984If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8985specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8986treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8987
8988If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8989contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8990address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8991domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8992is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8993.code
8994deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8995.endd
8996
8997The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8998address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8999senders:
9000
9001.ilist
9002.cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
9003.cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
9004If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
9005done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
9006You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
9007as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
9008to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
9009.code
9010deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
9011 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
9012.endd
9013The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
9014start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
9015
9016.next
9017.cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
9018Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
9019lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
9020example:
9021.code
9022deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
9023 mysql;select address from blocked where \
9024 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
9025.endd
9026Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
9027lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
9028not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
9029always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
9030
9031Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
9032cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
9033panic log.
9034.cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
9035However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
9036&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
9037default. For example, with this lookup:
9038.code
9039accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
9040.endd
9041the file could contains lines like this:
9042.code
9043user1@domain1.example
9044*@domain2.example
9045.endd
9046and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
9047that are tried is:
9048.code
9049nimrod@jaeger.example
9050*@jaeger.example
9051*
9052.endd
9053&*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
9054would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
9055
9056&*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
9057.code
9058deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
9059deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
9060.endd
9061The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
9062because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
9063domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
9064.endlist
9065
9066
9067The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
9068If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
9069always fails.
9070
9071
9072.ilist
9073.cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
9074.cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
9075.cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
9076If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
9077(for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
9078split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
9079it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
9080from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
9081of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
9082
9083.cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
9084The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
9085keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
9086patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
9087even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
9088with
9089.code
9090deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
9091.endd
9092the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
9093.code
9094baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
9095.endd
9096to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
9097
9098.cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9099If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
9100has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
9101may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
9102but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
9103surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
9104.code
9105aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
9106 spammer3 : spammer4
9107.endd
9108As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
9109doubling.
9110
9111If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
9112of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
9113list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
9114might have entries like
9115.code
9116aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
9117xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
9118*: ^\d{8}$
9119.endd
9120in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
9121local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
9122each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
9123chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
9124
9125.cindex "loop" "in lookups"
9126It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
9127them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
9128
9129.next
9130The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
9131lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
9132can only return a single list of local parts.
9133.endlist
9134
9135&*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
9136in these two examples:
9137.code
9138senders = +my_list
9139senders = *@+my_list
9140.endd
9141In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
9142example it is a named domain list.
9143
9144
9145
9146
9147.section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
9148.cindex "case of local parts"
9149.cindex "address list" "case forcing"
9150.cindex "case forcing in address lists"
9151Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
9152case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
9153Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
9154Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
9155blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
9156lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
9157default.
9158
9159The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
9160address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
9161comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
9162the address list itself, in files included as plain filenames, and in any file
9163that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
9164keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
9165works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
9166case-independent.
9167
9168.cindex "&`+caseful`&"
9169To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
9170an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
9171part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
9172longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
9173lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
9174performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
9175become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
9176
9177
9178
9179.section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
9180.cindex "list" "local part list"
9181.cindex "local part" "list"
9182Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
9183lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
9184setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
9185set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
9186case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
9187matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
9188&%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
9189option is case-sensitive from the start.
9190
9191If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
9192comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
9193only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
9194Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
9195that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
9196&`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
9197Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
9198types.
9199.ecindex IIDdohoadli
9200
9201
9202
9203
9204. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9205. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9206
9207.chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
9208.scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
9209Many strings in Exim's runtime configuration are expanded before use. Some of
9210them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
9211
9212When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
9213.cindex expansion "string concatenation"
9214when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
9215start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
9216below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
9217escape character, as described in the following section.
9218
9219Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
9220dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
9221options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
9222the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
9223conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
9224reasons,
9225.new
9226.cindex "tainted data" expansion
9227.cindex expansion "tainted data"
9228and expansion of data deriving from the sender (&"tainted data"&)
9229is not permitted.
9230.wen
9231
9232
9233
9234.section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
9235.cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
9236An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
9237backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
9238character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
9239If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
9240required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
9241the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
9242
9243.cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
9244A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
9245two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
9246expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
9247.code
9248deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9249.endd
9250On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9251without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9252string.
9253
9254
9255
9256.section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9257.cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9258A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9259expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9260carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9261octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9262backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9263encoding.
9264
9265These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9266in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9267and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9268
9269
9270.section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9271.cindex "expansion" "testing"
9272.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9273.oindex "&%-be%&"
9274Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9275takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9276arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9277to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9278since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9279value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9280database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9281and &%nhash%&.
9282
9283Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9284instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9285using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9286
9287.oindex "&%-bem%&"
9288If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9289from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9290option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a filename. The file is
9291read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9292.code
9293exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9294.endd
9295The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9296Exim message identifier. For example:
9297.code
9298exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9299.endd
9300This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9301is therefore restricted to admin users.
9302
9303
9304.section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9305.cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9306A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9307alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9308(which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9309used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9310instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9311the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9312that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9313its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9314from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9315taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9316being expanded.
9317
9318
9319
9320
9321.section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9322The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9323between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9324outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9325white space is significant.
9326
9327.vlist
9328.vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9329.cindex "expansion" "variables"
9330Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9331.code
9332$local_part
9333${domain}
9334.endd
9335The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9336characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9337&'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9338section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9339given, the expansion fails.
9340
9341.vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9342.cindex "expansion" "operators"
9343The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9344<&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9345.code
9346${lc:$local_part}
9347.endd
9348The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9349leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9350below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9351one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9352string easier to understand.
9353
9354.vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9355This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9356expansion item below.
9357
9358
9359.vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9360.cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9361.cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9362The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9363arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9364Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9365arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9366and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9367are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9368a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9369the result of the expansion.
9370If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9371the expansion result is an empty string.
9372If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9373
9374
9375.vitem "&*${authresults{*&<&'authserv-id'&>&*}}*&"
9376.cindex authentication "results header"
9377.cindex headers "authentication-results:"
9378.cindex authentication "expansion item"
9379This item returns a string suitable for insertion as an
9380&'Authentication-Results"'&
9381header line.
9382The given <&'authserv-id'&> is included in the result; typically this
9383will be a domain name identifying the system performing the authentications.
9384Methods that might be present in the result include:
9385.code
9386none
9387iprev
9388auth
9389spf
9390dkim
9391.endd
9392
9393Example use (as an ACL modifier):
9394.code
9395 add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
9396.endd
9397This is safe even if no authentication results are available.
9398
9399
9400.vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9401 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9402.cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9403.cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9404.cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9405The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9406The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9407the certificate. Supported fields are:
9408.display
9409&`version `&
9410&`serial_number `&
9411&`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9412&`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9413&`notbefore `& time
9414&`notafter `& time
9415&`sig_algorithm `&
9416&`signature `&
9417&`subj_altname `& tagged list
9418&`ocsp_uri `& list
9419&`crl_uri `& list
9420.endd
9421If the field is found,
9422<&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9423otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9424variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9425is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9426
9427If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9428key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9429extracted is used.
9430
9431Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9432
9433The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9434output a Distinguished Name string which is
9435not quite
9436parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9437(the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9438RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9439a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9440result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9441The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9442a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9443Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9444
9445The field selectors marked as "time" above
9446take an optional modifier of "int"
9447for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9448Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9449in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9450
9451The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9452newline-separated by default,
9453(embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9454The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9455a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9456
9457The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9458prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9459Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9460which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9461if so the element tags are omitted.
9462
9463If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9464
9465.vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9466 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9467.cindex &%dlfunc%&
9468This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9469This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9470.code
9471EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
9472.endd
9473set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9474object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9475(but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9476
9477There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
9478a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
9479included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9480are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9481must have the following type:
9482.code
9483int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9484.endd
9485Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9486function should return one of the following values:
9487
9488&`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9489into the expanded string that is being built.
9490
9491&`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9492from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9493
9494&`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9495taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9496
9497&`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9498
9499When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9500you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9501configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9502
9503
9504.vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9505.cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9506.cindex "environment" "values from"
9507The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9508removed.
9509This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9510If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9511and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9512
9513Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9514appear, for example:
9515.code
9516${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9517.endd
9518This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9519{<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9520
9521If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9522search failure.
9523If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9524search success.
9525
9526The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9527&%add_environment%& main section options.
9528
9529
9530.vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9531 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9532.cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9533.cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9534The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9535white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9536must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9537The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9538.display
9539<&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9540.endd
9541.vindex "&$value$&"
9542where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9543values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9544values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9545described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9546for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9547the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9548otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9549variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9550is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9551
9552If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9553key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9554extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9555yield &"2001"&:
9556.code
9557${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9558${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9559.endd
9560Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9561appear, for example:
9562.code
9563${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9564.endd
9565This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9566{<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9567
9568.vitem "&*${extract json{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9569 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9570 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9571 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9572.cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON object"
9573.cindex JSON expansions
9574The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9575white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9576must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9577The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9578.display
9579{ <&'"key1"'&> : <&'value1'&> , <&'"key2"'&> , <&'value2'&> ... }
9580.endd
9581.vindex "&$value$&"
9582The braces, commas and colons, and the quoting of the member name are required;
9583the spaces are optional.
9584Matching of the key against the member names is done case-sensitively.
9585For the &"json"& variant,
9586if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9587trailing quotes.
9588.new
9589For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9590leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9591.wen
9592. XXX should be a UTF-8 compare
9593
9594The results of matching are handled as above.
9595
9596
9597.vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9598 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9599.cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9600.cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9601The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9602apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9603This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9604behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9605extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9606argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9607<&'string3'&> as before.
9608
9609The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9610separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9611The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9612counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9613number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9614number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9615expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9616provided. For example:
9617.code
9618${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9619.endd
9620yields &"42"&, and
9621.code
9622${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9623.endd
9624yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9625empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9626
9627
9628.vitem "&*${extract json {*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9629 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9630 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9631 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9632.cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON array"
9633.cindex JSON expansions
9634The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9635apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9636
9637Field selection and result handling is as above;
9638there is no choice of field separator.
9639For the &"json"& variant,
9640if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9641trailing quotes.
9642.new
9643For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9644leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9645.wen
9646
9647
9648.vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9649.cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9650.cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9651.vindex "&$item$&"
9652After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9653default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9654For each item
9655in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9656evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9657item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9658separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9659input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9660.code
9661${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}}
9662.endd
9663yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9664to what it was before. See also the &%map%& and &%reduce%& expansion items.
9665
9666
9667.vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9668.cindex "hash function" "textual"
9669.cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9670This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9671early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9672(numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9673
9674The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9675<&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9676<&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9677use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9678.code
9679${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9680.endd
9681The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9682or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9683Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9684function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9685first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9686.code
9687abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9688.endd
9689If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9690letters appear. For example:
9691.display
9692&`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9693&`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9694&`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9695.endd
9696
9697.vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9698 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9699 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9700 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9701 "&*$lheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9702 &*$lh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9703 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9704 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9705.cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9706.vindex "&$header_$&"
9707.vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9708.vindex "&$lheader_$&"
9709.vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9710.cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9711.cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9712.cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9713Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9714.code
9715$header_reply-to:
9716.endd
9717The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9718internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9719lines) may be present.
9720
9721The difference between the four pairs of expansions is in the way
9722the data in the header line is interpreted.
9723
9724.ilist
9725.cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9726&%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9727processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9728
9729.next
9730.cindex "list" "of header lines"
9731&%lheader%& gives a colon-separated list, one element per header when there
9732are multiple headers with a given name.
9733Any embedded colon characters within an element are doubled, so normal Exim
9734list-processing facilities can be used.
9735The terminating newline of each element is removed; in other respects
9736the content is &"raw"&.
9737
9738.next
9739.cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9740&%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9741or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9742character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9743&"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9744.cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9745produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9746what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9747
9748.next
9749&%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9750standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9751be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9752returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9753&[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9754a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9755.endlist ilist
9756
9757In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9758command of the following form:
9759.code
9760headers charset "UTF-8"
9761.endd
9762This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9763subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9764character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9765option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9766value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9767ISO-8859-1.
9768
9769Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9770any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9771&'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9772if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9773
9774Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9775this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9776message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9777filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9778router or transport are not accessible.
9779
9780For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
9781ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
9782because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
9783They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
9784Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9785are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9786point they are added.
9787When any of the above ACLs ar
9788running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
9789
9790Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9791following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9792this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9793white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9794expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9795expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9796section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9797header.)
9798
9799If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9800to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9801&%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9802each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9803newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9804newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9805those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9806junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9807
9808
9809.vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9810.cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9811.cindex &%hmac%&
9812This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9813shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9814RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9815&`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9816cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9817or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9818present. For example:
9819.code
9820${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9821.endd
9822For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9823produces:
9824.code
9825dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9826.endd
9827As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9828an Exim configuration:
9829.code
9830SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9831.endd
9832In a router or a transport you could then have:
9833.code
9834headers_add = \
9835 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9836 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9837 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9838.endd
9839Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9840&'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9841this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9842host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9843using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example, by using the
9844&'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9845
9846
9847.vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9848.cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9849.cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9850If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9851item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9852in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9853.code
9854${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9855.endd
9856The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9857true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9858be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9859case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9860&<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9861
9862If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9863is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9864cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9865.code
9866condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9867.endd
9868you can use
9869.code
9870condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9871.endd
9872
9873
9874
9875.vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
9876.cindex expansion "imap folder"
9877.cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
9878This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
9879folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
9880For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
9881
9882
9883
9884.vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9885.cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9886.cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9887The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9888strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9889you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9890change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9891some of the braces:
9892.code
9893${length_<n>:<string>}
9894.endd
9895The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> bytes or the whole
9896of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9897&%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9898All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
9899
9900
9901.vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9902 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9903.cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9904.cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9905.cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9906The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9907apart from an optional leading minus,
9908and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9909
9910After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9911default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9912
9913The first field of the list is numbered one.
9914If the number is negative, the fields are
9915counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9916The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9917then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9918
9919If the modulus of the
9920number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9921the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9922
9923For example:
9924.code
9925${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9926.endd
9927yields &"42"&, and
9928.code
9929${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9930.endd
9931yields &"result: 42"&.
9932
9933If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9934If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9935extracted is used.
9936You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9937
9938
9939.vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9940 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9941This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9942described in the next item.
9943
9944.vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9945 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9946.cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9947.cindex "file" "lookups"
9948.cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9949The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9950discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9951lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9952<&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9953
9954If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9955a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9956other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9957in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9958out by the system administrator.
9959
9960.vindex "&$value$&"
9961If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9962During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9963lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9964level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9965the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9966string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9967lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9968original lookup fails.
9969
9970If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9971data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9972expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9973the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9974appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9975to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9976{<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9977successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9978
9979For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9980search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9981type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9982&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9983
9984.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9985If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9986and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9987They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9988
9989This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9990.code
9991${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9992.endd
9993This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9994the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9995.code
9996${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9997 {$value}fail}
9998.endd
9999
10000
10001.vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10002.cindex "expansion" "list creation"
10003.vindex "&$item$&"
10004After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10005default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10006For each item
10007in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
10008expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
10009for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
10010setting is not included in the output. For example:
10011.code
10012${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
10013.endd
10014expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
10015value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &%filter%&
10016and &%reduce%& expansion items.
10017
10018.vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10019.cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10020.cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10021The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10022<&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10023if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10024can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10025.code
10026${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10027.endd
10028The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
10029the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
10030processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
10031slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
10032example,
10033.code
10034${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
10035.endd
10036returns the string &"6/33"&.
10037
10038
10039
10040.vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
10041.cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
10042.cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
10043This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
10044interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
10045expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
10046additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
10047name of the subroutine, is nine.
10048
10049The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
10050the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
10051way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
10052Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
10053return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
10054not its contents.
10055
10056If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
10057with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
10058Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
10059
10060The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
10061out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10062
10063
10064.vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
10065.cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
10066The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
10067keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
10068it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
10069to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
10070as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
10071and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10072
10073.vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
10074 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
10075.cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
10076This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
10077checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
10078yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
10079empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
10080prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
10081version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
10082variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
10083
10084These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
10085retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
10086against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
10087which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
10088
10089The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
10090string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
10091result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
10092whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
10093is the expansion of the third argument.
10094
10095All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
10096However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
10097For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10098
10099.vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
10100.cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
10101.cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
10102.cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
10103The filename and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
10104then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
10105the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
10106newlines are left in the string.
10107String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
10108you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
10109the string expansion fails.
10110
10111The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
10112locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10113
10114
10115
10116.vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
10117 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
10118.cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
10119.cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
10120.cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
10121This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
10122string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
10123examples:
10124.code
10125${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
10126${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
10127.endd
10128For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
10129For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
10130a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
10131number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
10132optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
10133example:
10134.code
10135${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
10136.endd
10137Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
10138one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
10139both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
10140unless it is an empty string; and no terminating NUL is ever sent)
10141and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
10142is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
10143extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
10144.code
10145${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
10146.endd
10147
10148The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
10149and must be present if the argument is given.
10150Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
10151Two option types is currently recognised: shutdown and tls.
10152The first defines whether (the default)
10153or not a shutdown is done on the connection after sending the request.
10154Example, to not do so (preferred, eg. by some webservers):
10155.code
10156${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
10157.endd
10158The second, tls, controls the use of TLS on the connection. Example:
10159.code
10160${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:tls=yes}}
10161.endd
10162The default is to not use TLS.
10163If it is enabled, a shutdown as descripbed above is never done.
10164
10165A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
10166that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
10167turns them into spaces:
10168.code
10169${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
10170.endd
10171As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
10172happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
10173addition, the following errors can occur:
10174
10175.ilist
10176Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
10177.next
10178Failure to connect the socket;
10179.next
10180Failure to write the request string;
10181.next
10182Timeout on reading from the socket.
10183.endlist
10184
10185By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
10186you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
10187errors occurs. For example:
10188.code
10189${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
10190 {socket failure}}
10191.endd
10192You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
10193expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
10194and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
10195if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
10196non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
10197
10198The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
10199locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10200
10201
10202.vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10203.cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
10204.cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
10205.vindex "&$value$&"
10206.vindex "&$item$&"
10207This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
10208<&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
10209separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10210Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
10211assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
10212list is assigned to &$item$&, in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
10213them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
10214iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
10215added to the expansion output. The &%reduce%& expansion item can be used in a
10216number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
10217.code
10218${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
10219.endd
10220The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
10221can be found:
10222.code
10223${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
10224.endd
10225At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
10226restored to what they were before. See also the &%filter%& and &%map%&
10227expansion items.
10228
10229.vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
10230This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
10231expansion item in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
10232
10233.vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
10234 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10235.cindex "expansion" "running a command"
10236.cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
10237The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
10238split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
10239in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
10240executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
10241a shell, you must explicitly code it.
10242
10243Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
10244which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
10245simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
10246script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
10247variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
10248quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
10249in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
10250around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
10251variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
10252character.
10253
10254The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
10255and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
10256.cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
10257.vindex "&$value$&"
10258If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
10259and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
10260from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
10261<&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
10262expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
10263&$value$&.
10264
10265If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
10266can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
10267command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
10268of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
10269
10270.vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
10271The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
10272In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
10273troubleshoot:
10274.code
10275warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
10276 log_message = Output of id: $value
10277.endd
10278If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
10279shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
10280.code
10281${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
10282.endd
10283
10284.vindex "&$runrc$&"
10285The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
10286remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
10287.code
10288if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
10289 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
10290 ...
10291endif
10292.endd
10293If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
10294the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
10295commands.
10296
10297&*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
10298option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
10299testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
10300by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
10301
10302The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
10303out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10304
10305
10306.vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
10307.cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
10308.cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
10309This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
10310option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
10311modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
10312into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
10313a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
10314.code
10315${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
10316.endd
10317yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
10318if any $, } or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
10319substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
10320.code
10321${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
10322.endd
10323yields &"defabc"&, and
10324.code
10325${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
10326.endd
10327yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
10328the regular expression from string expansion.
10329
10330The regular expression is compiled in 8-bit mode, working against bytes
10331rather than any Unicode-aware character handling.
10332
10333
10334.vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
10335.cindex sorting "a list"
10336.cindex list sorting
10337.cindex expansion "list sorting"
10338After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10339default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10340The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
10341of a two-argument expansion condition.
10342The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
10343The comparison should return true when applied to two values
10344if the first value should sort before the second value.
10345The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
10346the element being placed in &$item$&,
10347to give values for comparison.
10348
10349The item result is a sorted list,
10350with the original list separator,
10351of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10352
10353Examples:
10354.code
10355${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10356.endd
10357sorts a list of numbers, and
10358.code
10359${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10360.endd
10361will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10362
10363
10364.vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10365.cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10366.cindex "substring extraction"
10367.cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10368The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10369<&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10370if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10371can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10372.code
10373${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10374.endd
10375The second number is optional (in both notations).
10376If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10377omitted.
10378
10379The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10380&%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10381length required. For example
10382.code
10383${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10384.endd
10385If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10386null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10387length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10388given offset. The first byte (character) in the string has offset zero.
10389
10390The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10391from the right-hand end of its operand. The last byte (character) is offset -1,
10392the second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10393.code
10394${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10395.endd
10396yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10397length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10398the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10399.code
10400${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10401.endd
10402yields an empty string, but
10403.code
10404${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10405.endd
10406yields &"1"&.
10407
10408When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10409is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all bytes (characters) in the
10410string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10411no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
10412.code
10413${substr_-1:abcde}
10414${substr{-1}{abcde}}
10415.endd
10416yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
10417
10418All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10419
10420
10421
10422.vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
10423 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
10424.cindex "expansion" "character translation"
10425.cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
10426This item does single-character (in bytes) translation on its subject string. The second
10427argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
10428matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
10429replacement list. For example
10430.code
10431${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
10432.endd
10433yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
10434last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
10435last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10436place.
10437
10438All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10439
10440.endlist
10441
10442
10443
10444.section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10445.cindex "expansion" "operators"
10446For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10447the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10448The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10449following operations can be performed:
10450
10451.vlist
10452.vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10453.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10454.cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10455The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
10456header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10457not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10458
10459The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10460
10461
10462.vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10463.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10464.cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10465The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
104662822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10467operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10468result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10469doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10470Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10471
10472It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10473separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10474character. For example:
10475.code
10476${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10477.endd
10478expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. The string is expanded
10479first, so if the expanded string starts with >, it may change the output
10480separator unintentionally. This can be avoided by setting the output
10481separator explicitly:
10482.code
10483${addresses:>:$h_from:}
10484.endd
10485
10486Compare the &%address%& (singular)
10487expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10488address. See the &%filter%&, &%map%&, and &%reduce%& items for ways of
10489processing lists.
10490
10491To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10492a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10493unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10494email address separator. For the example header line:
10495.code
10496From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10497.endd
10498The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10499properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10500It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10501example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10502de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10503The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10504quoted. The fourth example shows SMTPUTF8 handling.
10505.code
10506# exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10507=?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10508user@example.com
10509# exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10510Last:user@example.com
10511# exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10512user@example.com
10513# exim -be '${addresses:フィル <フィリップ@example.jp>}'
10514フィリップ@example.jp
10515.endd
10516
10517.vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10518.cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
10519.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10520The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10521base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
10522Only lowercase letters are used.
10523
10524.vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
10525.cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
10526.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10527The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
10528The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
10529
10530.vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10531.cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10532.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10533The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10534base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10535the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10536its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive
10537filenames), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just
10538to be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10539
10540.vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10541.cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10542.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10543The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10544environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10545identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10546string.
10547
10548.vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10549.cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10550.cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10551.cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10552.cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10553This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10554
10555If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10556returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10557
10558
10559.vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10560.cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10561.cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10562.cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10563This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
10564
10565
10566.vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10567.cindex "domain" "extraction"
10568.cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
10569The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
10570from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10571
10572
10573.vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10574.cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
10575.cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
10576If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
10577escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
10578significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
10579is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
10580
10581.vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10582.cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
10583.cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
10584If the string contains and characters with the most significant bit set,
10585they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
10586Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
10587
10588
10589.vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10590.cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
10591.cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
10592.cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
10593These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
10594expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
10595arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10596logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10597integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10598C programming language):
10599.table2 70pt 300pt
10600.irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10601.irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10602.irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10603.irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10604.irow "" "and (&&)"
10605.irow "" "xor (^)"
10606.irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10607.endtable
10608Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10609space is permitted before or after operators.
10610
10611For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10612hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10613decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10614permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10615times, which often do have leading zeros.
10616
10617A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10618or 1024*1024*1024,
10619respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10620a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10621
10622.display
10623&`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10624&`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10625&`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10626&`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10627&`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
10628&`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10629&`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10630&`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10631&`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10632&`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
10633&`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10634.endd
10635
10636As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10637.code
10638deny message = Too many bad recipients
10639 condition = \
10640 ${if and { \
10641 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10642 { \
10643 < \
10644 {$recipients_count} \
10645 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10646 } \
10647 }{yes}{no}}
10648.endd
10649The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10650fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10651
10652
10653.vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10654.cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10655The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10656example,
10657.code
10658${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10659.endd
10660first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10661and then re-expands what it has found.
10662
10663
10664.vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10665.cindex "Unicode"
10666.cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10667.cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10668.cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10669The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10670email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10671to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10672UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10673converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10674the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10675
10676Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10677ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10678For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10679way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10680characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10681single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10682translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10683
10684
10685.vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10686.cindex "hash function" "textual"
10687.cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10688The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10689be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10690change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10691.code
10692${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10693.endd
10694See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10695abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10696
10697
10698
10699.vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10700.cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10701.cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10702.cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10703This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10704be useful for processing the output of the various hashing functions.
10705
10706
10707
10708.vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10709.cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10710.cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10711This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10712escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10713as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example, a
10714byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10715
10716
10717.vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10718.cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10719.cindex "IP address" normalisation
10720This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10721of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10722A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10723Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10724
10725.vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10726.cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10727.cindex "IP address" normalisation
10728.cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10729This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10730Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10731set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10732A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10733Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10734
10735
10736.vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10737.cindex "case forcing in strings"
10738.cindex "string" "case forcing"
10739.cindex "lower casing"
10740.cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10741.cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10742This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10743.code
10744${lc:$local_part}
10745.endd
10746Case is defined per the system C locale.
10747
10748.vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10749.cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10750.cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10751The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10752can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10753changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10754.code
10755${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10756.endd
10757See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10758&%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10759when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10760All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10761
10762
10763.vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10764.cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10765.cindex "list" "item count"
10766.cindex "list" "count of items"
10767.cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10768The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10769
10770
10771.vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10772.cindex "expansion" "named list"
10773.cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10774The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10775expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10776If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10777and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10778Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10779matching list is returned.
10780
10781
10782.vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10783.cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10784.cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10785The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10786extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10787empty.
10788The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10789
10790
10791.vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10792.cindex "masked IP address"
10793.cindex "IP address" "masking"
10794.cindex "CIDR notation"
10795.cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10796.cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10797If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10798slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10799expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10800masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10801the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10802.code
10803${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10804.endd
10805returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10806be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10807address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10808terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10809.code
10810${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10811.endd
10812returns the string
10813.code
108143ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10815.endd
10816Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10817
10818
10819.vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10820.cindex "MD5 hash"
10821.cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10822.cindex certificate fingerprint
10823.cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10824The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10825as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10826
10827If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10828returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10829
10830
10831.vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10832.cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10833.cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10834The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10835that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10836strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10837.code
10838${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10839.endd
10840See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10841
10842
10843.vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10844.cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10845.cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10846.cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10847The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10848is an empty string or
10849contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10850Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10851Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10852respectively For example,
10853.code
10854${quote:ab"*"cd}
10855.endd
10856becomes
10857.code
10858"ab\"*\"cd"
10859.endd
10860The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10861variable or a message header.
10862
10863.vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10864.cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10865This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10866required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10867example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10868If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10869(or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10870
10871This quoting determination is not SMTPUTF8-aware, thus quoting non-ASCII data
10872will likely use the quoting form.
10873Thus &'${quote_local_part:フィル}'& will always become &'"フィル"'&.
10874
10875
10876.vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10877.cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10878This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10879query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10880the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10881.code
10882${quote_ldap:two * two}
10883.endd
10884returns
10885.code
10886two%20%5C2A%20two
10887.endd
10888For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10889yields an unchanged string.
10890
10891
10892.vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10893.cindex "random number"
10894This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10895supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10896on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10897If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10898If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10899for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10900Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10901srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10902random().
10903
10904
10905.vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10906.cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10907This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10908dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10909dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10910for DNS. For example,
10911.code
10912${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10913${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10914.endd
10915returns
10916.code
109174.2.0.192
10918f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10919.endd
10920
10921
10922.vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10923.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10924.cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10925.cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10926This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10927encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10928assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10929&%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
10930contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10931characters
10932.code
10933? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10934.endd
10935it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10936string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10937characters.
10938
10939
10940.vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10941.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10942.cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10943.cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10944This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10945bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10946character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10947not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10948
10949&*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10950access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10951to use this operator as well.
10952
10953
10954
10955.vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10956.cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10957.cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10958.cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10959The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10960characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10961variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10962
10963
10964.vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10965.cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10966.cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10967.cindex certificate fingerprint
10968.cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
10969The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10970it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10971
10972If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10973returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10974
10975
10976.vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10977 &*${sha2:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10978 &*${sha2_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10979.cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10980.cindex "SHA-2 hash"
10981.cindex certificate fingerprint
10982.cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10983.cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10984.cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
10985The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
10986and returns
10987it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10988
10989If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10990returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10991
10992.new
10993The operator can also be spelled &%sha2%& and does the same as &%sha256%&
10994(except for certificates, which are not supported).
10995Finally, if an underbar
10996and a number is appended it specifies the output length, selecting a
10997member of the SHA-2 family of hash functions.
10998Values of 256, 384 and 512 are accepted, with 256 being the default.
10999.wen
11000
11001
11002.vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11003 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11004.cindex "SHA3 hash"
11005.cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
11006.cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
11007The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
11008and returns
11009it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11010
11011If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
11012the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
11013with 256 being the default.
11014
11015The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
11016compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later,
11017or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later.
11018The macro "_CRYPTO_HASH_SHA3" will be defined if it is supported.
11019
11020
11021.vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11022.cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
11023.cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
11024.cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
11025The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
11026function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
11027expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
11028series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
11029except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
11030a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
1103110-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
11032&"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
11033can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
11034
11035The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
11036the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
11037systems for files larger than 2GB.
11038
11039.vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11040.cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
11041Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
11042
11043
11044
11045.vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11046.cindex "expansion" "string length"
11047.cindex "string" "length in expansion"
11048.cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
11049The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
11050decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
11051All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11052
11053
11054.vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11055.cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
11056.cindex "substring extraction"
11057.cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
11058The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
11059can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
11060that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11061.code
11062${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
11063.endd
11064See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
11065abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
11066All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11067
11068.vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11069.cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
11070.cindex "time interval" "decoding"
11071This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
11072seconds.
11073
11074.vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11075.cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
11076.cindex "time interval" "formatting"
11077The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
11078represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
11079number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
11080&`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
11081
11082.vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11083.cindex "case forcing in strings"
11084.cindex "string" "case forcing"
11085.cindex "upper casing"
11086.cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
11087.cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
11088This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
11089Case is defined per the system C locale.
11090
11091.vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11092.cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
11093.cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
11094.cindex "incorrect utf-8"
11095.cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
11096.cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
11097This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
11098In versions of Exim before 4.92, this did not correctly do so for a truncated
11099final codepoint's encoding, and the character would be silently dropped.
11100If you must handle detection of this scenario across both sets of Exim behavior,
11101the complexity will depend upon the task.
11102For instance, to detect if the first character is multibyte and a 1-byte
11103extraction can be successfully used as a path component (as is common for
11104dividing up delivery folders), you might use:
11105.code
11106condition = ${if inlist{${utf8clean:${length_1:$local_part}}}{:?}{yes}{no}}
11107.endd
11108(which will false-positive if the first character of the local part is a
11109literal question mark).
11110
11111.vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11112 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11113 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11114 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
11115.cindex expansion UTF-8
11116.cindex UTF-8 expansion
11117.cindex EAI
11118.cindex internationalisation
11119.cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11120.cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11121.cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11122.cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11123These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
11124For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
11125.endlist
11126
11127
11128
11129
11130
11131
11132.section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
11133.scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
11134The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
11135while expanding strings:
11136
11137.vlist
11138.vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
11139.cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
11140.cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
11141Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
11142condition.
11143
11144.vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11145.cindex "numeric comparison"
11146.cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
11147There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
11148are:
11149.display
11150&`= `& equal
11151&`== `& equal
11152&`> `& greater
11153&`>= `& greater or equal
11154&`< `& less
11155&`<= `& less or equal
11156.endd
11157For example:
11158.code
11159${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
11160.endd
11161Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
11162two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
11163optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
11164lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
11165As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
11166zero.
11167
11168In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
11169<&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
1117010M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
11171
11172
11173.vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
11174 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
11175.cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
11176.cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
11177The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
11178arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
11179Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
11180arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
11181and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
11182are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
11183a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
11184the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
11185If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
11186If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
11187
11188.vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11189.cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11190.cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
11191This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
11192a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
11193(case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
11194false if zero.
11195An empty string is treated as false.
11196Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
11197thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
11198All other string values will result in expansion failure.
11199
11200When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
11201make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
11202For example:
11203.code
11204${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
11205.endd
11206
11207
11208.vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11209.cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11210.cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
11211Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
11212where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
11213loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
11214and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
11215true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
11216
11217Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
11218
11219.vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11220.cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
11221.cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
11222.cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
11223This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
11224authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
11225necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
11226included in the binary.
11227
11228The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
11229compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
11230be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
11231encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
11232does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
11233&[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
11234Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
11235string in LDAP form is:
11236.code
11237{md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
11238.endd
11239If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
11240be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
11241.code
11242${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
11243.endd
11244The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
11245supported:
11246
11247.ilist
11248.cindex "MD5 hash"
11249.cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
11250&%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11251printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11252length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
11253(as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
11254hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
11255comparison fails.
11256
11257.next
11258.cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11259&%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11260printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11261length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
11262If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
11263SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
11264
11265.next
11266.cindex "&[crypt()]&"
11267&%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
11268only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
11269systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
11270whatever its length.
11271
11272.next
11273.cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
11274&%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
11275use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
11276modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
11277.endlist
11278Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
11279&[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
11280HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
11281operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
11282the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
11283support &[crypt16()]&.
11284
11285Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
11286it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
11287turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
11288&[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
11289algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
11290
11291However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
11292functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
11293Exim is seen as very low priority.
11294
11295If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
11296comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
11297determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
11298default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
11299function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
11300
11301.vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
11302.cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
11303.cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
11304The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
11305variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
11306variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
11307.code
11308${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
11309.endd
11310Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
11311variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
11312
11313.vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
11314 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
11315.cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
11316This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
11317exists in the message. For example,
11318.code
11319${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
11320.endd
11321&*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
11322the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
11323
11324.vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11325 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11326.cindex "string" "comparison"
11327.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11328.cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
11329.cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
11330The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
11331resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
11332letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent, where
11333case is defined per the system C locale.
11334
11335.vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
11336.cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
11337.cindex "file" "existence test"
11338.cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
11339The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
11340condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
11341is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
11342users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
11343
11344.vitem &*first_delivery*&
11345.cindex "delivery" "first"
11346.cindex "first delivery"
11347.cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
11348.cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
11349This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
11350attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
11351
11352
11353.vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11354 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11355.cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11356.cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
11357.cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
11358.vindex "&$item$&"
11359These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
11360the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
11361the normal method (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
11362The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
11363be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
11364condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
11365.ilist
11366For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
11367the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
11368items in the list, the overall condition is false.
11369.next
11370For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
11371and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
11372all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
11373.endlist
11374Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
11375items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
11376that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
11377list separator is changed to a comma:
11378.code
11379${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
11380.endd
11381The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &%forany%& or &%forall%& is
11382being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
11383
11384To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
11385
11386.new
11387.vitem "&*forall_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11388 "&*forany_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11389 "&*forall_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11390 "&*forany_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11391.cindex JSON "iterative conditions"
11392.cindex JSON expansions
11393.cindex expansion "&*forall_json*& condition"
11394.cindex expansion "&*forany_json*& condition"
11395.cindex expansion "&*forall_jsons*& condition"
11396.cindex expansion "&*forany_jsons*& condition"
11397As for the above, except that the first argument must, after expansion,
11398be a JSON array.
11399The array separator is not changeable.
11400For the &"jsons"& variants the elements are expected to be JSON strings
11401and have their quotes removed before the evaluation of the condition.
11402.wen
11403
11404
11405
11406.vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11407 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11408.cindex "string" "comparison"
11409.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11410.cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
11411.cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
11412The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11413string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
11414comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
11415case-independent.
11416Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11417
11418.vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11419 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11420.cindex "string" "comparison"
11421.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11422.cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
11423.cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
11424The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11425string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
11426includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
11427case-independent.
11428Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11429
11430.vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11431 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11432.cindex "string" "comparison"
11433.cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11434Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
11435strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
11436is true.
11437For the case-independent &%inlisti%& condition, case is defined per the system C locale.
11438
11439These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
11440Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
11441.code
11442${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
11443 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
11444${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
11445 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
11446.endd
11447
11448.vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11449 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11450 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11451.cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
11452.cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
11453.cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
11454.cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
11455.cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
11456The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
11457an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
11458&%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
11459
11460For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
11461which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
11462colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
11463hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
11464component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
11465
11466&*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
11467values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
11468check.
11469This is no longer the case.
11470
11471The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
11472host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
11473.code
11474${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
11475.endd
11476to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
11477
11478.vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
11479.cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
11480.cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
11481.cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
11482This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
11483&<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
11484queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
11485query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
11486password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
11487server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
11488with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
11489will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
11490of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
11491this can be used.
11492
11493
11494.vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11495 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11496.cindex "string" "comparison"
11497.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11498.cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
11499.cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
11500The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11501string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
11502comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
11503case-independent.
11504Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11505
11506.vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11507 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11508.cindex "string" "comparison"
11509.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11510.cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
11511.cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
11512The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11513string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
11514includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
11515case-independent.
11516Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11517
11518
11519.vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11520.cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
11521.cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
11522.cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
11523The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
11524expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
11525regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
11526escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
11527(curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
11528premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
11529&`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
11530For example,
11531.code
11532${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
11533.endd
11534If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
11535backslashes is also required.
11536
11537The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
11538The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
11539metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
11540and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
11541the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
11542metacharacter at an appropriate point.
11543All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware,
11544but we might change this in a future Exim release.
11545
11546.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
11547At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
11548substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
11549succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
11550will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
11551of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
11552combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
11553variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
11554
11555.vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11556.cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
11557See &*match_local_part*&.
11558
11559.vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11560.cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
11561See &*match_local_part*&.
11562
11563.vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11564.cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
11565This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
11566be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
11567address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
11568list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
11569.code
11570${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
11571.endd
11572The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
11573
11574.ilist
11575An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
11576.next
11577A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
11578.next
11579An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
11580useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
11581in a single test such as
11582. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11583. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
11584. ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
11585. ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
11586.code
11587 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
11588.endd
11589where the first item in the list is the empty string.
11590.next
11591The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
11592.next
11593Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
11594even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
11595address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
11596&*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
11597masks. For example:
11598.code
11599 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
11600.endd
11601It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
11602do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
11603address mask, for example:
11604.code
11605 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
11606.endd
11607However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
11608just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
11609.code
11610 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
11611.endd
11612.endlist ilist
11613
11614Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11615Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11616
11617Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
11618
11619.vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11620.cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
11621.cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
11622.cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
11623.cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
11624This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
11625possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
11626condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
11627example is:
11628.code
11629${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
11630.endd
11631In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
11632list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
11633is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
11634Thus, you can use conditions like this:
11635.code
11636${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
11637.endd
11638.cindex "&`+caseful`&"
11639For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
11640item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
11641have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
11642caselessly.
11643
11644Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11645Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11646
11647&*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
11648hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
11649how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
11650matched using &%match_ip%&.
11651
11652.vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
11653.cindex "PAM authentication"
11654.cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
11655.cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
11656.cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
11657.cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
11658&'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
11659(&url(https://mirrors.edge.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
11660available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
11661distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
11662the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
11663.code
11664SUPPORT_PAM=yes
11665.endd
11666in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
11667in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
11668
11669The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
11670colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
11671The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
11672taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
11673The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
11674from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
11675request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
11676
11677There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
11678characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
11679separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
11680item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
11681of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
11682.code
11683server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
11684.endd
11685For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
11686.code
11687server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
11688.endd
11689In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
11690running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
11691messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
11692. --- 2018-09-07: the pam_exim modified variant has gone, removed claims re using Exim via that
11693
11694
11695.vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11696.cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
11697.cindex "Cyrus"
11698.cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
11699.cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
11700This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
11701This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
11702that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11703deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11704
11705The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11706the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11707building Exim. For example:
11708.code
11709CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11710.endd
11711You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11712the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11713from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11714access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11715
11716The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11717password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11718configuration, you might have this:
11719.code
11720server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11721.endd
11722Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11723.code
11724server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11725.endd
11726.vitem &*queue_running*&
11727.cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11728.cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11729.cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11730This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11731initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11732
11733
11734.vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11735.cindex "Radius"
11736.cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11737.cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11738Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11739set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11740the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11741support.
11742
11743With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11744library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11745this library, you need to set
11746.code
11747RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11748.endd
11749in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11750&%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11751.code
11752RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11753.endd
11754in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11755You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11756Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11757
11758The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11759Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11760the authentication is successful. For example:
11761.code
11762server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11763.endd
11764
11765
11766.vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11767 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11768.cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11769.cindex "Cyrus"
11770.cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11771.cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11772This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11773daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11774Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11775by a process that is not running as root.
11776
11777The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11778the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11779building Exim. For example:
11780.code
11781CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11782.endd
11783You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11784the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11785from the Cyrus SASL library.
11786
11787Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11788two are mandatory. For example:
11789.code
11790server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11791.endd
11792The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11793in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11794realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11795.endlist vlist
11796
11797
11798
11799.section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11800.cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11801Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11802and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11803conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11804sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11805the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11806
11807
11808.vlist
11809.vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11810.cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11811.cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11812The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11813any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11814For example,
11815.code
11816${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11817.endd
11818When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11819evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11820numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11821
11822.vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11823.cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11824.cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11825The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11826all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11827sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11828the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11829parsed but not evaluated.
11830.endlist
11831.ecindex IIDexpcond
11832
11833
11834
11835
11836.section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11837.cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11838This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11839of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11840support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11841
11842.vlist
11843.vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11844.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11845When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11846captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11847processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11848In the expansion condition case
11849they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11850values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11851variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11852precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11853Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11854matching condition.
11855
11856.vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11857Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11858any arguments are copied to these variables,
11859any unused variables being made empty.
11860
11861.vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11862Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11863can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11864long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11865example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11866variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11867used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11868same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11869with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11870during subsequent delivery.
11871
11872.vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11873These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11874are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11875received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11876message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11877also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11878message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11879and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11880delivery.
11881
11882.vitem &$acl_narg$&
11883Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11884this variable has the number of arguments.
11885
11886.vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11887.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11888After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11889message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11890be preserved by coding like this:
11891.code
11892warn !verify = sender
11893 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11894.endd
11895You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11896&%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11897failure.
11898
11899.vitem &$address_data$&
11900.vindex "&$address_data$&"
11901This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11902value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11903and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11904the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11905for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11906user filter files.
11907
11908If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11909a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11910conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11911to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11912of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11913from the child's routing.
11914
11915If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11916sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11917&$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11918address.
11919
11920In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11921after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11922these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11923
11924.vitem &$address_file$&
11925.vindex "&$address_file$&"
11926When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11927to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11928is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11929default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11930.code
11931/home/r2d2/savemail
11932.endd
11933then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11934contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11935.cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11936For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11937then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11938to the relevant file.
11939
11940.vitem &$address_pipe$&
11941.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11942When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11943this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11944
11945.vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11946.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11947These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11948&<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11949
11950.vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11951.cindex "authentication" "id"
11952.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11953When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11954preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11955&$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11956user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11957in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11958&$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11959
11960When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11961the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11962process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11963command line option.
11964This second case also sets up information used by the
11965&$authresults$& expansion item.
11966
11967.vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11968.cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11969.vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11970When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11971will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11972id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11973available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11974A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11975authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11976the ACL's as well.
11977
11978
11979.vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11980.cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11981.cindex "authentication" "sender"
11982.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11983.vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11984When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11985SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11986described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11987&"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11988available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11989sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11990
11991.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11992When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11993value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11994name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11995can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11996
11997
11998.vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11999.cindex "authentication" "failure"
12000.vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
12001This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
12002command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
12003possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
12004(&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
12005&"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
12006is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
12007negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
12008an undefined mechanism.
12009
12010.vitem &$av_failed$&
12011.cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
12012This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
12013extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
12014problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
12015the ACL malware condition.
12016
12017.vitem &$body_linecount$&
12018.cindex "message body" "line count"
12019.cindex "body of message" "line count"
12020.vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
12021When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12022number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
12023
12024.vitem &$body_zerocount$&
12025.cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
12026.cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
12027.cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12028.vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
12029When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12030number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
12031
12032.vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
12033.vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
12034This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
12035it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
12036chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12037
12038.vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
12039.vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
12040This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
12041up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
12042file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12043
12044.vitem &$caller_gid$&
12045.cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
12046.vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12047The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12048not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
12049&$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12050incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
12051
12052.vitem &$caller_uid$&
12053.cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
12054.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12055The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12056not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
12057&$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12058incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
12059
12060.vitem &$callout_address$&
12061.vindex "&$callout_address$&"
12062After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
12063address that was connected to.
12064
12065.vitem &$compile_number$&
12066.vindex "&$compile_number$&"
12067The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
12068of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
12069compilations of the same version of Exim.
12070
12071.vitem &$config_dir$&
12072.vindex "&$config_dir$&"
12073The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
12074&$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
12075contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
12076&$config_dir$& is ".".
12077
12078.vitem &$config_file$&
12079.vindex "&$config_file$&"
12080The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
12081
12082.new
12083.vitem &$dmarc_domain_policy$& &&&
12084 &$dmarc_status$& &&&
12085 &$dmarc_status_text$& &&&
12086 &$dmarc_used_domains$&
12087Results of DMARC verification.
12088For details see section &<<SECDMARC>>&.
12089.wen
12090
12091.vitem &$dkim_verify_status$&
12092Results of DKIM verification.
12093For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12094
12095.vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
12096 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
12097 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
12098 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
12099 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
12100 &$dkim_algo$& &&&
12101 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
12102 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
12103 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
12104 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
12105 &$dkim_created$& &&&
12106 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
12107 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
12108 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
12109 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
12110 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
12111 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
12112 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
12113 &$dkim_key_length$&
12114These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
12115For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12116
12117.vitem &$dkim_signers$&
12118.vindex &$dkim_signers$&
12119When a message has been received this variable contains
12120a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
12121For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12122
12123.vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
12124 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
12125 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
12126 &$dnslist_value$&
12127.vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
12128.vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
12129.vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
12130.vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
12131.cindex "black list (DNS)"
12132When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
12133the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
12134looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
12135main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
12136
12137.vitem &$domain$&
12138.vindex "&$domain$&"
12139When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
12140contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
12141case for &$domain$&.
12142
12143Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12144&$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
12145is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
12146message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
12147
12148When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
12149RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
12150have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
12151at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
12152the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
12153which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
12154
12155.oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
12156At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
12157set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
12158
12159The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
12160
12161.ilist
12162When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
12163the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
12164&$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
12165normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
12166is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
12167&$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
12168the &(smtp)& transport.
12169
12170.next
12171When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12172&$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
12173it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
12174rewrite domains by file lookup.
12175
12176.next
12177With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
12178&$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
12179a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
12180is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
12181that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
12182recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
12183
12184.next
12185.cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
12186.oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
12187When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
12188the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
12189.endlist
12190
12191
12192.vitem &$domain_data$&
12193.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
12194When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
12195means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
12196of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
12197address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
12198transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
12199used.
12200
12201&$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
12202domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
12203the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
12204to nothing.
12205
12206.vitem &$exim_gid$&
12207.vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
12208This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
12209
12210.vitem &$exim_path$&
12211.vindex "&$exim_path$&"
12212This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
12213
12214.vitem &$exim_uid$&
12215.vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
12216This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
12217
12218.vitem &$exim_version$&
12219.vindex "&$exim_version$&"
12220This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
12221The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
12222Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
12223There may be other characters following the minor version.
12224This value may be overridden by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
12225
12226.vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
12227This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
12228inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
12229be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
12230characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
12231See the full description in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
12232
12233.vitem &$headers_added$&
12234.vindex "&$headers_added$&"
12235Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
12236the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
12237The headers are a newline-separated list.
12238
12239.vitem &$home$&
12240.vindex "&$home$&"
12241When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
12242directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
12243means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
12244explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
12245by a setting on the transport itself.
12246
12247When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
12248of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
12249&%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
12250
12251.vitem &$host$&
12252.vindex "&$host$&"
12253If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
12254list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
12255to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
12256to local and remote transports.
12257
12258.cindex "transport" "filter"
12259.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12260For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
12261&$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
12262particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
12263using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
12264&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
12265is connected.
12266
12267When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
12268&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
12269client is connected.
12270
12271
12272.vitem &$host_address$&
12273.vindex "&$host_address$&"
12274This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
12275for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
12276when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
12277
12278.vitem &$host_data$&
12279.vindex "&$host_data$&"
12280If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
12281result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
12282allows you, for example, to do things like this:
12283.code
12284deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
12285message = $host_data
12286.endd
12287.vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12288.cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
12289.vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12290This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
12291message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
12292name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
12293variables is set to &"1"&.
12294
12295.ilist
12296If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
12297succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12298
12299.next
12300If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
12301tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
12302lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
12303.endlist ilist
12304
12305Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
12306single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
12307names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
12308is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
12309&$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
12310IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
12311sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
12312lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
12313the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
12314&"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
12315
12316.cindex authentication "expansion item"
12317Performing these checks sets up information used by the
12318&%authresults%& expansion item.
12319
12320
12321.vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
12322.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12323See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
12324
12325.vitem &$host_port$&
12326.vindex "&$host_port$&"
12327This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
12328for an outbound connection.
12329
12330.vitem &$initial_cwd$&
12331.vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
12332This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
12333directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
12334working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
12335to &$spool_directory$& later.
12336
12337.vitem &$inode$&
12338.vindex "&$inode$&"
12339The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
12340option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
12341of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
12342a unique name for the file.
12343
12344.vitem &$interface_address$&
12345.vindex "&$interface_address$&"
12346This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
12347
12348.vitem &$interface_port$&
12349.vindex "&$interface_port$&"
12350This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
12351
12352.vitem &$item$&
12353.vindex "&$item$&"
12354This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
12355conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
12356&*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
12357empty.
12358
12359.vitem &$ldap_dn$&
12360.vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
12361This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
12362contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
12363lookup.
12364
12365.vitem &$load_average$&
12366.vindex "&$load_average$&"
12367This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
12368is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
12369variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
12370
12371.vitem &$local_part$&
12372.vindex "&$local_part$&"
12373When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
12374variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
12375delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
12376session), &$local_part$& is not set.
12377
12378Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12379&$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
12380&$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
12381because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
12382once.
12383
12384.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12385.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12386.cindex affix variables
12387If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
12388value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
12389any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
12390&$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
12391
12392When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
12393result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
12394the parent address, not to the filename or command (see &$address_file$& and
12395&$address_pipe$&).
12396
12397When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
12398local part of the recipient address.
12399
12400When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12401&$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
12402it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
12403
12404In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
12405the addresses
12406.code
12407"abc:xyz"@test.example
12408abc\:xyz@test.example
12409.endd
12410the value of &$local_part$& is
12411.code
12412abc:xyz
12413.endd
12414If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
12415inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
12416have:
12417.code
12418data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
12419.endd
12420&*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
12421to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
12422&%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
12423
12424.vitem &$local_part_data$&
12425.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
12426When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
12427lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
12428router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
12429to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
12430handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
12431
12432&$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
12433matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
12434available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
12435variable expands to nothing.
12436
12437.vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
12438.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12439.cindex affix variables
12440When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12441specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12442variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12443
12444.vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
12445.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12446When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12447specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12448variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12449
12450.vitem &$local_scan_data$&
12451.vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
12452This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
12453a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
12454
12455.vitem &$local_user_gid$&
12456.vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
12457See &$local_user_uid$&.
12458
12459.vitem &$local_user_uid$&
12460.vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
12461This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
12462&%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
12463are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
12464and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
12465router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
12466are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
12467
12468.vitem &$localhost_number$&
12469.vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
12470This contains the expanded value of the
12471&%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
12472been read.
12473
12474.vitem &$log_inodes$&
12475.vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12476The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
12477log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
12478referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
12479the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
12480
12481.vitem &$log_space$&
12482.vindex "&$log_space$&"
12483The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
12484partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
12485whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
12486ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
12487the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
12488
12489
12490.vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
12491.vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
12492This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
12493a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
12494.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12495It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
12496&"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
12497and &"yes"& if it was.
12498Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
12499the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
12500as authenticated data.
12501
12502.vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
12503.vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
12504This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
12505&(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
12506&%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
12507contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
12508without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
12509variable is empty.
12510
12511.vitem &$malware_name$&
12512.vindex "&$malware_name$&"
12513This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
12514content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
12515when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
12516
12517.vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
12518.vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
12519.cindex "maximum" "line length"
12520.cindex "line length" "maximum"
12521This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
12522received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
12523character(s).
12524It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12525
12526.vitem &$message_age$&
12527.cindex "message" "age of"
12528.vindex "&$message_age$&"
12529This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
12530of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
12531delivery attempt.
12532
12533.vitem &$message_body$&
12534.cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12535.cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12536.cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12537.vindex "&$message_body$&"
12538.oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
12539This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
12540being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
12541number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
12542&%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
12543
12544.oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
12545By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
12546easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
12547this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
12548zeros are always converted into spaces.
12549
12550.vitem &$message_body_end$&
12551.cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12552.cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12553.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
12554This variable contains the final portion of a message's
12555body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
12556&$message_body$&.
12557
12558.vitem &$message_body_size$&
12559.cindex "body of message" "size"
12560.cindex "message body" "size"
12561.vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
12562When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
12563in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
12564separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
12565also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12566
12567If the spool file is wireformat
12568(see the &%spool_files_wireformat%& main option)
12569the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
12570
12571.vitem &$message_exim_id$&
12572.vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
12573When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12574unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
12575An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
12576received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
12577line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
12578&`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
12579
12580.vitem &$message_headers$&
12581.vindex &$message_headers$&
12582This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
12583is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
12584lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
12585same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
12586
12587.vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
12588.vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
12589This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
12590contents of header lines is done.
12591
12592.vitem &$message_id$&
12593This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
12594
12595.vitem &$message_linecount$&
12596.vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
12597This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
12598message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
12599During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
12600number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
12601routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
12602&'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
12603lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
12604from the body is not counted.
12605
12606As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
12607appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
12608&$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
12609file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
12610header and the body).
12611
12612Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
12613.code
12614deny message = Too many lines in message header
12615 condition = \
12616 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
12617.endd
12618In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
12619message has not yet been received.
12620
12621This variable is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12622
12623.vitem &$message_size$&
12624.cindex "size" "of message"
12625.cindex "message" "size"
12626.vindex "&$message_size$&"
12627When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
12628most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
12629message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
12630deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
12631expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
12632doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
12633precise size of the file that has been written. See also
12634&$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12635
12636.cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
12637While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
12638contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
12639value may not, of course, be truthful.
12640
12641.vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
12642A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
12643available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
12644details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
12645
12646.vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
12647These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
12648of the &%add%& command in filter files.
12649
12650.vitem &$original_domain$&
12651.vindex "&$domain$&"
12652.vindex "&$original_domain$&"
12653When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12654same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
12655generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
12656variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
12657differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
12658aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
12659single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
12660
12661If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12662filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12663part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12664
12665.vitem &$original_local_part$&
12666.vindex "&$local_part$&"
12667.vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
12668When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12669same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
12670local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
12671part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
12672filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
12673the original address.
12674
12675If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
12676case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
12677This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
12678one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
12679delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
12680
12681If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12682filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12683part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12684
12685.vitem &$originator_gid$&
12686.cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
12687.cindex "sender" "gid"
12688.vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12689.vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
12690This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
12691message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
12692gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
12693normally the gid of the Exim user.
12694
12695.vitem &$originator_uid$&
12696.cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
12697.cindex "sender" "uid"
12698.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12699.vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
12700The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
12701messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
12702For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
12703user.
12704
12705.vitem &$parent_domain$&
12706.vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
12707This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
12708above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12709
12710.vitem &$parent_local_part$&
12711.vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
12712This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
12713(see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12714
12715.vitem &$pid$&
12716.cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
12717.vindex "&$pid$&"
12718This variable contains the current process id.
12719
12720.vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
12721.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12722.cindex "transport" "filter"
12723.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
12724This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
12725&`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
12726&(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
12727(described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
12728It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
12729variable"& error if encountered.
12730
12731.vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12732.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12733This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12734configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12735a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12736&[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12737qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12738
12739
12740.vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
12741 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
12742 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
12743 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
12744 &$proxy_session$&
12745These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
12746or SOCKS5 support.
12747For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
12748
12749.vitem &$prdr_requested$&
12750.cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
12751This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
12752current message, otherwise &"no"&.
12753
12754.vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12755This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12756which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12757&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12758
12759.vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12760This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12761which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12762&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12763
12764.vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12765This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12766which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12767&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12768
12769.vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12770.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12771The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12772
12773.vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12774.vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12775The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12776or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12777
12778.vitem &$queue_name$&
12779.vindex &$queue_name$&
12780.cindex "named queues"
12781.cindex queues named
12782The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
12783
12784.new
12785.vitem &$r_...$&
12786.vindex &$r_...$&
12787.cindex router variables
12788Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& option of a router.
12789They can be given any name that starts with &$r_$&.
12790The values persist for the address being handled through subsequent routers
12791and the eventual transport.
12792.wen
12793
12794.vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12795.vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12796When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12797RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12798RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12799
12800.vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12801.vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12802.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12803When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12804RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12805temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12806
12807.vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12808.vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12809When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12810RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12811permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12812
12813.vitem &$received_count$&
12814.vindex "&$received_count$&"
12815This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12816including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12817is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12818delivering.
12819
12820.vitem &$received_for$&
12821.vindex "&$received_for$&"
12822If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12823variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12824built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12825the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12826
12827.vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12828.vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12829As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12830variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12831is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12832&$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12833the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12834option.
12835
12836As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12837could be used, for example, to make the filename for a TLS certificate depend
12838on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12839values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12840messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12841time.
12842For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12843
12844.vitem &$received_port$&
12845.vindex "&$received_port$&"
12846See &$received_ip_address$&.
12847
12848.vitem &$received_protocol$&
12849.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12850When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12851protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12852by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12853&"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12854(encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12855is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12856connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12857
12858Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12859automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12860&%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12861encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12862where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12863STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12864
12865The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12866messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12867identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12868
12869.vitem &$received_time$&
12870.vindex "&$received_time$&"
12871This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12872as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12873
12874.vitem &$recipient_data$&
12875.vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12876This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12877condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12878until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12879.display
12880&`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12881&`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12882.endd
12883&*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12884method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12885The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12886expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12887
12888.vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12889.vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12890In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12891information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12892
12893.ilist
12894&"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12895was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12896
12897.next
12898&"route"&: Routing failed.
12899
12900.next
12901&"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12902or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12903MAIL).
12904
12905.next
12906&"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12907.next
12908
12909&"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12910.endlist
12911
12912The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12913rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12914
12915.vitem &$recipients$&
12916.vindex "&$recipients$&"
12917This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12918a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12919is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12920unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12921cases:
12922
12923.olist
12924In a system filter file.
12925.next
12926In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12927is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12928&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12929&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12930.next
12931From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12932.endlist
12933
12934
12935.vitem &$recipients_count$&
12936.vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12937When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12938envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12939from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12940increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12941
12942
12943.vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12944.vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12945This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12946&%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12947
12948.vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
12949.cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
12950When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
12951these variables contain the
12952captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
12953
12954
12955.vitem &$reply_address$&
12956.vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12957When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12958&'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12959contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12960white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12961decoding or character code translation takes place.
12962
12963.vitem &$return_path$&
12964.vindex "&$return_path$&"
12965When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12966the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12967in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12968same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12969mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12970for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12971address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12972that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12973the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12974envelope sender.
12975
12976.vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12977.vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12978This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12979
12980.vitem &$router_name$&
12981.cindex "router" "name"
12982.cindex "name" "of router"
12983.vindex "&$router_name$&"
12984During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12985
12986.vitem &$runrc$&
12987.cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12988.vindex "&$runrc$&"
12989This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12990&%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12991assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12992preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12993reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12994another.
12995
12996.vitem &$self_hostname$&
12997.oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12998.vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12999When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
13000local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
13001One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
13002happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
13003original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
13004
13005.vitem &$sender_address$&
13006.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
13007When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
13008that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
13009is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
13010value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
13011
13012.vitem &$sender_address_data$&
13013.vindex "&$address_data$&"
13014.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
13015If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
13016sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
13017distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
13018after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
13019longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
13020
13021.vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
13022.vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
13023The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
13024
13025.vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
13026.vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
13027The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
13028
13029.vitem &$sender_data$&
13030.vindex "&$sender_data$&"
13031This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
13032in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
13033value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
13034this:
13035.display
13036&`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
13037&`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
13038.endd
13039&*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
13040method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
13041The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
13042expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
13043
13044.vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
13045.vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
13046When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
13047name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
13048brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
13049enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
13050issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
13051looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
13052&%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
13053start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
13054verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
13055the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
13056the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
13057
13058.vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
13059.vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
13060This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
13061.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13062done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
13063
13064.vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
13065.vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
13066When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
13067command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
13068set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
13069the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
13070
13071.vitem &$sender_host_address$&
13072.vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
13073When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
13074this variable contains that
13075host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
13076
13077.vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
13078.vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
13079This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
13080driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
13081received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
13082&$authenticated_id$&.
13083
13084.vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
13085.vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
13086If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
13087(by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
13088otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
13089resolver library states that both
13090the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
13091other times, this variable is false.
13092
13093.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13094It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
13095library, by setting:
13096.code
13097dns_dnssec_ok = 1
13098.endd
13099
13100Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
13101validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
13102
13103If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
13104mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
13105
13106This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
13107DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
13108all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
13109is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
13110
13111
13112.vitem &$sender_host_name$&
13113.vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
13114When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13115host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
13116other means, this variable is empty.
13117
13118.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13119If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
13120&$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
13121A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
13122via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
13123any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
13124&$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
13125
13126.vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
13127However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
13128DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
13129&$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
13130
13131Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
13132host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
13133in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
13134is set to &"1"&.
13135
13136Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
13137maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
13138these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
13139following are true:
13140
13141.ilist
13142A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
13143.next
13144The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
13145configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
13146to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
13147.next
13148Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
13149that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
13150&<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
13151.next
13152The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
13153In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
13154EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
13155.next
13156The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
13157domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
13158. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
13159. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
13160.code
13161 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
13162.endd
13163which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
13164IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
13165.endlist
13166
13167
13168.vitem &$sender_host_port$&
13169.vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
13170When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
13171number that was used on the remote host.
13172
13173.vitem &$sender_ident$&
13174.vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
13175When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13176identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
13177been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
13178called Exim.
13179
13180.vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
13181A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
13182&%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
13183&<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
13184
13185.vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
13186.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13187.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13188.vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
13189This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
13190either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
13191there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
13192there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
13193the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
13194followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
13195first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
13196the parentheses.
13197
13198There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
13199was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
13200address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
13201all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
13202into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
13203
13204.vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
13205.vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
13206In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
13207about the failure. The details are the same as for
13208&$recipient_verify_failure$&.
13209
13210.vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
13211.vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
13212This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13213been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
13214used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
13215on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
13216connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
13217
13218.vitem &$sending_port$&
13219.vindex "&$sending_port$&"
13220This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13221been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
13222connections, see &$received_port$&.
13223
13224.vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
13225.vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
13226During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
13227host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
13228&$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
13229value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
13230
13231.vitem &$smtp_command$&
13232.vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
13233During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
13234entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
13235the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
13236.code
13237MAIL FROM:<>
13238MAIL FROM: <>
13239.endd
13240For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
13241command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
13242rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
13243the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
13244
13245.vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
13246.cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
13247.vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
13248While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
13249argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
13250space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
13251somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
13252
13253.vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
13254.cindex SMTP "command history"
13255.vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
13256A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
13257received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
13258are remembered.
13259
13260.vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
13261.vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
13262This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
13263daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
13264in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
13265connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
13266the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
13267never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
13268there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
13269single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
13270daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
13271
13272.vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
13273These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
13274that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
13275filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
13276example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
13277message is junk mail.
13278
13279.vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
13280A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
13281is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
13282&<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
13283
13284.vitem &$spf_header_comment$& &&&
13285 &$spf_received$& &&&
13286 &$spf_result$& &&&
13287 &$spf_result_guessed$& &&&
13288 &$spf_smtp_comment$&
13289These variables are only available if Exim is built with SPF support.
13290For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
13291
13292.vitem &$spool_directory$&
13293.vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
13294The name of Exim's spool directory.
13295
13296.vitem &$spool_inodes$&
13297.vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13298The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
13299being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
13300If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
13301is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
13302
13303.vitem &$spool_space$&
13304.vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13305The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
13306Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
13307variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
13308find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
13309value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
13310megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
13311.code
13312condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
13313.endd
13314See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
13315
13316
13317.vitem &$thisaddress$&
13318.vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
13319This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
13320command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
13321command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
13322interfaces to mail filtering'&.
13323
13324.vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
13325.vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
13326Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13327on the inbound connection; the meaning of
13328this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13329If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13330The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
13331when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
13332
13333The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
13334except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13335the outbound.
13336
13337.vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
13338.vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
13339Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13340on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
13341this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13342If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13343
13344.vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
13345.vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
13346.cindex certificate variables
13347This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13348inbound connection when the message was received.
13349It is only useful as the argument of a
13350&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13351or a &%def%& condition.
13352
13353&*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
13354when a list of more than one
13355file is used for &%tls_certificate%&, this variable is not reliable.
13356
13357.vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
13358.vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
13359This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13360inbound connection when the message was received.
13361It is only useful as the argument of a
13362&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13363or a &%def%& condition.
13364If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13365which is not the leaf.
13366
13367.vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
13368.vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
13369This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13370outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13371&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13372or a &%def%& condition.
13373
13374.vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
13375.vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
13376This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13377outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13378&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13379or a &%def%& condition.
13380If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13381which is not the leaf.
13382
13383.vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
13384.vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
13385This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
13386message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
13387
13388The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
13389except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13390the outbound.
13391
13392.vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
13393.vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
13394This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
13395outbound SMTP connection was made,
13396and &"0"& otherwise.
13397
13398.vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
13399.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13400.vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
13401When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13402connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
13403example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
13404received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
13405&$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
13406non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
13407
13408The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
13409but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
13410becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
13411
13412.new
13413.vitem &$tls_in_cipher_std$&
13414.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher_std$&"
13415As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13416.wen
13417
13418.vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
13419.vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
13420This variable is
13421cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
13422and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
13423&<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
13424details of the &(smtp)& transport.
13425
13426,new
13427.vitem &$tls_out_cipher_std$&
13428.vindex "&$tls_out_cipher_std$&"
13429As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13430.wen
13431
13432.vitem &$tls_out_dane$&
13433.vindex &$tls_out_dane$&
13434DANE active status. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13435
13436.vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
13437.vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
13438When a message is received from a remote client connection
13439the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
13440.code
134410 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
134421 No response to request
134432 Response not verified
134443 Verification failed
134454 Verification succeeded
13446.endd
13447
13448.vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
13449.vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
13450When a message is sent to a remote host connection
13451the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
13452See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
13453
13454.vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
13455.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
13456.vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
13457.cindex certificate "extracting fields"
13458When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13459connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
13460the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13461&$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13462If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13463which is not the leaf.
13464
13465The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
13466except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13467the outbound.
13468
13469.vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
13470.vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
13471When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13472connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
13473the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13474&$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13475If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13476which is not the leaf.
13477
13478.vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
13479.vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
13480.vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
13481.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13482When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
13483Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
13484If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
13485some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
13486will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
13487a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
13488used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
13489
13490The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
13491except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13492the outbound.
13493
13494.vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
13495.vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
13496.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13497During outbound
13498SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
13499the transport.
13500
13501.vitem &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13502.vindex &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13503Bitfield of TLSA record types found. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13504
13505.vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
13506.vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
13507The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
13508files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
13509
13510.vitem &$tod_epoch$&
13511.vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
13512The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13513
13514.vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
13515.vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
13516The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13517
13518.vitem &$tod_full$&
13519.vindex "&$tod_full$&"
13520A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
13521+0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
13522positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
13523values for those that are behind (west).
13524
13525.vitem &$tod_log$&
13526.vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13527The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
135281995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
13529
13530.vitem &$tod_logfile$&
13531.vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
13532This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
13533is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
13534flag.
13535
13536.vitem &$tod_zone$&
13537.vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13538This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
13539-0500.
13540
13541.vitem &$tod_zulu$&
13542.vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
13543This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
13544by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
13545
13546.vitem &$transport_name$&
13547.cindex "transport" "name"
13548.cindex "name" "of transport"
13549.vindex "&$transport_name$&"
13550During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
13551
13552.vitem &$value$&
13553.vindex "&$value$&"
13554This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
13555or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
13556&*reduce*& expansion.
13557
13558.vitem &$verify_mode$&
13559.vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
13560While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
13561contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
13562Otherwise, empty.
13563
13564.vitem &$version_number$&
13565.vindex "&$version_number$&"
13566The version number of Exim. Same as &$exim_version$&, may be overridden
13567by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
13568
13569.vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
13570.vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
13571This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13572delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13573
13574.vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
13575.vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
13576This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13577delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13578.endlist
13579.ecindex IIDstrexp
13580
13581
13582
13583. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13584. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13585
13586.chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
13587.scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
13588Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
13589Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
13590use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
13591your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
13592the line
13593.code
13594EXIM_PERL = perl.o
13595.endd
13596in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
13597
13598
13599.section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
13600.oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
13601Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
13602&%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
13603no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
13604interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
13605the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
13606option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
13607a newly created Perl interpreter.
13608
13609The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
13610need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
13611should usually be something like
13612.code
13613perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
13614.endd
13615where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
13616use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
13617soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
13618the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
13619its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
13620fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
13621necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
13622the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
13623two ways:
13624
13625.ilist
13626.oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
13627Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
13628a startup when Exim is entered.
13629.next
13630The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
13631overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
13632.endlist
13633
13634There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
13635initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
13636
13637.ilist
13638.oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
13639.cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
13640To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
13641interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
13642taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
13643option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
13644defaults to false.
13645
13646
13647.section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
13648When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
13649of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
13650by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
13651forms:
13652.code
13653${perl{foo}}
13654${perl{foo}{argument}}
13655${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
13656.endd
13657which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
13658arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
13659with an error message of the form
13660.code
13661Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
13662.endd
13663The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
13664it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
13665return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
13666an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
13667by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
13668that was passed to &%die%&.
13669
13670
13671.section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
13672Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
13673is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
13674the Perl code
13675.code
13676my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
13677.endd
13678makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
13679Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
13680&$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
13681
13682If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
13683&'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
13684expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
13685an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
13686
13687.cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
13688.cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
13689Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
13690&'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
13691debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
13692&'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
13693timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
13694
13695
13696.section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
13697.cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
13698You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
13699Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
13700before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
13701SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
13702is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
13703error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
13704avoided, but the output is lost.
13705
13706.cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
13707The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
13708Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
13709you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
13710output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
13711change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
13712For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
13713.code
13714$SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
13715.endd
13716Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
13717example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
13718include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
13719as the first subroutine argument.
13720.ecindex IIDperl
13721
13722
13723. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13724. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13725
13726.chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
13727 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
13728 "Starting the daemon"
13729.cindex "daemon" "starting"
13730.cindex "interface" "listening"
13731.cindex "network interface"
13732.cindex "interface" "network"
13733.cindex "IP address" "for listening"
13734.cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
13735.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
13736.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13737A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
13738hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
13739or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
13740works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
13741In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
13742IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
13743knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
13744
13745.olist
13746When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
13747and ports to listen on.
13748.next
13749When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
13750are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
13751processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
13752same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
13753when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
13754local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
13755option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
13756as an error situation.
13757.next
13758When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
13759for the outgoing connection.
13760.endlist
13761
13762
13763Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
13764of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
13765addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
13766standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
13767rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
13768
13769In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
13770interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
13771options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
13772chapter describes how they operate.
13773
13774When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
13775actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
13776
13777
13778
13779.section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
13780When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
13781option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
13782following options:
13783
13784.ilist
13785&%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
13786or service names.
13787(For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
13788.next
13789&%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
13790listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
13791.endlist
13792
13793The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
13794described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
13795it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
13796colons. For example:
13797.code
13798local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
13799 192.168.23.65 ; \
13800 ::1 ; \
13801 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
13802.endd
13803There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
13804in &%local_interfaces%&:
13805
13806.olist
13807The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
13808on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
13809.code
13810local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
13811 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
13812.endd
13813.next
13814The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13815with a colon separator, for example:
13816.code
13817local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13818 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13819.endd
13820.endlist
13821
13822When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13823default setting contains just one port:
13824.code
13825daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13826.endd
13827If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13828specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13829&%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13830&_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13831IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13832
13833
13834
13835.section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13836The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13837as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13838case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13839instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13840default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13841.code
13842local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13843.endd
13844when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13845.code
13846local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13847.endd
13848Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13849
13850
13851
13852.section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13853The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13854&%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13855instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13856option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13857the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13858exim.
13859
13860The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13861changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) if required.
13862If there are any items that do not
13863contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13864&%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13865items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13866replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13867.code
13868-oX 1225
13869.endd
13870overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13871whereas
13872.code
13873-oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13874.endd
13875overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13876(However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13877value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13878
13879
13880
13881.section "Support for the submissions (aka SSMTP or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13882.cindex "submissions protocol"
13883.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13884.cindex "smtps protocol"
13885.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13886.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13887Exim supports the use of TLS-on-connect, used by mail clients in the
13888&"submissions"& protocol, historically also known as SMTPS or SSMTP.
13889For some years, IETF Standards Track documents only blessed the
13890STARTTLS-based Submission service (port 587) while common practice was to support
13891the same feature set on port 465, but using TLS-on-connect.
13892If your installation needs to provide service to mail clients
13893(Mail User Agents, MUAs) then you should provide service on both the 587 and
13894the 465 TCP ports.
13895
13896If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a list of port numbers or
13897service names, connections to those ports must first establish TLS, before
13898proceeding to the application layer use of the SMTP protocol.
13899
13900The common use of this option is expected to be
13901.code
13902tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13903.endd
13904per RFC 8314.
13905There is also a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports
13906to behave in this way when a daemon is started.
13907
13908&*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13909daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13910&%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13911because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13912connections via the daemon.)
13913
13914
13915
13916
13917.section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13918.cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13919IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13920can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13921interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13922address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13923percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13924adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13925.code
13926fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13927.endd
13928To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13929allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13930to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13931percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13932address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13933&[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13934.code
13935IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13936.endd
13937is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13938Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13939instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13940function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13941&[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13942
13943.section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13944.cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13945Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13946run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13947using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13948connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13949.oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13950&%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13951activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13952that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13953etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13954to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13955
13956On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13957disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13958option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13959and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13960IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13961
13962
13963
13964.section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13965The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13966.code
13967daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13968local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13969.endd
13970This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13971Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13972the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13973read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13974
13975To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13976.code
13977daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
13978.endd
13979(leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
13980.code
13981local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13982 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13983.endd
13984To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13985IPv4 loopback address only:
13986.code
13987local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13988.endd
13989To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13990.code
13991local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13992.endd
13993&*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13994
13995
13996
13997.section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13998The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13999whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
14000addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
14001treated as local.
14002
14003For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
14004the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
14005available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
14006(that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
14007
14008Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
14009many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
14010email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
14011interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
14012&%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
14013&"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
14014used for listening. Consider this example:
14015.code
14016local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
14017 192.168.53.235 ; \
14018 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
14019
14020extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14021.endd
14022The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
14023address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
14024Exim is routing.
14025
14026In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
14027address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
14028desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
14029these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
14030This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
14031during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
14032host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
14033addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
14034
14035
14036
14037.section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
14038Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
14039allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
14040there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
14041&%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
14042description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
14043details.
14044
14045
14046
14047
14048. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14049. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14050
14051.chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
14052.scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
14053.scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
14054The first part of the runtime configuration file contains three types of item:
14055
14056.ilist
14057Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
14058&<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
14059.next
14060Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
14061&"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
14062section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
14063.next
14064Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
14065(with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
14066&"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
14067only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
14068settings.
14069.endlist
14070
14071This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
14072types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
14073in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
14074are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
14075an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
14076listed in more than one group.
14077
14078.section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
14079.table2
14080.row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
14081.row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
14082.row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14083.row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
14084.row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
14085.row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
14086.row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
14087.row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
14088.row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
14089.row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
14090.row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
14091.endtable
14092
14093
14094.section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
14095.table2
14096.row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
14097.row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14098.row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
14099.row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
14100.row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
14101.row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
14102.endtable
14103
14104
14105
14106.section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
14107.table2
14108.row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
14109.row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
14110.row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
14111.row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
14112.row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14113.row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14114.row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
14115.row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
14116.row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
14117.row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
14118.row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
14119.row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
14120.endtable
14121
14122
14123
14124.section "Logging" "SECID99"
14125.table2
14126.row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
14127.row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
14128.row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14129.row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
14130.row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
14131.row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
14132.row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
14133.row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
14134.row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
14135.row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
14136.row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
14137.row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
14138.row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
14139.row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
14140.row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
14141.endtable
14142
14143
14144
14145.section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
14146.table2
14147.row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
14148.row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
14149.row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
14150.row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
14151.endtable
14152
14153
14154
14155.section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
14156.table2
14157.row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
14158.row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14159.row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14160.row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
14161.row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
14162.row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
14163.row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
14164.row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
14165.row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
14166.row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
14167.row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
14168.row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
14169.row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
14170.row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
14171.row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
14172.endtable
14173
14174
14175
14176.section "Message ids" "SECID102"
14177.table2
14178.row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
14179.row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
14180.endtable
14181
14182
14183
14184.section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
14185.table2
14186.row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
14187.row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
14188.row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
14189.endtable
14190
14191
14192
14193.section "Daemon" "SECID104"
14194.table2
14195.row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
14196.row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
14197.row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
14198.row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
14199.row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
14200.row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14201.row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14202.endtable
14203
14204
14205
14206.section "Resource control" "SECID105"
14207.table2
14208.row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14209.row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
14210.row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14211.row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
14212.row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
14213.row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
14214.row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14215.row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14216.row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14217.row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14218.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14219.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14220.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14221.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14222.row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14223.row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14224 connection"
14225.row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14226.row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14227.row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14228.row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
14229.row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14230.endtable
14231
14232
14233
14234.section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
14235.table2
14236.row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
14237.row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
14238.row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
14239.row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
14240.row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
14241.row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
14242.row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
14243.row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
14244.row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
14245.row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
14246.row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
14247.row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
14248.row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
14249.row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
14250.row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
14251.row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
14252.row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
14253.row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
14254.row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
14255.row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
14256.row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
14257.row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14258 words""&"
14259.row &%dns_cname_loops%& "follow CNAMEs returned by resolver"
14260.row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
14261.row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
14262.row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14263.row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14264.row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
14265.row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
14266.row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
14267.row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
14268.row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
14269.row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14270.row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14271.row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
14272.row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
14273.row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
14274.row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
14275.row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
14276.row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14277.row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
14278.row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
14279.endtable
14280
14281
14282
14283.section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
14284.table2
14285.row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
14286 item"
14287.row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
14288 item"
14289.row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
14290.row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
14291.row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
14292.endtable
14293
14294
14295
14296.section "TLS" "SECID108"
14297.table2
14298.row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
14299.row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
14300.row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
14301.row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14302.row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
14303.row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
14304.row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
14305.row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
14306.row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
14307.row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
14308.row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
14309.row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
14310.row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
14311.row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
14312.row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
14313.row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
14314.row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
14315.endtable
14316
14317
14318
14319.section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
14320.table2
14321.row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
14322.row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
14323.row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
14324.row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
14325.row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
14326.row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
14327.row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
14328.row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
14329.endtable
14330
14331
14332
14333.section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
14334.table2
14335.row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14336.row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14337.row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
14338.row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14339.row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
14340.row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
14341.row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
14342.row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
14343.endtable
14344
14345
14346
14347
14348.section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
14349.table2
14350.row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
14351.endtable
14352
14353
14354
14355
14356
14357.section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
14358See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
14359
14360.table2
14361.row &%dkim_verify_hashes%& "DKIM hash methods accepted for signatures"
14362.row &%dkim_verify_keytypes%& "DKIM key types accepted for signatures"
14363.row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domains for which DKIM ACL is run"
14364.row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14365.row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14366.row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
14367.row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
14368.row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
14369.row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
14370.row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
14371.row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14372.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14373.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14374.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14375.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14376.row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14377.row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14378 connection"
14379.row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14380.row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
14381.row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
14382.row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14383.row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14384.row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
14385.row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
14386.row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
14387.row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
14388.row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
14389.row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
14390.row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
14391.row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
14392.row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
14393.row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14394.row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14395.endtable
14396
14397
14398
14399.section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
14400.table2
14401.row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
14402.row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
14403.row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
14404.row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
14405.row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
14406.row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
14407.row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14408.row &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14409.row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
14410.row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
14411.row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14412.endtable
14413
14414
14415
14416.section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
14417.table2
14418.row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
14419.row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
14420.row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
14421.row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14422 words""&"
14423.row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14424.row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14425.row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
14426.row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
14427.row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
14428.row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
14429.row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14430.row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
14431.row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
14432.row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
14433.endtable
14434
14435
14436
14437.section "System filter" "SECID115"
14438.table2
14439.row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
14440.row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
14441 directory"
14442.row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
14443.row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
14444.row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
14445.row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
14446.row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
14447.endtable
14448
14449
14450
14451.section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
14452.table2
14453.row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14454.row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
14455.row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
14456.row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
14457.row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
14458.row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
14459.row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
14460.row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
14461.row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
14462.row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
14463.row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
14464.row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
14465.row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
14466.row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
14467.row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
14468.row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14469.row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
14470.row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
14471.row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
14472.row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
14473.row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14474.row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
14475.row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
14476.row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
14477.endtable
14478
14479
14480
14481.section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
14482.table2
14483.row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
14484.row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
14485.row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
14486.row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
14487.row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
14488.row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
14489.row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
14490.row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
14491.row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
14492.row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
14493.row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
14494.row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
14495.row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
14496.row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14497.row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
14498.endtable
14499
14500
14501
14502.section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
14503Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
14504&dagger;.
14505
14506.option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
14507.cindex "8BITMIME"
14508.cindex "8-bit characters"
14509.cindex "log" "selectors"
14510.cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
14511This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
14512EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
14513However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
14514takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
14515
14516Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
14517feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
14518It now defaults to true.
14519A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
14520.display
14521&url(https://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
14522.endd
14523
14524To log received 8BITMIME status use
14525.code
14526log_selector = +8bitmime
14527.endd
14528
14529.option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
14530.cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
14531.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14532This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
14533read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14534further details.
14535
14536.option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14537This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
14538messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
14539SMTP messages.
14540
14541.option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
14542.cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
14543.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14544This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
14545non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14546
14547.option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
14548.cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
14549.cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
14550This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
14551received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14552
14553.option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
14554.cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
14555This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
14556See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14557
14558.option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
14559.cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
14560This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
14561processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
14562acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14563
14564.option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
14565.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
14566.cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
14567.cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
14568.cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
14569This option defines the ACL that,
14570if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
14571is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
14572processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
14573acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14574
14575.option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
14576.cindex DKIM "ACL for"
14577This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
14578(by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
14579of a received message.
14580See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>& for further details.
14581
14582.option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
14583.cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
14584This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
14585received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14586
14587.option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
14588.cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
14589This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
14590received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14591
14592.option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
14593.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
14594.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
14595This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
14596command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14597
14598
14599.option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
14600.cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
14601This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
14602received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14603
14604.option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
14605.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
14606This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
14607a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
14608&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
14609
14610.option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14611.cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
14612This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
14613extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
14614section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
14615
14616.option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
14617.cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
14618This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
14619ends without a QUIT command being received.
14620See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14621
14622.option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
14623This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
14624received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14625further details.
14626
14627.option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
14628.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
14629This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
14630received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14631
14632.option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
14633.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
14634This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
14635received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14636
14637.option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
14638.cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
14639This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
14640received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14641
14642.option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
14643.cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
14644This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
14645received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14646
14647.option add_environment main "string list" empty
14648.cindex "environment" "set values"
14649This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
14650currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use.
14651See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
14652
14653.option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
14654.cindex "admin user"
14655This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
14656current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
14657colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
14658programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
14659admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
14660not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
14661To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
14662
14663.option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
14664.cindex "domain literal"
14665If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
14666email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
14667format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
14668has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
14669
14670Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
14671format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
14672addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
14673&%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
14674domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
14675configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
14676the local host's IP addresses.
14677
14678
14679.option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
14680.cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
14681It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
14682and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
14683MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
14684that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
14685practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
14686&%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
14687recommended, except when you have no other choice.
14688
14689.option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
14690.cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
14691.cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
14692Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
14693camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
14694that at least two other MTAs permit this.
14695This option allows Exim users to experiment if they wish.
14696
14697If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
14698UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
14699letters, digits, and hyphens.
14700
14701.new
14702If Exim is built with internationalization support
14703and the SMTPUTF8 ESMTP option is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>&)
14704this option can be left as default.
14705.wen
14706Without that,
14707if you want to look up such domain names in the DNS, you must also
14708adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
14709suitable setting is:
14710.code
14711dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
14712 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
14713.endd
14714Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
14715.code
14716dns_check_names_pattern =
14717.endd
14718That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
14719
14720
14721.option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14722.cindex "authentication" "advertising"
14723.cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
14724If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
14725response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
14726Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
14727Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
14728advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
14729authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
14730&%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
14731authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
14732
14733Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
14734and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
14735not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
14736authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
14737to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
14738which Exim advertises AUTH.
14739
14740.cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
14741If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
14742is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
14743option is expanded, with a setting like this:
14744.code
14745auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
14746.endd
14747.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
14748If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
14749the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
14750expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
14751
14752
14753.option auto_thaw main time 0s
14754.cindex "thawing messages"
14755.cindex "unfreezing messages"
14756If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
14757new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
14758this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
14759being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
14760saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
14761
14762&*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
14763&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
14764thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
14765
14766
14767.option av_scanner main string "see below"
14768This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
14769It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
14770.code
14771sophie:/var/run/sophie
14772.endd
14773If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
14774before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
14775
14776
14777.option bi_command main string unset
14778.oindex "&%-bi%&"
14779This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
14780the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
14781just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
14782required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
14783
14784
14785.option bounce_message_file main string unset
14786.cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
14787.cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
14788This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
14789for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
14790chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
14791
14792
14793.option bounce_message_text main string unset
14794When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
14795message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
14796delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
14797
14798.option bounce_return_body main boolean true
14799.cindex "bounce message" "including body"
14800This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
14801bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
14802causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
14803value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
14804message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
14805error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
14806point at which the error was detected are returned.
14807.cindex "bounce message" "including original"
14808
14809.option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
14810.cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
14811.cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
14812.cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
14813This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
14814that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
14815when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
14816The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
14817If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
14818treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
14819
14820The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
14821during reception of a message.
14822In this case lines from the original are truncated.
14823
14824The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
14825
14826
14827.option bounce_return_message main boolean true
14828If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
14829bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
14830&%bounce_return_body%&.
14831
14832
14833.option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
14834.cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
14835.cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
14836.cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
14837This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
14838senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
14839limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
14840any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
14841that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
14842
14843When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
14844greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
14845added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
14846to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
14847size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
14848messages.
14849
14850.option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
14851.cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
14852.cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
14853.cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
14854This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
14855bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
14856connection. A typical setting might be:
14857.code
14858bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14859.endd
14860which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
14861.code
14862MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14863.endd
14864The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
14865address.
14866
14867.option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14868.cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14869.cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14870This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14871domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14872section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14873
14874
14875.option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14876This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14877domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14878section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14879
14880
14881.option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14882This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14883address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14884section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14885
14886
14887.option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14888This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14889address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14890section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14891
14892
14893.option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14894This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14895callout verification. The default value is
14896.code
14897$primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14898.endd
14899See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14900
14901
14902.option check_log_inodes main integer 100
14903See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14904
14905
14906.option check_log_space main integer 10M
14907See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14908
14909.oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14910.cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14911.option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14912RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14913system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14914word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14915multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14916exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14917of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14918set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14919
14920
14921.option check_spool_inodes main integer 100
14922See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14923
14924
14925.option check_spool_space main integer 10M
14926.cindex "checking disk space"
14927.cindex "disk space, checking"
14928.cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14929The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14930message is accepted.
14931
14932.vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14933.vindex "&$log_space$&"
14934.vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14935.vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14936When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14937want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14938testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14939&$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14940
14941
14942&%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14943either value is greater than zero, for example:
14944.code
14945check_spool_space = 100M
14946check_spool_inodes = 100
14947.endd
14948The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14949SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14950transit.
14951
14952&%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14953files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14954&%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14955
14956If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14957incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14958error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14959SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14960&%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14961&%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14962
14963The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14964number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
14965If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
14966
14967For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
14968failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
14969it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
14970
14971There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
14972Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
14973high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
14974may wish to deliberately disable them.
14975
14976.option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14977.cindex CHUNKING advertisement
14978.cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
14979The CHUNKING extension (RFC3030) will be advertised in the EHLO message to
14980these hosts.
14981Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
14982
14983.option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
14984.cindex "restricting access to features"
14985This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
14986administrative user.
14987This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
14988
14989.option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
14990.cindex debugging "memory corruption"
14991.cindex memory debugging
14992This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
14993management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
14994it should normally be left as default.
14995
14996.option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
14997.cindex "port" "for daemon"
14998.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14999This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
15000listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
15001backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
15002
15003.option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
15004.cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
15005This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
15006the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
15007(typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
15008defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
15009&%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
15010
15011.option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
15012See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
15013
15014.option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
15015.cindex "warning of delay"
15016.cindex "delay warning, specifying"
15017.cindex "queue" "delay warning"
15018When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
15019intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
15020after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
15021string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
15022message has been in the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
15023between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
15024with
15025.code
15026delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
15027.endd
15028the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
15029the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
15030because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
15031just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
15032.code
15033delay_warning = 6h
15034.endd
15035messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
15036a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
15037.code
15038delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
15039.endd
15040Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
15041which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
15042Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
15043
15044.option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
15045.vindex "&$domain$&"
15046The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
15047deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
15048expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
15049forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
15050&"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
15051not sent. The default is:
15052.code
15053delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
15054 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
15055 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
15056 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
15057 } {no}{yes}}
15058.endd
15059This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
15060&'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
15061&"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
15062&"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
15063
15064.option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
15065.cindex "unprivileged delivery"
15066.cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
15067If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
15068delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
15069the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
15070of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
15071chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
15072
15073.option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
15074.cindex "load average"
15075.cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
15076When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
15077becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
15078ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
15079See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15080
15081
15082.option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
15083.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
15084Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
15085message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15086handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
15087should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
15088removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
15089occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15090
15091.option disable_fsync main boolean false
15092.cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
15093This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
15094ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
15095a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
15096build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
15097really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
15098distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
15099
15100When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
15101updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
15102such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
15103Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
15104
15105
15106.option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
15107.cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
15108If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
15109activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
15110that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
15111etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
15112to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
15113
15114
15115.new
15116.option dkim_verify_hashes main "string list" "sha256 : sha512 : sha1"
15117.cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
15118This option gives a list of hash types which are acceptable in signatures,
15119and an order of processing.
15120Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15121
15122Note that the presence of sha1 violates RFC 8301.
15123Signatures using the rsa-sha1 are however (as of writing) still common.
15124The default inclusion of sha1 may be dropped in a future release.
15125
15126.option dkim_verify_keytypes main "string list" "ed25519 : rsa"
15127This option gives a list of key types which are acceptable in signatures,
15128and an order of processing.
15129Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15130
15131.option dkim_verify_minimal main boolean false
15132If set to true, verification of signatures will terminate after the
15133first success.
15134.wen
15135
15136.option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
15137.cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
15138This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
15139It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
15140the ACL once for each signature in the message.
15141See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
15142
15143
15144.option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
15145.cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
15146DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
15147&"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
15148keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
15149incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
15150may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
15151anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
15152This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
15153by a setting such as this:
15154.code
15155dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
15156.endd
15157This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
15158&[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
15159since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
15160&(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
15161when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
15162options are applied after this global option.
15163
15164.option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
15165.cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
15166When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
15167names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
15168the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
15169contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
15170a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
15171done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
15172value of this option. The default pattern is
15173.code
15174dns_check_names_pattern = \
15175 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
15176.endd
15177which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
15178they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
15179permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
15180accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
15181&%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
15182empty string.
15183
15184.option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
15185This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
15186DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15187
15188.option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
15189This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
15190reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
15191section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15192
15193.option dns_cname_loops main integer 1
15194.cindex DNS "CNAME following"
15195This option controls the following of CNAME chains, needed if the resolver does
15196not do it internally.
15197As of 2018 most should, and the default can be left.
15198If you have an ancient one, a value of 10 is likely needed.
15199
15200The default value of one CNAME-follow is needed
15201thanks to the observed return for an MX request,
15202given no MX presence but a CNAME to an A, of the CNAME.
15203
15204
15205.option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
15206.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15207.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15208If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15209DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
15210default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
15211
15212If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
15213
15214
15215.option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
15216.cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
15217.cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
15218.cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
15219When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
15220looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
15221(A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
15222domain matches this list.
15223
15224This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
15225not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
15226servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
15227.new
15228Note that all lookups, including those done for verification, are affected;
15229this will result in verify failure for IPv6 connections or ones using names
15230only valid for IPv6 addresses.
15231.wen
15232
15233
15234.option dns_retrans main time 0s
15235.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15236.cindex timeout "dns lookup"
15237.cindex "DNS" timeout
15238The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
15239retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
15240defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
15241time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
15242totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
15243take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
15244parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
15245but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
15246to set in them.
15247See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
15248
15249
15250.option dns_retry main integer 0
15251See &%dns_retrans%& above.
15252
15253
15254.option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
15255.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15256.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15257If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
15258(Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
15259DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
15260match with this expanded domain list.
15261
15262Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
15263authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
15264bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
15265mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
15266Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
15267a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
15268
15269Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
15270to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
15271zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
15272
15273If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
15274in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
15275authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
15276authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
15277record in the authoritative section is used instead.
15278
15279.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15280.option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
15281.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15282.cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
15283.cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
15284If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15285DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
15286the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
15287on.
15288
15289If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
15290
15291OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
15292means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
15293is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
15294
15295
15296.option drop_cr main boolean false
15297This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
15298handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
15299described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
15300
15301.option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15302.cindex "bounce messages" "success"
15303.cindex "DSN" "success"
15304.cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
15305DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
15306and accepted from, these hosts.
15307Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
15308and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
15309A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
15310A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
15311are sent.
15312
15313.option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
15314.cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
15315.cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
15316This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
15317bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
15318Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
15319.code
15320dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
15321.endd
15322The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
15323panic is logged, and the default value is used.
15324
15325.option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
15326.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
15327Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
15328message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15329handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
15330message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
15331be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
15332the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
15333delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15334
15335
15336.option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
15337.cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
15338.cindex "copy of bounce message"
15339Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
15340generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
15341coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
15342items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
15343a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
15344must be enclosed in double quotes.
15345
15346Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
15347(see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
15348the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
15349items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
15350are examined. For example:
15351.code
15352errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
15353 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
15354 postmaster@mydomain.example
15355.endd
15356.vindex "&$domain$&"
15357.vindex "&$local_part$&"
15358The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
15359and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
15360there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
15361.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
15362variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
15363
15364
15365.option errors_reply_to main string unset
15366.cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
15367By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
15368.display
15369&`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
15370.endd
15371.oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
15372where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
15373A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
15374&(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
15375overrides the default.
15376
15377Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
15378&%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
15379and warning messages. For example:
15380.code
15381errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
15382.endd
15383The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
15384address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
15385&%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
15386own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
15387not used.
15388
15389
15390.option event_action main string&!! unset
15391.cindex events
15392This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
15393For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
15394
15395
15396.option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
15397.cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
15398.cindex "Exim group"
15399This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15400privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
15401option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
15402of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
15403configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
15404security issues.
15405
15406
15407.option exim_path main string "see below"
15408.cindex "Exim binary, path name"
15409This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
15410needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
15411the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
15412is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
15413other place.
15414&*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
15415you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
15416where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
15417settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
15418
15419
15420.option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
15421.cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
15422.cindex "Exim user"
15423This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15424privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
15425time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
15426options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
15427
15428Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
15429&[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
15430not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
15431used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
15432
15433
15434.option exim_version main string "current version"
15435.cindex "Exim version"
15436.cindex customizing "version number"
15437.cindex "version number of Exim" override
15438This option allows to override the &$version_number$&/&$exim_version$& Exim reports in
15439various places. Use with care, this may fool stupid security scanners.
15440
15441
15442.option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
15443This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
15444routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
15445&<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
15446
15447
15448. Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15449. for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15450
15451.option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
15452 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
15453.oindex "&%-t%&"
15454.cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
15455.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
15456According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
15457are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
15458envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
15459line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
15460behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
15461command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
15462&%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
15463argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
15464addresses.
15465
15466
15467.option finduser_retries main integer 0
15468.cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
15469On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
15470distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
15471related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
15472Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
15473errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
15474many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
15475retries.
15476
15477.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
15478You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
15479a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
15480search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
15481
15482
15483
15484.option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
15485.cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
15486On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
15487ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
15488delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
15489&%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
15490feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
15491warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
15492freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
15493is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
15494supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
15495message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
15496freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
15497log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
15498logging that you require.
15499
15500
15501.option gecos_name main string&!! unset
15502.cindex "HP-UX"
15503.cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
15504Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
15505password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
15506looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
15507headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
15508of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
15509it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
15510upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
15511
15512When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
15513expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
15514login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
15515user's name.
15516
15517.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
15518Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
15519pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
15520name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
15521.code
15522gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
15523gecos_name = $1
15524.endd
15525
15526.option gecos_pattern main string unset
15527See &%gecos_name%& above.
15528
15529
15530.option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
15531This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
15532server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
15533implementations of TLS.
15534
15535
15536.option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
15537This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
15538the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
15539
15540See
15541&url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
15542for documentation.
15543
15544
15545
15546.option headers_charset main string "see below"
15547This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
15548&"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
15549default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
15550ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
15551insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
15552
15553
15554
15555.option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
15556.cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
15557.cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
15558This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
15559section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
15560&_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
15561sections are rejected.
15562
15563
15564.option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
15565.cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
15566.cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
15567This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
15568all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
15569header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
15570zero means &"no limit"&.
15571
15572
15573
15574
15575.option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15576.cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
15577.cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
15578Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
15579mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
15580some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
15581this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
15582if you want to do semantic checking.
15583See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
15584set.
15585
15586
15587.option helo_allow_chars main string unset
15588.cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
15589.cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
15590.cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
15591This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
15592all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
15593hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
15594.code
15595helo_allow_chars = _
15596.endd
15597Note that the value is one string, not a list.
15598
15599
15600.option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
15601.cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15602.cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15603If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
15604list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
15605default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
15606its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
15607do.
15608
15609
15610.option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15611.cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
15612.cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
15613By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
15614&%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
15615to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
15616condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
15617Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
15618to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
15619necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
15620encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
15621Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
15622
15623When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
15624&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
15625EHLO command either:
15626
15627.ilist
15628is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
15629.next
15630.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
15631.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
15632matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
15633calling host address, or
15634.next
15635when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
15636.endlist
15637
15638However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
15639fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
15640be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
15641
15642If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
15643.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15644&$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
15645
15646.option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15647.cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
15648.cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
15649Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
15650backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
15651name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
15652&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
15653rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
15654If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
15655error.
15656
15657.option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15658.cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
15659.cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
15660This option allows mail for particular domains to be held in the queue
15661manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
15662&%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
15663verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
15664item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
15665it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
15666
15667This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
15668delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
15669configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
15670domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
15671&%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
15672
15673A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
15674messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
15675time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
15676retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
15677
15678
15679.option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
15680.cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
15681Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
15682is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
15683&%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
15684option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
15685default configuration file contains
15686.code
15687host_lookup = *
15688.endd
15689which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
15690is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
15691
15692After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
15693has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
15694this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
15695
15696.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
15697.vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
15698After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
15699unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
15700&%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
15701&`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
15702
15703
15704.option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
15705This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
15706to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
15707first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
15708if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
15709if you want.
15710
15711&*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
15712multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
15713&_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
15714case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
15715
15716
15717
15718.option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
15719.cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
15720If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
15721as soon as the connection is made.
15722This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
15723nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
15724connections immediately.
15725
15726The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
15727ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
15728sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
15729incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
15730chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
15731
15732
15733.option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
15734.cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
15735This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
15736happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
15737you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
15738127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
15739the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
15740list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
15741local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
15742.code
15743hosts_connection_nolog = :
15744.endd
15745If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
15746
15747
15748
15749.option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
15750.cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
15751This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
15752connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
15753
15754
15755.option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
15756.cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
15757.cindex "host" "treated as local"
15758If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
15759if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
15760records
15761or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
15762host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
15763
15764This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
15765&`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
15766section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
15767&(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
15768that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
15769chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
15770interfaces and recognizing the local host.
15771
15772
15773.option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
15774.cindex "InterBase" "server list"
15775This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
15776to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15777The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
15778
15779
15780
15781.option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
15782.cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
15783.cindex "discarding bounce message"
15784This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
15785that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
15786suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
15787
15788After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
15789because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
15790message has been in the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
15791the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
15792again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
15793bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
15794for frozen messages. For example,
15795.code
15796ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
15797.endd
15798retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
15799failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
15800failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
15801value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
15802dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
15803&%timeout_frozen_after%&.
15804
15805
15806.option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15807.cindex "&""From""& line"
15808.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15809Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
15810the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
15811message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
15812such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
15813match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
15814process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
15815&%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
15816
15817
15818.option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
15819See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
15820
15821.option keep_environment main "string list" unset
15822.cindex "environment" "values from"
15823This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
15824You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
15825these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
15826during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
15827installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
15828environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
15829external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
15830
15831Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
15832(&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
15833
15834WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
15835FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
15836unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
15837that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
15838
15839Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
15840&%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
15841current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
15842anymore.
15843
15844See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
15845environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
15846transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
15847details.
15848
15849
15850.option keep_malformed main time 4d
15851This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
15852have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
15853next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
15854logged.
15855
15856
15857.option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
15858.cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
15859.cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
15860This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
15861a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15862While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15863Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15864and constrained to be a directory.
15865
15866
15867.option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
15868.cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
15869.cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15870This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
15871a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15872While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15873Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15874and constrained to be a file.
15875
15876
15877.option ldap_cert_file main string unset
15878.cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
15879.cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15880This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
15881Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15882Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
15883
15884
15885.option ldap_cert_key main string unset
15886.cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
15887.cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
15888This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
15889to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15890Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
15891identity to be proven.
15892
15893
15894.option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
15895.cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
15896This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
15897the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
15898cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
15899
15900
15901.option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
15902.cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
15903This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
15904LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
15905details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
15906with LDAP support.
15907
15908
15909.option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
15910.cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
15911This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
15912A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
15913See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
15914Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
15915to hard/demand.
15916
15917
15918.option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
15919.cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
15920If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
15921connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
15922"STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
15923of SSL-on-connect.
15924In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
15925by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
15926This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
15927
15928
15929.option ldap_version main integer unset
15930.cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
15931This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
15932LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
15933-1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
15934the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
15935has been built with LDAP support.
15936
15937
15938
15939.option local_from_check main boolean true
15940.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
15941.cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
15942When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15943an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
15944checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
15945the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
15946
15947&*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
15948locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
15949&%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15950
15951You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
15952on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
15953&'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
15954and the default qualify domain.
15955
15956If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
15957and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
15958&'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
15959&%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
15960
15961.cindex "envelope from"
15962.cindex "envelope sender"
15963These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
15964is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
15965&%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
15966
15967For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
15968request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
15969has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15970
15971
15972
15973
15974.option local_from_prefix main string unset
15975When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
15976matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
15977ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
15978done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
15979appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
15980&%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
15981example, if
15982.code
15983local_from_prefix = *-
15984.endd
15985is set, a &'From:'& line containing
15986.code
15987From: anything-user@your.domain.example
15988.endd
15989will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
15990matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
15991qualify domain.
15992
15993
15994.option local_from_suffix main string unset
15995See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
15996
15997
15998.option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
15999This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
16000listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
16001&<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
16002options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
16003&%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
16004&%local_interfaces%& is
16005.code
16006local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
16007.endd
16008when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
16009.code
16010local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
16011.endd
16012
16013.option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
16014.cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
16015.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
16016This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
16017&<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
16018the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
16019message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
16020non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
16021
16022
16023
16024.option local_sender_retain main boolean false
16025.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
16026When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
16027an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
16028do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
16029also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
16030See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
16031&<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16032
16033
16034
16035
16036.option localhost_number main string&!! unset
16037.cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
16038.cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
16039.vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
16040Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
16041uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
16042value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
16043after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
16044host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
16045range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
16046systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
16047&$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
16048characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
16049time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
16050section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
16051
16052
16053
16054.option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
16055.cindex "log" "file path for"
16056This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
16057files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
16058when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
16059name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or runtime,
16060or if the option is unset at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
16061they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
16062.new
16063A path must start with a slash.
16064To send to syslog, use the word &"syslog"&.
16065.wen
16066Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
16067section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
16068used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
16069variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
16070configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
16071&_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
16072early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
16073
16074
16075.option log_selector main string unset
16076.cindex "log" "selectors"
16077This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
16078writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
16079minus characters. For example:
16080.code
16081log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
16082.endd
16083A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
16084logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
16085
16086
16087.option log_timezone main boolean false
16088.cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
16089.vindex "&$tod_log$&"
16090.vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
16091By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
16092timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
16093in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
16094avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
16095&%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
16096timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
16097of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
16098&$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
16099another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
16100
16101
16102.option lookup_open_max main integer 25
16103.cindex "too many open files"
16104.cindex "open files, too many"
16105.cindex "file" "too many open"
16106.cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
16107.cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
16108This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
16109lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
16110Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
16111file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
16112recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
16113actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
16114as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
16115open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
16116&%lookup_open_max%&.
16117
16118
16119.option max_username_length main integer 0
16120.cindex "length of login name"
16121.cindex "user name" "maximum length"
16122.cindex "limit" "user name length"
16123Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
16124&[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
16125this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
16126an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
16127
16128
16129.option message_body_newlines main bool false
16130.cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
16131.cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
16132.vindex "&$message_body$&"
16133.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16134By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
16135the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
16136option is set true, this no longer happens.
16137
16138
16139.option message_body_visible main integer 500
16140.cindex "body of message" "visible size"
16141.cindex "message body" "visible size"
16142.vindex "&$message_body$&"
16143.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16144This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
16145&$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
16146
16147
16148.option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
16149.cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
16150If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
16151(domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
16152locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
16153means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
16154Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
16155Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
16156replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
16157empty string, the option is ignored.
16158
16159
16160.option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
16161If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
16162the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
16163message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
16164take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
16165the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
16166it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
16167yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
16168before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
16169that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
16170means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
16171colons will become hyphens.
16172
16173
16174.option message_logs main boolean true
16175.cindex "message logs" "disabling"
16176.cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
16177If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
16178&_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
16179Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
16180minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
16181per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
16182which is not affected by this option.
16183
16184
16185.option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
16186.cindex "message" "size limit"
16187.cindex "limit" "message size"
16188.cindex "size" "of message, limit"
16189This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
16190value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
16191to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
16192TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
16193optionally followed by K or M.
16194
16195&*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
16196other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
16197the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
16198error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
16199&%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16200
16201Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
16202exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
16203failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
16204an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
16205the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
16206message that an individual transport can process.
16207
16208If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
16209maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
16210failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
16211virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
16212probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
16213default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
16214some problems may result.
16215
16216A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
16217SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
16218SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
16219
16220
16221.option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
16222.cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
16223This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
16224.code
16225SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
16226.endd
16227in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
16228moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
16229and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
16230standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
16231lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
16232
16233
16234.option mua_wrapper main boolean false
16235Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
16236it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
16237contains a full description of this facility.
16238
16239
16240
16241.option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
16242.cindex "MySQL" "server list"
16243This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
16244be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
16245option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
16246
16247
16248.option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
16249This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
16250message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
16251recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
16252It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
16253safety precaution.
16254
16255When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
16256list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
16257the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
16258contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
16259can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
16260
16261If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
16262&%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
16263example is
16264.code
16265never_users = root:daemon:bin
16266.endd
16267Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
16268harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
16269transport driver.
16270
16271
16272.option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +no_sslv3 +single_dh_use +no_ticket"
16273.cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
16274This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
16275by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
16276each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
16277
16278This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
16279available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
16280The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
16281the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
16282list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
16283&"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
16284names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
16285
16286Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
16287SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
16288yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
16289adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
16290invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
16291
16292The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
16293
16294Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
16295"+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
16296with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
16297some now infamous attacks.
16298
16299Examples:
16300.code
16301# Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
16302openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
16303 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
16304
16305# Disable older protocol versions:
16306openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
16307.endd
16308
16309Possible options may include:
16310.ilist
16311&`all`&
16312.next
16313&`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
16314.next
16315&`cipher_server_preference`&
16316.next
16317&`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
16318.next
16319&`ephemeral_rsa`&
16320.next
16321&`legacy_server_connect`&
16322.next
16323&`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
16324.next
16325&`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
16326.next
16327&`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
16328.next
16329&`netscape_challenge_bug`&
16330.next
16331&`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
16332.next
16333&`no_compression`&
16334.next
16335&`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
16336.next
16337&`no_sslv2`&
16338.next
16339&`no_sslv3`&
16340.next
16341&`no_ticket`&
16342.next
16343&`no_tlsv1`&
16344.next
16345&`no_tlsv1_1`&
16346.next
16347&`no_tlsv1_2`&
16348.next
16349&`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
16350.next
16351&`single_dh_use`&
16352.next
16353&`single_ecdh_use`&
16354.next
16355&`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
16356.next
16357&`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
16358.next
16359&`tls_block_padding_bug`&
16360.next
16361&`tls_d5_bug`&
16362.next
16363&`tls_rollback_bug`&
16364.endlist
16365
16366As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
16367all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
16368to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
16369to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
16370release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
16371where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
16372
16373
16374.option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
16375.cindex "Oracle" "server list"
16376This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
16377to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
16378The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
16379
16380
16381.option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16382.cindex "&""percent hack""&"
16383.cindex "source routing" "in email address"
16384.cindex "address" "source-routed"
16385The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
16386percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
16387replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
16388also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
16389option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
16390but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
16391an ACL.
16392
16393&*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
16394trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
16395if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
16396implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
16397routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
16398a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
16399local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
16400
16401
16402.option perl_at_start main boolean false
16403.cindex "Perl"
16404This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16405interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16406
16407
16408.option perl_startup main string unset
16409.cindex "Perl"
16410This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16411interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16412
16413.option perl_startup main boolean false
16414.cindex "Perl"
16415This Option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
16416
16417
16418.option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
16419.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
16420This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
16421data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
16422&<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
16423PostgreSQL support.
16424
16425
16426.option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
16427.cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
16428.cindex "pid file, path for"
16429This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
16430process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
16431to the host name:
16432.code
16433pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
16434.endd
16435If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
16436spool directory.
16437The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
16438option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
16439of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
16440
16441
16442.option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16443.cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
16444This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
16445PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
16446control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
16447&%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
16448for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
16449that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
16450not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
16451
16452.new
16453.option pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16454.cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
16455.cindex "pipelining" PIPE_CONNECT
16456If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
16457this option controls which hosts the facility is advertised to
16458and from which pipeline early-connection (before MAIL) SMTP
16459commands are acceptable.
16460When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
16461
16462Currently the option name &"X_PIPE_CONNECT"& is used.
16463.wen
16464
16465
16466.option prdr_enable main boolean false
16467.cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
16468This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
16469to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
16470If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
16471If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
16472an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
16473is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
16474
16475.option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
16476.cindex "message logs" "preserving"
16477If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
16478completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
16479called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
16480purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
16481volume of mail. Use with care!
16482
16483
16484.option primary_hostname main string "see below"
16485.cindex "name" "of local host"
16486.cindex "host" "name of local"
16487.cindex "local host" "name of"
16488.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16489This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
16490HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
16491option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
16492The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
16493server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
16494
16495If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
16496name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
16497contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
16498&[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
16499version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
16500explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
16501
16502
16503.option print_topbitchars main boolean false
16504.cindex "printing characters"
16505.cindex "8-bit characters"
16506By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
1650732&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
16508when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
16509sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
16510is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
16511characters.
16512
16513This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
16514&(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
16515the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
16516described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
16517Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
16518standards.
16519
16520
16521.option process_log_path main string unset
16522.cindex "process log path"
16523.cindex "log" "process log"
16524.cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
16525This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
16526&"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
16527utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
16528in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
16529can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
16530different spool directories.
16531
16532
16533.option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
16534.cindex "restricting access to features"
16535.oindex "&%-M%&"
16536.oindex "&%-R%&"
16537.oindex "&%-q%&"
16538The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
16539admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
16540&%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16541
16542
16543.option qualify_domain main string "see below"
16544.cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
16545.cindex "address" "qualification"
16546This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
16547addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
16548recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
16549are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
16550also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
16551locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16552
16553Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
16554unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
16555&%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
16556addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
16557necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
16558addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
16559&%primary_hostname%& value.
16560
16561
16562.option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
16563This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
16564addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
16565
16566
16567
16568.option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16569.cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
16570.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16571.cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
16572This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
16573A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
16574domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
16575next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
16576
16577
16578.option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
16579.cindex "restricting access to features"
16580.oindex "&%-bp%&"
16581The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
16582queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
16583&%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
16584See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16585
16586
16587.option queue_only main boolean false
16588.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16589.cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
16590If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
16591whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits in the queue for the
16592next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
16593delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
16594
16595The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
16596and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
16597&%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
16598&%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
16599
16600
16601.option queue_only_file main string unset
16602.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16603.cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
16604This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
16605one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
16606it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
16607each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
16608For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
16609&"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
16610.code
16611queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
16612.endd
16613causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
16614&_/some/file_& exists.
16615
16616
16617.option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
16618.cindex "load average"
16619.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16620.cindex "message" "queueing by load"
16621If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
16622all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
16623happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
16624the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
16625the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16626false.
16627
16628Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
16629option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
16630determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
16631&%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16632
16633
16634.option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
16635.cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
16636When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
16637because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
16638all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
16639This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
16640threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
16641connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
16642circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
16643where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16644should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
16645re-evaluated for each message.
16646
16647
16648.option queue_only_override main boolean true
16649.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16650When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
16651setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
16652&%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
16653to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
16654
16655
16656.option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
16657.cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
16658If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
16659in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
16660must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
16661single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
16662and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
16663single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
16664the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
16665avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
16666&%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
16667when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
16668large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
16669
16670
16671
16672.option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
16673.cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
16674This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
16675can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
16676but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
16677start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
16678very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
16679however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
16680started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
16681
16682Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
16683the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
16684run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
16685the daemon's command line.
16686
16687.cindex queues named
16688.cindex "named queues"
16689To set limits for different named queues use
16690an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
16691
16692.option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16693.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16694.cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
16695When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
16696received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
16697However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
16698&%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
16699message waits in the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
16700has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
16701when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
16702over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
16703SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
16704&%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
16705&%queue_domains%&.
16706
16707
16708.option receive_timeout main time 0s
16709.cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
16710This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
16711maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
16712the value is zero, it will wait forever. This setting is overridden by the
16713&%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
16714controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
16715
16716.option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
16717.cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
16718.cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
16719This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
16720added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
16721on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
16722used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
16723added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
16724&"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
16725header lines.
16726.new
16727The default setting is:
16728
16729.code
16730received_header_text = Received: \
16731 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
16732 {${if def:sender_ident \
16733 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
16734 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
16735 by $primary_hostname \
16736 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol }}\
16737 ${if def:tls_in_cipher_std { tls $tls_in_cipher_std\n\t}}\
16738 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
16739 ${if def:sender_address \
16740 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
16741 id $message_exim_id\
16742 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
16743.endd
16744.wen
16745
16746The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
16747support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
16748locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
16749header lines such as the following:
16750.code
16751Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
16752by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
16753(envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
16754id 16IOWa-00019l-00
16755for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
16756Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
16757id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
16758.endd
16759Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
16760the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
16761checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
16762message was accepted.
16763
16764
16765.option received_headers_max main integer 30
16766.cindex "loop" "prevention"
16767.cindex "mail loop prevention"
16768.cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
16769When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
16770counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
16771have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
16772This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
16773
16774
16775.option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16776.cindex "unqualified addresses"
16777.cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16778This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16779recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
16780qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
16781affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
16782addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
16783host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
16784or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
16785option was not set.
16786
16787
16788.option recipients_max main integer 0
16789.cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
16790.cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
16791If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
16792original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
16793by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
16794all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
16795Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
16796done.
16797
16798.cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
16799&*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
16800RCPT commands in a single message.
16801
16802
16803.option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
16804If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
16805recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
16806error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
16807error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
16808initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
16809for the remaining recipients at a later time.
16810
16811
16812.option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
16813.cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
16814This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
16815hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
16816does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
16817message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
16818have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
16819deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
16820deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
16821each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
16822same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
16823&%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
16824with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
16825tagged with its process id.
16826
16827This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
16828message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
16829manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
16830deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
16831is received.
16832
16833.cindex "number of deliveries"
16834.cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
16835If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
16836need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
16837are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
16838daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
16839fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
16840runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
16841delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
16842then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
16843&%remote_max_parallel%&.
16844
16845If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
16846&%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
16847doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
16848host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
16849
16850
16851.option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16852.cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
16853.cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
16854When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
16855domain into the order given by this list. For example,
16856.code
16857remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
16858.endd
16859would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
16860then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
16861
16862
16863.option retry_data_expire main time 7d
16864.cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
16865This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
16866database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
16867host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
16868past failures.
16869
16870
16871.option retry_interval_max main time 24h
16872.cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
16873.cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
16874Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
16875intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
16876straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
16877retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
16878the default value.
16879
16880
16881.option return_path_remove main boolean true
16882.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
16883RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
16884&'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
16885The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
16886MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
16887in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
16888&'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
16889received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
16890the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
16891
16892
16893.option return_size_limit main integer 100K
16894This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16895
16896
16897.option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
16898.cindex "RFC 1413"
16899.cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
16900RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
16901an item in the list.
16902The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
16903for the system.
16904
16905.option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
16906.cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
16907.cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
16908This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
16909no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
16910
16911
16912.option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16913.cindex "unqualified addresses"
16914.cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16915This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16916sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
16917&%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
16918not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
16919it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
16920&%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
16921using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
16922
16923.option add_environment main "string list" empty
16924.cindex "environment"
16925This option allows to add individual environment variables that the
16926currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use. The
16927default list is empty.
16928
16929
16930.option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
16931.cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
16932.cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
16933This option controls logging of slow lookups.
16934If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
16935and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
16936Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
16937
16938
16939
16940.option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
16941.cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
16942This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
16943TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
16944connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
16945other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
16946still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
16947this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
16948connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
16949tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
16950hours to detect unreachable hosts.
16951
16952
16953
16954.option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
16955.cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
16956.cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16957.cindex "inetd"
16958This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
16959that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
16960control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
16961value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
16962non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
16963set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16964
16965A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
16966has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
16967that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
16968and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
16969
16970
16971.option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
16972.cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
16973.cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
16974Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
16975the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
16976check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
16977client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
16978client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
16979
16980When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
16981allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
16982but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
16983or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
16984starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
16985counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
16986following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
16987MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
16988
16989
16990.option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16991You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
16992check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
16993changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
16994live with.
16995
16996
16997. Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
16998. for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
16999. We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
17000. non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
17001. zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
17002. html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
17003. inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
17004. searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
17005. the option name to split.
17006
17007.option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
17008 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
17009.cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
17010.cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
17011The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
17012prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
17013results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
17014response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
17015precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
17016seen).
17017
17018
17019.option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
17020.cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
17021.cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
17022This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
17023host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
17024expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
17025reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
17026connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
17027is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
17028of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
17029required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
17030
17031&*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
17032constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
17033happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
17034without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
17035could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
17036doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
17037
17038
17039
17040.option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
17041.cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
17042.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17043.cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
17044If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
17045listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
17046in the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
17047fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
17048subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
17049to all messages received in the same connection.
17050
17051A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
17052if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
17053also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
17054various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
17055
17056
17057. See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
17058
17059.option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
17060 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
17061.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17062.cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
17063This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
17064automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
17065the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
17066and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
17067number, subsequent messages are placed in the queue, but no delivery processes
17068are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
17069restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
17070systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
17071dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
17072
17073
17074.option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
17075.cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
17076.cindex "host" "reserved"
17077When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
17078number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
17079that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
17080&%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
17081restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
17082of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
17083of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
17084the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
17085individual host.
17086
17087For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
17088set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
17089connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
17090provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
17091
17092
17093.option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
17094.cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
17095.cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
17096.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
17097This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
17098several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
17099is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
17100responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
17101incoming HELO or EHLO command.
17102
17103.vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
17104The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
17105is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
17106in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
17107
17108If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
17109expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
17110used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
17111panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
17112value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
17113For example:
17114.code
17115smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
17116 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
17117.endd
17118
17119Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
17120messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
17121verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
17122&%helo_data%& value.
17123
17124.option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
17125.cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
17126.cindex "banner for SMTP"
17127.cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
17128.cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
17129This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
17130positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
17131.code
17132smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
17133 $version_number $tod_full
17134.endd
17135Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
17136multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
17137appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
17138in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
17139multiline response).
17140
17141
17142.option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
17143.cindex "checking disk space"
17144.cindex "disk space, checking"
17145.cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
17146When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
17147option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
17148spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
17149leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
17150is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
17151
17152
17153.option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
17154.cindex "connection backlog"
17155.cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
17156.cindex "backlog of connections"
17157This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
17158this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
17159of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
17160attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
17161say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
17162out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
17163value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
17164attacks by SYN flooding.
17165
17166
17167.option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
17168.cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
17169.cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
17170The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
17171the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
17172synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
17173fewer, but they still exist.
17174
17175Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
17176for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
17177client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
17178SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
17179for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
17180input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
17181does detect many instances.
17182
17183The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
17184If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
17185hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
17186(see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
17187
17188
17189
17190.option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
17191.cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
17192.vindex "&$domain$&"
17193If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
17194command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
17195chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
17196are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
17197argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
17198example:
17199.code
17200smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
17201 $sender_host_address
17202.endd
17203A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
17204complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
17205run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
17206a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
17207receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
17208the command.
17209
17210
17211.option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
17212.cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
17213When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
17214one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
17215section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
17216
17217
17218.option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
17219.cindex "load average"
17220If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
17221accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
17222If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
17223the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
17224systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
17225&%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
17226
17227
17228
17229.option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
17230.cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
17231.cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
17232Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
17233particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
17234.code
17235RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
17236.endd
17237causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
17238(The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
17239example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
17240too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
17241dropped. The limit is set by this option.
17242
17243.cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
17244When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
17245&"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
17246Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
17247&%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
17248not count towards the limit.
17249
17250
17251
17252.option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
17253.cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
17254.cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
17255If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
17256Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
17257that subvert web
17258clients
17259into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
17260non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
17261
17262
17263
17264.option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17265.cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
17266.cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
17267.cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
17268Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
17269can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
17270recipients.
17271
17272Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
17273facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
17274&%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
17275&<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
17276
17277When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
17278&%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
17279rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
17280respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
17281values:
17282
17283.ilist
17284A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
17285.next
17286An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
17287fractional parts are allowed here.
17288.next
17289A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
17290.next
17291A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
17292because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
17293.endlist
17294
17295For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
17296first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
17297.code
17298smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
17299smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
17300.endd
17301The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
17302two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
17303seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
17304delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
17305
17306
17307.option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
17308See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17309
17310
17311.option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
17312See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17313
17314
17315.option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
17316.cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
17317.cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
17318This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
17319input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
17320data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
17321the message is abandoned.
17322A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
17323.code
17324SMTP command timeout on connection from...
17325SMTP data timeout on connection from...
17326.endd
17327The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
17328means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
17329
17330If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
17331expanded before use and may depend on
17332&$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
17333
17334
17335.oindex "&%-os%&"
17336The value set by this option can be overridden by the
17337&%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
17338this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
17339of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
17340timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
17341
17342
17343.option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17344This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
17345&%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
17346
17347
17348.option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
17349.cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
17350.cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
17351In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
17352&"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
17353reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
17354to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
17355policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
17356&%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
17357example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
17358.code
17359550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
17360550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
17361.endd
17362
17363
17364.option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17365.cindex "SMTPUTF8" "advertising"
17366When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
17367the availability thereof is advertised in
17368response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17369chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
17370
17371
17372.option spamd_address main string "127.0.0.1 783"
17373This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
17374extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
17375See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
17376
17377
17378
17379.option spf_guess main string "v=spf1 a/24 mx/24 ptr ?all"
17380This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support.
17381See section &<<SECSPF>>& for more details.
17382
17383
17384
17385.option split_spool_directory main boolean false
17386.cindex "multiple spool directories"
17387.cindex "spool directory" "split"
17388.cindex "directories, multiple"
17389If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
17390subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
17391sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
17392subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
17393arrival of the message.
17394
17395Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
17396where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
17397directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
17398directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
17399are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
17400
17401It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
17402changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
17403&"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
17404after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
17405automatically deleted.
17406
17407When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
17408changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
17409trying to deliver each one, in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
17410sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
17411sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
17412spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
17413particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages in the queue. However,
17414if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
17415entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
17416
17417
17418.option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
17419.cindex "spool directory" "path to"
17420This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
17421it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
17422configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
17423string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
17424&$primary_hostname$&.
17425
17426If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
17427that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
17428log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
17429Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
17430as failures in the configuration file.
17431
17432By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
17433tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
17434
17435.option spool_wireformat main boolean false
17436.cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
17437If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternative format
17438for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
17439Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
17440Currently it is only done for messages received using the ESMTP CHUNKING
17441option.
17442
17443The following variables will not have useful values:
17444.code
17445$max_received_linelength
17446$body_linecount
17447$body_zerocount
17448.endd
17449
17450Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
17451and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
17452(except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
17453will need to be aware of the different formats potentially available.
17454
17455Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
17456(as a Unix-mbox-format file is constructed for them).
17457The transmission benefit is maintained.
17458
17459.option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
17460.cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
17461This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
17462access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
17463
17464.option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
17465.cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
17466This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
17467variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
17468is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
17469&<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
17470
17471.option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
17472.cindex "angle brackets, excess"
17473If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
17474items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
17475treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
17476passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
17477option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
17478
17479
17480.option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
17481.cindex "trailing dot on domain"
17482.cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
17483If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
17484ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
17485MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
17486domain causes a syntax error.
17487However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
17488syntax checking.
17489
17490
17491.option syslog_duplication main boolean true
17492.cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
17493When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
17494separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
17495be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
17496separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
17497nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
17498particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
17499both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
17500containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
17501Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
17502the LOG_ALERT priority.
17503
17504
17505.option syslog_facility main string unset
17506.cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
17507This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17508syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
17509&"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
17510If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17511details of Exim's logging.
17512
17513
17514.option syslog_pid main boolean true
17515.cindex "syslog" "pid"
17516If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
17517omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
17518the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
17519to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
17520into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17521
17522
17523
17524.option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
17525.cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
17526This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17527syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
17528&<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17529
17530
17531
17532.option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
17533.cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
17534If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
17535omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17536details of Exim's logging.
17537
17538
17539.option system_filter main string&!! unset
17540.cindex "filter" "system filter"
17541.cindex "system filter" "specifying"
17542.cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
17543This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
17544the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
17545must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
17546generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
17547appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
17548which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
17549&<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
17550A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
17551
17552
17553.option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
17554.vindex "&$address_file$&"
17555This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
17556&%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
17557implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
17558During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17559
17560
17561.option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
17562.cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
17563This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
17564command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
17565the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17566
17567.option system_filter_group main string unset
17568.cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
17569This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
17570gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
17571with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
17572
17573.option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
17574.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
17575.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
17576This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
17577is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
17578contains the pipe command.
17579
17580
17581.option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
17582.cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
17583This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
17584is used in a system filter.
17585
17586
17587.option system_filter_user main string unset
17588.cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
17589If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
17590delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
17591process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
17592Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
17593is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
17594configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
17595specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
17596&%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
17597
17598If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
17599under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
17600transport option overrides.
17601
17602
17603.option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
17604.cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
17605.cindex "Nagle algorithm"
17606.cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
17607If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
17608TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
17609turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
17610performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
17611should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
17612However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
17613this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
17614daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
17615TCP_NODELAY.
17616
17617
17618.option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
17619.cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
17620.cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
17621If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
17622message of any kind that has been in the queue for longer than the given time
17623is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
17624bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
17625sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
17626If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
17627frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
17628
17629&*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
17630frozen messages remain in the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
17631messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
17632
17633
17634.option timezone main string unset
17635.cindex "timezone, setting"
17636.cindex "environment" "values from"
17637The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
17638running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
17639created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
17640to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
17641.code
17642timezone = UTC
17643.endd
17644The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
17645or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
17646is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
17647time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
17648runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
17649unfortunately not all, operating systems.
17650
17651
17652.option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17653.cindex "TLS" "advertising"
17654.cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
17655.cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
17656When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
17657of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
17658response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17659chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
17660Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
17661using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
17662is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
17663
17664
17665.option tls_certificate main string list&!! unset
17666.cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
17667.cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
17668The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17669files which contain the server's certificates (in PEM format).
17670Commonly only one file is needed.
17671The server's private key is also
17672assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
17673&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17674
17675&*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
17676receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
17677use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
17678option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
17679
17680&*Note*&: If you use filenames based on IP addresses, change the list
17681separator in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) to avoid confusion under IPv6.
17682
17683&*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
17684when a list of more than one
17685file is used, the &$tls_in_ourcert$& variable is unreliable.
17686
17687&*Note*&: OCSP stapling is not usable under OpenSSL
17688when a list of more than one file is used.
17689
17690If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
17691if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
17692Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
17693&<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
17694
17695If this option is unset or empty a fresh self-signed certificate will be
17696generated for every connection.
17697
17698.option tls_crl main string&!! unset
17699.cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
17700.cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
17701This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
17702be the name of a file that contains CRLs in PEM format.
17703
17704Under OpenSSL the option can specify a directory with CRL files.
17705
17706&*Note:*& Under OpenSSL the option must, if given, supply a CRL
17707for each signing element of the certificate chain (i.e. all but the leaf).
17708For the file variant this can be multiple PEM blocks in the one file.
17709
17710See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17711
17712
17713.option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
17714.cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
17715The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
17716the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
17717interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
17718suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
17719
17720The value must be at least 1024.
17721
17722The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
17723hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
17724by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
17725
17726If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
17727number.
17728
17729Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
17730little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
17731larger prime than requested.
17732
17733
17734.option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
17735.cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
17736The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
17737to be used by Exim.
17738
17739&*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend using a filename with site-generated
17740local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
17741other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
17742"unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
17743
17744If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
17745then it names a file from which DH
17746parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
17747PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
17748OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
17749fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
17750loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
17751and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
17752
17753If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
17754loaded by Exim.
17755
17756If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
17757Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
17758does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
17759See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
17760
17761If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
17762a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
17763
17764In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
177652.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
17766in IKE is assigned number 23.
17767
17768Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
17769of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526, RFC 5114, RFC 7919, or from other
17770sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
17771the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
17772&`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17773
17774The available standard primes are:
17775&`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
17776&`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
17777&`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
17778&`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
17779
17780The available additional primes are:
17781&`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17782
17783Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
17784Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
17785The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
17786of the later IKE values, which led into RFC7919 providing new fixed constants
17787(the "ffdhe" identifiers).
17788
17789At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
17790they're still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
17791candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
17792
17793The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
17794to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
17795whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
17796tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
17797need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
17798userbase.
17799
17800Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
17801is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
17802applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
17803used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
17804mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
17805prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
17806acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
17807
17808
17809.option tls_eccurve main string&!! &`auto`&
17810.cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
17811This option selects a EC curve for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
17812It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS.
17813
17814After expansion it must contain a valid EC curve parameter, such as
17815&`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-512`&. Consult your OpenSSL manual
17816for valid selections.
17817
17818For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
17819&`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
17820&`auto`& tells the library to choose.
17821
17822If the option expands to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
17823
17824
17825.option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
17826.cindex TLS "certificate status"
17827.cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
17828This option
17829must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
17830status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
17831Certificate Authority.
17832
17833Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
17834
17835For GnuTLS 3.5.6 or later the expanded value of this option can be a list
17836of files, to match a list given for the &%tls_certificate%& option.
17837The ordering of the two lists must match.
17838
17839The file(s) should be in DER format
17840
17841.option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
17842.cindex SSMTP
17843.cindex SMTPS
17844This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
17845operate the SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
17846set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
17847further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
17848
17849
17850
17851.option tls_privatekey main string list&!! unset
17852.cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
17853The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17854files which contains the server's private keys.
17855If this option is unset, or if
17856the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
17857key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
17858&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17859
17860See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17861
17862
17863.option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
17864.cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
17865.cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
17866If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
17867&"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
17868support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
17869TLS session.
17870
17871
17872.option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
17873.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
17874.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
17875This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
17876The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
17877connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
17878different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
17879permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
17880in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
17881preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
17882&<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
17883
17884
17885.option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17886.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17887.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17888See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
17889
17890
17891.option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
17892.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17893.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17894The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
17895word "system"
17896or the absolute path to
17897a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
17898match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
17899
17900The "system" value for the option will use a
17901system default location compiled into the SSL library.
17902This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
17903and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
17904must be specified.
17905
17906The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
17907preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
17908
17909With OpenSSL the certificates specified
17910explicitly
17911either by file or directory
17912are added to those given by the system default location.
17913
17914These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
17915than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
17916the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
17917connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
17918Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
17919use the explicit directory version.
17920
17921See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17922
17923A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
17924being unset.
17925
17926
17927.option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17928.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17929.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17930This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
17931certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
17932&%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
17933either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
17934&%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
17935
17936Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
17937&%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
17938present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
17939aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
17940the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
17941connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
17942ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
17943
17944A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
17945matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
17946certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
17947abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
17948state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
17949such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
17950but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
17951certificate"&.
17952
17953Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
17954certificates.
17955
17956
17957.option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
17958.cindex "trusted groups"
17959.cindex "groups" "trusted"
17960This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17961option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
17962which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
17963specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
17964details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
17965&%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
17966are trusted.
17967
17968.option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
17969.cindex "trusted users"
17970.cindex "user" "trusted"
17971This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17972option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
17973trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
17974&<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
17975If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
17976Exim user are trusted.
17977
17978.option unknown_login main string&!! unset
17979.cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
17980.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
17981This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
17982the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
17983gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
17984used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
17985can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
17986is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
17987&%-F%& option.
17988
17989.option unknown_username main string unset
17990See &%unknown_login%&.
17991
17992.option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
17993.cindex "trusted users"
17994.cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
17995.cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
17996.cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
17997.cindex "envelope from"
17998.cindex "envelope sender"
17999When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
18000normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
18001default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
18002senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
18003is used) is ignored.
18004
18005However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
18006to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
18007.code
18008exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
18009.endd
18010.vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
18011The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
18012other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
18013users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
18014patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
18015identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
18016users to setting senders that start with their login ids
18017followed by a hyphen
18018by a setting like this:
18019.code
18020untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
18021.endd
18022If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
18023restriction, you can use
18024.code
18025untrusted_set_sender = *
18026.endd
18027The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
18028only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
18029to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
18030parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
18031&'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
18032necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
18033overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
18034described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
18035
18036The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
18037&"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
18038&%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
18039envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
18040sender address.
18041
18042
18043.option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
18044.cindex "&""From""& line"
18045.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
18046Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
18047an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
18048particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
18049of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
18050matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
18051&%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
18052default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
18053.code
18054From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
18055From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
18056.endd
18057The pattern can be seen by running
18058.code
18059exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
18060.endd
18061It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
18062year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
18063regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
18064&%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
18065(&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
18066&%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
18067
18068
18069.option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
18070See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
18071
18072
18073.option warn_message_file main string unset
18074.cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
18075.cindex "customizing" "warning message"
18076This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
18077for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
18078been in the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
18079&%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
18080&<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
18081
18082
18083.option write_rejectlog main boolean true
18084.cindex "reject log" "disabling"
18085If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
18086See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
18087.ecindex IIDconfima
18088.ecindex IIDmaiconf
18089
18090
18091
18092
18093. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18094. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18095
18096.chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
18097.scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
18098.scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
18099This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
18100Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
18101
18102For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
18103&<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
18104which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
18105provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
18106&%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
18107
18108
18109
18110.option address_data routers string&!! unset
18111.cindex "router" "data attached to address"
18112The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
18113precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
18114router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
18115&%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
18116delivery of the address to be deferred.
18117
18118.vindex "&$address_data$&"
18119When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
18120accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
18121routers, and the eventual transport.
18122
18123&*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
18124that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
18125in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
18126either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
18127put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
18128
18129Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
18130with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
18131on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
18132&$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
18133&"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
18134
18135The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
18136for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
18137you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
18138.code
18139uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
18140.endd
18141In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
18142.code
18143file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
18144.endd
18145This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
18146lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
18147
18148.new
18149See also the &%set%& option below.
18150.wen
18151
18152.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
18153.vindex "&$address_data$&"
18154The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
18155from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
18156&$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
18157ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
18158verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
18159
18160
18161
18162.option address_test routers&!? boolean true
18163.oindex "&%-bt%&"
18164.cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
18165If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
18166by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
18167your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
18168having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
18169routing.
18170
18171
18172
18173.option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
18174.cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
18175.cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
18176This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
18177routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
18178&"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
18179&%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
18180value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
18181includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
18182well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
18183you could put:
18184.code
18185cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
18186.endd
18187on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
18188and
18189.code
18190cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
18191.endd
18192on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
18193this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
18194explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
18195logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
18196
18197
18198.option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
18199.cindex "case of local parts"
18200.cindex "router" "case of local parts"
18201By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
18202manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
18203If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
18204this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
18205part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
18206turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
18207more details.
18208
18209.vindex "&$local_part$&"
18210.vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
18211.vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
18212The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
18213router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
18214an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
18215is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
18216addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
18217and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
18218
18219This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
18220recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
18221modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
18222(see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
18223
18224
18225
18226.option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
18227.cindex "local user, checking in router"
18228.cindex "router" "checking for local user"
18229.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
18230.vindex "&$home$&"
18231When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
18232address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
18233local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
18234than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
18235holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
18236user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
18237preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
18238given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
18239overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
18240the router is skipped.
18241
18242If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
18243or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
18244setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
18245two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
18246setting to achieve this. For example:
18247.code
18248local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
18249.endd
18250Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
18251up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
18252&%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
18253
18254
18255
18256.option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
18257.cindex "router" "customized precondition"
18258This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
18259router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
18260evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
18261result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
18262&"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
18263router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
18264
18265If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
18266precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
18267
18268This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
18269All &%condition%& options must succeed.
18270
18271The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
18272running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
18273the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
18274.code
18275condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18276.endd
18277Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
18278.code
18279condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
18280.endd
18281
18282A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
18283.code
18284condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18285condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
18286condition = foobar
18287.endd
18288
18289If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
18290of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
18291be specified using &%condition%&.
18292
18293Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
18294are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
18295they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
18296parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18297ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18298Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
18299Router rules processing behavior.
18300
18301This is best illustrated in an example:
18302.code
18303# If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
18304# in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
18305
18306$ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18307true {yes} {no}}
18308
18309$ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18310 {yes} {no}}
18311.endd
18312In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
18313&"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
18314default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
18315(which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
18316string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
18317with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
18318resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
18319&" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
18320
18321In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
18322&%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
18323mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
18324conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
18325string characters.
18326
18327Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
18328true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
18329match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
18330contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
18331expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
18332
18333
18334.option debug_print routers string&!! unset
18335.cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
18336If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
18337option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
18338the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
18339If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
18340output, and Exim carries on processing.
18341This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
18342so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
18343option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
18344variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
18345&%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
18346are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
18347The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
18348
18349
18350
18351.option disable_logging routers boolean false
18352If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
18353or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
18354unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
18355transport option of the same name.
18356
18357.option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
18358.cindex "MX record" "security"
18359.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18360.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18361.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18362DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
18363the dnssec request bit set.
18364This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18365
18366.option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
18367.cindex "MX record" "security"
18368.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18369.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18370.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18371DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
18372the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
18373(AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
18374This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18375
18376
18377.option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
18378.cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
18379.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
18380If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
18381the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
18382lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
18383expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
18384a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
18385
18386
18387
18388.option driver routers string unset
18389This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
18390to be used.
18391
18392
18393.option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
18394.cindex "DSN" "success"
18395.cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
18396If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
18397Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
18398instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
18399Not effective on redirect routers.
18400
18401
18402
18403.option errors_to routers string&!! unset
18404.cindex "envelope from"
18405.cindex "envelope sender"
18406.cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
18407If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
18408transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
18409there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
18410message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
18411provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
18412expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
18413
18414The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
18415subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
18416settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
18417setting.
18418
18419If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
18420the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
18421address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
18422expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
18423
18424If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
18425SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
18426any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
18427sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
18428settings:
18429.code
18430errors_to =
18431errors_to = ""
18432.endd
18433An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
18434this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
18435no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
18436address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
18437overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
18438
18439.vindex "&$address_data$&"
18440If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
18441MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
18442path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
18443setting &%return_path%&.
18444
18445The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
18446manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
18447implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
18448
18449
18450
18451.option expn routers&!? boolean true
18452.cindex "address" "testing"
18453.cindex "testing" "addresses"
18454.cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
18455.cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
18456If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
18457as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
18458want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
18459on for the system alias file.
18460See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18461are evaluated.
18462
18463The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
18464&<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
18465an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
18466
18467
18468
18469.option fail_verify routers boolean false
18470.cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
18471Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
18472&%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18473
18474
18475
18476.option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
18477If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18478verifying a recipient, verification fails.
18479
18480
18481
18482.option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
18483If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18484verifying a sender, verification fails.
18485
18486
18487
18488.option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
18489.cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
18490.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
18491String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
18492colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
18493changed (see section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&), and a port can be specified with
18494each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
18495defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
18496&<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
18497
18498If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
18499associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
18500list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
18501randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
18502transport for further details.
18503
18504
18505.option group routers string&!! "see below"
18506.cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
18507.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18508.cindex "transport" "local"
18509.cindex "router" "setting group"
18510When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18511specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
18512process.
18513The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18514error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18515The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
18516is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
18517and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18518
18519
18520
18521.option headers_add routers list&!! unset
18522.cindex "header lines" "adding"
18523.cindex "router" "adding header lines"
18524This option specifies a list of text headers,
18525newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
18526that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18527Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18528option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18529the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
18530&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
18531message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
18532header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
18533&"see"& the added header lines.
18534
18535The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
18536&%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
18537an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
18538failures are treated as configuration errors.
18539
18540Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
18541for a router; all listed headers are added.
18542
18543&*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18544router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18545
18546.cindex "duplicate addresses"
18547.oindex "&%unseen%&"
18548&*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18549additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
18550For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
18551address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
18552modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
18553circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
18554which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
18555avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18556
18557
18558
18559.option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
18560.cindex "header lines" "removing"
18561.cindex "router" "removing header lines"
18562This option specifies a list of text headers,
18563colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
18564that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18565Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18566option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18567the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
18568section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
18569the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
18570to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
18571&"see"& the original header lines.
18572
18573The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
18574&%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
18575the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
18576errors.
18577
18578Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
18579for a router; all listed headers are removed.
18580
18581&*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18582router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18583
18584&*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18585removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
18586routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
18587warning for &%headers_add%& above.
18588
18589&*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
18590items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
18591To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18592
18593
18594
18595.option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
18596.cindex "IP address" "discarding"
18597.cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
18598Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
18599entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
18600IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
18601address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
18602like
18603.code
18604remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
18605.endd
18606by setting
18607.code
18608ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
18609.endd
18610on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
18611discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
18612attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
18613domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
18614Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
18615router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
18616
18617You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
18618means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
18619.code
18620ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
18621ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
18622.endd
18623The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
18624in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
18625
18626This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
18627addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18628is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
18629domain that is being routed.
18630
18631.vindex "&$host_address$&"
18632During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
18633checked.
18634
18635.option initgroups routers boolean false
18636.cindex "additional groups"
18637.cindex "groups" "additional"
18638.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18639.cindex "transport" "local"
18640If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
18641the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
18642&[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
18643any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
18644and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18645
18646
18647
18648.option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
18649.cindex affix "router precondition"
18650.cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
18651.cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
18652If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
18653one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
18654section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
18655evaluated.
18656
18657The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
18658used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
18659asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
18660the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
18661some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
18662.cindex "multiple mailboxes"
18663.cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
18664Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
18665section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
18666
18667.vindex "&$local_part$&"
18668.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
18669During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
18670running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
18671expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
18672the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
18673a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
18674command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
18675This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
18676the relevant transport.
18677
18678When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
18679behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
18680means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
18681callout.
18682
18683The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
18684&%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
18685&%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
18686to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
18687immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
18688.code
18689real_localuser:
18690 driver = accept
18691 local_part_prefix = real-
18692 check_local_user
18693 transport = local_delivery
18694.endd
18695For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18696router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18697.code
18698 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18699 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18700.endd
18701
18702If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
18703both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
18704are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
18705separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
18706
18707
18708.option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
18709See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
18710
18711
18712
18713.option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
18714.cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
18715.cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
18716This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
18717local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
18718&%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
18719mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
18720character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
18721parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
18722&%username-foo%&.
18723
18724
18725.option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
18726See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
18727
18728
18729
18730.option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
18731.cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
18732.cindex "local part" "checking in router"
18733The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
18734See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18735are evaluated, and
18736section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
18737string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
18738example:
18739.code
18740local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
18741.endd
18742.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
18743If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
18744for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
18745expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
18746example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
18747send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
18748each virtual domain:
18749.code
18750postmaster:
18751 driver = redirect
18752 local_parts = postmaster
18753 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
18754.endd
18755
18756
18757.option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
18758.cindex "log" "delivery line"
18759.cindex "delivery" "log line format"
18760Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
18761deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
18762recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
18763this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
18764router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
18765router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
18766redirect addresses.
18767
18768
18769
18770.option more routers boolean&!! true
18771The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18772that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18773result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18774fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
18775delivery to be deferred.
18776
18777If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
18778further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
18779.oindex "&%self%&"
18780However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
18781means of the setting
18782.code
18783self = pass
18784.endd
18785or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
18786does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
18787case, the address is always passed to the next router.
18788
18789Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
18790expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
18791controls what happens next.
18792
18793
18794.option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
18795.cindex "timeout" "of router"
18796.cindex "router" "timeout"
18797If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
18798address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
18799router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
18800intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
18801host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
18802
18803There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
18804lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
18805applies to all of them.
18806
18807
18808
18809.option pass_router routers string unset
18810.cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
18811Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
18812&(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
18813routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
18814these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
18815router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
18816of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
18817be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
18818to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
18819&"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
18820
18821
18822
18823.option redirect_router routers string unset
18824.cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
18825Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
18826generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
18827example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
18828point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
18829
18830The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
18831It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
18832instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
18833which it is set does not generate new addresses.
18834
18835
18836
18837.option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
18838.cindex "file" "requiring for router"
18839.cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
18840This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
18841router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
18842Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
18843through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
18844
18845Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
18846be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used
18847(&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18848If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
18849failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
18850
18851If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
18852below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
18853&"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
18854existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
18855preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
18856
18857.cindex "NFS"
18858If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
18859the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
18860unavailable.
18861
18862This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
18863options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
18864look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
18865full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
18866these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
18867to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
18868that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
18869transport (e.g., &_.procmailrc_&).
18870
18871During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
18872facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
18873This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
18874operates as follows:
18875
18876If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
18877characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
18878comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
18879but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
18880used. For example:
18881.code
18882require_files = mail:/some/file
18883require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
18884.endd
18885If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
18886&%require_files%& condition fails.
18887
18888Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
18889checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
18890directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
18891access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
18892
18893&*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
18894incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
18895may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
18896may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
18897user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
18898
18899&*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
18900&[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
18901without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
18902is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
18903check again in that process.
18904
18905The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
18906be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
18907existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
18908circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
18909not exist. If the filename (or the exclamation mark that precedes the filename
18910for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
18911as if the file did not exist. For example:
18912.code
18913require_files = +/some/file
18914.endd
18915If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
18916handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
18917option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
18918
18919
18920
18921.option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
18922.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
18923.cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
18924When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
18925in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
18926domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
18927other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
18928Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
18929latter kind.
18930
18931This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
18932hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
18933.new
18934router. The default value is true for any router that has any of
18935&%check_local_user%&,
18936&%local_parts%&,
18937&%condition%&,
18938&%local_part_prefix%&,
18939&%local_part_suffix%&,
18940&%senders%& or
18941&%require_files%&
18942.wen
18943set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
18944for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
18945same name.
18946
18947Failing to set this option when it is needed
18948(because a remote router handles only some of the local-parts for a domain)
18949can result in incorrect error messages being generated.
18950
18951The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
18952appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
18953independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
18954
18955
18956
18957.option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
18958.cindex "router" "home directory for"
18959.cindex "home directory" "for router"
18960.vindex "&$home$&"
18961This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
18962&%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
18963transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
18964sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
18965forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
18966cause the router to defer.
18967
18968Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
18969&%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
18970place.
18971(See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18972are evaluated.)
18973While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
18974&$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
18975
18976When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
18977the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
18978delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
18979of these values that is set:
18980
18981.ilist
18982The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
18983.next
18984The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
18985.next
18986The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
18987.next
18988The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
18989.endlist
18990
18991In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
18992router, but not for the transport.
18993
18994
18995
18996.option self routers string freeze
18997.cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18998.cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18999This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
19000list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
19001and &(manualroute)& routers.
19002Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
19003of remote hosts.
19004Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
19005&(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
19006host on the list turns out to be the local host.
19007The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
19008&<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
19009
19010Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
19011example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
19012error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
19013reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
19014freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
19015cases:
19016
19017.vlist
19018.vitem &%defer%&
19019Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
19020
19021.vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
19022The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
19023be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
19024behaviour is essentially a redirection.
19025
19026.vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
19027The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
19028reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
19029rewritten.
19030
19031.vitem &%pass%&
19032.oindex "&%more%&"
19033.vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
19034The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
19035&%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
19036subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
19037name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
19038distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
19039combination
19040.code
19041self = pass
19042no_more
19043.endd
19044ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
19045Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
19046be passed to the next router.
19047
19048.vitem &%fail%&
19049Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
19050
19051.vitem &%send%&
19052.cindex "local host" "sending to"
19053The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
19054setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
19055makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
19056is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
19057different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
19058.endlist
19059
19060
19061
19062.option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
19063.cindex "router" "checking senders"
19064If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
19065address matches something on the list.
19066See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19067are evaluated.
19068
19069There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
19070dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
19071setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
19072to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
19073set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
19074verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
19075SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
19076matters.
19077
19078
19079.new
19080.option set routers "string list" unset
19081.cindex router variables
19082This option may be used multiple times on a router;
19083because of this the list aspect is mostly irrelevant.
19084The list separator is a semicolon but can be changed in the
19085usual way.
19086
19087Each list-element given must be of the form $"name = value"$
19088and the names used must start with the string &"r_"&.
19089Values containing a list-separator should have them doubled.
19090When a router runs, the strings are evaluated in order,
19091to create variables which are added to the set associated with
19092the address.
19093The variable is set with the expansion of the value.
19094The variables can be used by the router options
19095(not including any preconditions)
19096and by the transport.
19097Later definitions of a given named variable will override former ones.
19098Varible use is via the usual &$r_...$& syntax.
19099
19100This is similar to the &%address_data%& option, except that
19101many independent variables can be used, with choice of naming.
19102.wen
19103
19104
19105.option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
19106.cindex "IP address" "translating"
19107.cindex "packet radio"
19108.cindex "router" "IP address translation"
19109There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
19110it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
19111mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
19112routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
19113is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
19114code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
19115SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
19116
19117.vindex "&$host_address$&"
19118The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
19119by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
19120expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
19121For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
19122If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
19123address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
19124up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
19125produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
19126addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
19127.code
19128translate_ip_address = \
19129 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
19130 {$value}fail}}
19131.endd
19132The file would contain lines like
19133.code
1913410.2.3.128/26 some.host
1913510.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
19136.endd
19137You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
19138are doing.
19139
19140
19141
19142.option transport routers string&!! unset
19143This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
19144and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
19145only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
19146after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
19147and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
19148delivery is deferred.
19149
19150The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
19151have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
19152(see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
19153
19154
19155
19156.option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
19157.cindex "current directory for local transport"
19158This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
19159to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
19160explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
19161file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
19162option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
19163overridden by a setting on the transport.
19164If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19165logged, and delivery is deferred.
19166See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
19167environment.
19168
19169
19170
19171
19172.option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
19173.cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
19174This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
19175local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
19176configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
19177pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
19178string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
19179setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
19180If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19181logged, and delivery is deferred.
19182
19183If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
19184&%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
19185the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
19186the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
19187is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
19188
19189See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
19190environment.
19191
19192
19193
19194
19195.option unseen routers boolean&!! false
19196.cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
19197The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
19198that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
19199result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
19200fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
19201delivery to be deferred.
19202
19203When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
19204address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
19205overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
19206&%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
19207the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
19208sometimes true and sometimes false).
19209
19210.cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
19211Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
19212qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
19213delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
19214In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
19215&-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
19216to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
19217&%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
19218
19219&*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
19220this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
19221only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
19222no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
19223a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
19224duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
19225duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
19226&<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
19227so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
19228&%redirect%& router may be of help.
19229
19230Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
19231&%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
19232subsequent routers.
19233
19234
19235.option user routers string&!! "see below"
19236.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
19237.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19238.cindex "transport" "local"
19239.cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
19240.cindex "filter" "user for processing"
19241When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
19242specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
19243The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
19244error is logged and delivery is deferred.
19245This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
19246The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
19247the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
19248a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
19249See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
19250&<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19251
19252
19253
19254.option verify routers&!? boolean true
19255Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
19256&%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
19257
19258
19259.option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
19260.cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
19261.oindex "&%-bv%&"
19262.cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
19263If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
19264delivering in cutthrough mode or
19265testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
19266with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
19267restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
19268&%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
19269
19270&*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
19271SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
19272accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
19273user or group.
19274
19275
19276.option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
19277If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
19278addresses,
19279delivering in cutthrough mode
19280or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
19281See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19282are evaluated.
19283See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19284
19285
19286.option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
19287If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
19288or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
19289See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19290are evaluated.
19291See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19292.ecindex IIDgenoprou1
19293.ecindex IIDgenoprou2
19294
19295
19296
19297
19298
19299
19300. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19301. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19302
19303.chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
19304.cindex "&(accept)& router"
19305.cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
19306The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
19307used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
19308be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
19309specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
19310it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
19311up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
19312.code
19313localusers:
19314 driver = accept
19315 domains = mydomain.example
19316 check_local_user
19317 transport = local_delivery
19318.endd
19319The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
19320&%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
19321When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
19322address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
19323
19324
19325
19326
19327
19328
19329. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19330. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19331
19332.chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
19333.scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
19334.scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
19335The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
19336recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
19337unless &%verify_only%& is set.
19338
19339If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
19340SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
19341MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
19342However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
19343records.
19344
19345MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
19346looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
19347When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
19348except that IPv6 addresses are sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
19349IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
19350generic option, the router declines.
19351
19352Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
19353to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
19354are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
19355
19356.cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
19357.cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
19358.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
19359If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
19360address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
19361happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
19362
19363
19364.section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
19365There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
19366Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
19367SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
19368MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
19369problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
19370
19371For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
19372&%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
19373&(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
19374an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
19375domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
19376such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
19377proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
19378look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
19379case routing fails.
19380
19381
19382.section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
19383.cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
19384There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
19385an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
19386domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
19387
19388The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
19389is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
19390
19391Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
19392.ilist
19393The domain does not exist in DNS
19394.next
19395The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
19396convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
19397for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
19398.next
19399Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
19400.next
19401MX record points to a non-existent host.
19402.next
19403MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
19404&%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
19405.next
19406MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
19407addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
19408.next
19409The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
19410&%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
19411.next
19412&%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
19413not be found in the MX records (see below)
19414.endlist
19415
19416
19417
19418
19419.section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
19420.cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
19421The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
19422
19423.option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
19424.cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
19425If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
19426(and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
19427process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
19428differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
19429the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
19430
19431
19432.option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
19433.cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
19434The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
19435addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
19436enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
19437required. For example,
19438.code
19439check_srv = smtp
19440.endd
19441looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
19442expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
19443to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
19444submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
19445option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
19446normal way.
19447
19448When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
19449the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
19450host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
19451this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
19452SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
19453according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
19454
19455When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
19456the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
19457records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
19458this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
19459defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
19460and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
19461have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
19462trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
19463
19464See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
19465when there is a DNS lookup error.
19466
19467
19468
19469
19470.option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19471.cindex "MX record" "not found"
19472DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
19473which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
19474rather than the default behaviour of decline.
19475This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
19476domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
19477However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
19478also being queued.
19479
19480
19481.option ipv4_only "string&!!" unset
19482.cindex IPv6 disabling
19483.cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
19484The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19485or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19486(checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19487only A records are used.
19488
19489.option ipv4_prefer "string&!!" unset
19490.cindex IPv4 preference
19491.cindex DNS "IPv4 preference"
19492The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19493or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19494(checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19495A records are sorted before AAAA records (inverting the default).
19496
19497.option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19498.cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
19499.cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
19500A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
19501record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
19502For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
19503records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
19504setting:
19505.code
19506mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
19507.endd
19508This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
19509has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
19510the address record.
19511
19512
19513.option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19514If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19515DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
19516&<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19517
19518
19519
19520
19521.option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
19522.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19523.cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
19524When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
19525lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
19526single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
19527called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
19528&'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
19529resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
19530&'resolv.conf'&.
19531
19532
19533
19534.option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
19535.cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
19536.cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
19537If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
19538qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
19539an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
19540expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
19541occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
19542&%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
19543any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
19544header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
19545
19546This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
19547ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
19548sense.
19549
19550When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
19551servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
19552making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
19553some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
19554name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
19555header rewriting.
19556
19557
19558.option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
19559.cindex "address" "copying routing"
19560Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
19561to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
19562options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19563default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19564servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19565any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19566
19567If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19568domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
19569local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19570lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
19571routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
19572message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
19573without processing them independently,
19574provided the following conditions are met:
19575
19576.ilist
19577No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
19578&%headers_remove%&.
19579.next
19580The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
19581the domain.
19582.endlist
19583
19584
19585
19586
19587.option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
19588.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19589When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
19590lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
19591applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
19592the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
19593domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
19594up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
19595&'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
19596actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
19597
19598Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
19599record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
19600local wildcard.
19601
19602
19603
19604.option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19605If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19606DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
19607&<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19608
19609
19610
19611
19612.option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
19613.cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
19614If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
19615added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
19616if
19617.code
19618widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
19619.endd
19620is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
19621&'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
19622&'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
19623and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
19624the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
19625when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
19626
19627
19628.section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
19629When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
19630of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
19631corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
19632is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
19633
19634These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
19635for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
19636such as that implied by
19637.code
19638domains = @mx_any
19639.endd
19640that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
19641entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
19642.ecindex IIDdnsrou1
19643.ecindex IIDdnsrou2
19644
19645
19646
19647
19648
19649
19650
19651
19652
19653. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19654. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19655
19656.chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
19657.cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
19658.cindex "domain literal" "routing"
19659.cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
19660This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
19661verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
19662generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
19663takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
19664router handles the address
19665.code
19666root@[192.168.1.1]
19667.endd
19668by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
19669consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
19670are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
19671.code
19672postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
19673.endd
19674Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
19675grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
19676
19677.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
19678If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
19679declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
19680&%self%& option determines what happens.
19681
19682The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
19683controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
19684also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
19685Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
19686
19687
19688
19689. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19690. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19691
19692.chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
19693.cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
19694.cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
19695The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
19696Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
19697not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
19698must set
19699.code
19700ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
19701.endd
19702in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
19703
19704The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
19705connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
19706a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
19707message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
19708this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
19709can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
19710must not be specified for it.
19711
19712.cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
19713.option hosts iplookup string unset
19714This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
19715names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
19716(or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
19717and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
19718happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
19719
19720
19721.option optional iplookup boolean false
19722If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
19723is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
19724delivery to the address is deferred.
19725
19726
19727.option port iplookup integer 0
19728.cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
19729This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
19730call.
19731
19732
19733.option protocol iplookup string udp
19734This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
19735protocols is to be used.
19736
19737
19738.option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
19739This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
19740default value is:
19741.code
19742$local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
19743.endd
19744The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
19745query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
19746
19747
19748.option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
19749If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
19750returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
19751string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
19752in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
19753&$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
19754whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
19755up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
19756
19757
19758.option response_pattern iplookup string unset
19759This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
19760returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
19761router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
19762response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
19763check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
19764address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
19765the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
19766following could be used:
19767.code
19768response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
19769reroute = $local_part@$1
19770.endd
19771
19772.option timeout iplookup time 5s
19773This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
19774machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
19775call. It does not apply to UDP.
19776
19777
19778
19779
19780. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19781. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19782
19783.chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
19784.scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
19785.scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
19786.cindex "domain" "manually routing"
19787The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
19788routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
19789route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
19790normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
19791route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
19792messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
19793
19794The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
19795it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
19796has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
19797include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
19798&"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
19799generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
19800being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
19801
19802.vindex "&$host$&"
19803In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
19804router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
19805an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
19806transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
19807with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
19808passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
19809host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
19810text string.
19811
19812The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
19813&%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
19814or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
19815any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
19816below, following the list of private options.
19817
19818
19819.section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
19820
19821.cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
19822The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
19823
19824.option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
19825See &%host_find_failed%&.
19826
19827.option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
19828This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
19829address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
19830of the following values:
19831.code
19832decline
19833defer
19834fail
19835freeze
19836ignore
19837pass
19838.endd
19839The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
19840error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
19841forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
19842&%pass_router%&),
19843.oindex "&%more%&"
19844overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
19845router only if &%more%& is true.
19846
19847The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
19848cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
19849controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
19850as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
19851
19852The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
19853state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
19854generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
19855
19856
19857.option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
19858.cindex "randomized host list"
19859.cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
19860If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
19861is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
19862overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
19863crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
19864same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
19865(even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
19866deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
19867
19868When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
19869into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
19870set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
19871item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
19872.code
19873route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
19874.endd
19875The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
19876randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
19877If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
19878randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
19879&%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
19880
19881
19882.option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
19883If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
19884Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
19885example:
19886.code
19887route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
19888.endd
19889If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
19890router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
19891deferred.
19892
19893
19894.option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
19895This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
19896unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
19897that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
19898
19899
19900.option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
19901.cindex "address" "copying routing"
19902Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
19903router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
19904router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19905default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19906servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19907any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19908
19909If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19910domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
19911local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19912lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
19913&(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
19914addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
19915same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
19916if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
19917
19918
19919
19920
19921.section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
19922The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
19923rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
19924entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
19925described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19926Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
19927.display
19928<&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
19929.endd
19930The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
19931no options:
19932.code
19933route_list = \
19934 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
19935 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19936.endd
19937The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
19938list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
19939usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
19940single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
19941pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
19942&<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
19943except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
19944That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
19945lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
19946in a &%route_list%&).
19947
19948The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
19949matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
19950then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
19951&%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
19952
19953
19954
19955.section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
19956The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
19957routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
19958hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
19959The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
19960Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
19961expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
19962like this:
19963.code
19964dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
19965thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19966.endd
19967This data can be accessed by setting
19968.code
19969route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
19970.endd
19971Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
19972decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
19973requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
19974possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
19975be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
19976
19977
19978
19979
19980.section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
19981A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
19982always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
19983declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
19984and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports.
19985If the list is written with spaces, it must be protected with quotes.
19986The format of each item
19987in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
19988as described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&.
19989
19990If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
19991variables are set during its expansion:
19992
19993.ilist
19994.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19995If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
19996&$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
19997.code
19998route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
19999.endd
20000.next
20001&$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
20002.next
20003&$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
20004
20005.next
20006.vindex "&$value$&"
20007If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
20008looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
20009.code
20010route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
20011.endd
20012.endlist
20013
20014Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
20015semicolon is the default route list separator.
20016
20017
20018
20019.section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
20020Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
20021optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
20022is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
20023specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
20024by a colon. This leads to some complications:
20025
20026.ilist
20027Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
20028the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
20029be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
20030.code
20031route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
20032route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
20033.endd
20034.next
20035When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
20036colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
20037enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
20038number follows. For example:
20039.code
20040route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
20041.endd
20042.endlist
20043
20044.section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
20045When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
20046the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
20047delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
20048option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
20049transport.
20050
20051Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
20052hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
20053interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
20054records in the DNS. For example:
20055.code
20056route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
20057.endd
20058If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
20059example:
20060.code
20061route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
20062.endd
20063If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
20064randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
20065that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
20066be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
20067Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
20068happens is controlled by the
20069.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
20070&%self%& option of the router.
20071
20072A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
20073hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
20074lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
20075below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
20076preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
20077randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
20078defined by MX preferences.
20079
20080If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
20081not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
20082preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
20083
20084If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
20085depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
20086is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
20087Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
20088
20089If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
20090most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
20091router.
20092
20093DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
20094failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
20095&%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
20096
20097The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
20098whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
20099
20100
20101
20102.section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
20103The options are a sequence of words, space-separated.
20104One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
20105&%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
20106other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
20107per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
20108routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
20109
20110.ilist
20111&%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
20112setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
20113.next
20114&%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
20115overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
20116.next
20117&%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
20118find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
20119also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
20120.next
20121&%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
20122no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
20123timeout), delivery is deferred.
20124.next
20125&%ipv4_only%&: in direct DNS lookups, look up only A records.
20126.next
20127&%ipv4_prefer%&: in direct DNS lookups, sort A records before AAAA records.
20128.endlist
20129
20130For example:
20131.code
20132route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
20133 domain2 host4:host5
20134.endd
20135If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
20136DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
20137result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
20138or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
20139call.
20140
20141&*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
20142called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
20143instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
20144lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
20145function called.
20146
20147&*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
20148inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
20149option specified.
20150
20151
20152
20153If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
20154&%host_find_failed%& option.
20155
20156.vindex "&$host$&"
20157When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
20158The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
20159
20160
20161
20162.section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
20163In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
20164transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
20165
20166.ilist
20167.cindex "smart host" "example router"
20168The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
20169&'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
20170named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
20171.code
20172domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
20173.endd
20174You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
20175your first router something like this:
20176.code
20177smart_route:
20178 driver = manualroute
20179 domains = !+local_domains
20180 transport = remote_smtp
20181 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
20182.endd
20183This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
20184&'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
20185they are tried in order
20186(but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
20187Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
20188.code
20189smart_route:
20190 driver = manualroute
20191 transport = remote_smtp
20192 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
20193.endd
20194There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
20195However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
20196example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
20197precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
20198always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
20199would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
20200always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
20201&%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
20202
20203.next
20204.cindex "mail hub example"
20205A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
20206records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
20207the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
20208machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
20209&(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
20210to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
20211using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
20212lookup is easier to manage.
20213
20214If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
20215to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
20216example:
20217.code
20218hub_route:
20219 driver = manualroute
20220 transport = remote_smtp
20221 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
20222.endd
20223This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
20224whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
20225if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
20226that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
20227domain can be used to find the host:
20228.code
20229through_firewall:
20230 driver = manualroute
20231 transport = remote_smtp
20232 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
20233.endd
20234The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
20235hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
20236data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
20237next router.
20238
20239.next
20240.cindex "batched SMTP output example"
20241.cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
20242You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
20243SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
20244storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
20245can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
20246.code
20247save_in_file:
20248 driver = manualroute
20249 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
20250 route_list = saved.domain.example
20251.endd
20252though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
20253several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
20254different transports can be listed in the routing information:
20255.code
20256save_in_file:
20257 driver = manualroute
20258 route_list = \
20259 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
20260 *.saved.domain2.example \
20261 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
20262 batch_pipe
20263.endd
20264.vindex "&$domain$&"
20265.vindex "&$host$&"
20266The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
20267doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
20268file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
20269the address if the lookup fails.
20270
20271.next
20272.cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
20273Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
20274&(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
20275one way it can be done:
20276.code
20277# Transport
20278uucp:
20279 driver = pipe
20280 user = nobody
20281 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
20282 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
20283 return_fail_output = true
20284
20285# Router
20286uucphost:
20287 transport = uucp
20288 driver = manualroute
20289 route_data = \
20290 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
20291.endd
20292The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
20293.code
20294darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
20295.endd
20296It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
20297makes clear the distinction between the domain name
20298&'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
20299.endlist
20300.ecindex IIDmanrou1
20301.ecindex IIDmanrou2
20302
20303
20304
20305
20306
20307
20308
20309
20310. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20311. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20312
20313.chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
20314.scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
20315.scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
20316.cindex "routing" "by external program"
20317The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
20318and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
20319mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
20320However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
20321&%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
20322be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
20323options:
20324.cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
20325
20326.option command queryprogram string&!! unset
20327This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
20328command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
20329expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
20330&<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
20331
20332
20333.option command_group queryprogram string unset
20334.cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
20335This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
20336address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
20337uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
20338gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
20339
20340
20341.option command_user queryprogram string unset
20342.cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
20343This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
20344command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
20345it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
20346using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
20347not set, a value for the gid also.
20348
20349&*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
20350root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
20351However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
20352usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
20353is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
20354the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
20355gid.
20356
20357
20358.option current_directory queryprogram string /
20359This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
20360before running the command.
20361
20362
20363.option timeout queryprogram time 1h
20364If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
20365is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
20366timeout.
20367
20368
20369The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
20370the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
20371containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
20372the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
20373field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
20374
20375.ilist
20376&'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
20377below).
20378.next
20379&'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
20380&%no_more%& is set.
20381.next
20382&'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
20383subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
20384of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
20385included in the SMTP response.
20386.next
20387&'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
20388subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
20389included in any SMTP response.
20390.next
20391&'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
20392.next
20393&'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
20394&%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
20395.next
20396&'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
20397new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
20398or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
20399.endlist
20400
20401When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
20402number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
20403the page):
20404.code
20405ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
20406LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
20407.endd
20408The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
20409is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
20410used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
20411an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
20412
20413The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
20414As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
20415in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
20416&`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
20417(see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
20418
20419If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
20420find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
20421anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
20422goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
20423result of the lookup is the result of that call.
20424
20425.vindex "&$address_data$&"
20426If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
20427variable. For example, this return line
20428.code
20429accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
20430.endd
20431routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
20432the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
20433.ecindex IIDquerou1
20434.ecindex IIDquerou2
20435
20436
20437
20438
20439. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20440. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20441
20442.chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
20443.scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
20444.scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
20445.cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
20446.cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
20447The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
20448common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
20449(usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
20450files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
20451redirected in several different ways:
20452
20453.ilist
20454It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
20455independently.
20456.next
20457It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
20458.next
20459It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
20460.next
20461It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
20462.next
20463It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
20464.next
20465It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
20466.next
20467It can be discarded.
20468.endlist
20469
20470The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
20471However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
20472files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
20473&%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
20474
20475If success DSNs have been requested
20476.cindex "DSN" "success"
20477.cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
20478redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
20479
20480
20481
20482.section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
20483The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
20484expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
20485contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
20486options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
20487aliases, in a configuration like this:
20488.code
20489system_aliases:
20490 driver = redirect
20491 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
20492.endd
20493If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
20494expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
20495expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
20496cause delivery to be deferred.
20497
20498A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
20499&_.forward_& files, like this:
20500.code
20501userforward:
20502 driver = redirect
20503 check_local_user
20504 file = $home/.forward
20505 no_verify
20506.endd
20507If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
20508empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
20509is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
20510yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
20511comments.
20512
20513
20514
20515.section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
20516.cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
20517It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
20518&_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
20519
20520.ilist
20521When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
20522running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
20523the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
20524practice the router may not be able to operate.
20525.next
20526However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
20527is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
20528local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
20529saves some resources.
20530.endlist
20531
20532
20533
20534
20535
20536
20537.section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
20538.cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20539.cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20540The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
20541can be interpreted in two different ways:
20542
20543.ilist
20544If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
20545&"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
20546&'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
20547respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
20548in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
20549document is intended for use by end users.
20550.next
20551Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
20552described in the next section.
20553.endlist
20554
20555When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the filename given
20556in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
20557generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
20558configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
20559for the &(appendfile)& transport.
20560
20561
20562
20563.section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
20564.cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
20565When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
20566comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
20567addresses, filenames, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
20568&<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
20569disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
20570depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
20571commas or newlines.
20572If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
20573quotes.
20574
20575Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
20576also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
20577next newline character is ignored.
20578
20579If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
20580double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
20581(but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
20582&"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
20583removed.
20584
20585.vindex "&$local_part$&"
20586&*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
20587and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
20588of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
20589special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
20590&'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
20591setting:
20592.code
20593data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
20594.endd
20595
20596
20597.section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
20598.cindex "routing" "loops in"
20599.cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
20600.cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
20601A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
20602consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
20603automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
20604is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
20605Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
20606as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
20607complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
20608
20609.cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
20610Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
20611filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
20612mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
20613&'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
20614.code
20615cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
20616.endd
20617.cindex "backslash in alias file"
20618.cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
20619For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
20620preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
20621it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
20622synonymously.
20623
20624If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
206252822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
20626domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
20627addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
20628force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
20629
20630Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
20631Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
20632contains:
20633.code
20634Sam.Reman: spqr
20635.endd
20636Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
20637messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
20638this forward file:
20639.code
20640Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20641.endd
20642With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
20643&(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
20644second time round, because it has previously routed it,
20645and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
20646should really contain
20647.code
20648spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20649.endd
20650but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
20651below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
20652&(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
20653
20654
20655
20656.section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
20657In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
20658lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
20659
20660.ilist
20661.cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
20662.cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
20663An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
20664as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
20665command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
20666Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20667which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20668
20669Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
20670the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
20671the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
20672in double quotes, for example:
20673.code
20674"|/some/command ready,steady,go"
20675.endd
20676since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
20677quote just the command. An item such as
20678.code
20679|"/some/command ready,steady,go"
20680.endd
20681is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
20682
20683Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
20684of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
20685redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
20686quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
20687string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
20688are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
20689data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
20690transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
20691an &%accept%& router.
20692
20693.next
20694.cindex "file" "in redirection list"
20695.cindex "address redirection" "to file"
20696An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
20697parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
20698.code
20699/home/world/minbari
20700.endd
20701is treated as a filename, but
20702.code
20703/s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
20704.endd
20705is treated as an address. For a filename, a transport must be specified using
20706the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
20707forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
20708filename, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
20709
20710Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20711which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20712
20713.cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
20714However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
20715bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
20716instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
20717
20718.next
20719.cindex "included address list"
20720.cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
20721If an item is of the form
20722.code
20723:include:<path name>
20724.endd
20725a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
20726point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
20727out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
20728by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
20729item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
20730the alias name. This example is incorrect:
20731.code
20732list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
20733.endd
20734It must be given as
20735.code
20736list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
20737.endd
20738.next
20739.cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
20740.cindex "delivery" "discard"
20741.cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
20742.cindex "black hole"
20743.cindex "abandoning mail"
20744Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
20745&%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
20746the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
20747.code
20748:blackhole:
20749.endd
20750can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
20751done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
20752&_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
20753
20754&*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
20755delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
20756are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
20757database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
20758&_/dev/null_&.
20759
20760.next
20761.cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
20762.cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
20763.cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
20764.cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
20765.cindex "customizing" "failure message"
20766An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
20767redirection items of the form
20768.code
20769:defer:
20770:fail:
20771.endd
20772respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
20773to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
20774text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
20775associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
20776.code
20777X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
20778.endd
20779In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
20780of a
20781.cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
20782VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
20783default.
20784.cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
20785The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
20786the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
20787
20788.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20789By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
20790&':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
20791space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
20792followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
20793code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
20794incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
20795suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
20796&%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
20797ignored.
20798
20799.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
20800In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
20801default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
20802therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
20803
20804Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
20805not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
20806normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
20807as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
20808lookup and in &':include:'& files.
20809
20810During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
20811containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
20812whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain in the queue so that a
20813subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
20814deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
20815rules still apply.
20816
20817.next
20818.cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
20819Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
20820chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
20821for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
20822&':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
20823router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
20824results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
20825.endlist
20826
20827
20828.section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
20829.cindex "duplicate addresses"
20830.cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
20831.cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
20832Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
20833to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
20834routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
20835aliasing scheme of the type
20836.code
20837pipe: |/some/command $local_part
20838localpart1: pipe
20839localpart2: pipe
20840.endd
20841does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
20842when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
20843discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
20844such as
20845.code
20846localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
20847localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
20848.endd
20849does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
20850the pipes are distinct.
20851
20852
20853
20854.section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
20855.cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
20856.cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
20857When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
20858leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
20859afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
20860delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
20861members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
20862can be used to avoid this.
20863
20864
20865.section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
20866.cindex "address redirection" "errors"
20867If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
20868error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
20869for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
20870detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
20871deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
20872
20873
20874
20875.section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
20876
20877.cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
20878The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
20879
20880
20881.option allow_defer redirect boolean false
20882Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
20883data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
20884
20885
20886.option allow_fail redirect boolean false
20887.cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
20888If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
20889and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
20890
20891
20892.option allow_filter redirect boolean false
20893.cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
20894.cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
20895Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
20896&"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
20897are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
20898lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
20899
20900It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
20901the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
20902
20903
20904The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
20905&%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
20906&%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
20907files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
20908true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
20909
20910
20911
20912.option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
20913.cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
20914Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
20915This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
20916default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
20917let ordinary users do.
20918
20919
20920
20921.option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
20922This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
20923as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
20924Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
20925configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
20926for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
20927
20928When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
20929is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
20930the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
20931and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
20932domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
20933&_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
20934.code
20935\Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
20936.endd
20937Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
20938&"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
20939originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
20940(having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
20941&"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
20942&%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
20943file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
20944original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
20945
20946
20947.option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
20948When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
20949when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
20950&%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
20951&%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
20952deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
20953is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
20954&%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
20955
20956
20957
20958.option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
20959When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
20960this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
20961permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
20962option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
20963&%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
20964
20965
20966.option data redirect string&!! unset
20967This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
20968set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
20969list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
20970expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
20971has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
20972
20973When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
20974filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
20975terminated with newline characters. For example:
20976.code
20977data = #Exim filter\n\
20978 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
20979.endd
20980If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
20981you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
20982choice into a newline.
20983
20984
20985.option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
20986A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
20987ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20988specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20989configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
20990
20991
20992.option file redirect string&!! unset
20993This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
20994is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
20995use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
20996failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
20997must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
20998data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
20999entirely of comments), the router declines.
21000
21001.cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
21002If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
21003runs a check on the containing directory,
21004unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
21005If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
21006happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
21007is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
21008not, the router declines.
21009
21010
21011.option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
21012.vindex "&$address_file$&"
21013A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
21014ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
21015specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
21016configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
21017it is running, the filename is in &$address_file$&.
21018
21019
21020.option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
21021When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
21022relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
21023relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
21024relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
21025
21026
21027.option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
21028.cindex "restricting access to features"
21029.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21030If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
21031redirection list.
21032
21033
21034.option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
21035.cindex "restricting access to features"
21036.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21037If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
21038&%allow_filter%& is true.
21039
21040
21041
21042
21043.option forbid_file redirect boolean false
21044.cindex "restricting access to features"
21045.cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
21046.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21047.cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
21048.cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
21049If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
21050specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
21051conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
21052set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
21053locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
21054
21055
21056.option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
21057.cindex "restricting access to features"
21058.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21059If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
21060make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
21061functions.
21062
21063.option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
21064.cindex "restricting access to features"
21065.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21066.cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
21067If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
21068make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
21069
21070.option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
21071.cindex "restricting access to features"
21072.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21073If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
21074permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
21075under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
21076&_.forward_& files).
21077
21078
21079.option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
21080.cindex "restricting access to features"
21081.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21082If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21083to make use of &%lookup%& items.
21084
21085
21086.option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
21087.cindex "restricting access to features"
21088.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21089This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
21090it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
21091of the embedded Perl support.
21092
21093
21094.option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
21095.cindex "restricting access to features"
21096.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21097If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21098to make use of &%readfile%& items.
21099
21100
21101.option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
21102.cindex "restricting access to features"
21103.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21104If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21105to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
21106
21107
21108.option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
21109.cindex "restricting access to features"
21110.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21111If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
21112message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
21113files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
21114&%one_time%& is set.
21115
21116
21117.option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
21118.cindex "restricting access to features"
21119.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21120If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21121to make use of &%run%& items.
21122
21123
21124.option forbid_include redirect boolean false
21125.cindex "restricting access to features"
21126.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21127If this option is true, items of the form
21128.code
21129:include:<path name>
21130.endd
21131are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
21132
21133
21134.option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
21135.cindex "restricting access to features"
21136.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21137.cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
21138If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
21139specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
21140forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
21141
21142
21143.option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
21144.cindex "restricting access to features"
21145.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21146If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
21147&%allow_filter%& is true.
21148
21149
21150.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
21151.option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
21152If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
21153of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
21154the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
21155
21156
21157
21158
21159.option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
21160.cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
21161If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
21162generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
21163generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
21164bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
21165bounce may well quote the generated address.
21166
21167
21168.option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
21169.cindex "EACCES"
21170If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21171EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
21172file did not exist.
21173
21174
21175.option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
21176.cindex "ENOTDIR"
21177If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21178ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
21179router behaves as if the file did not exist.
21180
21181Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
21182router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
21183(the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
21184against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
21185is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
21186is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
21187a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
21188that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
21189
21190
21191
21192.option include_directory redirect string unset
21193If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
21194redirection list must start with this directory.
21195
21196
21197.option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
21198This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
21199&%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
21200
21201
21202.option one_time redirect boolean false
21203.cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
21204.cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
21205.cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
21206.cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
21207.cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
21208Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
21209files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
21210of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
21211is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
21212but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
21213message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
21214lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
21215before they subscribed.
21216
21217If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
21218deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
21219&"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
21220&"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
21221attempt.
21222
21223&*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
21224router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
21225reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
21226permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
21227
21228&*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
21229to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
21230and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
21231
21232&*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
21233&%one_time%&.
21234
21235The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
21236addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
21237addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
21238&%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
21239typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
21240expansion.
21241
21242
21243.option owners redirect "string list" unset
21244.cindex "ownership" "alias file"
21245.cindex "ownership" "forward file"
21246.cindex "alias file" "ownership"
21247.cindex "forward file" "ownership"
21248This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
21249This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
21250See &%check_owner%& above.
21251
21252
21253.option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
21254This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
21255The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
21256&%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
21257
21258
21259.option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
21260.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
21261A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
21262starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
21263transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
21264name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
21265When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
21266
21267
21268.option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
21269.vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
21270If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
21271generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
21272in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
21273expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
21274to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
21275&$qualify_recipient$&.
21276
21277This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
21278but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
21279not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
21280addresses.
21281
21282.option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
21283.cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
21284.cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
21285.cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
21286If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
21287set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
21288without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
21289address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
21290&%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
21291this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
21292
21293
21294.option repeat_use redirect boolean true
21295If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
21296any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
21297the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
21298only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
21299&%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
21300
21301
21302.option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
21303A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
21304&%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
21305by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
21306transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
21307are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
21308
21309
21310.option rewrite redirect boolean true
21311.cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
21312If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
21313subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
21314and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
21315
21316
21317.option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
21318The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
21319:subaddress part of an address.
21320
21321.option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
21322The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
21323of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
21324(including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
21325
21326
21327.option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
21328.cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
21329To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
21330&%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
21331(do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
21332&%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
21333needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
21334
21335
21336
21337.option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
21338.cindex "forward file" "broken"
21339.cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
21340.cindex "alias file" "broken"
21341.cindex "broken alias or forward files"
21342.cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
21343.cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
21344.cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
21345If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
21346non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
21347&%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
21348giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
21349are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
21350&%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
21351be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
21352&%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
21353
21354If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
21355errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
21356the following routers.
21357
21358If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
21359error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
21360taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
21361so it is passed to the following routers.
21362
21363.cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
21364Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
21365action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
21366&%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
21367
21368&%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
21369lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
21370option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
21371notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
21372.code
21373userforward:
21374 driver = redirect
21375 allow_filter
21376 check_local_user
21377 file = $home/.forward
21378 file_transport = address_file
21379 pipe_transport = address_pipe
21380 reply_transport = address_reply
21381 no_verify
21382 skip_syntax_errors
21383 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
21384 syntax_errors_text = \
21385 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
21386 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
21387 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
21388 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
21389 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
21390 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
21391 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
21392 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
21393 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
21394 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
21395.endd
21396You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
21397&`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
21398put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
21399.code
21400real_localuser:
21401 driver = accept
21402 check_local_user
21403 local_part_prefix = real-
21404 transport = local_delivery
21405.endd
21406For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
21407router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
21408.code
21409 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
21410 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
21411.endd
21412
21413
21414.option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
21415See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21416
21417
21418.option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
21419See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21420.ecindex IIDredrou1
21421.ecindex IIDredrou2
21422
21423
21424
21425
21426
21427
21428. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21429. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21430
21431.chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
21432 "Environment for local transports"
21433.scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
21434.scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
21435.scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
21436Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
21437transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
21438in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
21439mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
21440
21441Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
21442some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
21443transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
21444&<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
21445
21446The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
21447different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
21448settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
21449or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
21450configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
21451
21452
21453
21454.section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
21455.cindex "concurrent deliveries"
21456.cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
21457If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
21458simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
21459the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
21460rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
21461time.
21462
21463However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
21464locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
21465.code
21466my_transport:
21467 driver = pipe
21468 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
21469.endd
21470This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
21471messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
21472&%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
21473file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
21474
21475
21476
21477
21478.section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
21479.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
21480.cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
21481All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
21482overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
21483set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
21484delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
21485group (set by the transport). For example:
21486.code
21487# Routers ...
21488# User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
21489local_users:
21490 driver = accept
21491 check_local_user
21492 transport = group_delivery
21493
21494# Transports ...
21495# This transport overrides the group
21496group_delivery:
21497 driver = appendfile
21498 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21499 group = mail
21500.endd
21501If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
21502address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
21503gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
21504set.
21505
21506.oindex "&%initgroups%&"
21507When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
21508function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
21509&%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
21510by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
21511for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
21512
21513.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
21514The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
21515is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
21516receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
21517original gid is also used.
21518
21519This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
21520following that is set is used:
21521
21522.ilist
21523A &%group%& setting of the transport;
21524.next
21525A &%group%& setting of the router;
21526.next
21527A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
21528&%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
21529.next
21530The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
21531.next
21532In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
21533the uid is the creator's uid;
21534.next
21535The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
21536.endlist
21537
21538If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
21539no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
21540This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
21541The first of the following that is set is used:
21542
21543.ilist
21544A &%user%& setting of the transport;
21545.next
21546In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
21547.next
21548A &%user%& setting of the router;
21549.next
21550A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
21551.next
21552The Exim uid.
21553.endlist
21554
21555Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
21556&%never_users%& list.
21557
21558
21559
21560
21561
21562.section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
21563.cindex "current directory for local transport"
21564.cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
21565.cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
21566.cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
21567Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
21568the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
21569However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
21570are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
21571for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21572
21573.ilist
21574The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
21575.next
21576The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
21577.next
21578The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
21579.next
21580The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
21581.endlist
21582
21583The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21584
21585.ilist
21586The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
21587.next
21588The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
21589.endlist
21590
21591
21592If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
21593value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
21594directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
21595
21596
21597
21598.section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
21599.vindex "&$domain$&"
21600.vindex "&$local_part$&"
21601.vindex "&$original_domain$&"
21602Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
21603variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
21604deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
21605at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
21606other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
21607never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
21608and &$original_domain$& is never set.
21609.ecindex IIDenvlotra1
21610.ecindex IIDenvlotra2
21611.ecindex IIDenvlotra3
21612
21613
21614
21615
21616
21617
21618
21619. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21620. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21621
21622.chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
21623.scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
21624.scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
21625.scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
21626The following generic options apply to all transports:
21627
21628
21629.option body_only transports boolean false
21630.cindex "transport" "body only"
21631.cindex "message" "transporting body only"
21632.cindex "body of message" "transporting"
21633If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
21634mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
21635or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
21636&%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
21637automatically suppress them.
21638
21639
21640.option current_directory transports string&!! unset
21641.cindex "transport" "current directory for"
21642This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
21643transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
21644If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
21645logged, and delivery is deferred.
21646
21647
21648.option disable_logging transports boolean false
21649If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
21650deliveries by the transport or for any
21651transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
21652what you are doing.
21653
21654
21655.option debug_print transports string&!! unset
21656.cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
21657If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
21658option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
21659transport is run.
21660If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
21661output, and Exim carries on processing.
21662This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
21663so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
21664option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
21665variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
21666one.
21667The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
21668transport and the router that called it.
21669
21670.option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
21671.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
21672If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
21673This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
21674header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
21675requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
21676safely be resent to other recipients.
21677
21678
21679.option driver transports string unset
21680This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
21681There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
21682
21683
21684.option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
21685.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21686If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
21687This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
21688delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
21689configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
21690address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
21691header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
21692its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
21693resent to other recipients.
21694
21695
21696.option event_action transports string&!! unset
21697.cindex events
21698This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
21699For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
21700
21701
21702.option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
21703.cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
21704This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
21705value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
21706&%user%& (see below).
21707
21708
21709.option headers_add transports list&!! unset
21710.cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
21711.cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
21712This option specifies a list of text headers,
21713newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
21714which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
21715portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
21716&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
21717routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21718is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21719errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21720
21721Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
21722for a transport; all listed headers are added.
21723
21724
21725.option headers_only transports boolean false
21726.cindex "transport" "header lines only"
21727.cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
21728.cindex "header lines" "transporting"
21729If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
21730exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
21731transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
21732checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
21733
21734
21735.option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
21736.cindex "header lines" "removing"
21737.cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
21738This option specifies a list of header names,
21739colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
21740these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
21741in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
21742routers.
21743Each list item is separately expanded.
21744If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21745is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21746errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21747
21748Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
21749for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
21750
21751&*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
21752items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
21753To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
21754
21755
21756
21757.option headers_rewrite transports string unset
21758.cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
21759.cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
21760This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
21761that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
21762option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
21763the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
21764message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
21765example,
21766.code
21767headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
21768 x@y w@z
21769.endd
21770changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
21771&'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
21772header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
21773only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
21774the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
21775filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
21776affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
21777envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
21778change envelope recipients at this time.
21779
21780
21781.option home_directory transports string&!! unset
21782.cindex "transport" "home directory for"
21783.vindex "&$home$&"
21784This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
21785overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
21786placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
21787used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
21788&%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
21789&%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
21790for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
21791deferred.
21792
21793
21794.option initgroups transports boolean false
21795.cindex "additional groups"
21796.cindex "groups" "additional"
21797.cindex "transport" "group; additional"
21798If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
21799transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
21800to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
21801
21802
21803.option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
21804.cindex limit "transport parallelism"
21805.cindex transport "parallel processes"
21806.cindex transport "concurrency limit"
21807.cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
21808If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
21809it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
21810The control does not apply to shadow transports.
21811
21812.cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
21813Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
21814incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
21815is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
21816Obviously there is scope for
21817records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
21818guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
21819
21820If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
21821relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
21822start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
21823may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
21824are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
21825
21826
21827.option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
21828.cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
21829.cindex "size" "of message, limit"
21830.cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
21831This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
21832expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
21833digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
21834including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
21835delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
21836message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
21837the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
21838ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
21839&%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
21840delivered.
21841
21842
21843
21844.option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
21845.cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
21846.cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
21847.cindex "local part" "prefix"
21848.cindex "local part" "suffix"
21849When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
21850affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
21851form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
21852that contains
21853.code
21854local_part_prefix = *-
21855.endd
21856routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
21857is delivered with
21858.code
21859RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
21860.endd
21861This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
21862recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
21863whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
21864deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
21865&(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
21866
21867
21868.option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
21869.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
21870When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
21871in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
21872is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
21873deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
21874part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
21875temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
21876deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
21877
21878However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
21879as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
21880(For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
21881this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
21882
21883For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
21884the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
21885on a remote transport in the current implementation.
21886
21887
21888.option return_path transports string&!! unset
21889.cindex "envelope sender"
21890.cindex "envelope from"
21891.cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
21892.cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
21893If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
21894the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
21895that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
21896designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
21897SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
21898only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
21899header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
21900
21901&*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
21902&%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
21903
21904.vindex "&$return_path$&"
21905The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
21906either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
21907&%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
21908replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
21909option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
21910section &<<SECTverp>>&.
21911
21912&*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
21913remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
21914the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
21915This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
21916&%errors_to%& in a router.
21917
21918
21919
21920.option return_path_add transports boolean false
21921.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
21922If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
21923Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
21924mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
21925have easy access to it.
21926
21927RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
21928the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
21929header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
21930option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
21931incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
21932recipients.
21933
21934
21935.option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
21936See &%shadow_transport%& below.
21937
21938
21939.option shadow_transport transports string unset
21940.cindex "shadow transport"
21941.cindex "transport" "shadow"
21942A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
21943another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
21944
21945Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
21946&%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
21947string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
21948passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
21949expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
21950cause a log line to be written.
21951
21952The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
21953subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
21954provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
21955is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
21956ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
21957of the form
21958.code
21959ST=<shadow transport name>
21960.endd
21961If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
21962parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
21963purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
21964provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
21965headers that some sites insist on.
21966
21967
21968.option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
21969.cindex "transport" "filter"
21970.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21971This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
21972at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
21973individual users or via a system filter.
21974If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
21975
21976When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
21977&%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
21978the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
21979input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
21980command must be specified as an absolute path.
21981
21982The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
21983terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
21984SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
21985lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
21986settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
21987&(pipe)& transports.
21988
21989The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
21990standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
21991destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
21992filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
21993are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
21994
21995The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
21996care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
21997test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
21998SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
21999
22000.cindex "content scanning" "per user"
22001A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
22002at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
22003message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
22004a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
22005not possible to discard a message at this stage.
22006
22007.cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
22008A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
22009being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
22010support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
22011at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
22012more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
22013the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
22014additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
22015
22016.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22017The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
22018the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
22019parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
22020Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
22021section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
22022to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
22023of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
22024an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
22025&(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
22026
22027.vindex "&$host$&"
22028.vindex "&$host_address$&"
22029The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
22030transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
22031which the message is being sent. For example:
22032.code
22033transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
22034 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
22035.endd
22036
22037Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
22038generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
22039command is split up &'before'& expansion.
22040.ilist
22041If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
22042part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
22043expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
22044example:
22045.code
22046transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
22047.endd
22048This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
22049&(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
22050stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
22051the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
22052&`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
22053Exim tried to expand the first one.
22054.next
22055Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
22056expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
22057arguments. Consider this example:
22058.code
22059transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
22060 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
22061.endd
22062The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
22063if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
22064.code
22065transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
22066 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
22067.endd
22068.endlist
22069
22070The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
22071For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
22072normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
22073A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
22074serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
22075the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
22076bounced from a transport filter.
22077
22078If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
22079passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
22080message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
22081
22082
22083.option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
22084.cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
22085When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
22086that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
22087temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
22088&(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
22089way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
22090error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
22091becomes a temporary error.
22092
22093
22094.option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
22095.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
22096.cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
22097This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
22098run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
22099given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
22100associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
22101option is not set.
22102
22103For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
22104specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
22105&%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
22106
22107.cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
22108For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
22109sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
22110to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
22111retry data.
22112.ecindex IIDgenoptra1
22113.ecindex IIDgenoptra2
22114.ecindex IIDgenoptra3
22115
22116
22117
22118
22119
22120
22121. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22122. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22123
22124.chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
22125 "Address batching"
22126.cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
22127The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
22128one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
22129remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
22130normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
22131transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
22132copy of the message is delivered each time.
22133
22134.cindex "batched local delivery"
22135.oindex "&%batch_max%&"
22136.oindex "&%batch_id%&"
22137In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
22138local transport, for example:
22139
22140.ilist
22141In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
22142delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
22143recipients saves space.
22144.next
22145In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
22146a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
22147.next
22148In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
22149to a scanner program or
22150to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
22151acceptable.
22152.endlist
22153
22154These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
22155(&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
22156repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
22157
22158The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
22159delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
22160(no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
22161&%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
22162(that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
22163to certain conditions:
22164
22165.ilist
22166.vindex "&$local_part$&"
22167If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
22168batching is possible.
22169.next
22170.vindex "&$domain$&"
22171If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
22172addresses with the same domain are batched.
22173.next
22174.cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
22175If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
22176addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
22177customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
22178including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
22179from taking place.
22180.next
22181Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
22182delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
22183group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
22184be the same.
22185.endlist
22186
22187In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
22188both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
22189is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
22190course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
22191option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
22192&"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
22193&%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
22194.code
22195check_string = "."
22196escape_string = ".."
22197.endd
22198when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
22199given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
22200&%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
22201
22202.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
22203If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
22204&'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
22205that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
22206transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
22207addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
22208
22209.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
22210.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22211If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
22212transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
22213the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
22214of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
22215argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
22216delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
22217are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
22218
22219
22220
22221
22222. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22223. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22224
22225.chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
22226.scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
22227.scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
22228.cindex "directory creation"
22229.cindex "creating directories"
22230The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
22231file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
22232files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
22233format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
22234University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
22235being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
22236to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
22237delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
22238supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
22239directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
22240
22241The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
22242default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
22243SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
22244included.
22245
22246.cindex "quota" "system"
22247Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
22248also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
22249system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
22250
22251If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
22252partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
22253modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
22254creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
22255
22256Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
22257file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
22258private options.
22259
22260The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
22261users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
22262putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
22263&"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
22264option).
22265
22266
22267
22268.section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
22269The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
22270the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
22271the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
22272normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
22273
22274.vindex "&$address_file$&"
22275.vindex "&$local_part$&"
22276However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
22277directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
22278forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
22279user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
22280the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
22281name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
22282operation. There are two cases:
22283
22284.ilist
22285If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
22286must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
22287common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
22288different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
22289default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
22290name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
22291&%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
22292.next
22293If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
22294used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
22295contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
22296.endlist
22297
22298
22299.cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
22300.cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
22301As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
22302have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
22303form:
22304.code
22305save folder23
22306.endd
22307or Sieve filter commands of the form:
22308.code
22309require "fileinto";
22310fileinto "folder23";
22311.endd
22312In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
22313must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute filename. In the
22314case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
22315is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
22316way of handling this requirement:
22317.code
22318file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
22319 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
22320 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
22321 {$address_file} \
22322 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
22323 }} \
22324 }
22325.endd
22326With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
22327location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
22328&_mail_& directory within the home directory.
22329
22330&*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
22331&_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
22332the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
22333you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
22334&%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
22335path to the transport.
22336
22337&*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
22338the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
22339
22340
22341
22342
22343.section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
22344.cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
22345
22346
22347
22348.option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
22349.cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
22350.cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
22351.cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
22352Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
22353regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
22354delivery is deferred.
22355
22356
22357.option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
22358.cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22359.cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22360By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
22361that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
22362are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
22363what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
22364are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
22365
22366
22367.option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
22368See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22369However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
22370happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
22371file.
22372
22373
22374.option batch_max appendfile integer 1
22375See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22376
22377
22378.option check_group appendfile boolean false
22379When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
22380option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
22381delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
22382file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
22383
22384
22385.option check_owner appendfile boolean true
22386When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
22387is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
22388process is running.
22389
22390
22391.option check_string appendfile string "see below"
22392.cindex "&""From""& line"
22393As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
22394matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
22395replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
22396a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
22397contains is significant.
22398
22399If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
22400are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
22401configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
22402&">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
22403&%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
22404
22405The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
22406suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
22407&"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
22408if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
22409.cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
22410.cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
22411.code
22412check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22413escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
22414message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22415message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22416.endd
22417.option create_directory appendfile boolean true
22418.cindex "directory creation"
22419When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
22420directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
22421is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
22422
22423The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
22424operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
22425example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
22426is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
22427in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
22428
22429
22430
22431.option create_file appendfile string anywhere
22432This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
22433by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
22434directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
22435delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
22436beneath.
22437
22438The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
22439&"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
22440set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit filename is
22441given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when filenames
22442are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
22443by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
22444&%file_must_exist%&.
22445
22446
22447.option directory appendfile string&!! unset
22448This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
22449or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
22450redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
22451
22452When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
22453into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
22454appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
22455(see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
22456&<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
22457
22458
22459.option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
22460.cindex "base62"
22461.vindex "&$inode$&"
22462When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
22463&%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
22464whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
22465.code
22466q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
22467.endd
22468This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
22469inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
22470option.
22471
22472
22473.option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
22474If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
22475&%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
22476
22477
22478.option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
22479See &%check_string%& above.
22480
22481
22482.option file appendfile string&!! unset
22483This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
22484&%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
22485of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
22486specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
22487&%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
22488&%file%&.
22489
22490.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22491.cindex "locking files"
22492.cindex "lock files"
22493If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
22494mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
22495
22496The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
22497path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
22498examples:
22499.code
22500file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
22501file = /home/$local_part/inbox
22502file = $home/inbox
22503.endd
22504.cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
22505In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
22506is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
22507create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
22508deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
22509run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
22510
22511
22512
22513.option file_format appendfile string unset
22514.cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
22515This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
22516before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
22517start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
22518colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
22519second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
22520string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
22521transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
22522this added to it:
22523.code
22524file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
22525 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
22526.endd
22527Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
22528a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
22529to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
22530to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
22531is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
22532match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
22533delivery is deferred.
22534
22535
22536.option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
22537If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
22538A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
22539If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
22540
22541
22542.option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
22543.cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22544.cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
22545.cindex "locking files"
22546By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
22547when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
22548sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
22549Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
22550for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
22551deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
22552mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
22553misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
22554
22555On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
22556not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
22557is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
22558and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
22559
22560If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
22561timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
22562retries is
22563.code
22564(lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
22565.endd
22566rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
22567which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
22568&%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
22569
22570You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
22571local deliveries because of errors of the form
22572.code
22573failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
22574.endd
22575
22576.option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
22577This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
22578&%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
22579&%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
22580
22581
22582.option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
22583This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
22584for details of locking.
22585
22586
22587.option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
22588This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
22589is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
22590
22591
22592.option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22593This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
22594used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
22595
22596
22597.option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
22598.cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22599When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
22600exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
22601accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
22602
22603
22604.option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
22605.cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22606.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22607If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22608number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
22609followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
22610external source that maintains the data.
22611
22612
22613.option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
22614.cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22615.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22616If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22617size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
22618This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
22619maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
22620it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
22621
22622
22623
22624.option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
22625.cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
22626If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
22627file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
22628transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
22629&(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
22630&%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
22631directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
22632SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
22633&<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22634
22635
22636.option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
22637.cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
22638.cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
22639This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
22640a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
22641directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
22642calculation. The default value is:
22643.code
22644maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
22645.endd
22646This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
22647(directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
22648&_Trash_&
22649folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
22650.code
22651maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
22652.endd
22653This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
22654directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
22655calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
22656directly into that directory.
22657
22658
22659.option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
22660This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
22661&"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22662
22663
22664.option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
22665This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
22666section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22667
22668
22669.option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
22670.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22671The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
22672If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
22673creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
22674quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
22675value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
22676&<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22677
22678.option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
22679.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
22680.cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
22681The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
22682effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
22683matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
22684containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
22685delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
22686&_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
22687See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
22688
22689
22690.option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
22691.cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
22692If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
22693new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
22694SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
22695below for further details.
22696
22697
22698.option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
22699This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22700section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22701
22702
22703.option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
22704This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22705section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22706
22707
22708.option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
22709.cindex "locking files"
22710.cindex "file" "locking"
22711.cindex "file" "MBX format"
22712.cindex "MBX format, specifying"
22713This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22714set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
22715the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
22716traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
22717IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
22718
22719&*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
22720automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
22721empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
22722combination:
22723.code
22724mbx_format = true
22725message_prefix =
22726message_suffix =
22727.endd
22728If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
22729&%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
22730is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
22731&%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
22732interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
22733should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
22734going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
22735mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
22736
22737If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
22738the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
22739(this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
22740append messages to it.
22741
22742
22743.option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22744.cindex "&""From""& line"
22745The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22746The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22747in which case it is:
22748.code
22749message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
22750 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
22751.endd
22752&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22753&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22754
22755.option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22756The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22757The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22758in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
22759setting
22760.code
22761message_suffix =
22762.endd
22763&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22764&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22765
22766.option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22767If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
22768has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
22769permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
22770if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
22771a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
22772value, and this option is ignored.
22773
22774
22775.option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
22776This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
22777mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
22778true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
22779continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
22780
22781
22782.option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
22783If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
22784successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
22785on users about incoming mail.
22786
22787
22788.option quota appendfile string&!! unset
22789.cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
22790This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
22791or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
22792is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
22793all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
22794individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
22795&%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
22796have no shell access to their mailboxes).
22797
22798As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
22799multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
22800For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
22801
22802A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
22803may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
22804If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
22805become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
22806Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
22807the obvious value which users understand most easily.
22808
22809The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
22810(decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
22811for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
22812and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
22813large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
22814be handled.
22815
22816The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22817quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22818
22819&*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
22820
22821The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
22822the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
22823be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
22824fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
22825system quota failures.
22826
22827By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
22828mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
22829last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
22830during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
22831refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
22832message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
22833changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
22834for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
22835continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
22836delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
22837
22838
22839.option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
22840This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
22841into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
22842called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
22843delivery directory.
22844
22845
22846.option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
22847This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
22848number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
22849can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
22850failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
22851&"no quota"&.
22852
22853The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22854quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22855
22856.option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
22857See &%quota%& above.
22858
22859
22860.option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
22861This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
22862for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
22863these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
22864If this is set to a regular expression that matches the filename, and it
22865captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
22866file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
22867
22868This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
22869&-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
22870facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
22871the file length to the filename. For example:
22872.code
22873maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
22874quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
22875.endd
22876An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
22877number of lines in the message.
22878
22879The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
22880filename (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
22881sometimes add other information onto the ends of message filenames.
22882
22883Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
22884
22885.new
22886This option should not be used when other message-handling software
22887may duplicate messages by making hardlinks to the files. When that is done Exim
22888will count the message size once for each filename, in contrast with the actual
22889disk usage. When the option is not set, calculating total usage requires
22890a system-call per file to get the size; the number of links is then available also
22891as is used to adjust the effective size.
22892.wen
22893
22894
22895.option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
22896See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
22897&%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
22898.code
22899quota_warn_message = "\
22900 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
22901 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
22902 This message is automatically created \
22903 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
22904 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
22905 a warning threshold that is\n\
22906 set by the system administrator.\n"
22907.endd
22908
22909
22910.option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
22911.cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
22912.cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
22913.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22914This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
22915resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
22916size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
22917threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
22918may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
22919sign. For example:
22920.code
22921quota = 10M
22922quota_warn_threshold = 75%
22923.endd
22924If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
22925percent sign is ignored.
22926
22927The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
22928and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
22929warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
22930the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
22931can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
22932&'From:'& line, the default is:
22933.code
22934From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
22935.endd
22936.oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
22937If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
22938option.
22939
22940The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
22941are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
22942percentage.
22943
22944
22945.option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
22946.cindex "envelope from"
22947.cindex "envelope sender"
22948If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
22949format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
22950you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
22951so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
22952for details of batch SMTP.
22953
22954
22955.option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
22956.cindex "carriage return"
22957.cindex "linefeed"
22958This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22959(carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22960of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
22961of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22962
22963&*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
22964(which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
22965in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
22966carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
22967have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
22968changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22969
22970
22971.option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22972This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
22973exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
22974&%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
22975that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22976&%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
22977
22978
22979.option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
22980This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
22981the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
22982&[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
22983each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
22984
22985This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
22986&[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
22987where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
22988both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
22989
22990.cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
22991Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
22992have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
22993&[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
22994the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
22995error.
22996
22997&*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
22998is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
22999
23000
23001.option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
23002If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
23003appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
23004&[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
23005sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
23006&[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
23007delivering over NFS from more than one host.
23008
23009.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23010In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
23011necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
23012achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
23013file corruption.
23014
23015The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
23016It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
23017except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
23018
23019
23020.option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
23021This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
23022set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
23023locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
23024of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
23025are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
23026the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
23027rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
23028does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
23029
23030You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
23031&%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
23032MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
23033without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
23034
23035
23036
23037
23038.section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
23039.cindex "appending to a file"
23040.cindex "file" "appending"
23041Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
23042
23043.ilist
23044If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
23045return is given.
23046
23047.next
23048.cindex "directory creation"
23049If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
23050&%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
23051&%directory_mode%& option.
23052
23053.next
23054If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
23055indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
23056transport.
23057
23058.next
23059.cindex "file" "locking"
23060.cindex "locking files"
23061.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23062If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
23063reliably over NFS, as follows:
23064
23065.olist
23066Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
23067current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
23068as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
23069.next
23070Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock filename.
23071.next
23072If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
23073Unlink the hitching post name.
23074.next
23075Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
23076then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
23077of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
23078restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
23079.next
23080If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
23081up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
23082mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
23083lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
23084existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
23085it before trying again.
23086.endlist olist
23087
23088.next
23089A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
23090so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
23091than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
23092
23093.next
23094.cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
23095.cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
23096If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
23097&%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
23098checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
23099is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
23100ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
23101directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
23102idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
23103checked.
23104
23105.next
23106If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
23107and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
23108different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
23109delivery is deferred.
23110
23111.next
23112If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
23113If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
23114is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
23115permissions.
23116
23117.next
23118The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
23119If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
23120hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
23121
23122.next
23123If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
23124changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
23125have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
23126
23127.next
23128If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
23129option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
23130directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
23131open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
23132except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
23133set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
23134the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
23135that prevents link following.
23136
23137.next
23138.cindex "loop" "while file testing"
23139If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
23140existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
23141being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
23142after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
23143
23144.next
23145If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
23146
23147.next
23148.cindex "file" "locking"
23149.cindex "locking files"
23150Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
23151are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
23152&%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
23153However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
23154file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
23155.code
23156/tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
23157.endd
23158using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
23159the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
23160the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
23161
23162If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
23163depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
23164&%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
23165
23166If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
23167&%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
23168to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
23169delivery is deferred.
23170
23171If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
23172&[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
23173waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
23174immediately. It retries up to
23175.code
23176(lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
23177.endd
23178times (rounded up).
23179.endlist
23180
23181At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
23182and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
23183
23184
23185.section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
23186.cindex "delivery" "to single file"
23187.cindex "&""From""& line"
23188When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
23189delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
23190activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
23191&%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
23192router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
23193configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
23194ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
23195
23196No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
23197locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
23198separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
23199of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
23200newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
23201&%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
23202any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
23203
23204If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
23205the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
23206different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
23207deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
23208
23209
23210.cindex "maildir format"
23211.cindex "mailstore format"
23212There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
23213done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
23214&%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
23215formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
23216SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
23217
23218.cindex "directory creation"
23219In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
23220sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
23221option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
23222constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
23223the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
23224&%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
23225deferred.
23226
23227
23228
23229.section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
23230.cindex "maildir format" "description of"
23231If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
23232it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
23233directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
23234directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
23235&_new_& subdirectory.
23236
23237In the filename, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
23238<&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
23239Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
23240before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
23241filename. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
23242opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
23243Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
23244
23245Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
23246called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
23247do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
23248path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
23249&%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
23250contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
23251&_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
23252&_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
23253
23254These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
23255and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
23256folders. Consider this example:
23257.code
23258maildir_format = true
23259directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
23260 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
23261 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
23262maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
23263.endd
23264If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
23265delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
23266the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
23267not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
23268&_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
23269&_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
23270
23271However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
23272delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
23273does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
23274&_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
23275directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
23276
23277&*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
23278not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
23279&_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
23280
23281.cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
23282.cindex "maildir++"
23283If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
23284&%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
23285the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
23286Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
23287down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
23288the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
23289amount of space used.
23290
23291One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
23292computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
23293checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
23294needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
23295use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
23296of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
23297
23298
23299
23300
23301.section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
23302If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
23303When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
23304tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
23305name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
23306the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
23307
23308
23309.vindex "&$message_size$&"
23310Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
23311&%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
23312happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
23313variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
23314forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
23315be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
23316Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
23317empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
23318colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
23319maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
23320backwards compatibility).
23321
23322For one common implementation, you might set:
23323.code
23324maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
23325.endd
23326but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
23327
23328It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
23329as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
23330&[stat()]& each message file.
23331
23332
23333.section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
23334.cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
23335.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
23336If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
23337storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
23338within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
23339creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
23340the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
23341to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
23342
23343The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
23344messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
23345in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
23346value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
23347is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
23348need to know the quota.
23349
23350If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
23351file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
23352
23353A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
23354maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
23355See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
23356details.
23357
23358
23359.section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
23360.cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
23361If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
23362files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
23363message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
23364this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
23365contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
23366itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
23367
23368During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
23369&_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
23370&_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
23371mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
23372file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
23373the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
23374
23375The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
23376option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
23377the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
23378There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
23379greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
23380appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
23381
23382If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
23383failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
23384configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
23385&$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
23386
23387
23388.section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
23389If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
23390file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
23391messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
23392section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
23393.code
23394directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
23395.endd
23396might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
23397then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
23398expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
23399.ecindex IIDapptra1
23400.ecindex IIDapptra2
23401
23402
23403
23404
23405
23406
23407. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23408. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23409
23410.chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
23411.scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
23412.scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
23413The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
23414the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
23415automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
23416&'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
23417to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
23418
23419If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
23420&%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
23421delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
23422that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
23423another router can set up a normal message delivery.
23424
23425
23426The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
23427&"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
23428directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
23429message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
23430empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
23431
23432The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
23433by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
23434passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
23435transport is run as a consequence of a
23436&%mail%&
23437or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
23438supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
23439that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
23440case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
23441is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
23442&%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
23443
23444&(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
23445command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
23446gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
23447&<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
23448
23449There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
23450that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
23451&(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
23452address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
23453separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
23454the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
23455message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
23456
23457Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
23458message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
23459immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
23460the transport defers.
23461Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
23462controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
23463
23464If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
23465&%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
23466of the original message that is included in the generated message when
23467&%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
23468
23469.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23470If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
23471the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
23472as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
23473is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
23474problems. They are just discarded.
23475
23476
23477
23478.section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
23479.cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
23480
23481.option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
23482This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
23483message when the message is specified by the transport.
23484
23485
23486.option cc autoreply string&!! unset
23487This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
23488when the message is specified by the transport.
23489
23490
23491.option file autoreply string&!! unset
23492The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
23493is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
23494string comes first.
23495
23496
23497.option file_expand autoreply boolean false
23498If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
23499subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
23500
23501
23502.option file_optional autoreply boolean false
23503If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
23504option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
23505
23506
23507.option from autoreply string&!! unset
23508This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
23509specified by the transport.
23510
23511
23512.option headers autoreply string&!! unset
23513This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
23514when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
23515&"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
23516
23517
23518.option log autoreply string&!! unset
23519This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
23520the message is specified by the transport.
23521
23522
23523.option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
23524If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
23525used.
23526
23527
23528.option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
23529If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
23530item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
23531discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
23532generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
23533
23534
23535
23536.option once autoreply string&!! unset
23537This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
23538recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
23539This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
23540
23541If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
23542By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty filename, the message
23543is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
23544However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
23545message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
23546this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
23547prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
23548infinity.
23549
23550If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
23551and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
23552greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
23553Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
23554regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
23555
23556In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
23557which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
23558be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
23559means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
23560unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
23561file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
23562
23563
23564.option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
23565See &%once%& above.
23566
23567
23568.option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
23569See &%once%& above.
23570After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
23571
23572
23573.option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
23574This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
23575specified by the transport.
23576
23577
23578.option return_message autoreply boolean false
23579If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
23580message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
23581configuration option.
23582
23583
23584.option subject autoreply string&!! unset
23585This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
23586specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
23587automatic responses. For example:
23588.code
23589subject = Re: $h_subject:
23590.endd
23591There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
23592subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
23593bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
23594non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
23595small.
23596
23597
23598
23599.option text autoreply string&!! unset
23600This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
23601message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
23602the text comes first.
23603
23604
23605.option to autoreply string&!! unset
23606This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
23607when the message is specified by the transport.
23608.ecindex IIDauttra1
23609.ecindex IIDauttra2
23610
23611
23612
23613
23614. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23615. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23616
23617.chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
23618.cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
23619.cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
23620.cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
23621.cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
23622The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
23623specified command
23624or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
23625This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
23626transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
23627implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
23628to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
23629has it commented out. You need to ensure that
23630.code
23631TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
23632.endd
23633.cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
23634is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
23635included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
23636as follows:
23637
23638.option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
23639See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23640
23641
23642.option batch_max lmtp integer 1
23643This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23644Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
23645good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
23646batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23647
23648
23649.option command lmtp string&!! unset
23650This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
23651is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
23652arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
23653number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
23654is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
23655LMTP protocol.
23656
23657.option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
23658.cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23659If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
23660commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
23661in its response to the LHLO command.
23662
23663.option socket lmtp string&!! unset
23664This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
23665be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
23666delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
23667
23668
23669.option timeout lmtp time 5m
23670The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
23671respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
23672is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
23673LMTP transport:
23674.code
23675lmtp:
23676 driver = lmtp
23677 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
23678 batch_max = 20
23679 user = exim
23680.endd
23681This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
23682necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
23683
23684
23685
23686. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23687. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23688
23689.chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
23690.scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
23691.scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
23692The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
23693running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
23694pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
23695(such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
23696their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
23697following ways:
23698
23699.ilist
23700.vindex "&$local_part$&"
23701A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
23702transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
23703contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
23704is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
23705.next
23706.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23707If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
23708transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
23709more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
23710(because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
23711(described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
23712that are routed to the transport.
23713.next
23714.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
23715A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
23716alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
23717pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
23718&%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
23719(&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
23720this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
23721.endlist
23722
23723
23724The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
23725deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
23726implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
23727
23728In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
23729&_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
23730other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
23731transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
23732directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
23733details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
23734for a discussion of local delivery batching.
23735
23736
23737.section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
23738If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
23739delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
23740any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
23741write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
23742Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
23743of "1" to enforce serialization.
23744
23745
23746
23747
23748.section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
23749.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
23750If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
23751have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
23752the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
23753in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
23754later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
23755logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
23756&"local delivery failed"&.
23757
23758If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
23759the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
23760will be sent as normal.
23761
23762If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
23763script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
23764value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
23765apply in this case.
23766
23767If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
23768return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
23769asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
23770a non-existent command may be the problem.
23771
23772The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
23773set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
23774error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
23775return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
23776included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
23777similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
23778failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
23779&%temp_errors%&.
23780
23781
23782
23783.section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
23784.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
23785The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
23786by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
23787&%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
23788run.
23789
23790.cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
23791Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
23792double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
23793way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
23794
23795String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
23796traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
23797expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
23798For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
23799quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
23800.code
23801command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
23802.endd
23803will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
23804arguments. You have to write
23805.code
23806command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
23807.endd
23808to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
23809argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
23810result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
23811interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
23812generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
23813expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
23814example:
23815.code
23816command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
23817.endd
23818
23819.cindex "transport" "filter"
23820.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23821.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23822Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
23823&`$pipe_addresses`& (no quotes).
23824This is not a general expansion variable; the only
23825place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
23826transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
23827inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
23828avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
23829&(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
23830
23831If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, special handling takes place
23832for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
23833is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
23834argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
23835&'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
23836the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
23837should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
23838run while preserving the argument vector separation.
23839
23840After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
23841in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
23842message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
23843standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
23844read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
23845may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
23846control what is done with it.
23847
23848Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
23849in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
23850taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
23851explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
23852where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
23853under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
23854an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
23855works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
23856as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
23857&%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
23858with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
23859
23860
23861
23862.section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
23863.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23864.cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23865The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
23866This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
23867the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
23868environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
23869to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
23870.display
23871&`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
23872&`HOME `& the home directory, if set
23873&`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
23874&`LOCAL_PART `& see below
23875&`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
23876&`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
23877&`LOGNAME `& see below
23878&`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
23879&`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
23880&`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
23881&`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
23882&`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
23883&`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
23884&`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
23885&`USER `& see below
23886.endd
23887When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
23888router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
23889called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
23890the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
23891removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
23892LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
23893same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
23894
23895.cindex "HOST"
23896HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
23897associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
23898pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
23899the router.
23900
23901.cindex "HOME"
23902If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
23903for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
23904by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
23905user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
23906
23907
23908.section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
23909.cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
23910
23911
23912
23913.option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
23914.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
23915The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23916permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
23917permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
23918paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
23919&%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
23920in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
23921the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
23922&%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
23923otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
23924example, if
23925.code
23926allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
23927.endd
23928and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
23929&_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
23930&%use_shell%& is set.
23931
23932
23933.option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
23934See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23935
23936
23937.option batch_max pipe integer 1
23938This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23939See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23940
23941
23942.option check_string pipe string unset
23943As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
23944&%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
23945by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
23946&%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
23947any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
23948of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
23949the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
23950ignored.
23951
23952
23953.option command pipe string&!! unset
23954This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
23955obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
23956set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
23957the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
23958Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
23959&<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
23960
23961
23962.option environment pipe string&!! unset
23963.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23964.cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23965This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
23966command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
23967a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23968environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
23969
23970
23971.option escape_string pipe string unset
23972See &%check_string%& above.
23973
23974
23975.option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
23976.cindex "exec failure"
23977.cindex "failure of exec"
23978.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
23979Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
23980any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
23981is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
23982frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
23983
23984
23985.option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
23986.cindex "signal exit"
23987.cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
23988Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
23989a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
23990frozen in Exim's queue instead.
23991
23992
23993.option force_command pipe boolean false
23994.cindex "force command"
23995.cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
23996Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
23997the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
23998is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
23999useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
24000command. For example:
24001.code
24002command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
24003force_command
24004.endd
24005
24006Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
24007&%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
24008separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
24009
24010
24011.option ignore_status pipe boolean false
24012If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
24013run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
24014Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
24015from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
24016&%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
24017
24018&*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
24019See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
24020
24021
24022.option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
24023.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
24024If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
24025one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
24026and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
24027written to the main log.
24028
24029
24030.option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
24031If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
24032stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
24033the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
24034failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
24035option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
24036be set.
24037
24038
24039.option log_output pipe boolean false
24040If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
24041stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
24042the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
24043exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
24044
24045
24046.option max_output pipe integer 20K
24047This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
24048standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
24049process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
24050catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
24051the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
24052&%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
24053exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
24054
24055
24056.option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
24057The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
24058The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
24059.code
24060message_prefix = \
24061 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
24062 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
24063.endd
24064.cindex "Cyrus"
24065.cindex "&%tmail%&"
24066.cindex "&""From""& line"
24067This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
24068However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
24069or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
24070setting
24071.code
24072message_prefix =
24073.endd
24074&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
24075&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
24076
24077
24078.option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
24079The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
24080The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
24081The suffix can be suppressed by setting
24082.code
24083message_suffix =
24084.endd
24085&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
24086&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
24087
24088
24089.option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
24090This option is expanded and
24091specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
24092variable of the subprocess.
24093If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
24094sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
24095apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
24096
24097
24098.option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
24099Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
24100a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
24101during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
24102It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
24103for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
24104resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
24105installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
24106of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
24107
24108
24109.option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
24110.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
24111If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
24112process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
24113to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
24114&%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
24115accept the message is used.
24116
24117
24118.option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
24119When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
24120contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
24121in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
24122command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
24123handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
24124
24125
24126.option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
24127If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
24128return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
24129is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
24130However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
24131message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
24132&%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
24133
24134
24135
24136.option return_output pipe boolean false
24137If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
24138deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
24139is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
24140However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
24141output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
24142option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
24143of them may be set.
24144
24145
24146
24147.option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
24148.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
24149This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
24150asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
24151and &%return_output%& is not set,
24152and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
24153temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
24154numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
24155codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
24156defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
24157compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
24158and 73, respectively.
24159
24160
24161.option timeout pipe time 1h
24162If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
24163causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
24164specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
24165command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
24166and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
24167if one of the processes starts a new process group.
24168
24169.option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
24170A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
24171runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
24172treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
24173is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
24174delivery to be deferred.
24175
24176.option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
24177This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
24178
24179
24180.option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
24181.cindex "envelope sender"
24182If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
24183SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
24184commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
24185you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
24186&<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
24187
24188.option use_classresources pipe boolean false
24189.cindex "class resources (BSD)"
24190This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
24191BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
24192resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
24193limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
24194class database.
24195
24196
24197.option use_crlf pipe boolean false
24198.cindex "carriage return"
24199.cindex "linefeed"
24200This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
24201(carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
24202of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
24203of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
24204
24205The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
24206written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
24207are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
24208&%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
24209values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
24210
24211
24212.option use_shell pipe boolean false
24213.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24214If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
24215instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
24216&<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
24217where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
24218modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
24219&`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
24220command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
24221its &%-c%& option.
24222
24223
24224
24225.section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
24226.cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
24227.cindex "&'procmail'&"
24228.cindex "external local delivery"
24229.cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
24230.cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
24231The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
24232delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
24233this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
24234uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
24235by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
24236necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
24237appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
24238configuration for &%procmail%&:
24239.code
24240# transport
24241procmail_pipe:
24242 driver = pipe
24243 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
24244 return_path_add
24245 delivery_date_add
24246 envelope_to_add
24247 check_string = "From "
24248 escape_string = ">From "
24249 umask = 077
24250 user = $local_part
24251 group = mail
24252
24253# router
24254procmail:
24255 driver = accept
24256 check_local_user
24257 transport = procmail_pipe
24258.endd
24259In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
24260&'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
24261or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
24262user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
24263&%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
24264home directory is the user's home directory by default.
24265
24266&*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
24267.code
24268IFS=" "
24269.endd
24270as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
24271use a shell to run pipe commands.
24272
24273.cindex "Cyrus"
24274The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
24275deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
24276.code
24277# transport
24278local_delivery_cyrus:
24279 driver = pipe
24280 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
24281 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
24282 user = cyrus
24283 group = mail
24284 return_output
24285 log_output
24286 message_prefix =
24287 message_suffix =
24288
24289# router
24290local_user_cyrus:
24291 driver = accept
24292 check_local_user
24293 local_part_suffix = .*
24294 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
24295.endd
24296Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
24297&%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
24298sender.
24299.ecindex IIDpiptra1
24300.ecindex IIDpiptra2
24301
24302
24303. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24304. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24305
24306.chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
24307.scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
24308.scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
24309The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
24310or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
24311that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
24312explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
24313&<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
24314
24315
24316.section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
24317The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
24318two ways:
24319
24320.ilist
24321If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
24322routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
24323that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
24324the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
24325does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
24326value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
24327section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
24328.next
24329.cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
24330When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
24331looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
24332connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
24333for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
24334process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
24335process.
24336.endlist
24337
24338
24339For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
24340incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
24341no further messages are sent over that connection.
24342
24343
24344
24345.section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
24346.vindex "&$host$&"
24347.vindex "&$host_address$&"
24348At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
24349&$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
24350passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
24351specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
24352&$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
24353that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
24354&%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
24355
24356
24357.section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
24358.vindex &$tls_bits$&
24359.vindex &$tls_cipher$&
24360.vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
24361.vindex &$tls_sni$&
24362At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
24363&$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
24364are the values that were set when the message was received.
24365These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
24366SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
24367variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
24368appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
24369are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
24370&%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
24371
24372These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
24373and will be removed in a future release.
24374
24375
24376.section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
24377.cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
24378The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
24379
24380
24381.option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
24382.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
24383When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
24384is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
24385runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
24386reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
24387setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
24388problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
24389
24390.option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
24391.cindex "local host" "sending to"
24392.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24393When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
24394to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
24395deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
24396the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
24397configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
24398configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
24399
24400
24401.option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
24402.cindex "Cyrus"
24403When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
24404is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
24405overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
24406forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
24407to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
24408ignored.
24409
24410The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
24411started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
24412&$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
24413particular connection.
24414
24415If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
24416&%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
24417deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
24418unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
24419
24420This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
24421deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
24422&"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
24423.code
24424authenticated_sender = $local_part
24425.endd
24426This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
24427allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
24428
24429Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
24430domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
24431value.
24432
24433
24434.option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
24435If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
24436is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
24437authenticated as a client.
24438
24439
24440.option command_timeout smtp time 5m
24441This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
24442sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
24443remote host. Its value must not be zero.
24444
24445
24446.option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
24447This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
24448to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
24449several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
24450less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
24451systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
24452option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
24453
24454
24455.option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
24456.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
24457.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
24458.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24459This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
24460over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
24461For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
24462option.
24463
24464
24465.option dane_require_tls_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24466.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers for DANE"
24467.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24468.cindex DANE "TLS ciphers"
24469This option may be used to override &%tls_require_ciphers%& for connections
24470where DANE has been determined to be in effect.
24471If not set, then &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used.
24472Normal SMTP delivery is not able to make strong demands of TLS cipher
24473configuration, because delivery will fall back to plaintext. Once DANE has
24474been determined to be in effect, there is no plaintext fallback and making the
24475TLS cipherlist configuration stronger will increase security, rather than
24476counter-intuitively decreasing it.
24477If the option expands to be empty or is forced to fail, then it will
24478be treated as unset and &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used instead.
24479
24480
24481.option data_timeout smtp time 5m
24482This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
24483the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
24484of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
24485
24486
24487.option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
24488DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24489.option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
24490DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24491.option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
24492DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24493.option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
24494DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24495.option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
24496DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24497.option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
24498DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24499.option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
24500DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24501.option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "per RFC"
24502DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24503.option dkim_timestamps smtp string&!! unset
24504DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24505
24506
24507.option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
24508.cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
24509.cindex retry "final cutoff"
24510This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
24511domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
24512cutoff times.
24513
24514In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
24515them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
24516Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
24517retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
24518a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
24519unhappy at this prospect, so...
24520
24521If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24522addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
24523IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24524none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
24525delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
24526addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
24527continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
24528&%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
24529to them.
24530
24531
24532.option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
24533If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
24534and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
24535the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
24536in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
24537
24538
24539.option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
24540If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
24541&%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
24542See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
24543details.
24544
24545
24546.option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
24547.cindex "MX record" "security"
24548.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24549.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24550.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24551DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
24552the dnssec request bit set. Setting this transport option is only useful if the
24553transport overrides or sets the host names. See the &%dnssec_request_domains%&
24554router option.
24555
24556
24557
24558.option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
24559.cindex "MX record" "security"
24560.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24561.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24562.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24563DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
24564the dnssec request bit set. Setting this transport option is only
24565useful if the transport overrides or sets the host names. See the
24566&%dnssec_require_domains%& router option.
24567
24568
24569
24570.option dscp smtp string&!! unset
24571.cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
24572This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
24573of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
24574The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
24575Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
24576&`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
24577
24578The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
24579(for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
24580that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
24581equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
24582Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
24583
24584
24585.option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
24586.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24587String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
24588colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
24589port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
24590&<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24591item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24592in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
24593
24594Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
24595addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
24596&%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
24597not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
24598&%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
24599However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
24600
24601If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
24602the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
24603transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
24604address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
24605list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
24606
24607Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
24608re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
24609addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
24610copy of the message is sent.
24611
24612The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
24613&%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
24614both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
24615from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
24616fails"& facility.
24617
24618
24619.option final_timeout smtp time 10m
24620This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
24621line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
24622zero.
24623
24624.option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
24625If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
24626being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
24627(or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
24628instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
24629it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
24630
24631.option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
24632This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
24633server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
24634implementations of TLS.
24635
24636.option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
24637.cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
24638.cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
24639.cindex "LHLO argument setting"
24640The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
24641been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
24642command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
24643option is:
24644.code
24645$primary_hostname
24646.endd
24647During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
24648the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
24649&$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
24650used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
24651servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
24652that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
24653interface address, you could use this:
24654.code
24655helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
24656 {$primary_hostname}}
24657.endd
24658The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
24659callouts.
24660
24661.option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
24662Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
24663finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
24664&(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
24665email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
24666all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
24667
24668The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
24669processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
24670&%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
24671&%hosts_override%& is set.
24672
24673The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
24674list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
24675separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
24676&<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24677item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24678in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
24679of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
24680
24681If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
24682the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
24683well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
24684address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
24685&[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
24686&%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
24687that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
24688address are used.
24689
24690During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
24691unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
24692
24693
24694.option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24695.cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
24696.cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
24697.cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
24698.cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24699This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
24700example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
24701matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
24702start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
24703facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
24704
24705
24706.option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
24707.cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24708Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
24709that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
24710
24711.new
24712.option hosts_pipe_connect smtp "host list&!!" unset
24713.cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
24714.cindex "pipelining" PIPE_CONNECT
24715If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
24716this option controls which to hosts the facility watched for
24717and recorded, and used for subsequent connections.
24718
24719The retry hints database is used for the record,
24720and records are subject to the &%retry_data_expire%& option.
24721When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
24722It also turns SMTP into a client-first protocol
24723so combines well with TCP Fast Open.
24724
24725Note:
24726When the facility is used, the transport &%helo_data%& option
24727will be expanded before the &$sending_ip_address$& variable
24728is filled in.
24729A check is made for the use of that variable, without the
24730presence of a &"def:"& test on it, but suitably complex coding
24731can avoid the check and produce unexpected results.
24732You have been warned.
24733.wen
24734
24735
24736.option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24737.cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24738Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24739matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24740
24741.option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24742.cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24743Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
24744or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
24745to any host that matches this list.
24746
24747
24748.option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
24749.cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24750.cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
24751.cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
24752.cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
24753This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
24754delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
24755&<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
24756
24757
24758.option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
24759This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
24760tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
24761why it exists.
24762
24763
24764
24765.option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24766.cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24767.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24768.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24769For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
24770been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24771message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
24772explanation of when this might be needed.
24773
24774.new
24775.option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24776.cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24777.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24778.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24779For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
24780been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24781message on the same session.
24782.wen
24783
24784The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
24785process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
24786sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
24787instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
24788the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
24789The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
24790logging.
24791
24792
24793
24794.option hosts_override smtp boolean false
24795If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
24796attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
24797&%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
24798&%fallback_hosts%&.
24799
24800
24801.option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
24802.cindex "randomized host list"
24803.cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
24804.cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
24805If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
24806&%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
24807were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
24808router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
24809is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
24810list can be used to do crude load sharing.
24811
24812When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
24813order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
24814behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
24815&`+`& in the host list. For example:
24816.code
24817hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
24818.endd
24819The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
24820randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
24821If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
24822
24823.option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24824.cindex "authentication" "required by client"
24825This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
24826before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
24827servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
24828authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
24829temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
24830hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
24831&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24832
24833
24834.option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
24835.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24836Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
24837TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24838&%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24839
24840.option hosts_require_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
24841.cindex DANE "transport options"
24842.cindex DANE "requiring for certain servers"
24843If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
24844TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
24845and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made. See
24846the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
24847There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24848See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24849
24850.option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24851.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24852Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
24853TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24854&%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24855
24856.option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24857.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24858Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24859matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24860&*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
24861incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
24862
24863.option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24864.cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
24865This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24866authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
24867connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
24868unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
24869&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24870
24871.option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
24872.cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
24873.cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
24874.cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
24875This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24876CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
24877BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
24878
24879.option hosts_try_dane smtp "host list&!!" *
24880.cindex DANE "transport options"
24881.cindex DANE "attempting for certain servers"
24882If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
24883TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
24884and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made. See
24885the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
24886There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24887See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24888
24889.option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list&!!" *
24890.cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
24891.cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
24892.cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
24893This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
24894the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
24895perform a TCP Fast Open.
24896No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
24897supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
24898the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
24899
24900The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
24901as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
24902
24903On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
24904in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
24905There is no option for control of the server side; if the system supports
24906it it is always enabled. Note that lengthy operations in the connect ACL,
24907such as DNSBL lookups, will still delay the emission of the SMTP banner.
24908
24909.option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
24910.cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
24911This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24912PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
24913for multi-recipient messages.
24914The option can usually be left as default.
24915
24916.option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
24917.cindex "bind IP address"
24918.cindex "IP address" "binding"
24919.vindex "&$host$&"
24920.vindex "&$host_address$&"
24921This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
24922call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
24923&`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
24924message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
24925&$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
24926outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
24927interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
24928unknown.
24929
24930During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
24931&$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
24932during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
24933string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
24934string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
24935separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
24936For example:
24937.code
24938interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
24939.endd
24940The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
24941connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
24942&%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
24943interface to use if the host has more than one.
24944
24945
24946.option keepalive smtp boolean true
24947.cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
24948This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
24949connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
24950periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
24951of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
24952or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
24953that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
24954that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
24955TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
24956unreachable hosts.
24957
24958
24959.option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
24960.cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
24961If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
24962string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
24963has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
24964
24965.option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
24966.cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
24967This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
24968SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
24969so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
24970permits this.
24971
24972
24973.option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
24974.vindex "&$domain$&"
24975When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
24976addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
24977to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
24978handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
24979&$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
24980is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
24981
24982It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
24983&$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
24984&$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
24985
24986.option port smtp string&!! "see below"
24987.cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
24988.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
24989This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
24990&*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
24991received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
24992The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
24993variable that contains an outgoing port.
24994
24995If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
24996otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
24997normally &"smtp"&,
24998but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"& the default is &"lmtp"&
24999and if &%protocol%& is set to &"smtps"& the default is &"smtps"&.
25000If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
25001is deferred.
25002
25003Note that at least one Linux distribution has been seen failing
25004to put &"smtps"& in its &"/etc/services"& file, resulting is such deferrals.
25005
25006
25007
25008.option protocol smtp string smtp
25009.cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
25010.cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
25011.cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
25012.vindex "&$port$&"
25013If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
25014the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
25015protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
25016deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
25017over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
25018
25019If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
25020changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
25021connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
25022The Internet standards bodies used to strongly discourage use of this mode,
25023but as of RFC 8314 it is perferred over STARTTLS for message submission
25024(as distinct from MTA-MTA communication).
25025
25026
25027.option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
25028Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
25029constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
25030means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
25031tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
25032addresses is not affected.
25033
25034However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
25035each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
25036the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
25037Exim to use only the host name.
25038Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
25039
25040
25041.option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
25042.cindex "serializing connections"
25043.cindex "host" "serializing connections"
25044Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
25045host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
25046the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
25047slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
25048Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
25049&%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
25050
25051.cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
25052Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
25053written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
25054is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
25055records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
25056guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
25057
25058If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
25059relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
25060start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
25061may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
25062are used for ETRN serialization.
25063
25064See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
25065
25066
25067.option size_addition smtp integer 1024
25068.cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
25069.cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
25070.cindex "size" "of message"
25071.cindex "transport" "filter"
25072.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
25073If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
25074MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
25075an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
25076sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
25077configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
25078this if a lot of text is added to messages.
25079
25080Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
25081the use of the SIZE option altogether.
25082
25083
25084.option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
25085.cindex proxy SOCKS
25086This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
25087transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
25088
25089
25090.option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
25091.cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
25092.cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
25093.vindex "&$host$&"
25094.vindex "&$host_address$&"
25095The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
25096client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
25097connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
25098address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
25099details of TLS.
25100
25101&*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
25102certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
25103name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
25104assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
25105client.
25106
25107
25108.option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
25109.cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
25110.cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
25111This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
25112be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
25113
25114
25115.option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
25116.cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
25117When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
25118key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
25119for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
25120If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
25121will fail.
25122
25123Only supported when using GnuTLS.
25124
25125
25126.option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
25127.cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
25128.vindex "&$host$&"
25129.vindex "&$host_address$&"
25130The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
25131client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
25132connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
25133&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25134expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
25135result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
25136the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25137
25138
25139.option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
25140.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
25141.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
25142.vindex "&$host$&"
25143.vindex "&$host_address$&"
25144The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
25145when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
25146the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
25147&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25148expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
25149is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
25150&<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
25151ciphers is a preference order.
25152
25153
25154
25155.option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
25156.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
25157.vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
25158If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
25159TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
25160the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
25161certificate and private key for the session.
25162
25163See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
25164
25165Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
25166TLS extensions.
25167
25168
25169
25170
25171.option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
25172.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
25173When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
25174setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
25175to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
25176current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
25177option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
25178response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
25179TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
25180unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
25181in clear.
25182
25183
25184.option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
25185.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25186.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25187This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
25188certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
25189The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
25190Note that unless the host is in this list
25191TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
25192when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
25193The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
25194certificate verification succeeds.
25195
25196
25197.option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
25198.cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
25199.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25200This option give a list of hosts for which,
25201while verifying the server certificate,
25202checks will be included on the host name
25203(note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
25204versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
25205limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
25206
25207There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
25208
25209
25210.option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
25211.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25212.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25213.vindex "&$host$&"
25214.vindex "&$host_address$&"
25215The value of this option must be either the
25216word "system"
25217or the absolute path to
25218a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
25219for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
25220
25221The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
25222This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
25223is taken as empty and an explicit location
25224must be specified.
25225
25226The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
25227preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
25228
25229With OpenSSL the certificates specified
25230explicitly
25231either by file or directory
25232are added to those given by the system default location.
25233
25234The values of &$host$& and
25235&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25236expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25237
25238For back-compatibility,
25239if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
25240(a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
25241and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
25242
25243
25244.option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
25245.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25246.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25247This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
25248certificate verification must succeed.
25249The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
25250If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
25251operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
25252
25253.option utf8_downconvert smtp integer!! unset
25254.cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
25255.cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
25256If built with internationalization support,
25257this option controls conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
25258to a-label form.
25259For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
25260
25261
25262
25263
25264.section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
25265 "SECTvalhosmax"
25266.cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
25267.cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
25268There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
25269tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
25270&%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
25271
25272
25273The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
25274for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
25275option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
25276multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
25277retrying.
25278
25279Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
25280multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
25281created as a result of routing one of these domains.
25282
25283Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
25284several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
25285problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
25286&%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
25287delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
25288
25289Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
25290arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
25291limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
25292some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
25293&%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
25294that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
25295see below for an exception).
25296
25297Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
25298list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
25299If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
25300but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
25301that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
25302
25303Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
25304higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
25305hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
25306which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
25307tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
25308reached their retry times.
25309
25310However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
25311large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
25312Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
25313of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
25314time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
25315without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
25316all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
25317there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
25318the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
25319every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
25320reached.
25321
25322The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
25323particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
25324out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
25325reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
25326been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
25327take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
25328
25329The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
25330Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
25331and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
25332possible IP addresses have been tried.
25333.ecindex IIDsmttra1
25334.ecindex IIDsmttra2
25335
25336
25337
25338
25339
25340. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25341. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25342
25343.chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
25344.scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
25345There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
25346addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
25347(referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
25348abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
25349
25350Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
25351messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
25352&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
25353appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
25354locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
25355unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
25356lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
25357
25358One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
25359when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
25360such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
25361do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
25362
25363
25364.section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
25365This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
25366main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
25367&%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
25368
25369Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
25370Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
25371facility; you do not have to use it.
25372
25373The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
25374configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
25375addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
25376address to which it applies.
25377
25378Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
25379the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
25380rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
25381those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
25382by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
25383are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
25384rules.
25385
25386Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
25387applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
25388well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
25389headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
25390
25391
25392In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
25393legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
25394in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
25395used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
25396Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
25397discouraged.
25398
25399There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
25400illustrated by these examples:
25401
25402.ilist
25403The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
25404exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
25405gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
25406&'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
25407.next
25408A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
25409&'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
25410.endlist
25411
25412
25413
25414.section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
25415.cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
25416.cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
25417Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
25418message's processing.
25419
25420.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
25421At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
25422by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
25423ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
25424is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
25425rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
25426rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
25427RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
25428rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
25429
25430.vindex "&$domain$&"
25431.vindex "&$local_part$&"
25432Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
25433may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
25434rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
25435from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
25436for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
25437value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
25438as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
25439SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
25440
25441As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
25442recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
25443the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
25444any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
25445.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
25446before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
25447
25448When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
25449rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
25450redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
25451
25452.cindex "envelope from"
25453.cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
25454.cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
25455.cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
25456At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
25457specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
25458This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
25459section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
25460header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
25461applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
25462
25463The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
25464transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
25465transport time.
25466
25467
25468
25469
25470.section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
25471.cindex "rewriting" "testing"
25472.cindex "testing" "rewriting"
25473Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the runtime
25474configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
25475&%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
254762822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
25477transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
25478appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
25479envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
25480.code
25481exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
25482.endd
25483might produce the output
25484.code
25485sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25486from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25487to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25488cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25489bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25490reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25491env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25492env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25493.endd
25494which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
25495the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
25496present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
25497set for a particular transport.
25498
25499
25500.section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
25501.cindex "rewriting" "rules"
25502The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
25503rules in the form
25504.display
25505<&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
25506.endd
25507Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
25508transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
25509takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
25510any colons must be doubled, of course).
25511
25512The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
25513Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
25514case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
25515characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
25516ignored.
25517
25518For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
25519order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
25520replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
25521
25522The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
25523releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
25524received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
25525lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
25526address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
25527(or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
25528that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
25529
25530.vindex "&$domain$&"
25531.vindex "&$local_part$&"
25532The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
25533string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
25534rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
25535.code
25536*@* ${lookup ...
25537.endd
25538where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
25539refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25540
25541
25542.section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
25543.cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
25544.cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
25545The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
25546address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
25547single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
25548against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
25549you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
25550facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
25551
25552Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
25553case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
25554can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
25555
25556.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
25557After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
25558depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
25559replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
25560refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
25561numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
25562of pattern they are set as follows:
25563
25564.ilist
25565If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
25566refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
25567the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
25568pattern
25569.code
25570*queen@*.fict.example
25571.endd
25572is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
25573.code
25574$0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
25575$1 = hearts-
25576$2 = wonderland
25577.endd
25578Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
25579does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
25580
25581.next
25582If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
25583of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
25584for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
25585rewriting rule of the form
25586.display
25587&`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
25588.endd
25589and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
25590.code
25591$1 = foo
25592$2 = bar
25593$3 = baz.example
25594.endd
25595If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
25596wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
25597&$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
25598partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
25599whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
25600.endlist
25601
25602
25603.section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
25604.cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
25605If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
25606match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
25607rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
25608.code
25609hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
25610.endd
25611specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
25612&'From:'& headers.
25613
25614.vindex "&$domain$&"
25615.vindex "&$local_part$&"
25616If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
25617yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
25618&$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25619Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
25620cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
25621matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
25622the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
25623current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
25624expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
25625entry written to the panic log.
25626
25627
25628
25629.section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
25630There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
25631
25632.ilist
25633Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
25634c, f, h, r, s, t.
25635.next
25636A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
25637.next
25638Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
25639.endlist
25640
25641For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
25642E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
25643
25644
25645
25646.section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
25647 "SECID154"
25648.cindex "rewriting" "flags"
25649If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
25650&<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
25651and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
25652transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
25653rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
25654.display
25655&`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
25656&`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
25657&`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
25658&`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
25659&`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
25660&`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
25661&`h`& rewrite all headers
25662&`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
25663&`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
25664&`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
25665.endd
25666"All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
25667individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
25668other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
25669
25670You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
25671restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
25672
25673
25674.section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
25675.cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
25676.cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
25677.cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
25678The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
25679SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
25680before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
25681required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
25682data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
25683
25684.vindex "&$domain$&"
25685.vindex "&$local_part$&"
25686This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
25687compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
25688input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
25689the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
25690expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
25691original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
25692
25693
25694.section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
25695There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
25696take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
25697correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
25698
25699.ilist
25700If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
25701unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
25702absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
25703.next
25704If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
25705even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
25706expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
25707(does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
25708.next
25709The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
25710address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
25711rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
25712.next
25713.cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
25714When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
25715to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
25716left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
25717.code
25718From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
25719.endd
25720into
25721.code
25722From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
25723.endd
25724.cindex "RFC 2047"
25725Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
25726done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
25727causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
25728replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
257292822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
25730brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
25731(except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
25732is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
25733
25734When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
25735rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
25736.endlist
25737
25738
25739.section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
25740Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
25741.code
25742*@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
25743*@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
25744 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
25745.endd
25746Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
25747the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
25748has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
25749consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
25750present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
25751explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
25752at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
25753error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
25754
25755The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
25756domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
25757.code
25758root@*.hitch.fict.example *
25759.endd
25760were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
25761local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
25762
25763Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
25764&${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
25765messages that originate outside the local host:
25766.code
25767*@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
25768 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
25769.endd
25770The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
25771space.
25772
25773.cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
25774.cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
25775Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
25776an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
25777the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
25778remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
25779sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
25780components. For example, the rule
25781.code
25782\N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
25783.endd
25784rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
25785&'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
25786a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
25787method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
25788to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
25789use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
25790can be done on the rewritten addresses.
25791.ecindex IIDaddrew
25792
25793
25794
25795
25796
25797. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25798. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25799
25800.chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
25801.scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
25802.scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
25803The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
25804retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
25805be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
25806empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
25807errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
25808general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
25809line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
25810address, domain and error.
25811
25812The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
25813host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
25814Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
25815address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
25816been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
25817tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
25818log selector is set, the message
25819.cindex "retry" "time not reached"
25820&"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
25821skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
25822the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
25823
25824Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
25825in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
25826actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
25827failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
25828the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
25829added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
25830same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
25831domain are maintained independently.
25832
25833When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
25834receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
25835always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
25836behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
25837quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
25838suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
25839subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
25840the local address is reached.
25841
25842.section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
25843If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
25844whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
25845files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
25846always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
25847
25848The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
25849rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
25850record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
25851timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
25852and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
25853messages that it should now be retaining.
25854
25855
25856
25857.section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
25858.cindex "retry" "rules"
25859Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
25860separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
25861addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
25862enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
25863in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
25864present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
25865message's sender, respectively.
25866
25867
25868The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
25869&<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
25870which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
25871has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
25872list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
25873which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
25874example,
25875.code
25876lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25877.endd
25878provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
25879whereas
25880.code
25881alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25882.endd
25883applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
25884In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
25885part.
25886
25887.cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
25888&*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
25889must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
25890expressions work in address lists.
25891.display
25892&`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
25893&`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
25894.endd
25895
25896
25897.section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
25898When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
25899example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
25900against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
25901router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
25902regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
25903A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
25904&"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
25905&%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
25906
25907Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
25908failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
25909configuration is tested against the complete address only if
25910&%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
25911local transports).
25912
25913.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
25914However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
25915suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
25916whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
25917rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
25918failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
25919recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
25920reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
25921&%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
25922lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
25923commands.
25924
25925
25926
25927.section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
25928 "SECID160"
25929For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
25930example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
25931twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
25932&"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
25933the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
25934suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
25935.code
25936a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
25937 MX 6 p.q.r.example
25938 MX 7 m.n.o.example
25939.endd
25940and the retry rules are
25941.code
25942p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
25943a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
25944.endd
25945and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
25946first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
25947rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
25948to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
25949tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
25950first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
25951
25952In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
25953first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
25954&'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
25955routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
25956
25957&*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
25958However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
25959host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
25960.code
25961route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
25962.endd
25963then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
25964textual form of the IP address.
25965
25966.section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
25967.cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
25968The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
25969asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
25970
25971.vlist
25972.vitem &%auth_failed%&
25973Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
25974&%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
25975
25976.vitem &%data_4xx%&
25977A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
25978after the command, or after sending the message's data.
25979
25980.vitem &%mail_4xx%&
25981A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
25982
25983.vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
25984A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
25985.endlist
25986
25987For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
25988as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
25989recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
25990and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
25991retry rule of this form:
25992.code
25993the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
25994.endd
25995These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
25996LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
25997
25998.vlist
25999.vitem &%lost_connection%&
26000A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
26001legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
26002for the same host, it indicates something odd.
26003
26004.vitem &%lookup%&
26005A DNS lookup for a host failed.
26006Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
26007its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
26008Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
26009its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
26010
26011.vitem &%refused_MX%&
26012A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
26013
26014.vitem &%refused_A%&
26015A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
26016
26017.vitem &%refused%&
26018A connection was refused.
26019
26020.vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
26021A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
26022
26023.vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
26024A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
26025
26026.vitem &%timeout_connect%&
26027A connection attempt timed out.
26028
26029.vitem &%timeout_MX%&
26030There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
26031obtained from an MX record.
26032
26033.vitem &%timeout_A%&
26034There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
26035obtained from an MX record.
26036
26037.vitem &%timeout%&
26038There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
26039
26040.vitem &%tls_required%&
26041The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
26042&(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
26043to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
26044
26045.vitem &%quota%&
26046A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
26047transport.
26048
26049.vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
26050.cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
26051.cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
26052A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
26053transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
26054&'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
26055for four days.
26056.endlist
26057
26058.cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
26059The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
26060timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
26061it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
26062However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
26063heuristic rules:
26064
26065.ilist
26066If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
26067used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
26068quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
26069.next
26070.cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
26071For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
26072subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
26073the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
26074change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
26075MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
26076time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
26077.next
26078For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
26079obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
26080.endlist
26081
26082The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
26083mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
26084when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
26085error).
26086
26087
26088
26089.section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
26090.cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
26091You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
26092specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
26093apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
26094form:
26095.display
26096&`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
26097.endd
26098The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
26099.code
26100* rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
26101.endd
26102matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
26103host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
26104For example:
26105.code
26106a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
26107.endd
26108&*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
26109(which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
26110only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
26111its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
26112all messages, not just those with specific senders.
26113
26114When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
26115&%-f%& command line option, like this:
26116.code
26117exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
26118.endd
26119If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
26120list is never matched.
26121
26122
26123
26124
26125
26126.section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
26127.cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
26128The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
26129sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
26130.display
26131<&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
26132.endd
26133The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
26134time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
26135arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
26136time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
26137relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
26138
26139.cindex "retry" "algorithms"
26140.cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
26141.cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
26142.cindex "retry" "random intervals"
26143The available algorithms are:
26144
26145.ilist
26146&'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
26147the interval.
26148.next
26149&'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
26150specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
26151is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
26152.next
26153&'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
26154retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
26155maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
26156the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
26157rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
26158members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
26159queue processing times.
26160.endlist
26161
26162When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
26163order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
26164used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
26165case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
26166current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
26167computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
26168interval is found. The main configuration variable
26169.cindex "limit" "retry interval"
26170.cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
26171.oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
26172&%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
26173cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
26174
26175A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
26176host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
26177basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
26178for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
26179generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
26180time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
26181time.
26182
26183.cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
26184Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
26185run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
26186starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
26187new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
26188If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
26189occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
26190messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
26191processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
26192your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
26193number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
26194sending everything to a smart host, for example).
26195
26196The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
26197&'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
26198&<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
26199&'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
26200are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
26201deliveries that have been deferred.
26202
26203
26204.section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
26205Here are some example retry rules:
26206.code
26207alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
26208wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
26209wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
26210lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
26211* refused_A F,2h,20m;
26212* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
26213.endd
26214The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
26215&'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
26216mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
26217hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
26218parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
26219effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
26220fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
26221days.
26222
26223The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
26224happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
26225intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
26226first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
26227so on (this is a rather extreme example).
26228
26229The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
26230They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
26231all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
26232were not obtained from an MX record.
26233
26234The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
26235first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
26236not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
26237hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
262381.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
26239
26240
26241
26242.section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
26243.cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
26244.oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
26245.cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
26246.cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
26247Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
26248consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
26249set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
26250been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
26251arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
26252failing for the first time.
26253
26254This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
26255backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
26256Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
26257down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
26258
26259If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
26260every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
26261message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
26262
26263
26264
26265
26266.section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
26267.cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
26268.cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
26269Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
26270that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
26271default retry rule:
26272.code
26273* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
26274.endd
26275the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
26276long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
26277failure for the recipient address that counts.
26278
26279When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
26280addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
26281causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
26282In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
26283time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
26284
26285For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
26286messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
26287post-cutoff retry time is not used.
26288
26289.cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
26290.cindex retry "final cutoff"
26291If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
26292.oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
26293&%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
26294default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses,
26295as set by the &%retry_data_expire%& option, is
26296reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
26297attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
26298those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
26299the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
26300
26301In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
26302for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
26303times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
26304behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
26305to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
26306notice.
26307
26308If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
26309addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
26310addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
26311no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
26312words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
26313addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
26314If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
26315&%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
26316deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
26317true.
26318
26319.section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
26320.cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
26321Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
26322intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
26323its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
26324because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
26325host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
26326failing messages remain in the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
26327reached.
26328
26329Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
26330applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
26331Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
26332examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
26333commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
26334time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
26335is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
26336time out the address.
26337
26338The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
26339the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
26340given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
26341time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
26342not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
26343considered immediately.
26344.ecindex IIDretconf1
26345.ecindex IIDregconf2
26346
26347
26348
26349
26350
26351
26352. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26353. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26354
26355.chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
26356.scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
26357.scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
26358The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's runtime configuration is concerned
26359with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
26360described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
26361to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
26362permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
26363transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
26364other.
26365
26366.cindex "AUTH" "description of"
26367Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
26368
26369.ilist
26370The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
26371the client's EHLO command.
26372.next
26373The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
26374may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
26375.next
26376The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
26377appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
26378just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
26379any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
26380with the AUTH command.
26381.next
26382The server either accepts or denies authentication.
26383.next
26384If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
26385option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
26386mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
26387connection.
26388.next
26389If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
26390authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
26391unauthenticated connection.
26392.endlist
26393
26394If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
26395mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
26396SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
26397includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
26398.display
26399&`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
26400&`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
26401&`Connected to server.example.`&
26402&`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
26403&`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
26404&*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
26405&`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
26406&`250-SIZE 52428800`&
26407&`250-PIPELINING`&
26408&`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
26409&`250 HELP`&
26410.endd
26411The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
26412authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
26413mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
26414routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
26415controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
26416included by setting
26417.code
26418AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
26419AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
26420AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
26421AUTH_EXTERNAL=yes
26422AUTH_GSASL=yes
26423AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
26424AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
26425AUTH_SPA=yes
26426AUTH_TLS=yes
26427.endd
26428in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
26429authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
26430the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
26431The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
26432work via a socket interface.
26433.new
26434The fourth provides for negotiation of authentication done via non-SMTP means,
26435as defined by RFC 4422 Appendix A.
26436.wen
26437The fifth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
26438provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
26439The sixth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
26440supporting setting a server keytab.
26441The seventh can be configured to support
26442the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
26443not formally documented, but used by several MUAs.
26444The eighth authenticator
26445supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
26446The last is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
26447instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
26448
26449The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
26450section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
26451authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
26452authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
26453is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
26454messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
26455options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
26456
26457To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
26458&%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
26459either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
26460functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
26461to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
26462both sets of options, is required. For example:
26463.code
26464cram:
26465 driver = cram_md5
26466 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26467 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
26468 client_name = ph10
26469 client_secret = secret2
26470.endd
26471The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
26472&%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
26473
26474Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
26475The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
26476authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
26477in Exim.
26478
26479&*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
26480per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
26481account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
26482authenticating data.
26483
26484Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
26485&'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
26486and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
26487Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
26488used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
26489second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
26490user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
26491configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
26492&'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
26493as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
26494choose to honour.
26495
26496A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
26497to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
26498mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
26499typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
26500
26501
26502
26503.section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
26504.cindex "authentication" "generic options"
26505.cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
26506
26507.option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26508When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
26509&%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
26510used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
26511encrypted by a setting such as:
26512.code
26513client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
26514.endd
26515
26516
26517.option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26518When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
26519result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
26520Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
26521
26522
26523.option driver authenticators string unset
26524This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
26525authenticators is to be used.
26526
26527
26528.option public_name authenticators string unset
26529This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
26530implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
26531contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
26532but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
26533defaults to the driver's instance name.
26534
26535
26536.option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26537When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
26538is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
26539mechanism is not advertised.
26540If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
26541forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
26542See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
26543
26544
26545.option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26546This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
26547is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
26548for details.
26549
26550For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
26551mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
26552
26553For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
26554authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
26555authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
26556authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
26557to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
26558error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
26559string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26560expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
26561other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
26562the error text.
26563
26564
26565.option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
26566If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
26567command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
26568output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
26569out the values of variables.
26570If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
26571output, and Exim carries on processing.
26572
26573
26574.option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26575.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26576.vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
26577When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
26578expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
26579messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
26580lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
26581configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
26582refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
26583On a failing authentication the expansion result is instead saved in
26584the &$authenticated_fail_id$& variable.
26585If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
26586
26587
26588.option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26589This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
26590as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
26591driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
26592as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
26593remembered for later use.
26594How it is used is described in the following section.
26595
26596
26597
26598
26599
26600.section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
26601.cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
26602.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26603When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
26604the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
26605message:
26606
26607.ilist
26608If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
26609than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
26610.next
26611If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
26612.next
26613.vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
26614If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
26615running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
26616from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
26617&$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
26618return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
26619given for the MAIL command.
26620.next
26621If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
26622is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
26623authenticated.
26624.next
26625If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
26626the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
26627&%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
26628valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
26629fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
26630&$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
26631the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
26632message.
26633.endlist
26634
26635
26636When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
26637hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
26638&$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
26639process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
26640
26641.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
26642Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
26643MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
26644therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
26645value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
26646ACL is run.
26647
26648
26649
26650.section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
26651.cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
26652When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
26653authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
26654conditions:
26655
26656.ilist
26657The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
26658.next
26659It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
26660yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
26661.endlist
26662
26663The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
26664the mechanisms are advertised.
26665
26666Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
26667provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
26668even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
26669set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
26670You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
26671For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
26672that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
26673.code
26674auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
26675.endd
26676so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
26677
26678The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
26679authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
26680advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
26681such as:
26682.code
26683server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
26684.endd
26685.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26686If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
26687yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
26688
26689When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
26690immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
26691command. This is the case if
26692
26693.ilist
26694The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
26695.next
26696No authenticators are configured with server options; or
26697.next
26698Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
26699server authenticators.
26700.endlist
26701
26702
26703Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
26704to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
26705AUTH is accepted from any client host.
26706
26707If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
26708server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
26709that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
26710the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
26711fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
26712rejected with a 504 error.
26713
26714.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
26715.vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
26716When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
26717&$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
26718or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
26719public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
26720client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
26721no successful authentication.
26722
26723.cindex authentication "expansion item"
26724Successful authentication sets up information used by the
26725&%authresults%& expansion item.
26726
26727
26728
26729
26730.section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
26731.cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
26732.cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
26733.cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
26734Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
26735configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
26736encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
26737script:
26738.code
26739use MIME::Base64;
26740printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
26741.endd
26742.cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
26743This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
26744interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
26745some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
26746command line to run this script on such data might be
26747.code
26748encode '\0user\0password'
26749.endd
26750Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
26751backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
26752whose code value is zero.
26753
26754&*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
26755digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
26756you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
26757interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
26758
26759&*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
26760specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
26761example, a command such as
26762.code
26763encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
26764.endd
26765gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
26766
26767If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
26768base64-encoded strings is to run the command
26769.code
26770echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
26771.endd
26772The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
26773in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
26774output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
26775should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
26776
26777
26778
26779.section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
26780.cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
26781The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
26782&%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
26783announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
26784of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
26785
26786.ilist
26787For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
26788they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
26789mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
26790of the authenticator.
26791.next
26792.vindex "&$host$&"
26793.vindex "&$host_address$&"
26794When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
26795variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
26796that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
26797any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
26798Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
26799delivery to be deferred.
26800.next
26801If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
26802Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
26803try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
26804usual way.
26805.next
26806If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
26807carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
26808possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
26809no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
26810what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
26811&%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
26812delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
26813turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
26814deliver the message unauthenticated.
26815.endlist
26816
26817Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
26818confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
26819upon and the time that the transport runs. For example, with a manualroute
26820router given a host name, and with DNS "round-robin" used by that name: if
26821the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
26822running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
26823check which does not match the connection peer IP.
26824No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
26825
26826For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
26827
26828.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26829When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
26830parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
26831the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
26832is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
26833incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
26834allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
26835to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
26836&%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
26837&%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
26838the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
26839.ecindex IIDauthconf1
26840.ecindex IIDauthconf2
26841
26842
26843
26844
26845
26846
26847. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26848. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26849
26850.chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
26851.scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
26852.scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
26853The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
26854LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
26855plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
26856security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
26857(see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
26858use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
26859connections as you do for login accounts.
26860
26861.section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
26862.cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
26863When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
26864
26865.option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26866This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
26867configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
26868
26869.option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
26870The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
26871prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
26872given.
26873
26874.section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
26875.cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26876.cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26877.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
26878 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26879.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26880.cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26881
26882When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
26883expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
26884response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
26885values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
26886a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
26887are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
26888(neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
26889
26890For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
26891the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
26892variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
26893string expansions that also use them for other things.
26894
26895If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
26896supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
26897data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
26898
26899.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26900Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
26901&%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
26902authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
26903to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
26904&"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26905expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
26906generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
26907For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
26908string as the error text.
26909
26910&*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
26911password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
26912There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
26913
26914
26915
26916.section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
26917.cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
26918.cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
26919.cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26920The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
26921sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
26922separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
26923subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
26924
26925The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
26926Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
26927configured as follows:
26928.code
26929fixed_plain:
26930 driver = plaintext
26931 public_name = PLAIN
26932 server_prompts = :
26933 server_condition = \
26934 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
26935 server_set_id = $auth2
26936.endd
26937Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
26938are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
26939password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
26940or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
26941
26942The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
26943the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
26944AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
26945authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
26946.code
26947250-AUTH PLAIN
26948.endd
26949and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
26950.code
26951AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
26952.endd
26953As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
26954data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
26955.code
26956AUTH PLAIN
26957.endd
26958to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
26959prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
26960
26961The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
26962when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
26963represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
26964is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
26965second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
26966
26967Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
26968realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
26969authenticating clients it could make sense.
26970
26971A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
26972&$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
26973comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
26974this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
26975This is an incorrect example:
26976.code
26977server_condition = \
26978 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
26979.endd
26980The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
26981which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
26982incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
26983non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
26984strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
26985the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
26986name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
26987.code
26988server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
26989 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
26990.endd
26991In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
26992fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
26993used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
26994always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
26995writing the test makes the logic clearer.
26996
26997
26998.section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
26999.cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
27000.cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
27001The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
27002in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
27003user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
27004plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
27005.code
27006fixed_login:
27007 driver = plaintext
27008 public_name = LOGIN
27009 server_prompts = User Name : Password
27010 server_condition = \
27011 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
27012 server_set_id = $auth1
27013.endd
27014Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
27015with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
27016if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
27017strings are used to obtain two data items.
27018
27019Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
27020example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
27021&"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
27022strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
27023name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
27024.code
27025login:
27026 driver = plaintext
27027 public_name = LOGIN
27028 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
27029 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
27030 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
27031 ldapauth{\
27032 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
27033 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
27034 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
27035 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
27036.endd
27037We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
27038does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
27039operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
27040&%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
27041correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
27042the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
27043uninterpreted string.
27044
27045
27046.section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
27047A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
27048interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
27049traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
27050Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
27051&<<SECTexpcond>>&.
27052
27053
27054
27055
27056.section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
27057.cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
27058The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
27059
27060.option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
27061If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
27062authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
27063the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
27064usual.
27065
27066.option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
27067The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
27068string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
27069string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
27070to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
27071most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
27072with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
27073way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
27074(with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
27075so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
27076&%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
27077&$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
27078
27079&*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
27080splitting takes priority and happens first.
27081
27082Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
27083the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
27084there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
27085NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
27086the string.
27087
27088This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
27089authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
27090.code
27091fixed_plain:
27092 driver = plaintext
27093 public_name = PLAIN
27094 client_send = ^username^mysecret
27095.endd
27096The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
27097command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
27098that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
27099.code
27100fixed_login:
27101 driver = plaintext
27102 public_name = LOGIN
27103 client_send = : username : mysecret
27104.endd
27105The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
27106the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
27107prompts.
27108.ecindex IIDplaiauth1
27109.ecindex IIDplaiauth2
27110
27111
27112
27113
27114. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27115. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27116
27117.chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
27118.scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
27119.scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
27120.cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
27121.cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
27122The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
27123sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
27124name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
27125string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
27126is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
27127secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
27128available in plain text at either end.
27129
27130
27131.section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
27132.cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
27133This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
27134authenticator as a server:
27135
27136.option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
27137.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
27138When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
27139the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
27140obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
27141that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
27142string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
27143fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
27144returned to the client.
27145
27146For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
27147in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
27148deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
27149numeric variables for other things.
27150
27151For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
27152client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
27153user name, authentication fails.
27154.code
27155fixed_cram:
27156 driver = cram_md5
27157 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27158 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
27159 server_set_id = $auth1
27160.endd
27161.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27162If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
27163name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
27164secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
27165.code
27166lookup_cram:
27167 driver = cram_md5
27168 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27169 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
27170 {$value}fail}
27171 server_set_id = $auth1
27172.endd
27173Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
27174because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
27175
27176As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
27177using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
27178lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
27179realm, with:
27180.code
27181cyrusless_crammd5:
27182 driver = cram_md5
27183 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27184 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
27185 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
27186 server_set_id = $auth1
27187.endd
27188
27189.section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
27190.cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
27191When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
27192
27193
27194
27195.option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
27196This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
27197computing the response to the server's challenge.
27198
27199
27200.option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
27201This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
27202expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
27203
27204
27205.vindex "&$host$&"
27206.vindex "&$host_address$&"
27207Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
27208to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
27209expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
27210prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
27211authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
27212send the message to the current server.
27213
27214A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
27215strings, is:
27216.code
27217fixed_cram:
27218 driver = cram_md5
27219 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27220 client_name = ph10
27221 client_secret = secret
27222.endd
27223.ecindex IIDcramauth1
27224.ecindex IIDcramauth2
27225
27226
27227
27228. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27229. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27230
27231.chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
27232.scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
27233.scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
27234.cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
27235.cindex "Kerberos"
27236The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick while
27237at A L Digital Ltd.
27238
27239The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
27240library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
27241Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
27242including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
27243directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
27244
27245The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
27246the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
27247then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
27248name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
27249
27250Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example, in GSSAPI
27251or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
27252user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
27253by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
27254depending on the driver you are using.
27255
27256The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
27257be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
27258Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
27259changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
27260layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
27261implementation.
27262
27263For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
27264may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
27265variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
27266Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
27267With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
27268environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
27269is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
27270the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
27271
27272
27273.section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
27274The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
27275(on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
27276previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
27277use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
27278confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
27279things.
27280
27281
27282.option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
27283This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
27284library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
27285SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
27286
27287
27288.option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
27289This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
27290default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
27291you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
27292example:
27293.code
27294sasl:
27295 driver = cyrus_sasl
27296 public_name = X-ANYTHING
27297 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
27298 server_set_id = $auth1
27299.endd
27300
27301.option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
27302This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
27303
27304
27305.option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
27306This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
27307
27308
27309For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
27310private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
27311the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
27312PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
27313.code
27314sasl_cram_md5:
27315 driver = cyrus_sasl
27316 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27317 server_set_id = $auth1
27318
27319sasl_plain:
27320 driver = cyrus_sasl
27321 public_name = PLAIN
27322 server_set_id = $auth2
27323.endd
27324Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
27325not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
27326but it is present in many binary distributions.
27327.ecindex IIDcyrauth1
27328.ecindex IIDcyrauth2
27329
27330
27331
27332
27333. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27334. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27335.chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
27336.scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
27337.scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
27338This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
27339Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
27340Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
27341If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
27342to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
27343authenticator only. There is only one option:
27344
27345.option server_socket dovecot string unset
27346
27347This option must specify the UNIX socket that is the interface to Dovecot
27348authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
27349mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
27350authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
27351.code
27352dovecot_plain:
27353 driver = dovecot
27354 public_name = PLAIN
27355 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
27356 server_set_id = $auth1
27357
27358dovecot_ntlm:
27359 driver = dovecot
27360 public_name = NTLM
27361 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
27362 server_set_id = $auth1
27363.endd
27364If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
27365&$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
27366option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
27367connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
27368option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
27369who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
27370.ecindex IIDdcotauth1
27371.ecindex IIDdcotauth2
27372
27373
27374. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27375. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27376.chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
27377.scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
27378.scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
27379.cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
27380.cindex "authentication" "SASL"
27381.cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
27382.cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
27383.cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
27384.cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
27385.cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
27386.cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
27387.cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
27388The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
27389library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
27390and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
27391scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
27392made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
27393without code changes in Exim.
27394
27395Exim's &(gsasl)& authenticator does not have client-side support at this
27396time; only the server-side support is implemented. Patches welcome.
27397
27398
27399.option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
27400Do not set this true without consulting a cryptographic engineer.
27401
27402Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
27403of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
27404authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
27405ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
27406context.
27407
27408This should have meant that certificate identity and verification becomes a
27409non-issue, as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and
27410server to see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
27411
27412This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
27413only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
27414writing, that's the SCRAM family.
27415
27416This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
27417this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
27418of Exim might have switched the default to be true.
27419
27420However, Channel Binding in TLS has proven to be broken in current versions.
27421Do not plan to rely upon this feature for security, ever, without consulting
27422with a subject matter expert (a cryptographic engineer).
27423
27424
27425.option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
27426This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
27427library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
27428Some mechanisms will use this data.
27429
27430
27431.option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
27432This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
27433default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
27434you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
27435example:
27436.code
27437sasl:
27438 driver = gsasl
27439 public_name = X-ANYTHING
27440 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
27441 server_set_id = $auth1
27442.endd
27443
27444
27445.option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
27446Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
27447that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
27448the password itself.
27449
27450The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
27451In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
27452The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
27453if available, else the empty string.
27454The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
27455else the empty string.
27456
27457A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
27458
27459If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
27460option to be simply "true".
27461
27462
27463.option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
27464This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
27465Some mechanisms will use this data.
27466
27467
27468.option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
27469This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
27470&$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
27471(This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
27472
27473
27474.option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
27475This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
27476&$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
27477(This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
27478
27479
27480.option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
27481This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
27482Some mechanisms will use this data.
27483
27484
27485.section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
27486.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27487These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
27488They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
27489
27490Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
27491meanings for these variables:
27492
27493.ilist
27494.vindex "&$auth1$&"
27495&$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
27496.next
27497.vindex "&$auth2$&"
27498&$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
27499.next
27500.vindex "&$auth3$&"
27501&$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
27502.endlist
27503
27504On a per-mechanism basis:
27505
27506.ilist
27507.cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
27508EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
27509the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27510.next
27511.cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
27512ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
27513the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27514.next
27515.cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
27516GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
27517&$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
27518the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27519.endlist
27520
27521An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
27522identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
27523email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
27524
27525
27526An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
27527and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
27528.code
27529gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
27530 driver = gsasl
27531 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27532 server_realm = imap.example.org
27533 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
27534 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
27535 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
27536 server_condition = yes
27537.endd
27538
27539
27540. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27541. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27542
27543.chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
27544.scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
27545.scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
27546.cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
27547.cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
27548The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
27549Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
27550reliably.
27551
27552.option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
27553This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
27554for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
27555identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
27556
27557.option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
27558If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
27559&_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
27560The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
27561
27562.option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
27563This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
27564&%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
27565from the keytab.
27566
27567
27568.section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
27569Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
27570to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
27571not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
27572
27573The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
27574Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
27575Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
27576role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
27577
27578.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27579.ilist
27580.vindex "&$auth1$&"
27581&$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
27582.next
27583.vindex "&$auth2$&"
27584&$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
27585authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
27586GSS Display Name.
27587.endlist
27588
27589
27590. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27591. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27592
27593.chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
27594.scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
27595.scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
27596.cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
27597.cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
27598.cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
27599.cindex "NTLM authentication"
27600The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
27601Password Authentication'& mechanism,
27602which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
27603this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
27604taken from the Samba project (&url(https://www.samba.org/)). The code for the
27605server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
27606follows:
27607
27608.ilist
27609After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
27610authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
27611.next
27612The server sends back a challenge.
27613.next
27614The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
27615and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
27616.endlist
27617
27618Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
27619
27620
27621
27622.section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
27623.cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
27624The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
27625
27626.option server_password spa string&!! unset
27627.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
27628This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
27629authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
27630compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
27631&$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
27632it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
27633for other things. For example:
27634.code
27635spa:
27636 driver = spa
27637 public_name = NTLM
27638 server_password = \
27639 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
27640.endd
27641If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27642failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27643
27644
27645
27646
27647
27648.section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
27649.cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
27650The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
27651
27652
27653
27654.option client_domain spa string&!! unset
27655This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
27656
27657
27658.option client_password spa string&!! unset
27659This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
27660
27661
27662.option client_username spa string&!! unset
27663This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
27664configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
27665&'msn.com'&:
27666.code
27667msn:
27668 driver = spa
27669 public_name = MSN
27670 client_username = msn/msn_username
27671 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
27672 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
27673.endd
27674.ecindex IIDspaauth1
27675.ecindex IIDspaauth2
27676
27677
27678
27679
27680
27681. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27682. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27683
27684.chapter "The external authenticator" "CHAPexternauth"
27685.scindex IIDexternauth1 "&(external)& authenticator"
27686.scindex IIDexternauth2 "authenticators" "&(external)&"
27687.cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
27688.cindex "authentication" "X509"
27689.cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
27690The &(external)& authenticator provides support for
27691authentication based on non-SMTP information.
27692The specification is in RFC 4422 Appendix A
27693(&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4422)).
27694It is only a transport and negotiation mechanism;
27695the process of authentication is entirely controlled
27696by the server configuration.
27697
27698The client presents an identity in-clear.
27699It is probably wise for a server to only advertise,
27700and for clients to only attempt,
27701this authentication method on a secure (eg. under TLS) connection.
27702
27703One possible use, compatible with the
27704K-9 Mail Andoid client (&url(https://k9mail.github.io/)),
27705is for using X509 client certificates.
27706
27707It thus overlaps in function with the TLS authenticator
27708(see &<<CHAPtlsauth>>&)
27709but is a full SMTP SASL authenticator
27710rather than being implicit for TLS-connection carried
27711client certificates only.
27712
27713The examples and discussion in this chapter assume that
27714client-certificate authentication is being done.
27715
27716The client must present a certificate,
27717for which it must have been requested via the
27718&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
27719(see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27720For authentication to be effective the certificate should be
27721verifiable against a trust-anchor certificate known to the server.
27722
27723.section "External options" "SECTexternsoptions"
27724.cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (server)"
27725The &(external)& authenticator has two server options:
27726
27727.option server_param2 external string&!! unset
27728.option server_param3 external string&!! unset
27729.cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27730These options are expanded before the &%server_condition%& option
27731and the result are placed in &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& resectively.
27732If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27733failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27734
27735They can be used to clarify the coding of a complex &%server_condition%&.
27736
27737.section "Using external in a server" "SECTexternserver"
27738.cindex "AUTH" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27739.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
27740 "in &(external)& authenticator"
27741.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27742.cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27743
27744When running as a server, &(external)& performs the authentication test by
27745expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
27746response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
27747values when decoded. The decoded value is treated as
27748an identity for authentication and
27749placed in the expansion variable &$auth1$&.
27750
27751For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the value is also placed in
27752the expansion variable &$1$&. However, the use of this
27753variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
27754string expansions that also use them for other things.
27755
27756.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27757Once an identity has been received,
27758&%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
27759authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
27760to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
27761&"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
27762expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
27763generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
27764For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
27765string as the error text.
27766
27767Example:
27768.code
27769ext_ccert_san_mail:
27770 driver = external
27771 public_name = EXTERNAL
27772
27773 server_advertise_condition = $tls_in_certificate_verified
27774 server_param2 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
27775 {$tls_in_peercert}}
27776 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth2} \
27777 {eq {$item}{$auth1}}}
27778 server_set_id = $auth1
27779.endd
27780This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
27781of your configured trust-anchors
27782(which usually means the full set of public CAs)
27783and which has a mail-SAN matching the claimed identity sent by the client.
27784
27785Note that, up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
27786The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
27787TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
27788in this way.
27789Likewise, a traditional plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
27790
27791
27792.section "Using external in a client" "SECTexternclient"
27793.cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (client)"
27794The &(external)& authenticator has one client option:
27795
27796.option client_send external string&!! unset
27797This option is expanded and sent with the AUTH command as the
27798identity being asserted.
27799
27800Example:
27801.code
27802ext_ccert:
27803 driver = external
27804 public_name = EXTERNAL
27805
27806 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
27807 client_send = myaccount@smarthost.example.net
27808.endd
27809
27810
27811.ecindex IIDexternauth1
27812.ecindex IIDexternauth2
27813
27814
27815
27816
27817
27818. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27819. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27820
27821.chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
27822.scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
27823.scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
27824.cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
27825.cindex "authentication" "X509"
27826.cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
27827The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
27828authentication based on client certificates.
27829
27830It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
27831advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
27832It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
27833the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
27834by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
27835the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
27836
27837The client must present a verifiable certificate,
27838for which it must have been requested via the
27839&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
27840(see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27841
27842If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
27843run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
27844and can authenticate the connection.
27845If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
27846
27847A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
27848
27849
27850.cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
27851The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
27852
27853.option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
27854.cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
27855This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
27856the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
27857If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27858failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27859
27860.option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
27861.option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
27862As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
27863
27864&%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
27865
27866
27867Example:
27868.code
27869tls:
27870 driver = tls
27871 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
27872 {$tls_in_peercert}}
27873 server_condition = ${if and { {eq{$tls_in_certificate_verified}{1}} \
27874 {forany {$auth1} \
27875 {!= {0} \
27876 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
27877 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
27878 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
27879 } } } }}}
27880 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
27881.endd
27882This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
27883of your configured trust-anchors
27884(which usually means the full set of public CAs)
27885and which has a SAN with a good account name.
27886
27887Note that, up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
27888The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
27889TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
27890in this way.
27891Likewise, a traditional plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
27892
27893. An alternative might use
27894. .code
27895. server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
27896. .endd
27897. to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
27898. (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
27899. This would help for per-device use.
27900.
27901. However, for the future we really need support for checking a
27902. user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
27903
27904.ecindex IIDtlsauth1
27905.ecindex IIDtlsauth2
27906
27907
27908Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
27909the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
27910a connect- or helo-ACL.
27911
27912
27913
27914. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27915. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27916
27917.chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
27918 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
27919.scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
27920.scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
27921.cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
27922.cindex "OpenSSL"
27923.cindex "GnuTLS"
27924Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
27925Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
27926GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
27927cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
27928order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
27929version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
27930You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
27931level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
27932certificates are used.
27933
27934RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
27935connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
27936server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
27937mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
27938between them is encrypted.
27939
27940Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
27941and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
27942certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
27943possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
27944encryption state.
27945
27946&*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
27947disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
27948in order to get TLS to work.
27949
27950
27951
27952.section "Support for the &""submissions""& (aka &""ssmtp""& and &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
27953 "SECID284"
27954.cindex "submissions protocol"
27955.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
27956.cindex "smtps protocol"
27957.cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
27958.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
27959.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
27960The history of port numbers for TLS in SMTP is a little messy and has been
27961contentious. As of RFC 8314, the common practice of using the historically
27962allocated port 465 for "email submission but with TLS immediately upon connect
27963instead of using STARTTLS" is officially blessed by the IETF, and recommended
27964by them in preference to STARTTLS.
27965
27966The name originally assigned to the port was &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, but as
27967clarity emerged over the dual roles of SMTP, for MX delivery and Email
27968Submission, nomenclature has shifted. The modern name is now &"submissions"&.
27969
27970This approach was, for a while, officially abandoned when encrypted SMTP was
27971standardized, but many clients kept using it, even as the TCP port number was
27972reassigned for other use.
27973Thus you may encounter guidance claiming that you shouldn't enable use of
27974this port.
27975In practice, a number of mail-clients have only ever supported submissions,
27976not submission with STARTTLS upgrade.
27977Ideally, offer both submission (587) and submissions (465) service.
27978
27979Exim supports TLS-on-connect by means of the &%tls_on_connect_ports%&
27980global option. Its value must be a list of port numbers;
27981the most common use is expected to be:
27982.code
27983tls_on_connect_ports = 465
27984.endd
27985The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
27986via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
27987the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
27988the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
27989an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
27990defined elsewhere.
27991
27992There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
27993&%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the TLS-only behaviour for all ports.
27994
27995
27996
27997
27998
27999
28000.section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
28001.cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
28002The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
28003followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
28004to use GnuTLS, you need to set
28005.code
28006USE_GNUTLS=yes
28007.endd
28008in Local/Makefile, in addition to
28009.code
28010SUPPORT_TLS=yes
28011.endd
28012You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
28013include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
28014
28015There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
28016
28017.ilist
28018The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
28019cannot be the path of a directory
28020for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
28021(for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
28022.next
28023The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
28024.next
28025.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
28026.vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
28027Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
28028separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
28029affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
28030.next
28031OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
28032DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
28033RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
28034in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
28035for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
28036to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
28037&%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
28038option).
28039.next
28040The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
28041sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
28042.next
28043The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
28044When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
28045(If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
28046let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
28047.next
28048With GnuTLS, if an explicit list is used for the &%tls_privatekey%& main option
28049main option, it must be ordered to match the &%tls_certificate%& list.
28050.next
28051Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
28052This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
28053explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
28054implementation, then patches are welcome.
28055.endlist
28056
28057
28058.section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
28059This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
28060an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
28061but not the chosen filename.
28062By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
28063See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
28064
28065GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
28066to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
28067Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
28068&_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
28069of bits requested.
28070The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
28071its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
28072parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
28073that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
28074renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
28075this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
28076place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
28077
28078For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
28079recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
28080If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
28081are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
28082not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
28083
28084Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
28085values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
28086parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
28087If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
28088until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
28089a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
28090
28091The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
28092in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
28093generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
28094
28095To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
28096and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
28097&(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
28098renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
28099.code
28100# ls
28101[ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
28102# rm -f new-params
28103# touch new-params
28104# chown exim:exim new-params
28105# chmod 0600 new-params
28106# certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
28107# openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
28108[ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
28109 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
28110 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
28111# chmod 0400 new-params
28112# mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
28113.endd
28114If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
28115stalling is removed.
28116
28117The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
28118Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
28119the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
28120a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
28121and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
28122failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
28123of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
28124which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
28125GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
28126to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
28127limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
28128
28129The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
28130value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
28131&%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
281322432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
28133
28134In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
28135increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
28136bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
28137procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
28138the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
28139
28140
28141.section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
28142.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
28143.oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
28144There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
28145suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
28146are acceptable for TLS versions prior to 1.3.
28147The list is colon separated and may contain names like
28148DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
28149directly to this function call.
28150Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
28151&'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
28152The following quotation from the OpenSSL
28153documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
28154
28155.ilist
28156It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
28157.next
28158It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
28159or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
28160ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
28161SSL v3 algorithms.
28162.next
28163Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
28164the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
28165SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
28166algorithms.
28167.endlist
28168
28169Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
28170&`-`& or &`+`&.
28171.ilist
28172If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
28173ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
28174stated.
28175.next
28176If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
28177of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
28178.next
28179If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
28180option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
28181.endlist
28182
28183If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
28184a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
28185includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
28186not be moved to the end of the list.
28187.endlist
28188
28189The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
28190string:
28191.code
28192# note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
28193$ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
28194.endd
28195
28196This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
28197there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
28198submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
28199choice of clients used:
28200.code
28201# OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
28202tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
28203 {DEFAULT}\
28204 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
28205.endd
28206
28207This example will prefer ECDSA-authenticated ciphers over RSA ones:
28208.code
28209tls_require_ciphers = ECDSA:RSA:!COMPLEMENTOFDEFAULT
28210.endd
28211
28212For TLS version 1.3 the control available is less fine-grained
28213and Exim does not provide access to it at present.
28214The value of the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is ignored when
28215TLS version 1.3 is negotiated.
28216
28217As of writing the library default cipher suite list for TLSv1.3 is
28218.code
28219TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
28220.endd
28221
28222
28223.section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
28224 "SECTreqciphgnu"
28225.cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
28226.cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
28227.cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
28228.cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
28229.cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
28230.cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
28231.oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
28232The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
28233as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
28234ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
28235
28236The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
28237and controls both protocols and ciphers.
28238
28239The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
28240controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
28241&(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
28242the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
28243the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
28244aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
28245
28246Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
28247"Priority strings". This is online as
28248&url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
28249but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
28250installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
28251then the example code
28252&url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
28253on that site can be used to test a given string.
28254
28255For example:
28256.code
28257# Disable older versions of protocols
28258tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
28259.endd
28260
28261Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
28262additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
28263"&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
28264
28265This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
28266there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
28267by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
28268where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
28269used:
28270.code
28271# GnuTLS variant
28272tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
28273 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
28274 {SECURE128}}
28275.endd
28276
28277
28278.section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
28279.cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
28280When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
28281the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
28282but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
28283that STARTTLS is always advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
28284this is reasonable for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
28285
28286If STARTTLS is to be used you
28287need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
28288
28289If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
28290problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
28291persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
28292with the error
28293.code
28294554 Security failure
28295.endd
28296If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
28297rejected with a 554 error code.
28298
28299To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
28300must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
28301
28302If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
28303meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
28304You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
28305from someone able to intercept the communication.
28306
28307Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
28308
28309To make TLS work you need to set, in the server,
28310.code
28311tls_certificate = /some/file/name
28312tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
28313.endd
28314These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
28315the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
28316contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
28317that goes with it. These files need to be
28318PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
28319always be given as full path names.
28320The key must not be password-protected.
28321They can be the same file if both the
28322certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
28323set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
28324is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
28325certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
28326the server's certificate.
28327
28328For dual-stack (eg. RSA and ECDSA) configurations, these options can be
28329colon-separated lists of file paths. Ciphers using given authentication
28330algorithms require the presence of a suitable certificate to supply the
28331public-key. The server selects among the certificates to present to the
28332client depending on the selected cipher, hence the priority ordering for
28333ciphers will affect which certificate is used.
28334
28335If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
28336source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
28337few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
28338
28339&*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
28340they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
28341Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
28342transport.
28343
28344With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
28345require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
28346this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
28347.code
28348tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
28349.endd
28350is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
28351with the parameters contained in the file.
28352Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
28353available:
28354.code
28355tls_dhparam = none
28356.endd
28357This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
28358DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
28359used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
28360documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
28361
28362See the command
28363.code
28364openssl dhparam
28365.endd
28366for a way of generating file data.
28367
28368The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
28369host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
28370for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
28371in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
28372forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
28373
28374.cindex "cipher" "logging"
28375.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
28376.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
28377The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
28378an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
28379incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
28380also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
28381&"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
28382condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
28383
28384Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
28385can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
28386cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
28387example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
28388contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
28389documentation for more details.
28390
28391For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
28392(again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
28393
28394
28395.section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
28396.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
28397.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
28398If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
28399session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
28400&%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
28401apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
28402Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
28403contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
28404expected trust-anchors or certificates.
28405These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
28406an explicit file or,
28407depending on library version, a directory, identified by
28408&%tls_verify_certificates%&.
28409
28410A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
28411directory is used
28412(OpenSSL only),
28413each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
28414of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
28415certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
28416.code
28417openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
28418.endd
28419where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
28420
28421There is no checking of names of the client against the certificate
28422Subject Name or Subject Alternate Names.
28423
28424The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
28425what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
28426does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
28427&%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
28428attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
28429dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
28430session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
28431fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
28432example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
28433relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
28434
28435.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
28436When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
28437the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
28438&$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
28439
28440.cindex "log" "distinguished name"
28441Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
28442&'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
28443&"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
28444&%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
28445certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
28446
28447
28448.section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
28449.cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
28450.cindex "revocation list"
28451.cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
28452.cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
28453Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
28454certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
28455server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
28456an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
28457of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
28458CRL in PEM format.
28459The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
28460file from every certificate authority they know of.
28461
28462The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
28463Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
28464against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
28465usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
28466private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
28467is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
28468
28469The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
28470comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
28471connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
28472re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
28473
28474The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
28475issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
28476the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
28477negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
28478CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
28479resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
28480starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
28481proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
28482
28483Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
28484or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
28485support for OCSP stapling is included.
28486
28487There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
28488The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
28489an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
28490option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
28491contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
28492
28493Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
28494proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
28495Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
28496contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
28497on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
28498next connection.
28499
28500When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
28501in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
28502ignored.
28503
28504For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
28505also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
28506certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
28507of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
28508intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
28509file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
28510
28511Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
28512not any of the chain from CA to it.
28513
28514There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
28515
28516.code
28517 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
28518 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
28519 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
28520
28521 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
28522 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
28523 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
28524.endd
28525
28526
28527
28528
28529.section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECTclientTLS"
28530.cindex "cipher" "logging"
28531.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
28532.cindex "log" "distinguished name"
28533.cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
28534The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
28535deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
28536server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
28537within the &(smtp)& transport.
28538
28539It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
28540transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
28541server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
28542this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
28543transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
28544
28545If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
28546to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
28547&%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
28548those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
28549set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
28550usual way.
28551
28552When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
28553the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
28554a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
28555session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
28556&%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
28557delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
28558it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
28559STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
28560negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
28561unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
28562unencrypted.
28563
28564The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
28565transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
28566if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
28567&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
28568
28569.new
28570Do not use a certificate which has the OCSP-must-staple extension,
28571for client use (they are usable for server use).
28572As TLS has no means for the client to staple before TLS 1.3 it will result
28573in failed connections.
28574.wen
28575
28576If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
28577specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
28578These may be
28579the system default set (depending on library version),
28580a file,
28581or (depending on library version) a directory.
28582The client verifies the server's certificate
28583against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
28584in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
28585Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
28586&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
28587
28588The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
28589certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
28590or need not succeed respectively.
28591
28592The &%tls_verify_cert_hostnames%& option lists hosts for which additional
28593checks are made: that the host name (the one in the DNS A record)
28594is valid for the certificate.
28595The option defaults to always checking.
28596
28597The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
28598&%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
28599is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
28600value is empty.
28601&%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
28602a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
28603value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
28604otherwise.
28605
28606The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
28607&%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
28608for OCSP to be relevant.
28609
28610If
28611&%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
28612list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
28613the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
28614alternative hosts, if any.
28615
28616 &*Note*&:
28617These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
28618is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
28619by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
28620client.
28621
28622.vindex "&$host$&"
28623.vindex "&$host_address$&"
28624All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
28625&$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
28626which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
28627behave as if the relevant option were unset.
28628
28629.vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
28630.vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
28631.vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
28632.vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
28633Before an SMTP connection is established, the
28634&$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
28635variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
28636that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
28637successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
28638outgoing connection.
28639
28640
28641
28642.section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
28643.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
28644.vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
28645.oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
28646With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
28647information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
28648extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
28649&"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
28650client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
28651within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
28652for this session.
28653
28654This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
28655which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
28656address.
28657
28658With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
28659against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
28660provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
28661be of limited use in that environment.
28662
28663With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
28664connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
28665choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
28666wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
28667different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
28668
28669The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
28670if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
28671nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
28672only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
28673for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
28674
28675Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
28676received from a client.
28677It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
28678
28679If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
28680option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
28681during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
28682
28683.ilist
28684&%tls_certificate%&
28685.next
28686&%tls_crl%&
28687.next
28688&%tls_privatekey%&
28689.next
28690&%tls_verify_certificates%&
28691.next
28692&%tls_ocsp_file%&
28693.endlist
28694
28695Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
28696attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
28697can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
28698arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
28699Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI has arrived, so
28700an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
28701when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
28702
28703The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
28704are re-expanded.
28705
28706When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
28707for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
28708enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
28709see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
28710
28711When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
287120.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
28713built, then you have SNI support).
28714
28715
28716
28717.section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
28718 "SECTmulmessam"
28719.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
28720.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
28721Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
28722an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
28723one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
28724of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
28725connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
28726to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
28727starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
28728unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
28729
28730An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
28731&%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
28732this list the proxy process described above is not used; instead Exim
28733shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
28734before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
28735try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
28736if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
28737
28738The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
28739after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
28740just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
28741reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
28742successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
28743SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
28744should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
28745subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
28746and delay other deliveries to that host.
28747
28748To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
28749closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
28750closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
28751information is recorded.
28752
28753There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
28754&(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
28755connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
28756
28757
28758
28759
28760.section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
28761.cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
28762In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
28763certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities.
28764This is a large topic and an introductory guide is unsuitable for the Exim
28765reference manual, so instead we provide pointers to existing documentation.
28766
28767The Apache web-server was for a long time the canonical guide, so their
28768documentation is a good place to start; their SSL module's Introduction
28769document is currently at
28770.display
28771&url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_intro.html)
28772.endd
28773and their FAQ is at
28774.display
28775&url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_faq.html)
28776.endd
28777
28778Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
287790-201-61598-3) in 2001, contains both introductory and more in-depth
28780descriptions.
28781More recently Ivan Ristić's book &'Bulletproof SSL and TLS'&,
28782published by Feisty Duck (ISBN 978-1907117046) in 2013 is good.
28783Ivan is the author of the popular TLS testing tools at
28784&url(https://www.ssllabs.com/).
28785
28786
28787.section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
28788The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
28789certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
28790sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
28791not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
28792First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
28793certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
28794intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
28795certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
28796The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
28797validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
28798root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
28799install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
28800
28801Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
28802even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
28803server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
28804diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
28805
28806
28807
28808.section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
28809.cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
28810You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
28811with OpenSSL, like this:
28812. ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
28813. ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
28814.code
28815openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
28816 -days 9999 -nodes
28817.endd
28818&_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
28819delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
28820specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
28821important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
28822that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
28823prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
28824this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
28825
28826. ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
28827. ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
28828. ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
28829. ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
28830. ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
28831. ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
28832. ==== -pdp, 2012
28833NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
28834epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
28835the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
28836the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
28837of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
28838writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
28839progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
28840be a sensible resolution).
28841
28842A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
28843may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
28844encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
28845
28846However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
28847user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
28848certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
28849must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
28850authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
28851signed with that self-signed certificate.
28852
28853For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
28854user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
28855Open-source PKI book, available online at
28856&url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/ospkibook/).
28857.ecindex IIDencsmtp1
28858.ecindex IIDencsmtp2
28859
28860
28861
28862.section DANE "SECDANE"
28863.cindex DANE
28864DNS-based Authentication of Named Entities, as applied to SMTP over TLS, provides assurance to a client that
28865it is actually talking to the server it wants to rather than some attacker operating a Man In The Middle (MITM)
28866operation. The latter can terminate the TLS connection you make, and make another one to the server (so both
28867you and the server still think you have an encrypted connection) and, if one of the "well known" set of
28868Certificate Authorities has been suborned - something which *has* been seen already (2014), a verifiable
28869certificate (if you're using normal root CAs, eg. the Mozilla set, as your trust anchors).
28870
28871What DANE does is replace the CAs with the DNS as the trust anchor. The assurance is limited to a) the possibility
28872that the DNS has been suborned, b) mistakes made by the admins of the target server. The attack surface presented
28873by (a) is thought to be smaller than that of the set of root CAs.
28874
28875It also allows the server to declare (implicitly) that connections to it should use TLS. An MITM could simply
28876fail to pass on a server's STARTTLS.
28877
28878DANE scales better than having to maintain (and side-channel communicate) copies of server certificates
28879for every possible target server. It also scales (slightly) better than having to maintain on an SMTP
28880client a copy of the standard CAs bundle. It also means not having to pay a CA for certificates.
28881
28882DANE requires a server operator to do three things: 1) run DNSSEC. This provides assurance to clients
28883that DNS lookups they do for the server have not been tampered with. The domain MX record applying
28884to this server, its A record, its TLSA record and any associated CNAME records must all be covered by
28885DNSSEC.
288862) add TLSA DNS records. These say what the server certificate for a TLS connection should be.
288873) offer a server certificate, or certificate chain, in TLS connections which is is anchored by one of the TLSA records.
28888
28889There are no changes to Exim specific to server-side operation of DANE.
28890Support for client-side operation of DANE can be included at compile time by defining SUPPORT_DANE=yes
28891in &_Local/Makefile_&.
28892If it has been included, the macro "_HAVE_DANE" will be defined.
28893
28894A TLSA record consist of 4 fields, the "Certificate Usage", the
28895"Selector", the "Matching type", and the "Certificate Association Data".
28896For a detailed description of the TLSA record see
28897&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7671#page-5,RFC 7671).
28898
28899The TLSA record for the server may have "Certificate Usage" (1st) field of DANE-TA(2) or DANE-EE(3).
28900These are the "Trust Anchor" and "End Entity" variants.
28901The latter specifies the End Entity directly, i.e. the certificate involved is that of the server
28902(and if only DANE-EE is used then it should be the sole one transmitted during the TLS handshake);
28903this is appropriate for a single system, using a self-signed certificate.
28904DANE-TA usage is effectively declaring a specific CA to be used; this might be a private CA or a public,
28905well-known one.
28906A private CA at simplest is just a self-signed certificate (with certain
28907attributes) which is used to sign server certificates, but running one securely
28908does require careful arrangement.
28909With DANE-TA, as implemented in Exim and commonly in other MTAs,
28910the server TLS handshake must transmit the entire certificate chain from CA to server-certificate.
28911DANE-TA is commonly used for several services and/or servers, each having a TLSA query-domain CNAME record,
28912all of which point to a single TLSA record.
28913DANE-TA and DANE-EE can both be used together.
28914
28915Our recommendation is to use DANE with a certificate from a public CA,
28916because this enables a variety of strategies for remote clients to verify
28917your certificate.
28918You can then publish information both via DANE and another technology,
28919"MTA-STS", described below.
28920
28921When you use DANE-TA to publish trust anchor information, you ask entities
28922outside your administrative control to trust the Certificate Authority for
28923connections to you.
28924If using a private CA then you should expect others to still apply the
28925technical criteria they'd use for a public CA to your certificates.
28926In particular, you should probably try to follow current best practices for CA
28927operation around hash algorithms and key sizes.
28928Do not expect other organizations to lower their security expectations just
28929because a particular profile might be reasonable for your own internal use.
28930
28931When this text was last updated, this in practice means to avoid use of SHA-1
28932and MD5; if using RSA to use key sizes of at least 2048 bits (and no larger
28933than 4096, for interoperability); to use keyUsage fields correctly; to use
28934random serial numbers.
28935The list of requirements is subject to change as best practices evolve.
28936If you're not already using a private CA, or it doesn't meet these
28937requirements, then we encourage you to avoid all these issues and use a public
28938CA such as &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt) instead.
28939
28940The TLSA record should have a "Selector" (2nd) field of SPKI(1) and
28941a "Matching Type" (3rd) field of SHA2-512(2).
28942
28943For the "Certificate Authority Data" (4th) field, commands like
28944
28945.code
28946 openssl x509 -pubkey -noout <certificate.pem \
28947 | openssl rsa -outform der -pubin 2>/dev/null \
28948 | openssl sha512 \
28949 | awk '{print $2}'
28950.endd
28951
28952are workable to create a hash of the certificate's public key.
28953
28954An example TLSA record for DANE-EE(3), SPKI(1), and SHA-512 (2) looks like
28955
28956.code
28957 _25._tcp.mail.example.com. TLSA 3 1 2 8BA8A336E...
28958.endd
28959
28960At the time of writing, &url(https://www.huque.com/bin/gen_tlsa)
28961is useful for quickly generating TLSA records.
28962
28963
28964For use with the DANE-TA model, server certificates must have a correct name (SubjectName or SubjectAltName).
28965
28966The Certificate issued by the CA published in the DANE-TA model should be
28967issued using a strong hash algorithm.
28968Exim, and importantly various other MTAs sending to you, will not
28969re-enable hash algorithms which have been disabled by default in TLS
28970libraries.
28971This means no MD5 and no SHA-1. SHA2-256 is the minimum for reliable
28972interoperability (and probably the maximum too, in 2018).
28973
28974The use of OCSP-stapling should be considered, allowing for fast revocation of certificates (which would otherwise
28975be limited by the DNS TTL on the TLSA records). However, this is likely to only be usable with DANE-TA. NOTE: the
28976default of requesting OCSP for all hosts is modified iff DANE is in use, to:
28977
28978.code
28979 hosts_request_ocsp = ${if or { {= {0}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} \
28980 {= {4}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} } \
28981 {*}{}}
28982.endd
28983
28984The (new) variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& is a bitfield with numbered bits set for TLSA record usage codes.
28985The zero above means DANE was not in use, the four means that only DANE-TA usage TLSA records were
28986found. If the definition of &%hosts_request_ocsp%& includes the
28987string "tls_out_tlsa_usage", they are re-expanded in time to
28988control the OCSP request.
28989
28990This modification of hosts_request_ocsp is only done if it has the default value of "*". Admins who change it, and
28991those who use &%hosts_require_ocsp%&, should consider the interaction with DANE in their OCSP settings.
28992
28993
28994For client-side DANE there are three new smtp transport options, &%hosts_try_dane%&, &%hosts_require_dane%&
28995and &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%&.
28996The require variant will result in failure if the target host is not
28997DNSSEC-secured. To get DNSSEC-secured hostname resolution, use
28998the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router or transport option.
28999
29000DANE will only be usable if the target host has DNSSEC-secured MX, A and TLSA records.
29001
29002A TLSA lookup will be done if either of the above options match and the host-lookup succeeded using dnssec.
29003If a TLSA lookup is done and succeeds, a DANE-verified TLS connection
29004will be required for the host. If it does not, the host will not
29005be used; there is no fallback to non-DANE or non-TLS.
29006
29007If DANE is requested and usable, then the TLS cipher list configuration
29008prefers to use the option &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%& and falls
29009back to &%tls_require_ciphers%& only if that is unset.
29010This lets you configure "decent crypto" for DANE and "better than nothing
29011crypto" as the default. Note though that while GnuTLS lets the string control
29012which versions of TLS/SSL will be negotiated, OpenSSL does not and you're
29013limited to ciphersuite constraints.
29014
29015If DANE is requested and useable (see above) the following transport options are ignored:
29016.code
29017 hosts_require_tls
29018 tls_verify_hosts
29019 tls_try_verify_hosts
29020 tls_verify_certificates
29021 tls_crl
29022 tls_verify_cert_hostnames
29023.endd
29024
29025If DANE is not usable, whether requested or not, and CA-anchored
29026verification evaluation is wanted, the above variables should be set appropriately.
29027
29028Currently the (router or transport options) &%dnssec_request_domains%& must be active and &%dnssec_require_domains%& is ignored.
29029
29030If verification was successful using DANE then the "CV" item in the delivery log line will show as "CV=dane".
29031
29032There is a new variable &$tls_out_dane$& which will have "yes" if
29033verification succeeded using DANE and "no" otherwise (only useful
29034in combination with events; see &<<CHAPevents>>&),
29035and a new variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& (detailed above).
29036
29037.cindex DANE reporting
29038An event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "dane:fail" will be raised on failures
29039to achieve DANE-verified connection, if one was either requested and offered, or
29040required. This is intended to support TLS-reporting as defined in
29041&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-uta-smtp-tlsrpt-17).
29042The &$event_data$& will be one of the Result Types defined in
29043Section 4.3 of that document.
29044
29045Under GnuTLS, DANE is only supported from version 3.0.0 onwards.
29046
29047DANE is specified in published RFCs and decouples certificate authority trust
29048selection from a "race to the bottom" of "you must trust everything for mail
29049to get through". There is an alternative technology called MTA-STS, which
29050instead publishes MX trust anchor information on an HTTPS website. At the
29051time this text was last updated, MTA-STS was still a draft, not yet an RFC.
29052Exim has no support for MTA-STS as a client, but Exim mail server operators
29053can choose to publish information describing their TLS configuration using
29054MTA-STS to let those clients who do use that protocol derive trust
29055information.
29056
29057The MTA-STS design requires a certificate from a public Certificate Authority
29058which is recognized by clients sending to you.
29059That selection of which CAs are trusted by others is outside your control.
29060
29061The most interoperable course of action is probably to use
29062&url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt), with automated certificate
29063renewal; to publish the anchor information in DNSSEC-secured DNS via TLSA
29064records for DANE clients (such as Exim and Postfix) and to publish anchor
29065information for MTA-STS as well. This is what is done for the &'exim.org'&
29066domain itself (with caveats around occasionally broken MTA-STS because of
29067incompatible specification changes prior to reaching RFC status).
29068
29069
29070
29071. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29072. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29073
29074.chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
29075.scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
29076.cindex "control of incoming mail"
29077.cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
29078.cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
29079Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the runtime
29080configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
29081name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
29082one very small ACL:
29083.code
29084begin acl
29085small_acl:
29086 accept hosts = one.host.only
29087.endd
29088You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
29089which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
29090
29091The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
29092certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
29093when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
29094option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
29095in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
29096local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
29097a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
29098&<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
29099
29100
29101.section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
29102The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
29103configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
29104
29105
29106.section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
29107.cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
29108In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
29109options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
29110.cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
29111.cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
29112.cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
29113.cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
29114.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
29115.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
29116.cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
29117.cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
29118.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
29119.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
29120.cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
29121.cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
29122.cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
29123.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
29124.cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
29125.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
29126
29127.table2 140pt
29128.irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
29129.irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
29130.irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
29131.irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
29132.irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
29133.irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
29134.irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
29135.irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
29136.irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
29137.irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
29138.irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
29139.irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
29140.irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
29141.irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
29142.irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
29143.irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
29144.irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
29145.irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
29146.irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
29147.irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
29148.endtable
29149
29150For example, if you set
29151.code
29152acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
29153.endd
29154the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
29155in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
29156done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
29157sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
29158command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
29159trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
29160testing as possible at RCPT time.
29161
29162
29163.section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
29164.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
29165The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
29166apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
29167really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
29168the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
29169relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
29170are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
29171&$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
29172&$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
29173in any of these ACLs.
29174
29175The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
29176non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
29177analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
29178batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
29179result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
29180really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
29181on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
29182controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
29183.code
29184control = suppress_local_fixups
29185.endd
29186This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
29187run, it is too late.
29188
29189The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29190content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29191
29192The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
29193kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
29194temporary error for these kinds of message.
29195
29196
29197.section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
29198.cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
29199.oindex &%smtp_banner%&
29200The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
29201session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
29202an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
29203accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
29204the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
29205&%smtp_banner%& option.
29206
29207
29208.section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
29209.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
29210.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
29211The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
29212EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
29213&%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
29214Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
29215session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
29216setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
29217
29218Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
29219mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
29220&$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
29221
29222If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
29223modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
29224at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
29225affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
29226an EHLO response.
29227
29228
29229.section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
29230.cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
29231Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
29232command, with two responses being sent to the client.
29233When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
29234is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
29235the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
29236response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
29237added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
29238are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
29239
29240You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
29241in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
29242tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
29243received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
29244the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
29245associated with the DATA command.
29246
29247.cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
29248.cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
29249.cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
29250If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
29251the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
29252. XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
29253The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
29254the data specified is received.
29255
29256For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
29257error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
29258MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
29259before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
29260and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
29261your resources.
29262
29263The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
29264the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
29265the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
29266and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
29267
29268.section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
29269The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
29270enabled (which is the default).
29271
29272The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
29273received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
29274otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
29275
29276This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29277
29278For details on the operation of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
29279
29280
29281.section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
29282The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29283content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29284
29285This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29286
29287
29288.section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
29289.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
29290.oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
29291The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
29292with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
29293It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
29294client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
29295has been accepted.
29296
29297The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
29298has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
29299with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
29300The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
29301The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
29302can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
29303for some or all recipients.
29304
29305PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
29306one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
29307content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
29308.cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
29309for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
29310is &"yes"&.
29311Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
29312ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
29313will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
29314
29315See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
29316and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
29317
29318This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29319If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
29320the feature was not requested by the client.
29321
29322.section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
29323.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
29324The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
29325does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
29326does not in fact control any access.
29327For this reason, it may only accept
29328or warn as its final result.
29329
29330This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
29331session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
29332messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
29333more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
29334
29335&*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
29336the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
29337
29338You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
29339&%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
29340response to QUIT.
29341
29342This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
29343failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
29344because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
29345client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
29346connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
29347
29348
29349.section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
29350.vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
29351The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
29352an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
29353trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
29354because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
29355situation even worse.
29356
29357Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
29358logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
29359modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
29360and &%warn%&.
29361
29362.vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
29363When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
29364to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
29365connection. The possible values are:
29366.table2
29367.irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
29368.irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
29369.irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
29370.irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
29371.irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
29372.irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
29373.irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
29374.irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
29375.irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
29376.irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
29377.endtable
29378In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
29379Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
29380With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
29381overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
29382&%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
29383used.
29384
29385
29386.section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
29387.cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
29388The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
29389you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
29390.code
29391acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
29392 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
29393.endd
29394In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
29395providing an RFC 4409 message &"submission"& service on port 587 and
29396an RFC 8314 &"submissions"& service on port 465. You can use a string
29397expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
29398more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
29399
29400The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
29401configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
29402string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
29403
29404.ilist
29405If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a filename, and reads its
29406contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
29407Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
29408lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
29409If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
29410causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
29411.code
29412acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
29413 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
29414 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
29415.endd
29416This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
29417back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
29418file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
29419can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
29420.next
29421If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
29422Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
29423matches the string.
29424.next
29425If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
29426the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
29427want to have something like
29428.code
29429acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
29430.endd
29431in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
29432newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
29433.endlist
29434
29435
29436
29437
29438.section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
29439.cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
29440Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
29441section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
29442&"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
29443database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
29444return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
29445&"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
29446This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
29447
29448For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
29449&"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
29450submitters of non-SMTP messages.
29451
29452
29453ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
29454has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
29455individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
29456blackholing facility. Use it with care.
29457
29458If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
29459ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
29460RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
29461recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
29462run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
29463remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
29464&%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
29465
29466If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
29467is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
29468
29469
29470.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
29471The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
29472recipients; it may create new recipients.
29473
29474
29475
29476.section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
29477.cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
29478The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
29479all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
29480not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
29481reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
29482
29483For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
29484these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
29485used to accept or reject anything.
29486
29487For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
29488&%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
29489&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
29490when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
29491
29492For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
29493&%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
29494This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
29495messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
29496configuration file.
29497
29498
29499
29500
29501.section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
29502.cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
29503.vindex &$domain$&
29504.vindex &$local_part$&
29505.vindex &$sender_address$&
29506.vindex &$sender_host_address$&
29507.vindex &$smtp_command$&
29508When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
29509that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
29510&$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
29511statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
29512&$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
29513is available in &$smtp_command$&.
29514
29515When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
29516contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
29517set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
29518how it is used.
29519
29520.vindex "&$message_size$&"
29521The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
29522the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
29523that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
29524the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
29525received).
29526
29527.vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
29528.vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
29529The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
29530The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
29531accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
29532of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
29533&$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
29534&$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
29535
29536
29537
29538
29539
29540.section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
29541.cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
29542.vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
29543.vindex &$smtp_command$&
29544When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
29545the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
29546and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
29547These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
29548here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
29549encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
29550does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
29551unencrypted connections.
29552.code
29553acl_check_auth:
29554 accept encrypted = *
29555 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
29556 {CRAM-MD5}}
29557 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
29558.endd
29559(Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
29560that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
29561encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
29562option to do this.)
29563
29564
29565
29566.section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
29567.cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
29568.cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
29569An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
29570with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
29571Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
29572set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
29573
29574If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
29575used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
29576provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
29577example:
29578.code
29579deny dnslists = list1.example
29580 dnslists = list2.example
29581.endd
29582If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
29583the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
29584happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
29585all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
29586test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
29587
29588
29589.section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
29590The ACL verbs are as follows:
29591
29592.ilist
29593.cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
29594&%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
29595of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
29596appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
29597is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
29598after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
29599check a RCPT command:
29600.code
29601accept domains = +local_domains
29602 endpass
29603 verify = recipient
29604.endd
29605If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
29606passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
29607the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
29608fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
29609&%endpass%&.
29610
29611The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
29612use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
29613that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
29614configuration.
29615
29616.cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
29617If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
29618depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
29619(when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
29620statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
29621SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
29622.display
29623&`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
29624&` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
29625.endd
29626You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
29627response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
29628same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
29629
29630If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
29631an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
29632for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
29633of &%endpass%&.
29634
29635
29636.next
29637.cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
29638&%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
29639an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
29640&%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
29641temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
29642&(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
29643be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
29644
29645
29646.next
29647.cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
29648&%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
29649the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
29650example,
29651.code
29652deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29653.endd
29654rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
29655
29656
29657.next
29658.cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
29659&%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
29660&"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
29661that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
29662the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
29663recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
29664recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
29665message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
29666do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
29667
29668If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
29669its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
29670The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
29671
29672
29673.next
29674.cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
29675&%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
29676forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
29677.code
29678drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
29679 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
29680.endd
29681There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
29682The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
29683
29684.next
29685.cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
29686&%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
29687statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
29688example, when checking a RCPT command,
29689.code
29690require message = Sender did not verify
29691 verify = sender
29692.endd
29693passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
29694verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
29695&%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
29696discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
29697
29698.next
29699.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
29700&%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
29701&%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
29702to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
29703written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
29704message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
29705duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
29706
29707If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
29708and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
29709&%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
29710first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
29711&<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
29712
29713If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
29714some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
29715This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
29716is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
29717conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
29718is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
29719onwards.
29720
29721
29722.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29723When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
29724text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
29725want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
29726.code
29727warn !verify = sender
29728 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
29729.endd
29730.endlist
29731
29732At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
29733
29734As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
29735written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
29736subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
29737continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
29738mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
29739
29740
29741
29742.section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
29743.cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
29744There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
29745can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
29746of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
29747transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
29748variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
29749an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
29750alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
29751the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
29752.ilist
29753The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
29754throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
29755while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
29756on the same SMTP connection.
29757.next
29758The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
29759while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
29760reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
29761.endlist
29762
29763When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
29764preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
29765time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
29766.code
29767accept hosts = whatever
29768 set acl_m4 = some value
29769accept authenticated = *
29770 set acl_c_auth = yes
29771.endd
29772&*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
29773be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
29774&%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
29775
29776.oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
29777What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
29778referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
29779false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
29780error is generated.
29781
29782Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
29783their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
29784
29785
29786.section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
29787.cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
29788.cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
29789An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
29790.code
29791deny domains = *.dom.example
29792 !verify = recipient
29793.endd
29794causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
29795&'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
29796negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
29797two statements are equivalent:
29798.code
29799deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
29800deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
29801.endd
29802However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
29803side negation of the whole condition is possible.
29804
29805The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
29806of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
29807condition is true. Consider these two statements:
29808.code
29809accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
29810 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
29811accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
29812 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
29813.endd
29814Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
29815the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
29816different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
29817condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
29818therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
29819the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
29820and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
29821
29822ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
29823specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
29824others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
29825warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
29826message is handled.
29827
29828The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
29829processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
29830modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
29831consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
29832.code
29833require message = Can't verify sender
29834 verify = sender
29835 message = Can't verify recipient
29836 verify = recipient
29837 message = This message cannot be used
29838.endd
29839If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
29840&"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
29841so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
29842recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
29843verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
29844because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
29845
29846For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
29847modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
29848happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
29849the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
29850.code
29851deny hosts = ...
29852 !senders = *@my.domain.example
29853 message = Invalid sender from client host
29854.endd
29855The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
29856by which time Exim has set up the message.
29857
29858
29859
29860.section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
29861.cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
29862The ACL modifiers are as follows:
29863
29864.vlist
29865.vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29866This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
29867incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
29868accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
29869
29870.vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29871.cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
29872.cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
29873This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
29874continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
29875the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
29876update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
29877write rather ugly lines like this:
29878.display
29879&`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
29880.endd
29881Instead, all you need is
29882.display
29883&`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
29884.endd
29885
29886.vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29887.cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
29888This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
29889incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
29890lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
29891lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
29892controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
29893even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
29894
29895As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
29896separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
29897in several different ways. For example:
29898
29899. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
29900. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
29901. ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
29902. ==== way.
29903
29904.ilist
29905It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
29906.code
29907 accept ...some conditions
29908 control = queue_only
29909.endd
29910In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
29911other words, when the conditions are all true.
29912
29913.next
29914It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
29915.code
29916 accept ...some conditions...
29917 control = queue_only
29918 ...some more conditions...
29919.endd
29920If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
29921statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
29922In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
29923to be relevant.
29924
29925.next
29926It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
29927decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
29928example:
29929.code
29930 warn ...some conditions...
29931 control = freeze
29932 accept ...
29933.endd
29934This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
29935&%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
29936log entry.
29937
29938.next
29939If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
29940&%require%& verb. For example:
29941.code
29942 require control = no_multiline_responses
29943.endd
29944.endlist
29945
29946.vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
29947.cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
29948.oindex "&%-bh%&"
29949This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
29950the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
29951&%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
29952output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
29953happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
29954output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
29955
29956Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
29957example:
29958.code
29959deny ...some conditions...
29960 delay = 30s
29961.endd
29962The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
29963&"deny"&. Compare this with:
29964.code
29965deny delay = 30s
29966 ...some conditions...
29967.endd
29968which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
29969can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
29970.code
29971warn ...some conditions...
29972 delay = 2m
29973 control = freeze
29974accept ...
29975.endd
29976
29977If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
29978responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
29979they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
29980delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
29981appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
29982unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
29983using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
29984
29985
29986.vitem &*endpass*&
29987.cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
29988This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
29989&%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
29990failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
29991failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
29992confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
29993&"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
29994
29995
29996.vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29997.cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
29998This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
29999ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
30000.code
30001require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
30002 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
30003.endd
30004&%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
30005example:
30006.display
30007&`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
30008&` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
30009.endd
30010When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
30011that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
30012recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
30013message.
30014
30015The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
30016the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
30017denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
30018available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
30019variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
30020&%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
30021ignored.
30022
30023.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30024If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
30025verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
30026error message.
30027
30028If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
30029the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
30030more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
30031actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
30032of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
30033is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
30034
30035If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
30036example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
30037the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
30038logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
30039both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
30040logging rejections.
30041
30042
30043.vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
30044.cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
30045.cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
30046This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
30047about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
30048be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
30049may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
30050ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
30051.display
30052&`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
30053&` log_reject_target =`&
30054.endd
30055This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
30056permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
30057current ACL.
30058
30059
30060.vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30061.cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
30062.cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
30063This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
30064processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
30065&%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
30066access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
30067ACLs. For example:
30068.display
30069&`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
30070&` control = freeze`&
30071&` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
30072.endd
30073By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
30074with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
30075another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
30076example:
30077.code
30078logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
30079logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
30080.endd
30081
30082
30083.vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30084.cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
30085This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
30086message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
30087or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
30088there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
30089&%accept%& for details.)
30090
30091The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
30092to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
30093generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
30094&%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
30095the &%hosts%& condition fails:
30096.code
30097require message = Host not recognized
30098 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
30099.endd
30100(Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
30101processed.)
30102
30103.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
30104.oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
30105For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
30106of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
30107is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
30108is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
30109overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
30110accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
30111truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
30112EHLO options.
30113
30114When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
30115consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
30116of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
30117.code
30118deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
30119 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
30120.endd
30121The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
30122by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
30123access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
301242&'xx'&.
30125
30126Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
30127the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
30128
30129The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
30130literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
30131anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
30132response.
30133
30134.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30135For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
30136stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
30137
30138If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
30139specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
30140However, the original message is available in the variable
30141&$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
30142wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
30143routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
30144use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
30145
30146For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
30147is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
30148modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
30149all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
30150&%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
30151&%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
30152effect.
30153
30154
30155.vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30156.cindex "&%queue%& ACL modifier"
30157.cindex "named queues" "selecting in ACL"
30158This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
30159for the message.
30160It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
30161the DATA ACL).
30162This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
30163of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
30164Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
30165If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
30166
30167
30168.vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30169This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
30170 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
30171the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
30172
30173
30174.vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
30175.cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
30176This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
30177&<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
30178
30179
30180.vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
30181.cindex "UDP communications"
30182This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
30183collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
30184the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
30185of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
30186server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
30187separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
30188example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
30189when:
30190.code
30191udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
30192 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
30193.endd
30194.endlist
30195
30196
30197
30198
30199.section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
30200.cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
30201The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
30202
30203.vlist
30204.vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
30205This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
30206has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
30207apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
30208HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
30209really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
30210not work without it. For example:
30211.code
30212warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
30213 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
30214.endd
30215Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
30216the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
30217matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
30218mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
30219by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
30220
30221
30222.vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
30223 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
30224.cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
30225.cindex "case of local parts"
30226.vindex "&$local_part$&"
30227These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
30228(that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
30229are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
30230any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
30231for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
30232is encountered.
30233
30234These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
30235local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
30236in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
30237handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
30238configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
30239
30240This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
30241containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
30242spam score:
30243.code
30244warn control = caseful_local_part
30245 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
30246 $acl_m4 + \
30247 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
30248 }
30249 control = caselower_local_part
30250.endd
30251Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
30252is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
30253
30254
30255.vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
30256.cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
30257.cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
30258This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
30259
30260The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
30261If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
30262and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
30263is used for all recipients of the message,
30264then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
30265and data is copied from one to the other.
30266
30267An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
30268for a mail will be quietly ignored.
30269If a recipient-verify callout
30270(with use_sender)
30271connection is subsequently
30272requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
30273any subsequent recipients and the data,
30274otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
30275
30276Note that routers are used in verify mode,
30277and cannot depend on content of received headers.
30278Note also that headers cannot be
30279modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
30280Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
30281The &'Received-By:'& header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
30282rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
30283this will affect the timestamp.
30284
30285All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
30286rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
30287the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
30288Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
30289message body.
30290
30291Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
30292of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
30293before the entire message has been received from the source.
30294It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
30295or CHUNKING
30296options in use.
30297
30298Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
30299a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
30300If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
30301the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
30302before the acceptance "<=" line.
30303
30304If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
30305usual fashion.
30306This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
30307to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
30308&"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
30309and does not queue the message.
30310Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
30311
30312Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
30313(possibly faked)
30314sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
30315
30316
30317.vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
30318.cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
30319.cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
30320This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
30321with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
30322by default called &'debuglog'&.
30323The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
30324may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
30325the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
30326option.
30327Logging started this way may be stopped, and the file removed,
30328with the &'kill'& option.
30329Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
30330contexts):
30331.code
30332 control = debug
30333 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
30334 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
30335 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
30336 control = debug/kill
30337.endd
30338
30339
30340.vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
30341.cindex "disable DKIM verify"
30342.cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
30343This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
30344the operation and configuration of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
30345
30346
30347.vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
30348.cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
30349.cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
30350This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
30351connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
30352strings or to numeric value.
30353The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
30354Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
30355&`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
30356
30357The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
30358(for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
30359that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
30360equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
30361Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
30362
30363
30364.vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
30365 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
30366.cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
30367.cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
30368These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
30369is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
30370state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
30371in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
30372
30373The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
30374connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
30375messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
30376&%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
30377before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
30378synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
30379work with.
30380
30381
30382.vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
30383.cindex "fake defer"
30384.cindex "defer, fake"
30385This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
30386except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
30387550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
30388messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
30389use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
30390
30391.vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
30392.cindex "fake rejection"
30393.cindex "rejection, fake"
30394This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
30395words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
30396message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
30397However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
30398only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
30399the same SMTP connection.
30400
30401The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
30402message is supplied, the following is used:
30403.code
30404550-Your message has been rejected but is being
30405550-kept for evaluation.
30406550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
30407550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
30408.endd
30409This facility should be used with extreme caution.
30410
30411.vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
30412.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
30413This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
30414other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
30415it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
30416current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
30417SMTP connection.
30418
30419This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
30420&%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
30421is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
30422are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
30423
30424.vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
30425.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
30426Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
30427avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
30428use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
30429disables such output flushing.
30430
30431.vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
30432.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
30433Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
30434avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
30435use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
30436that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
30437
30438.vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
30439This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
30440extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
30441of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
30442or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
30443needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
30444only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
30445the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
30446to be useful in production.
30447
30448.vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
30449.cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
30450This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
30451It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
30452SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
30453
30454If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
30455suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
30456one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
30457(&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
30458responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
30459sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
30460
30461.ilist
30462Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
30463sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
30464verification failed"&) is sent.
30465.next
30466If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
30467line is output.
30468.endlist
30469
30470The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
30471calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
30472
30473.vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
30474.cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
30475This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
30476the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
30477response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
30478controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
30479&%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
30480
30481.vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
30482.oindex "&%queue_only%&"
30483.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
30484This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
30485other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
30486it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
30487runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
30488effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
30489to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
30490same SMTP connection.
30491
30492.vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
30493.cindex "message" "submission"
30494.cindex "submission mode"
30495This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
30496latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
30497the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
30498operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
30499necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
30500This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
30501late (the message has already been created).
30502
30503Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
30504messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
30505submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
30506The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
30507that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
30508
30509.vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
30510.cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
30511This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
30512complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
30513normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
30514
30515.ilist
30516Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
30517dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
30518.next
30519No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
30520.next
30521There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
30522.endlist ilist
30523
30524This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
30525passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
30526used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
30527and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
30528data is read.
30529
30530&*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
30531that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
30532
30533.vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
30534This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
30535to a-label form.
30536For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
30537.endlist vlist
30538
30539
30540.section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
30541All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
30542
30543.ilist
30544Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
30545.next
30546Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
30547&`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
30548.next
30549Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
30550.next
30551Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
30552.endlist
30553
30554
30555
30556.section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
30557.cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
30558.cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
30559.cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
30560The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
30561to an incoming message, as in this example:
30562.code
30563warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30564 dialup.mail-abuse.org
30565 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
30566.endd
30567The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
30568MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
30569receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
30570&%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
30571any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
30572RCPT ACL).
30573
30574Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
30575DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
30576
30577Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
30578the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
30579contains one or more newlines that
30580are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
30581lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
30582front of any line that is not a valid header line.
30583
30584Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
30585They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
30586However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
30587is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
30588during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
30589with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
30590lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
30591In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
30592non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
30593message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
30594are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
30595
30596.cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
30597Header lines are not visible in string expansions
30598of message headers
30599until they are added to the
30600message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
30601ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
30602header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
30603ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
30604passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
30605this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
30606&<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
30607
30608The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
30609
30610The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
30611processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
30612.display
30613&`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
30614&` `&<&'some condition'&>
30615
30616&`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
30617&` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
30618.endd
30619In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
30620condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
30621condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
30622ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
30623honoured.
30624
30625.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
30626For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
30627&%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
30628effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
30629them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
30630usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
30631are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
30632specifications.
30633
30634By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
30635header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
30636be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
30637after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
30638that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
30639
30640This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
30641&":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
30642header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
30643to be a header name first.) For example:
30644.code
30645warn add_header = \
30646 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
30647.endd
30648If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
30649each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
30650you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
30651up in reverse order.
30652
30653&*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
30654added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
30655system filter or in a router or transport.
30656
30657
30658
30659.section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
30660.cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
30661.cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
30662.cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
30663The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
30664from an incoming message, as in this example:
30665.code
30666warn message = Remove internal headers
30667 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
30668.endd
30669The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
30670MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
30671receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
30672&%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
30673with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
30674any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
30675
30676Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
30677DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
30678
30679More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
30680list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
30681not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
30682create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
30683are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
30684.code
30685warn hosts = +internal_hosts
30686 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
30687warn message = Remove internal headers
30688 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
30689.endd
30690Header names for removal are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
30691Matching header lines are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
30692If multiple header lines match, all are removed.
30693There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor in removing
30694a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
30695during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
30696if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
30697accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
30698all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
30699ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
30700would have been removed.
30701
30702.cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
30703Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
30704is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
30705not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
30706removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
30707this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
30708passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
30709you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
30710&<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
30711
30712The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
30713processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
30714.display
30715&`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
30716&` `&<&'some condition'&>
30717
30718&`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
30719&` remove_header = X-Internal`&
30720.endd
30721In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
30722condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
30723condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
30724same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
30725are honoured.
30726
30727&*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
30728present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
30729in a system filter or in a router or transport.
30730
30731
30732
30733
30734.section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
30735.cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
30736Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
30737compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
30738for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
30739content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30740
30741Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
30742senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
30743result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
30744done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
30745can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
30746same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
30747The conditions are as follows:
30748
30749
30750.vlist
30751.vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
30752.cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
30753.cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
30754.cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
30755.cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
30756The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
30757&%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
30758&"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
30759false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
30760condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
30761condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
30762ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
30763
30764If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
30765can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
30766and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
30767Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
30768The name and values are expanded separately.
30769Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
30770will act as argument separators.
30771
30772If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
30773the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
30774&%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
30775conditions are tested.
30776
30777ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
30778loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
30779circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
30780for different local users or different local domains.
30781
30782.vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
30783.cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
30784.cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
30785.cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
30786If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
30787the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
30788authentication by any authenticator, you can set
30789.code
30790authenticated = *
30791.endd
30792
30793.vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
30794.cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
30795.cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
30796.cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
30797.cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
30798This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
30799expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
30800&"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
30801number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
30802any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
30803&"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
30804ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
30805negative.
30806
30807.vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
30808.cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
30809This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30810content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
30811&%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
30812If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
30813problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
30814chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30815
30816.vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
30817.cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
30818.cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
30819.cindex "black list (DNS)"
30820.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
30821This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
30822&"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
30823use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
30824different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
30825&<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
30826
30827.vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
30828.cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
30829.cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
30830.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
30831.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
30832This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
30833of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
30834enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
30835lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
30836&%domains%& test.
30837
30838&*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
30839use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
30840
30841
30842.vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
30843.cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
30844.cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
30845.cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
30846If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
30847name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
30848encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
30849.code
30850encrypted = *
30851.endd
30852
30853
30854.vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
30855.cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
30856.cindex "host" "ACL checking"
30857.cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
30858This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
30859name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
30860you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
30861.code
30862accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
30863.endd
30864The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
30865the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
30866and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
30867
30868The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
30869Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
30870but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
30871find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
30872opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
30873found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
30874
30875If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
30876address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
30877.code
30878accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
30879accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
30880.endd
30881The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
30882is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
30883statement can then check the IP address.
30884
30885.vindex "&$host_data$&"
30886If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
30887of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
30888allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
30889.code
30890deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
30891message = $host_data
30892.endd
30893which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
30894
30895.vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
30896.cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
30897.cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
30898.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
30899.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
30900This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
30901part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
30902enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
30903result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
30904the next &%local_parts%& test.
30905
30906.vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
30907.cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
30908.cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
30909.cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
30910This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30911content-scanning extension
30912and only after a DATA command.
30913It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
30914viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30915
30916.vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
30917.cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
30918.cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
30919This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30920content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
30921&%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
30922with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
30923&<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30924
30925.vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
30926.cindex "rate limiting"
30927This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
30928messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
30929
30930.vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
30931.cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
30932.cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
30933.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
30934This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
30935recipient address against a list of recipients.
30936
30937.vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
30938.cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
30939.cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
30940This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30941content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
30942non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
30943any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30944
30945.vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
30946.cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
30947.cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
30948.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
30949.vindex "&$domain$&"
30950.vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
30951This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
30952domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
30953&$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
30954of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
30955lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
30956RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
30957influence the sender checking.
30958
30959&*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
30960relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
30961
30962.vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
30963.cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
30964.cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
30965.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
30966This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
30967for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
30968.code
30969senders = :
30970.endd
30971&*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
30972relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
30973
30974.vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
30975.cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
30976.cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
30977This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30978content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
30979SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30980
30981.vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
30982.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30983.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
30984.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
30985.cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
30986.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
30987This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
30988certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
30989server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
30990or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
30991
30992.vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
30993.cindex "CSA verification"
30994This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
30995send email. Details of how this works are given in section
30996&<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
30997
30998.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
30999.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31000.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
31001.cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
31002.cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
31003This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
31004received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
31005&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
31006there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
31007allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
31008
31009Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
31010problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
31011detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
31012
31013.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
31014.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31015.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
31016.cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
31017.cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
31018.cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
31019This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
31020received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
31021&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
31022of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
31023is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
31024However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
31025that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
31026to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
31027might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
31028
31029Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
31030section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
31031&<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
31032condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
31033.code
31034deny senders = :
31035 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
31036 !verify = header_sender
31037.endd
31038
31039.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
31040.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31041.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
31042.cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
31043.cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
31044This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
31045received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
31046&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
31047lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
31048and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
31049Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
31050permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
31051&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
31052appropriate.
31053
31054Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
31055ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
31056.code
31057To: @
31058.endd
31059and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
31060common as they used to be.
31061
31062.vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
31063.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31064.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
31065.cindex "HELO" "verifying"
31066.cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
31067.cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
31068.cindex "verifying" "HELO"
31069This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
31070client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
31071attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
31072condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
31073&%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
31074independently of this condition, and for detail of the verification.
31075
31076For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
31077option), this condition is always true.
31078
31079
31080.vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind/*&<&'options'&>
31081.cindex "verifying" "not blind"
31082.cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
31083This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
31084Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
31085&'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
31086case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
31087&'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
31088used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
31089
31090.new
31091There is one possible option, &`case_insensitive`&. If this is present then
31092local parts are checked case-insensitively.
31093.wen
31094
31095There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
31096recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
31097
31098
31099.vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
31100.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31101.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
31102.cindex "recipient" "verifying"
31103.cindex "verifying" "recipient"
31104.vindex "&$address_data$&"
31105This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
31106recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
31107&<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
31108of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
31109This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
31110verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
31111address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
31112value for the child address.
31113
31114.vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
31115.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31116.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
31117.cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
31118This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
31119address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
31120was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
31121Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
31122one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
31123original IP address.
31124
31125There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
31126DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
31127
31128If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
31129is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
31130
31131.vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
31132.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31133.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
31134.cindex "sender" "verifying"
31135.cindex "verifying" "sender"
31136This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
31137message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
31138the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
31139condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
31140
31141.vindex "&$address_data$&"
31142.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
31143If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
31144value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
31145value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
31146statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
31147want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
31148
31149Details of verification are given later, starting at section
31150&<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
31151to avoid doing it more than once per message.
31152
31153.vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
31154.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31155This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
31156verified as a sender.
31157
31158Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
31159(eg. is generated from the received message)
31160they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
31161.code
31162verify = sender=${sg{${address:$h_sender:}}{/}{//}}
31163.endd
31164.endlist
31165
31166
31167
31168.section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
31169.cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
31170.cindex "black list (DNS)"
31171.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
31172In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
31173is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
31174address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
31175domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
31176special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
31177address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
31178.code
31179deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
31180 dialups.mail-abuse.org
31181.endd
31182the following records are looked up:
31183.code
3118443.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
3118543.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
31186.endd
31187As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
31188Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
31189to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
31190use two separate conditions:
31191.code
31192deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31193 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
31194.endd
31195If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
31196behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
31197record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
31198processed.
31199
31200This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
31201(which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
31202blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
31203following special items in the list:
31204.display
31205&`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
31206&`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
31207&`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
31208.endd
31209.cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
31210.cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
31211.cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
31212Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
31213.code
31214deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
31215.endd
31216Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
31217warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
31218.code
31219deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31220warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
31221 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
31222.endd
31223.cindex caching "of dns lookup"
31224.cindex DNS TTL
31225DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
31226(but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
31227so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
31228connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
31229Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
31230connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
31231
31232There are a number of DNS lists to choose from, some commercial, some free,
31233or free for small deployments. An overview can be found at
31234&url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Comparison_of_DNS_blacklists).
31235
31236
31237
31238.section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
31239.cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
31240By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
31241of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
31242after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
31243.code
31244deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
31245.endd
31246This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
31247use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
31248MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
31249&<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
31250
31251
31252
31253
31254.section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
31255.cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
31256There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
31257addresses (see, e.g., the &'domain based zones'& link at
31258&url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
31259with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
31260listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
31261.code
31262deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
31263 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
31264.endd
31265This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
31266RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
31267example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
31268up by this example is
31269.code
31270tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
31271.endd
31272A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
31273addresses. For example:
31274.code
31275deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31276 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
31277.endd
31278The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
31279name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
31280
31281
31282
31283
31284.section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
31285.cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
31286The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
31287names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
31288name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
31289As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
31290this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
31291either to double the separators like this:
31292.code
31293dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
31294.endd
31295or to change the separator character, like this:
31296.code
31297dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
31298.endd
31299If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
31300blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
31301occurs. Consider this condition:
31302.code
31303dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
31304.endd
31305The DNS lookups that occur are:
31306.code
313072.1.168.192.black.list.tld
31308a.domain.black.list.tld
31309.endd
31310Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
31311address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
31312are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
31313or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
31314only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
31315successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
31316error for a previous item.
31317
31318The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
31319syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
31320.code
31321dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
31322dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
31323.endd
31324However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
31325is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
31326.code
31327deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
31328 $sender_address_domain \
31329 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
31330 see $dnslist_text.
31331 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
31332 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
31333 $sender_address_domain} }} }
31334.endd
31335Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
31336multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
31337and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
31338of expanding the condition might be something like this:
31339.code
31340dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
31341.endd
31342Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
31343domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
31344
31345The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
31346&$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
31347
31348
31349
31350
31351.section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
31352.cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
31353DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
31354just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
31355RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
31356The values used on the RBL+ list are:
31357.display
31358127.1.0.1 RBL
31359127.1.0.2 DUL
31360127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
31361127.1.0.4 RSS
31362127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
31363127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
31364127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
31365.endd
31366Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
31367different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
31368see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
31369
31370
31371.section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
31372.cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
31373.cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
31374.vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
31375.vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
31376.vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
31377.vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
31378When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
31379the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
31380&`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
31381(for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
31382the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
31383&$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
31384cases, for example:
31385.code
31386deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
31387.endd
31388the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
31389&$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
31390For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
31391might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
31392.code
31393deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
31394.endd
31395If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
31396&`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
31397
31398If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
31399addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
31400The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
31401record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
31402very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
31403information.
31404
31405You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
31406&-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
31407expanded until after it has failed. For example:
31408.code
31409deny hosts = !+local_networks
31410 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
31411 at $dnslist_domain
31412 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
31413.endd
31414
31415
31416
31417.section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
31418.cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
31419You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
31420in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
31421For example,
31422.code
31423deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
31424.endd
31425rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
31426any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
31427that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
31428describes how multiple records are handled.
31429
31430More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
31431separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
31432&%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
31433.code
31434deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31435.endd
31436If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
31437addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
31438first. For example:
31439.code
31440deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
31441 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
31442.endd
31443
31444If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
31445listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
31446In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
31447true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
31448tested. For example:
31449.code
31450dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
31451.endd
31452matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
31453want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
31454being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
31455.code
31456dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
31457.endd
31458matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
31459an odd number.
31460
31461
31462
31463.section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
31464You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
31465condition. Whereas
31466.code
31467deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31468.endd
31469means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
31470IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
31471.code
31472deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31473.endd
31474means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
31475IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
31476words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
31477the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
31478
31479&*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
31480host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
31481
31482If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
31483previous example is precisely equivalent to
31484.code
31485deny dnslists = a.b.c
31486 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31487.endd
31488However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
31489Consider this example:
31490.code
31491deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31492 list.dsbl.org : \
31493 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
31494 relays.ordb.org
31495.endd
31496Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
31497.code
31498deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31499 list.dsbl.org
31500deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
31501 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
31502deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
31503.endd
31504which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
31505
31506
31507
31508
31509.section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
31510A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
31511thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
31512is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
31513the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
31514the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
31515.code
31516dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
31517.endd
31518What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
31519127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
31520condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
31521because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
31522affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
31523additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
31524
31525.ilist
31526If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
31527IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
31528condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
31529.next
31530If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
31531looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
31532changed to:
31533.code
31534dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
31535.endd
31536and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31537false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
31538.code
31539dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
31540.endd
31541for the condition to be true.
31542.endlist
31543
31544When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
31545the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
31546.ilist
31547If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
31548addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
31549.code
31550dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
31551.endd
31552If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31553false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
31554.next
31555If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
31556looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
31557.code
31558dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
31559.endd
31560If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31561true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
31562.code
31563dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
31564.endd
31565for the condition to be false.
31566.endlist
31567When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
31568between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
31569
31570
31571
31572
31573.section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
31574.cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
31575When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
31576the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
31577the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
31578address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
31579only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
31580can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
31581in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
31582lists.
31583
31584A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
31585two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
31586do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
31587If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
31588restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
31589a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
31590domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
31591.code
31592deny message = \
31593 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
31594 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
31595 dnslists = \
31596 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
31597 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
31598.endd
31599For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
31600&'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
31601match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
31602value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
31603record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
31604The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
31605
31606If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
31607given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
31608the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
31609.code
31610deny dnslists = \
31611 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
31612 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
31613 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
31614 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
31615.endd
31616In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
31617values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
31618done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
31619
31620
31621
31622.section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
31623.cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
31624.cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
31625If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
31626nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
316273ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
31628.code
316291.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
31630 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31631.endd
31632(split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
31633lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
31634IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
31635.code
31636*.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
31637.endd
31638is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
31639Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
31640
31641You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
31642&%condition%& condition, as in this example:
31643.code
31644deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
31645 dnslists = some.list.example
31646.endd
31647
31648If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
31649address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
31650(DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
31651.code
31652 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
31653.endd
31654
31655.section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
31656.cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
31657.cindex "limiting client sending rates"
31658.oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
31659The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
31660which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
31661&%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
31662commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
31663works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
31664host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
31665.display
31666&`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
31667.endd
31668If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
31669period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
31670
31671As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
31672&$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
31673configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
31674of &'p'&.
31675
31676The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
31677time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
31678means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
31679parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
31680send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
31681in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
31682constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
31683changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
31684both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
31685
31686There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
31687log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
31688when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
31689instructions when it is run with no arguments.
31690
31691The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
31692sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
31693retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
31694which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
31695By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
31696of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
31697user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
31698&$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
31699example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
31700authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
31701
31702The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
31703rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
31704&`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
31705ACL.
31706
31707Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
31708specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example, messages or recipients
31709or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
31710&%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
31711using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
31712separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
31713
31714Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
31715any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
31716stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
31717remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
31718remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
31719behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
31720the &%count=%& option.
31721
31722
31723.section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
31724.cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
31725The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
31726normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
31727&%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
31728
31729The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
31730the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
31731&%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
31732&%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
31733
31734The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
31735the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
31736in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
31737used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
31738in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
31739follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
31740in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
31741
31742The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
31743accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
31744&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
31745&%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
31746ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
31747in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
31748recipients as a large high-speed burst.
31749
31750The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
31751number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
31752last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
31753recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
31754&%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
31755
31756The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
31757condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
31758command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
31759multiple different commands.
31760
31761The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
31762measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
31763&`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
31764increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
31765other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
31766
31767The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
31768
31769
31770.section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
31771.cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
31772You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
31773control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
31774mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
31775
31776If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
31777previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
31778
31779For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
31780it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
31781can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
31782in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
31783new rate.
31784.code
31785acl_check_connect:
31786 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
31787 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
31788 (max $sender_rate_limit)
31789# ...
31790acl_check_mail:
31791 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
31792 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
31793 (max $sender_rate_limit)
31794.endd
31795
31796If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
31797processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
31798it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
31799in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
31800same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
31801multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
31802checks.
31803
31804The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
31805use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
31806update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
31807&%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
31808next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
31809
31810
31811.section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
31812.cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
31813If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
31814engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
31815&%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
31816counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
31817rest of the ACL.
31818
31819The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
31820updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
31821client's average rate of successfully sent email,
31822up to the given limit.
31823This is appropriate if the countermeasure when the condition is true
31824consists of refusing the message, and
31825is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
31826If the action when true is anything more complex then this option is
31827likely not what is wanted.
31828
31829The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
31830updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
31831of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
31832actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
31833counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
31834pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
31835again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
31836attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
31837.code
31838 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
31839.endd
31840
31841
31842.section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
31843.cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
31844The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
31845rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
31846mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
31847sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
31848&`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
31849measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
31850options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
31851
31852For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
31853has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
31854rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
31855per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
31856go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
31857recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
31858
31859When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
31860&%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
31861rate.
31862
31863The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
31864other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
31865unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
31866required increases with larger limits.
31867
31868The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
31869will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
31870the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
31871the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
31872events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
31873times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
31874throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
31875limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
31876are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
31877as intended.
31878
31879
31880.section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
31881Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
31882when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
31883(for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
31884policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
31885message. For example:
31886.code
31887# Log all senders' rates
31888warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
31889 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
31890
31891# Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
31892# at the decimal point.
31893warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
31894 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
31895 $sender_rate_limit }s
31896
31897# Keep authenticated users under control
31898deny authenticated = *
31899 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
31900
31901# System-wide rate limit
31902defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
31903 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
31904
31905# Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
31906# set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
31907defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
31908 messages per $sender_rate_period
31909 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
31910 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
31911 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
31912.endd
31913&*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
31914especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
31915bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
31916making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
31917RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
31918this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
31919hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
31920
31921
31922
31923.section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
31924.cindex "verifying address" "options for"
31925.cindex "policy control" "address verification"
31926Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
31927&<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
31928&<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
31929The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
31930verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
31931other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
31932.code
31933verify = sender/callout
31934verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
31935.endd
31936The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
31937address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
31938difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
31939be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
31940(see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
31941The available options are as follows:
31942
31943.ilist
31944If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
31945remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
31946check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
31947.next
31948If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
31949normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
31950options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
31951verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
31952.next
31953The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
31954discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
31955.next
31956The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
31957immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
31958generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
31959discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
31960.endlist
31961
31962.cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
31963.vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
31964.vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
31965.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31966After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
31967error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
31968coding like this:
31969.code
31970warn !verify = sender
31971 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
31972.endd
31973If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
31974denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
31975verification failure.
31976
31977In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
31978appropriate) contains one of the following words:
31979
31980.ilist
31981&%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
31982was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
31983.next
31984&%route%&: Routing failed.
31985.next
31986&%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
31987occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
31988connection, HELO, or MAIL).
31989.next
31990&%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
31991.next
31992&%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
31993.endlist
31994
31995The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
31996rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
31997
31998The above variables may also be set after a &*successful*&
31999address verification to:
32000
32001.ilist
32002&%random%&: A random local-part callout succeeded
32003.endlist
32004
32005
32006
32007
32008.section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
32009.cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
32010.cindex "callout" "verification"
32011.cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
32012For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
32013checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
32014the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
32015&'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
32016a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
32017address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
32018sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
32019deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
32020sender's domain.
32021
32022Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
32023request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
32024described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
32025lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
32026cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
32027caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
32028
32029Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
32030the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
32031callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
32032callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
32033on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
32034
32035If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
32036second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
32037one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
32038&(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
32039router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
32040&%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
32041&%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
32042supplies a host list.
32043Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
32044
32045The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
32046remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
32047specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
32048specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
32049specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
32050the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
32051&$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
32052
32053For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
32054test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
32055following SMTP commands are sent:
32056.display
32057&`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
32058&`MAIL FROM:<>`&
32059&`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
32060&`QUIT`&
32061.endd
32062LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
32063set to &"lmtp"&.
32064
32065The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
32066settings.
32067
32068A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
32069for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
32070the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
32071that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
32072do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
32073&%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
32074
32075If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
32076succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
32077Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
32078hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
32079&%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
32080
32081.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
32082A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
32083output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
32084clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
32085disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
32086
32087
32088
32089
32090.section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
32091.cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
32092The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
32093optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
32094.code
32095verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
32096.endd
32097The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
32098separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
32099deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
32100
32101
32102.vlist
32103.vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
32104.cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
32105This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
32106For example:
32107.code
32108verify = sender/callout=5s
32109.endd
32110The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
32111remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
32112the &%connect%& parameter.
32113
32114
32115.vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
32116.cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
32117This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
32118for making the SMTP connection. For example:
32119.code
32120verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
32121.endd
32122If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
32123
32124.vitem &*defer_ok*&
32125.cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
32126When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
32127of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
32128updated in this circumstance.
32129
32130.vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
32131.cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
32132This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
32133&'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
32134accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
32135unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
32136
32137
32138.vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
32139.cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
32140When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
32141verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
32142sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
32143whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
32144MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
32145as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
32146(empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
32147address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
32148.code
32149require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
32150.endd
32151This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
32152
32153
32154.vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
32155.cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
32156This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
32157For example:
32158.code
32159verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
32160.endd
32161This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
32162commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
32163be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
32164very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
32165(for example, when network connections are timing out).
32166
32167
32168.vitem &*no_cache*&
32169.cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
32170.cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
32171When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
32172
32173.vitem &*postmaster*&
32174.cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
32175When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
32176check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
32177rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
32178the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
32179used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
32180made, until the cache record expires.
32181
32182.vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
32183The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
32184You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
32185For example:
32186.code
32187require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
32188.endd
32189If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
32190one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
32191.code
32192require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
32193.endd
32194&*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
32195account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
32196a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
32197postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
32198
32199
32200.vitem &*random*&
32201.cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
32202When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
32203check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
32204really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
32205&%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
32206.code
32207$primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
32208.endd
32209The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
32210parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
32211specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
32212a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
32213succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
32214
32215.vitem &*use_postmaster*&
32216.cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
32217This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32218.code
32219deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
32220.endd
32221.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
32222It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
32223performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
32224that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
32225domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
32226
32227.vitem &*use_sender*&
32228This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32229.code
32230require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
32231.endd
32232It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
32233command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
32234need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
32235sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
32236usefulness of callout caching.
32237
32238.vitem &*hold*&
32239This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32240.code
32241require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
32242.endd
32243It causes the connection to be held open and used for any further recipients
32244and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
32245Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
32246when that is used for the connections.
32247The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
32248(which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
32249if the use_sender option is used,
32250if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
32251and if no other callouts intervene.
32252.endlist
32253
32254If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
32255command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
32256&%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
32257usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
32258that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
32259Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
32260these circumstances.
32261
32262However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
32263host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
32264callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
32265sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
32266callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
32267own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
32268is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
32269
32270Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
32271caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
32272by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
32273actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
32274
32275
32276
32277
32278.section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
32279.cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
32280.cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
32281.cindex "caching" "callout"
32282Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
32283used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
32284option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
32285different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
32286a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
32287entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
32288
32289When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
32290the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
32291is not available.
32292
32293The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
32294independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
32295(default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
32296
32297If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
32298commands up to and including
32299.code
32300MAIL FROM:<>
32301.endd
32302(but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
32303any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
32304domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
32305making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
32306separate expiry times for domain cache records:
32307&%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
32308&%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
32309
32310Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
32311cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
32312Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
32313ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
32314will eventually be noticed.
32315
32316The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
32317being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
32318behaviour will be the same.
32319
32320
32321
32322.section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
32323.cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
32324See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
32325verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
32326failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
32327relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
32328you might see:
32329.code
32330MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
32331250 OK
32332RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
32333550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
32334550-Called: 192.168.34.43
32335550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
32336550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
32337550 Sender verification failed
32338.endd
32339If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
32340only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
32341out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
32342&`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
32343example:
32344.code
32345verify = sender/no_details
32346.endd
32347
32348.section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
32349.cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
32350.cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
32351A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
32352during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
32353or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
32354it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
32355
32356.ilist
32357When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
32358continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
32359verification also fails.
32360.next
32361When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
32362verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
32363.endlist
32364
32365This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
32366way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
32367example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
32368.code
32369A.Wol: aw123
32370aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
32371.endd
32372work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
32373redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
32374mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
32375verification to succeed.
32376
32377It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
32378redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
32379generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
32380option. For example:
32381.code
32382require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
32383.endd
32384In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
32385the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
32386
32387When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
32388redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
32389also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
32390address and a report is output for each of them.
32391
32392
32393
32394.section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
32395.cindex "CSA" "verifying"
32396Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
32397which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
32398special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
32399domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
32400Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
32401.code
32402verify = csa
32403.endd
32404This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
32405valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
32406succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
32407&$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
32408&"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
32409be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
32410
32411The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
32412detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
32413looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
32414address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
32415
32416.ilist
32417The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
32418.next
32419The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
32420.next
32421The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
32422(for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
32423.next
32424The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
32425that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
32426.endlist
32427
32428The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
32429use for the DNS query. The default is:
32430.code
32431verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
32432.endd
32433This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
32434is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
32435address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
32436the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
32437meaningful to say:
32438.code
32439verify = csa/$sender_host_address
32440.endd
32441In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
32442This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
32443&%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
32444
32445If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
32446is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
32447making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
32448using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
32449default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
32450default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
32451(&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
32452of legitimate HELO domains.
32453
32454The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
32455direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
32456search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
32457addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
32458lookup such as:
32459.code
32460${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
32461.endd
32462has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
32463The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
32464authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
32465
32466
32467
32468
32469.section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
32470.cindex "BATV, verifying"
32471Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
32472of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
32473Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
32474recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
32475bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
32476spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
32477
32478There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
32479&"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
32480the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
32481address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
32482item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
32483The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
32484&<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
32485The validity period on signed addresses is seven days.
32486
32487As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
32488database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
32489like this:
32490.code
32491PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
32492 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
32493 }{$value}}
32494.endd
32495Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
32496list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
32497use this:
32498.code
32499# Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
32500deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
32501 senders = :
32502 recipients = +batv_senders
32503
32504# Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
32505deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
32506 senders = :
32507 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
32508 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
32509 !condition = $prvscheck_result
32510.endd
32511The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
32512to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
32513send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
32514recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
32515the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
32516
32517A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
32518&%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
32519prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
32520the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
32521the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
32522timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
32523of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
32524
32525There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
32526you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
32527deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
32528router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
32529.code
32530batv_redirect:
32531 driver = redirect
32532 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
32533.endd
32534This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
32535of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
32536address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
32537local addresses.
32538
32539To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
32540can be used:
32541.code
32542external_smtp_batv:
32543 driver = smtp
32544 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
32545 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
32546 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
32547 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
32548 {$value}fail}}}
32549.endd
32550If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
32551
32552
32553
32554.section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
32555.cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
32556.cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
32557.cindex "policy control" "relay control"
32558An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
32559delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
32560within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
32561passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
32562.cindex "&""percent hack""&"
32563but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
32564
32565Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
32566A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
32567relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
32568a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
32569with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
32570same host is fulfilling both functions,
32571. ///
32572. as illustrated in the diagram below,
32573. ///
32574but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
32575not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
32576system to arbitrary domains.
32577
32578
32579You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
32580runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
32581Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
32582example, suppose you want to do the following:
32583
32584.ilist
32585Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
32586locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
32587&'my.dom2.example'&.
32588.next
32589Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
32590These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
32591.next
32592Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
32593Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
32594.endlist
32595
32596
32597In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
32598.code
32599domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
32600domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
32601hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
32602.endd
32603Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
32604command:
32605.code
32606acl_check_rcpt:
32607 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
32608 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
32609.endd
32610The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
32611the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
32612statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
32613hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
32614than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
32615default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
32616in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
32617
32618
32619
32620.section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
32621.cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
32622You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
32623that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
32624the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
32625.ecindex IIDacl
32626
32627
32628
32629. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32630. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32631
32632.chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
32633.scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
32634The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
32635as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
32636was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
32637maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
32638specification.
32639
32640It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
32641&[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
32642scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
32643messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
32644chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
32645
32646If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
32647Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
32648&_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
32649
32650.ilist
32651Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
32652for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
32653.next
32654Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
32655&%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
32656run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
32657.next
32658An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
32659of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
32660.next
32661Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
32662conditions.
32663.next
32664Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
32665.endlist
32666
32667Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
32668added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
32669changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
32670EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
32671this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
32672&_doc/experimental.txt_&.
32673
32674All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
32675temporarily created in a file called:
32676.display
32677<&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
32678.endd
32679The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
32680expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
32681first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
32682scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
32683removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
32684.code
32685control = no_mbox_unspool
32686.endd
32687has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
32688same directory by default.
32689
32690
32691
32692.section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
32693.cindex "virus scanning"
32694.cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
32695.cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
32696The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
32697It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
32698specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
32699in memory and thus are much faster.
32700
32701.new
32702Since message data needs to have arrived,
32703the condition may be only called in ACL defined by
32704&%acl_smtp_data%&,
32705&%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
32706&%acl_smtp_mime%& or
32707&%acl_smtp_dkim%&
32708.wen
32709
32710A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
32711if it expires then a defer action is taken.
32712
32713.oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
32714You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
32715to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
32716are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
32717.display
32718&`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
32719.endd
32720If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
32721.code
32722av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
32723.endd
32724If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
32725before use.
32726The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
32727The following scanner types are supported in this release,
32728though individual ones can be included or not at build time:
32729
32730.vlist
32731.vitem &%avast%&
32732.cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
32733This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
32734Security (currently at version 2.2.0).
32735You can get a trial version at &url(https://www.avast.com) or for Linux
32736at &url(https://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
32737This scanner type takes one option,
32738which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
32739or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
32740The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
32741single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
32742A list of options may follow. These options are interpreted on the
32743Exim's side of the malware scanner, or are given on separate lines to
32744the daemon as options before the main scan command.
32745
32746.cindex &`pass_unscanned`& "avast"
32747If &`pass_unscanned`&
32748is set, any files the Avast scanner can't scan (e.g.
32749decompression bombs, or invalid archives) are considered clean. Use with
32750care.
32751
32752For example:
32753.code
32754av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
32755av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:pass_unscanned:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
32756av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
32757.endd
32758If you omit the argument, the default path
32759&_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
32760is used.
32761If you use a remote host,
32762you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
32763as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
32764For information about available commands and their options you may use
32765.code
32766$ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
32767 FLAGS
32768 SENSITIVITY
32769 PACK
32770.endd
32771
32772If the scanner returns a temporary failure (e.g. license issues, or
32773permission problems), the message is deferred and a paniclog entry is
32774written. The usual &`defer_ok`& option is available.
32775
32776.vitem &%aveserver%&
32777.cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
32778This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
32779at &url(https://www.kaspersky.com/). This scanner type takes one option,
32780which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
32781example:
32782.code
32783av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
32784.endd
32785
32786
32787.vitem &%clamd%&
32788.cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
32789This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
32790&url(https://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
32791unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
32792in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
32793
32794The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
32795a UNIX socket specification,
32796a TCP socket specification,
32797or a (global) option.
32798
32799A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
32800For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
32801for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
32802and the second a port number,
32803Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
32804These per-server options are supported:
32805.code
32806retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
32807.endd
32808
32809The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
32810a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
32811
32812If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
32813
32814Examples:
32815.code
32816av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
32817av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
32818av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
32819av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
32820av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
32821.endd
32822If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
32823&`local`&
32824option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
32825to be scanned, which should normally result in less I/O happening and be
32826more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
32827Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
32828
32829The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
32830randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
32831that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
32832socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
32833unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
32834When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
32835not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
32836selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
32837email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
32838.code
328392013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
32840 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
32841 (Connection refused)
32842.endd
32843
32844If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
32845contributing the code for this scanner.
32846
32847.vitem &%cmdline%&
32848.cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
32849This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
32850used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
32851type takes 3 mandatory options:
32852
32853.olist
32854The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
32855and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
32856
32857.next
32858A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
32859virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
32860absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
32861the &"trigger"& expression.
32862
32863.next
32864Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
32865match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
32866&"name"& expression.
32867.endlist olist
32868
32869For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
32870.code
32871Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
32872.endd
32873For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
32874name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
32875for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
32876configuration setting:
32877.code
32878av_scanner = cmdline:\
32879 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
32880 found in file:'(.+)'
32881.endd
32882.vitem &%drweb%&
32883.cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
32884The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(https://www.sald.ru/)) interface
32885takes one option,
32886either a full path to a UNIX socket,
32887or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
32888The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
32889single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
32890For example:
32891.code
32892av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
32893av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
32894.endd
32895If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
32896is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
32897
32898.vitem &%f-protd%&
32899.cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
32900The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
32901One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
32902(or port-range).
32903For example:
32904.code
32905av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
32906.endd
32907If you omit the argument, the default values shown above are used.
32908
32909.vitem &%f-prot6d%&
32910.cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
32911The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
32912One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
32913For example:
32914.code
32915av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
32916.endd
32917If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
32918
32919.vitem &%fsecure%&
32920.cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
32921The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(https://www.f-secure.com/)) takes one
32922argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
32923.code
32924av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
32925.endd
32926If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
32927Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
32928
32929.vitem &%kavdaemon%&
32930.cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
32931This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
32932Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
32933scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
32934For example:
32935.code
32936av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
32937.endd
32938The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
32939
32940.vitem &%mksd%&
32941.cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
32942This was a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users,
32943though some documentation was available in English.
32944The history can be shown at &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Mks_vir)
32945and this appears to be a candidate for removal from Exim, unless
32946we are informed of other virus scanners which use the same protocol
32947to integrate.
32948The only option for this scanner type is
32949the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
32950provided that mksd has
32951been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
32952.code
32953av_scanner = mksd:2
32954.endd
32955You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
32956
32957.vitem &%sock%&
32958.cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
32959This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
32960running on the local machine.
32961There are four options:
32962an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
32963a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
32964the path to the mail file to be scanned),
32965an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
32966and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
32967For example:
32968.code
32969av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
32970.endd
32971Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
32972there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
32973The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
32974Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
32975specify an empty element to get this.
32976
32977.vitem &%sophie%&
32978.cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
32979Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
32980You can get Sophie at &url(http://sophie.sourceforge.net/). The only option
32981for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
32982client communication. For example:
32983.code
32984av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
32985.endd
32986The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
32987the option.
32988.endlist
32989
32990When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
32991the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
32992ACL.
32993
32994The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
32995makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
32996The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
32997for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
32998However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
32999which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
33000message.
33001
33002The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
33003use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
33004The first element can then be one of
33005
33006.ilist
33007&"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
33008The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
33009recommended usage.
33010.next
33011&"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
33012the condition fails immediately.
33013.next
33014A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
33015condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
33016expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
33017Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
33018unless the separator is changed (in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
33019.endlist
33020
33021You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
33022messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
33023Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
33024
33025You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
33026specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
33027For example:
33028.code
33029malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
33030.endd
33031A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
33032
33033.vindex "&$callout_address$&"
33034When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
33035is set to record the actual address used.
33036
33037.vindex "&$malware_name$&"
33038When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
33039&$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
33040&%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
33041logging data.
33042
33043Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
33044imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
33045
33046Here is a very simple scanning example:
33047.code
33048deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33049 malware = *
33050.endd
33051The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
33052.code
33053deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33054 malware = */defer_ok
33055.endd
33056The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
33057aveserver. It assumes you have set:
33058.code
33059av_scanner = $acl_m0
33060.endd
33061in the main Exim configuration.
33062.code
33063deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33064 set acl_m0 = sophie
33065 malware = *
33066
33067deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33068 set acl_m0 = aveserver
33069 malware = *
33070.endd
33071
33072
33073.section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
33074.cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
33075.cindex "spam scanning"
33076.cindex "SpamAssassin"
33077.cindex "Rspamd"
33078The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
33079score and a report for the message.
33080Support is also provided for Rspamd.
33081
33082For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
33083Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
33084&url(https://spamassassin.apache.org/) and &url(https://www.rspamd.com/)
33085
33086SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
33087.code
33088perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
33089.endd
33090SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
33091documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
33092nicely, however.
33093
33094.oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
33095By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
33096intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
33097&%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
33098you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
33099configuration as follows (example):
33100.code
33101spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 783
33102.endd
33103The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
33104If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
33105iptables firewall, consider setting
33106&%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
33107timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
33108server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
33109connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
33110soon.
33111
33112
33113To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
33114on TCP port 11333)
33115you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
33116.code
33117spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
33118.endd
33119
33120As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
33121sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
33122filename instead of an address/port pair:
33123.code
33124spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
33125.endd
33126You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
33127reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
33128&%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
33129option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&):
33130.code
33131spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
33132 192.168.2.11 783 : \
33133 192.168.2.12 783
33134.endd
33135Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
33136When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
33137servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
33138condition defers.
33139
33140Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
33141Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
33142and changeable in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
33143take care to not double the separator.
33144
33145For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
33146subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
33147and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
33148In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
33149
33150Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
33151are options.
33152The supported options are:
33153.code
33154pri=<priority> Selection priority
33155weight=<value> Selection bias
33156time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
33157retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
33158tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
33159variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
33160.endd
33161
33162The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
33163higher values being tried first.
33164The default priority is 1.
33165
33166The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
33167Within a priority set
33168servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
33169The default value for selection bias is 1.
33170
33171Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
33172in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
33173Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
33174characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
33175
33176Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
33177are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
33178
33179The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
33180The default value is two minutes.
33181
33182The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
33183a failed connect is made.
33184The default is to not retry.
33185
33186The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
33187a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
33188used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
33189expansion.
33190
33191.vindex "&$callout_address$&"
33192When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
33193is set to record the actual address used.
33194
33195.section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
33196Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
33197.code
33198deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33199 spam = joe
33200.endd
33201The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
33202relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
33203to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
33204default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
33205Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
33206right-hand side.
33207
33208The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
33209principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
33210have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
33211&%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
33212read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
33213are not set.
33214Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
33215(e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
33216after the first),
33217or the use of PRDR,
33218.cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
33219are needed to use this feature.
33220
33221The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
33222you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
33223&"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
33224
33225
33226Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
33227large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
33228are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
33229example:
33230.code
33231deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33232 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
33233 spam = nobody
33234.endd
33235
33236The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
33237SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
33238&%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
33239it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
33240
33241.cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
33242When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
33243variables.
33244Except for &$spam_report$&,
33245these variables are saved with the received message so are
33246available for use at delivery time.
33247
33248.vlist
33249.vitem &$spam_score$&
33250The spam score of the message, for example, &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
33251for inclusion in log or reject messages.
33252
33253.vitem &$spam_score_int$&
33254The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
33255example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
33256because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
33257The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
33258
33259.vitem &$spam_bar$&
33260A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
33261integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
33262&$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
33263headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
33264spam bar is 50 characters.
33265
33266.vitem &$spam_report$&
33267A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
33268message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
33269This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
33270Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
33271when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
33272unencoded in headers.
33273
33274.vitem &$spam_action$&
33275For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
33276spam score versus threshold.
33277For Rspamd, the recommended action.
33278
33279.endlist
33280
33281The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
33282spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
33283does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
33284
33285The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
33286the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
33287failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
33288statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
33289spam condition, like this:
33290.code
33291deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33292 spam = joe/defer_ok
33293.endd
33294This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
33295
33296Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
33297condition:
33298.code
33299# put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
33300warn spam = nobody:true
33301 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
33302 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
33303
33304# add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
33305# is over threshold
33306warn spam = nobody
33307 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
33308
33309# reject spam at high scores (> 12)
33310deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
33311 spam = nobody:true
33312 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
33313.endd
33314
33315
33316
33317.section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
33318.cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
33319.cindex "MIME content scanning"
33320.oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
33321.oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
33322The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
33323each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
33324of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
33325specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
33326options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
33327cases.
33328
33329These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
33330ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
33331the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
33332message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
33333ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
33334result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
33335&%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
33336
33337You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
33338only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
33339condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
33340&%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
33341&<<SECTscanregex>>&).
33342
33343At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
33344information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
33345of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
33346parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
33347part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
33348syntax is:
33349.display
33350&`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
33351.endd
33352The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
33353the value can be:
33354
33355.olist
33356&"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
33357.next
33358The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
33359&"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
33360a sequential filename consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
33361full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
33362.next
33363A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
33364directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
33365is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
33366the full path and filename.
33367.next
33368If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
33369filename, and the default path is then used.
33370.endlist
33371The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
33372errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
33373a file with its original, proposed filename using
33374.code
33375decode = $mime_filename
33376.endd
33377However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
33378anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
33379automatically unlinked.
33380
33381For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
33382content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
33383as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
33384variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
33385before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
33386
33387The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
33388used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
33389respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
33390
33391.cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
33392The following list describes all expansion variables that are
33393available in the MIME ACL:
33394
33395.vlist
33396.vitem &$mime_boundary$&
33397If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
33398have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
33399has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
33400contains the empty string.
33401
33402.vitem &$mime_charset$&
33403This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
33404&'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
33405.code
33406us-ascii
33407gb2312 (Chinese)
33408iso-8859-1
33409.endd
33410Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
33411case-insensitively.
33412
33413.vitem &$mime_content_description$&
33414This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
33415header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
33416implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
33417only used for display purposes.
33418
33419.vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
33420This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
33421header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
33422
33423.vitem &$mime_content_id$&
33424This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
33425This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
33426
33427.vitem &$mime_content_size$&
33428This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
33429successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
33430size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
33431has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
33432
33433.vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
33434This variable contains the normalized content of the
33435&'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
33436type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
33437
33438.vitem &$mime_content_type$&
33439If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
33440value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
33441are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
33442.code
33443text/plain
33444text/html
33445application/octet-stream
33446image/jpeg
33447audio/midi
33448.endd
33449If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
33450empty string.
33451
33452.vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
33453This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
33454successfully run. It contains the full path and filename of the file
33455containing the decoded data.
33456.endlist
33457
33458.cindex "RFC 2047"
33459.vlist
33460.vitem &$mime_filename$&
33461This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
33462proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
33463&'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
33464RFC2047
33465or RFC2231
33466decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
33467 If no filename was
33468found, this variable contains the empty string.
33469
33470.vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
33471This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
33472attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
33473content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
33474
33475The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
33476cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
33477follows:
33478
33479.olist
33480The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
33481
33482.next
33483If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
33484so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
33485
33486.next
33487If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
33488and the rest are attachments.
33489
33490.next
33491All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
33492.endlist olist
33493
33494As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
33495alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
33496coverletter mail attached to non-HTML coverletter mail will also be allowed:
33497.code
33498deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
33499!condition = $mime_is_rfc822
33500condition = $mime_is_coverletter
33501condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
33502.endd
33503.vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
33504This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
33505&"multipart"&, for example, &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
33506Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
33507want to carry out specific actions on them.
33508
33509.vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
33510This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
33511checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
33512decoding is fully recursive.
33513
33514.vitem &$mime_part_count$&
33515This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
33516starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
33517counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
33518&$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
33519complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
33520parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
33521.endlist
33522
33523
33524
33525.section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
33526.cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
33527.cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
33528You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
33529the message, or on individual MIME parts.
33530
33531The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
33532matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
33533MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
33534linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
33535have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
33536
33537The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
33538to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
33539part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
33540is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
33541and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
3354232K characters are checked.
33543
33544The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
33545literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
33546expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
33547with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
33548Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
33549.code
33550deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
33551 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
33552.endd
33553The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
33554&$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
33555matching regular expression.
33556The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
33557are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
33558
33559&*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
33560CPU-intensive.
33561
33562.ecindex IIDcosca
33563
33564
33565
33566
33567. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33568. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33569
33570.chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
33571 "Local scan function"
33572.scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
33573.cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
33574.cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
33575In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
33576want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
33577
33578The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
33579passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
33580a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
33581condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
33582non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
33583
33584To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
33585possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
33586in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
33587can of course use a little C stub to call it.
33588
33589The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
33590when Exim is just about to accept the message.
33591It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
33592well as messages arriving via SMTP.
33593
33594Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
33595option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
33596Zero means &"no timeout"&.
33597Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
33598before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
33599are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
33600incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
33601For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
33602code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
33603
33604
33605
33606.section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
33607.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
33608To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
33609function is before building Exim, by setting
33610both HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN and
33611LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
33612&_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
33613directory, so you might set
33614.code
33615HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN=yes
33616LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
33617.endd
33618for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
33619Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
33620be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
33621function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
33622commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
33623_src/local_scan.c_.
33624
33625If you want to make use of Exim's runtime configuration file to set options
33626for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
33627.code
33628LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
33629.endd
33630in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
33631
33632
33633
33634
33635.section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
33636.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
33637.cindex &%dlfunc%& "API description"
33638You must include this line near the start of your code:
33639.code
33640#include "local_scan.h"
33641.endd
33642This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
33643prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
33644almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
33645for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
33646It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
33647strings and pointers to character strings:
33648.code
33649#define CS (char *)
33650#define CCS (const char *)
33651#define CSS (char **)
33652#define US (unsigned char *)
33653#define CUS (const unsigned char *)
33654#define USS (unsigned char **)
33655.endd
33656The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
33657.code
33658extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
33659.endd
33660The arguments are as follows:
33661
33662.ilist
33663&%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
33664(the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
33665recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
33666
33667The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
33668character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
33669id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
33670macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
33671case this changes in some future version.
33672.next
33673&%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
33674string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
33675.endlist
33676
33677The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
33678
33679.vlist
33680.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
33681.vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
33682The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
33683the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
33684newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
33685maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
33686
33687.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
33688This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
33689queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
33690
33691.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
33692This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
33693queued without immediate delivery.
33694
33695.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
33696The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
33697passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
33698they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
33699&`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
33700used.
33701
33702.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
33703The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
33704message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
33705problem"& is used.
33706
33707.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
33708This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
33709message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
33710&%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
33711&%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
33712&%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
33713same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
33714
33715.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
33716This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
33717LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
33718.endlist
33719
33720If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
33721reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
33722&%-oe%& command line options.
33723
33724
33725
33726.section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
33727.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
33728It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
33729that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
33730want to do this, you must have the line
33731.code
33732LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
33733.endd
33734in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
33735&_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
33736file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
33737to define them.
33738
33739The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
33740&`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
33741and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
33742alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
33743variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
33744entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
33745.code
33746static int my_integer_option = 42;
33747static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
33748
33749optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
33750 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
33751 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
33752};
33753
33754int local_scan_options_count =
33755 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
33756.endd
33757The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
33758configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
33759.code
33760begin local_scan
33761my_integer = 99
33762my_string = some string of text...
33763.endd
33764The available types of option data are as follows:
33765
33766.vlist
33767.vitem &*opt_bool*&
33768This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
33769variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
33770that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
33771whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
33772TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
33773values.)
33774
33775.vitem &*opt_fixed*&
33776This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
33777The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
33778multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
33779
33780.vitem &*opt_int*&
33781This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
33782&`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
33783Exim.
33784
33785.vitem &*opt_mkint*&
33786This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
33787&%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
33788printed with the suffix K or M.
33789
33790.vitem &*opt_octint*&
33791This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
33792octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
33793always output in octal.
33794
33795.vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
33796This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
33797variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
33798
33799.vitem &*opt_time*&
33800This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
33801type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
33802.endlist
33803
33804If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
33805out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
33806
33807
33808
33809.section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
33810.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
33811The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
33812are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
33813Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
33814including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
33815C variables are as follows:
33816
33817.vlist
33818.vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
33819This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
33820It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
33821
33822.vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
33823This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
33824It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
33825
33826.vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
33827This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
33828is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
33829&[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
33830
33831.ilist
33832The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
33833testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
33834other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
33835
33836.next
33837The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
33838by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
33839of debugging bits.
33840.endlist ilist
33841
33842Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
33843selected, you should use code like this:
33844.code
33845if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
33846 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
33847.endd
33848.vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
33849After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
33850variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
33851
33852.vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
33853A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
33854discussed below.
33855
33856.vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
33857A pointer to the last of the header lines.
33858
33859.vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
33860The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
33861
33862.vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
33863This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
33864&%-bh%& command line option.
33865
33866.vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
33867The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
33868is NULL for locally submitted messages.
33869
33870.vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
33871The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
33872command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
33873specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
33874
33875.vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
33876This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
33877&$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
33878
33879.vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
33880The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
33881
33882.vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
33883The number of accepted recipients.
33884
33885.vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
33886.cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
33887.cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
33888The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
33889&%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
33890can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
33891below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
33892adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
33893&%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
33894value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
33895blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
33896and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
33897
33898.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
33899The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
33900
33901.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
33902The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
33903locally-submitted messages.
33904
33905.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
33906The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
33907was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
33908
33909.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
33910The name of the sending host, if known.
33911
33912.vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
33913The port on the sending host.
33914
33915.vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
33916This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
33917
33918.vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
33919This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
33920
33921.vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
33922The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
33923requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
33924.endlist
33925
33926
33927.section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
33928The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
33929You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
33930(see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
33931their type to *.
33932
33933
33934.vlist
33935.vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
33936A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
33937
33938.vitem &*int&~type*&
33939A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
33940characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
33941Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
33942with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
33943rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
33944lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
33945
33946.vitem &*int&~slen*&
33947The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
33948internal newlines.
33949
33950.vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
33951A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
33952a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
33953.endlist
33954
33955
33956
33957.section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
33958The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
33959
33960.vlist
33961.vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
33962This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
33963
33964.vitem &*int&~pno*&
33965This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
33966the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
33967and must always contain -1 at this stage.
33968
33969.vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
33970If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
33971recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
33972envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
33973router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
33974an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
33975&%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
33976is NULL for all recipients.
33977.endlist
33978
33979
33980
33981.section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
33982.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
33983The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
33984These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
33985release:
33986
33987.vlist
33988.vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
33989 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
33990
33991This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
33992&%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
33993be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
33994for the process in &%newumask%&.
33995
33996Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
33997and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
33998standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
33999descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
34000argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
34001
34002The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
34003
34004.vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
34005This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
34006seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
34007return value is as follows:
34008
34009.ilist
34010>= 0
34011
34012The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
34013ending status.
34014
34015.next
34016< 0 and > &--256
34017
34018The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
34019signal number.
34020
34021.next
34022&--256
34023
34024The process timed out.
34025.next
34026&--257
34027
34028The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
34029.endlist
34030
34031.vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
34032This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
34033Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
34034want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
34035forks a subprocess that is running
34036.code
34037exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
34038.endd
34039and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
34040that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
34041of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
34042recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
34043
34044When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
34045finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
34046fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
34047addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
34048
34049
34050.vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
34051 *sender_authentication)*&
34052This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
34053that it runs is:
34054.display
34055&`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
34056.endd
34057The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
34058
34059
34060.vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
34061This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
34062output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
34063calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
34064conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
34065.code
34066if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
34067 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
34068.endd
34069
34070.vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
34071This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
34072expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
34073The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
34074expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
34075the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
34076block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
34077&<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
34078
34079.vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
34080This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
34081existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
34082character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
34083substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
34084if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
34085
34086.vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
34087 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
34088This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
34089chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
34090
34091If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
34092&%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
34093NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
34094matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
34095&%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
34096found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
34097marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
34098option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
34099top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
34100headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
34101.code
34102header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
34103 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
34104.endd
34105Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
34106there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
34107
34108
34109.vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
34110This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
34111occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
34112particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
34113match the specification, the function does nothing.
34114
34115
34116.vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
34117 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
34118This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
34119a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
34120colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
34121&"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
34122.code
34123if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
34124.endd
34125.vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
34126.cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
34127This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
34128The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
34129back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
34130zero-terminated.
34131
34132.vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
34133This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
34134zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
34135to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
34136string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
34137yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
34138easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
34139added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
34140
34141.vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
34142This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
34143matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
34144.display
34145&`OK `& match succeeded
34146&`FAIL `& match failed
34147&`DEFER `& match deferred
34148.endd
34149DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
34150inability to contact a database.
34151
34152.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
34153 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
34154This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
34155controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
34156&'lss_match_domain()'&.
34157
34158.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
34159 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
34160This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
34161controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
34162matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
34163
34164.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
34165 uschar&~*list)*&"
34166This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
34167expected to be
34168.code
34169lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
34170.endd
34171.vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
34172An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
34173is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
34174looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
34175values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
34176returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
34177failed.
34178
34179.vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
34180 *format,&~...)*&"
34181This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
34182is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
34183&`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
34184them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
34185arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
34186contain any newlines, not even at the end.
34187
34188
34189.vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
34190This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
34191is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
34192with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
34193
34194This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
34195described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
34196the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
34197value afterwards. For example:
34198.code
34199 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
34200 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
34201 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
34202.endd
34203
34204.vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
34205This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
34206recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
34207matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
34208address.
34209.endlist
34210
34211
34212.cindex "RFC 2047"
34213.vlist
34214.vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
34215 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
34216This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
34217these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
34218from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
34219a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
34220made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
34221binary string is returned with an error message.
34222
34223The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
34224maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
34225encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
34226
34227.cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
34228.cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
34229If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
34230contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
34231not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
34232
34233The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
34234&%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
34235which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
34236
34237If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
34238argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
34239set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
34240returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
34241with translation.
34242
34243
34244.vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
34245This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
34246below.
34247
34248.vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
34249The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
34250output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
34251stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
34252SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
34253is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
34254opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
34255test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
34256is involved.
34257
34258If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
34259output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
34260
34261Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
34262must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
34263LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
34264LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
34265initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
34266to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
34267that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
34268.code
34269smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
34270return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
34271.endd
34272Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
34273the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
34274&'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
34275multiple output lines.
34276
34277The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
34278does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
34279the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
34280detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
34281you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
34282dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
34283arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
34284is an error.
34285
34286.vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
34287This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
34288chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
34289runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
34290
34291.vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
34292This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
34293permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
34294
34295.vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
34296See below.
34297
34298.vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
34299See below.
34300
34301.vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
34302These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
34303The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
34304number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
34305and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
34306pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
34307more discussion.
34308.endlist
34309
34310
34311
34312.section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
34313.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
34314No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
34315The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
34316recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
34317to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
34318message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
34319terminates.
34320
34321Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
34322data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
34323connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
34324one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
34325
34326If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
34327in the same SMTP connection, you should set
34328.code
34329store_pool = POOL_PERM
34330.endd
34331before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
34332restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
34333the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
34334set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
34335
34336The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
34337&'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
34338There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
34339block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
34340&%store_pool%&.
34341.ecindex IIDlosca
34342
34343
34344
34345
34346. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34347. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34348
34349.chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
34350.scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
34351.scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
34352.scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
34353The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
34354that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
34355also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
34356they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
34357
34358The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
34359is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
34360It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
34361commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
34362The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
34363
34364The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
34365is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
34366the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
34367If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
34368of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
34369prevent it happening on retries.
34370
34371.vindex "&$domain$&"
34372.vindex "&$local_part$&"
34373&*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
34374specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
34375&$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
34376you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
34377independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
34378described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
34379
34380
34381.section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
34382.cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
34383.cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
34384The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
34385setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
34386other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
34387&%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
34388.code
34389system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
34390system_filter_user = exim
34391.endd
34392If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
34393&%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
34394specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
34395&%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
34396&%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
34397by the &%reply%& command.
34398
34399
34400.section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
34401You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
34402filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
34403are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
34404
34405If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
34406you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
34407
34408
34409
34410.section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
34411The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
34412files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
34413mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
34414available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
34415If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
34416they cause errors.
34417
34418.cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
34419There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
34420files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
34421is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
34422&%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
34423subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
34424manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
34425
34426&*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
34427specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
34428succeed, it will not be tried again.
34429If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
34430arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
34431
34432When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
34433&$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
34434users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
34435to which users' filter files can refer.
34436
34437
34438
34439.section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
34440.vindex "&$recipients$&"
34441The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
34442of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
34443filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
34444
34445
34446
34447.section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
34448.cindex "freezing messages"
34449.cindex "message" "freezing"
34450.cindex "message" "forced failure"
34451.cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
34452.cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
34453.cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
34454There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
34455always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
34456filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
34457for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
34458word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
34459.code
34460fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
34461.endd
34462The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
34463
34464The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
34465message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
34466and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
34467delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
34468that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
34469run.
34470
34471The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
34472not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
34473filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
34474is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
34475
34476.cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
34477.cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
34478The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
34479well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
34480up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
34481log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
34482two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
34483strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
34484message. For example:
34485.code
34486fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
34487 because it contains attachments that we are \
34488 not prepared to receive."
34489.endd
34490
34491.cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
34492Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
34493the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
34494the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
34495command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
34496Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
34497use, for example
34498.code
34499if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
34500then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
34501.endd
34502though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
34503alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
34504generated by the filter.
34505
34506The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
34507&%defer%&,
34508&%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
34509set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
34510as
34511.code
34512mail ...
34513freeze
34514.endd
34515to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
34516failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
34517take place.
34518
34519
34520
34521.section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
34522.cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
34523.cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
34524.cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
34525Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
34526.code
34527headers add <string>
34528headers remove <string>
34529.endd
34530The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
34531added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
34532filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
34533space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
34534forced to fail, the command has no effect.
34535
34536You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
34537continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
34538including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
34539example:
34540.code
34541headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
34542 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
34543 X-header-2: ...."
34544.endd
34545Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
34546be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
34547space after input continuations is ignored.
34548
34549The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
34550This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
34551those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
34552&'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
34553header with the same name, they are all removed.
34554
34555The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
34556of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
34557from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
34558modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
34559Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
34560used for all recipients of the message.
34561
34562During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
34563header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
34564that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
34565routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
34566routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
34567until the message is actually being written (see section
34568&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
34569
34570If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
34571added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
34572present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
34573present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
34574message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
34575conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
34576modified more than once.
34577
34578Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
34579use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
34580For example:
34581.code
34582headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
34583headers remove "Subject"
34584headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
34585headers remove "Old-Subject"
34586.endd
34587
34588
34589
34590.section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
34591.cindex "envelope from"
34592.cindex "envelope sender"
34593In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
34594.code
34595errors_to <some address>
34596.endd
34597in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
34598delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
34599user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
34600might use
34601.code
34602unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
34603.endd
34604to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
34605address if its delivery failed.
34606
34607
34608
34609.section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
34610.vindex "&$domain$&"
34611.vindex "&$local_part$&"
34612In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
34613delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
34614operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
34615such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
34616filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
34617which implements such a filter:
34618.code
34619central_filter:
34620 check_local_user
34621 driver = redirect
34622 domains = +local_domains
34623 file = /central/filters/$local_part
34624 no_verify
34625 allow_filter
34626 allow_freeze
34627.endd
34628The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
34629&%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
34630the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
34631use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
34632
34633Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
34634specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
34635its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
34636address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
34637normal way.
34638.ecindex IIDsysfil1
34639.ecindex IIDsysfil2
34640.ecindex IIDsysfil3
34641
34642
34643
34644
34645
34646
34647. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34648. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34649
34650.chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
34651.scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
34652Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
34653all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
34654these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
34655this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
34656removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
34657before it is placed on Exim's queue.
34658
34659Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
34660&"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
34661that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
34662its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
34663set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
34664
34665&*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
34666or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
34667loopback interface specially in any way.
34668
34669If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
34670that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
34671
34672
34673
34674
34675.section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
34676.cindex "message" "submission"
34677.cindex "submission mode"
34678Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
34679&%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
34680received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
34681state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
34682.code
34683control = submission
34684.endd
34685in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
34686&<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
34687a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
34688known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
34689example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
34690interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
34691.code
34692warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
34693 control = submission
34694.endd
34695.cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
34696There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
34697is used to separate options. For example:
34698.code
34699control = submission/sender_retain
34700.endd
34701Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
34702true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
34703of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
34704the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
34705authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
34706&'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
34707attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
34708
34709When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
34710domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
34711example:
34712.code
34713control = submission/domain=some.domain
34714.endd
34715The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
34716&<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
34717that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
34718&'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
34719.code
34720accept authenticated = *
34721 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
34722 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
34723 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
34724.endd
34725Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
34726option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
34727the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
34728.code
34729bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
34730.endd
34731then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
34732line would be:
34733.code
34734Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
34735.endd
34736.cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
34737By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
34738used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
34739specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
34740
34741&*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
34742ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
34743untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
34744specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
34745does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
34746spoof another's address.
34747
34748.section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
34749.cindex "line endings"
34750.cindex "carriage return"
34751.cindex "linefeed"
34752RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
34753linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
34754SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
34755conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
34756use CRLF or just CR.
34757
34758Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
34759using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
34760receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
34761Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
34762MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
34763has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
34764that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
34765other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
34766follows:
34767
34768.ilist
34769LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
34770.next
34771CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
34772is ignored.
34773.next
34774The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
34775nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
34776terminator.
34777.next
34778If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
34779the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
34780is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
34781people trying to play silly games.
34782.next
34783If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
34784bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
34785line.
34786.endlist
34787
34788
34789
34790
34791
34792.section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
34793.cindex "unqualified addresses"
34794.cindex "address" "qualification"
34795By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
34796host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
34797SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
34798messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
34799requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
34800
34801Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
34802sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
34803&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
34804cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
34805value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
34806
34807.oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
34808.oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
34809Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
34810that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
34811line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
34812are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
34813other words, such qualification is also controlled by
34814&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
34815
34816
34817
34818
34819.section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
34820.cindex "&""From""& line"
34821.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
34822.cindex "sender" "address"
34823.oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
34824.oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
34825.cindex "envelope from"
34826.cindex "envelope sender"
34827.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
34828Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
34829with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
34830&"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
34831.code
34832From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
34833From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
34834.endd
34835This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
34836Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
34837via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
34838such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
34839&%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
34840and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
34841regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
34842default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
34843that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
34844
34845.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
34846When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
34847a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
34848contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
34849then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
34850qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
34851the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
34852
34853If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
34854sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
34855that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
34856
34857Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
34858treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
34859as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
34860incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
34861
34862
34863
34864.section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
34865.cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
34866.cindex "header lines" "Resent-"
34867RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
34868&`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
34869recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
34870&'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
34871&'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
34872
34873.blockquote
34874&'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
34875processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
34876.endblockquote
34877
34878This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
34879address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
34880follows:
34881
34882.ilist
34883A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
34884is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
34885.next
34886If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
34887&%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
34888&'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
34889.next
34890For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
34891also removed.
34892.next
34893For a locally-submitted message,
34894if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
34895&'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
34896the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
34897included in log lines in this case.
34898.next
34899The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
34900&%Resent-%& header lines are present.
34901.endlist
34902
34903
34904
34905
34906.section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
34907Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
34908includes the header line:
34909.code
34910Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
34911.endd
34912
34913.section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
34914.cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
34915If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
34916message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
34917extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
34918existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
34919
34920
34921.section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
34922.cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
34923.cindex "header lines" "Date:"
34924If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
34925Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
34926&%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
34927
34928.section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
34929.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
34930.oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
34931&'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
34932set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
34933the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
34934in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
34935set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
34936messages.
34937
34938
34939.section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
34940.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
34941.cindex "header lines" "Envelope-to:"
34942.oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
34943&'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
34944Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
34945generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
34946messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
34947(the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
34948messages.
34949
34950
34951.section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
34952.cindex "&'From:'& header line"
34953.cindex "header lines" "From:"
34954.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
34955.cindex "message" "submission"
34956.cindex "submission mode"
34957If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
34958adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
34959
34960.ilist
34961The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
34962message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
34963.next
34964.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
34965The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
34966.olist
34967.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
34968If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
34969&$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
34970.next
34971If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
34972part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
34973.next
34974If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
34975&$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
34976.endlist
34977.endlist
34978
34979A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
34980
34981If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
34982line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
34983containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
34984are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
34985They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
34986&%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
34987&%qualify_domain%&.
34988
34989For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
34990&'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
34991user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
34992name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
34993
34994
34995.section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
34996.cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
34997.cindex "header lines" "Message-ID:"
34998.cindex "message" "submission"
34999.oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
35000If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
35001&'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
35002&%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
35003to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
35004creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
35005message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
35006followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
35007in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
35008&%message_id_header_domain%& options.
35009
35010
35011.section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
35012.cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
35013.cindex "header lines" "Received:"
35014A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
35015contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
35016Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
35017
35018The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
35019have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
35020line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
35021that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
35022
35023Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
35024changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
35025-H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
35026
35027
35028.section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
35029.cindex "&'References:'& header line"
35030.cindex "header lines" "References:"
35031Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
35032header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
35033section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
35034header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
35035responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
35036processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
35037than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
35038incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
3503911 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
35040
35041
35042
35043.section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
35044.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
35045.cindex "header lines" "Return-path:"
35046.oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
35047&'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
35048it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
35049transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
35050transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
35051default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
35052
35053
35054
35055.section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
35056.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
35057.cindex "message" "submission"
35058.cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
35059For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
35060existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
35061these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
35062&%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
35063control setting.
35064
35065When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
35066&%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
35067control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
35068&'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
35069that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
35070&%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
35071be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
35072appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
35073line is added to the message.
35074
35075If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
35076the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
35077&%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
35078options true at the same time.
35079
35080.cindex "submission mode"
35081By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
35082received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
35083a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
35084not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
35085
35086.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
35087First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
35088authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
35089created as follows:
35090
35091.ilist
35092.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
35093If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
35094&$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
35095.next
35096If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
35097is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
35098.next
35099If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
35100&$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
35101.endlist
35102
35103This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
35104are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
35105added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
35106by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
35107
35108.cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
35109&*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
35110the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
35111except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
35112
35113
35114
35115.section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
35116 "SECTheadersaddrem"
35117.cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
35118.cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
35119When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
35120specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
35121process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
35122modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
35123as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
35124
35125In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
35126specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
35127addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
35128changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
35129transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
35130they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
35131
35132&*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
35133the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
35134expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
35135
35136For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
35137option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
35138newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
35139.code
35140headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
35141 X-added-second: another added header line
35142.endd
35143Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
35144
35145Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
35146specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
35147Each header-line is separately expanded.
35148
35149The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
35150list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
35151often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
35152not part of the names. For example:
35153.code
35154headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
35155.endd
35156
35157Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
35158specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
35159Each item is separately expanded.
35160Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
35161form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
35162will act as list separators.
35163
35164When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
35165items are expanded at routing time,
35166and then associated with all addresses that are
35167accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
35168an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
35169forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
35170
35171.oindex "&%unseen%&"
35172However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
35173the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
35174&"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
35175
35176Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
35177settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
35178dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
35179requirements.
35180
35181The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
35182with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
35183these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
35184recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
35185consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
35186names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
35187instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
35188
35189After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
35190lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
35191the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
35192header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
35193
35194This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
35195the following consequences:
35196
35197.ilist
35198The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
35199remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
35200to it, at all times.
35201.next
35202Header lines that are added by a router's
35203&%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
35204expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
35205.next
35206Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
35207in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
35208.next
35209Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
35210a later router or by a transport.
35211.next
35212An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
35213removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
35214.code
35215headers_remove = subject
35216headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
35217.endd
35218.endlist
35219
35220&*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
35221for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
35222
35223
35224
35225
35226
35227.section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
35228.cindex "address" "constructed"
35229.cindex "constructed address"
35230When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
35231the form
35232.display
35233<&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
35234.endd
35235For example:
35236.code
35237Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
35238.endd
35239The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
35240otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
35241&"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
35242ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
35243upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
35244&%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
35245The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
35246there is no password file entry.
35247
35248.cindex "RFC 2047"
35249In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
35250parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
35251characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
35252including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
35253&%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
35254characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
35255&%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
35256is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
35257
35258
35259
35260.section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
35261.cindex "case of local parts"
35262.cindex "local part" "case of"
35263RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
35264be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
35265addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
35266because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
35267routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
35268original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
35269router option.
35270
35271.cindex "mixed-case login names"
35272If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
35273assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
35274your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
35275correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
35276.code
35277correct_case:
35278 driver = redirect
35279 domains = +local_domains
35280 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
35281 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
35282 @$domain
35283.endd
35284For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
35285(&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
35286up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
35287on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
35288local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
35289
35290
35291
35292.section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
35293.cindex "dot" "in local part"
35294.cindex "local part" "dots in"
35295RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
35296part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
35297middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
35298empty components for compatibility.
35299
35300
35301
35302.section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
35303.cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
35304Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
35305happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
35306in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
35307&'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
35308
35309Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
35310in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
35311routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
35312example, a header such as
35313.code
35314To: hare@teaparty
35315.endd
35316might get rewritten as
35317.code
35318To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
35319.endd
35320Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
35321does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
35322been routed.
35323
35324Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
35325addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
35326result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
35327deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
35328immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
35329routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
35330.ecindex IIDmesproc
35331
35332
35333
35334. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35335. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35336
35337.chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
35338.scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
35339.scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
35340Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
35341LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
35342closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
35343processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
35344
35345.ilist
35346SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
35347.next
35348SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
35349.next
35350Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
35351.endlist
35352
35353For mail delivery, the following are available:
35354
35355.ilist
35356SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
35357.next
35358LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
35359&"lmtp"&);
35360.next
35361LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
35362transport);
35363.next
35364Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
35365the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
35366.endlist
35367
35368&'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
35369stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
35370used to contain the envelope information.
35371
35372
35373
35374.section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
35375.cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
35376.cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
35377.cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
35378.cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
35379.cindex "EHLO"
35380.cindex "HELO"
35381.cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
35382Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
35383The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
35384processing is the same in both cases.
35385
35386If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
35387parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
35388command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
35389&%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
35390such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
35391.cindex "transport" "filter"
35392.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
35393transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
35394suppressed.
35395
35396If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
35397pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
35398required for the transaction.
35399
35400If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
35401was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
35402server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
35403Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
35404is called for verification.
35405
35406If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
35407the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
35408in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
35409
35410.cindex "carriage return"
35411.cindex "linefeed"
35412Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
35413LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
35414order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
35415line terminator.
35416
35417If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
35418characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
35419same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
35420even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
35421of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
35422they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
35423each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
35424in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
35425significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
35426
35427When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
35428message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
35429records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
35430particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
35431
35432.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
35433Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
35434a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
35435See the next section for more detail about error handling.
35436
35437.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
35438.cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
35439When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
35440looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
35441messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
35442creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
35443a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
35444so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
35445does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
35446turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
35447
35448The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
35449limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
35450
35451.cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
35452The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
35453identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
35454square bracket of the IP address.
35455
35456
35457
35458
35459.section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
35460.cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
35461.cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
35462.cindex "host" "error"
35463Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
35464message errors, and recipient errors.
35465
35466.vlist
35467.vitem "&*Host errors*&"
35468A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
35469particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
35470
35471.ilist
35472Connection refused or timed out,
35473.next
35474Any error response code on connection,
35475.next
35476Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
35477.next
35478Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
35479.next
35480I/O errors at any time,
35481.next
35482Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
35483the &"."& at the end of the data.
35484.endlist ilist
35485
35486For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
35487EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
35488error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
35489host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
35490the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
35491alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
35492host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
35493made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
35494
35495.vitem "&*Message errors*&"
35496.cindex "message" "error"
35497A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
35498particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
35499message errors are:
35500
35501.ilist
35502Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
35503the data,
35504.next
35505Timeout after MAIL,
35506.next
35507Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
35508timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
35509connection at any other time.
35510.endlist ilist
35511
35512For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
35513to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
35514temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
35515addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
35516a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
35517message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
35518that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
35519time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
35520affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
35521it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
35522
35523If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
35524to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
35525over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
35526response to MAIL.
35527
35528.vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
35529.cindex "recipient" "error"
35530A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
35531recipient errors are:
35532
35533.ilist
35534Any error response to RCPT,
35535.next
35536Timeout after RCPT.
35537.endlist
35538
35539For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
35540recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
35541sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
35542address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
35543used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
35544routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
35545operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
35546to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
35547if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
35548(&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
35549have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
35550the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
35551the retry clock is reset.
35552
35553The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
35554host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
35555other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
35556in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
35557proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
35558than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
35559if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
35560through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
35561recipient's retry time.
35562.endlist
35563
35564In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
35565current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
35566tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
35567own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
35568until the next delivery attempt.
35569
35570Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
35571MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
35572would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
35573host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
35574What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
35575is created.
35576
35577The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
35578these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
35579procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
35580response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
35581it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
35582message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
35583helpful to treat this case as a message error.
35584
35585Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
35586host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
35587or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
35588the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
35589then to be treated as a host error.
35590
35591There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
35592terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
35593reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
35594should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
35595host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
35596
35597
35598
35599
35600.section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
35601.cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
35602.cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
35603.cindex "inetd"
35604.cindex "daemon"
35605Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
35606listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
35607&_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
35608.code
35609smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
35610.endd
35611Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
35612agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
35613a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
35614the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
35615with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
35616stream and exits with an error code.
35617
35618By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
35619disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
35620unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
35621&%smtp_connection%& log selector.
35622
35623.cindex "carriage return"
35624.cindex "linefeed"
35625Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
35626LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
35627order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
35628line terminator.
35629Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
35630sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
35631sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
35632
35633.cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
35634.cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
35635One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
35636HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
35637commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
35638the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
35639Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
35640match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
35641
35642.cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
35643.cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
35644The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
35645a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
35646&%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
35647false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
35648&%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
35649value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
35650message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
35651
35652When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
35653its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
35654logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
35655
35656The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
35657prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
35658number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
35659&%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
35660rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
35661
35662The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
35663subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
35664for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
35665things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
35666processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
35667sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
35668it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
35669
35670When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
35671and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
35672high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
35673&%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
35674applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
35675
35676Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
35677can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
35678&%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
35679number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
35680SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
35681&%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
35682subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
35683a delivery process.
35684
35685The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
35686&%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
35687started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
35688handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
35689however, available with &'inetd'&.
35690
35691Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
35692are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
35693to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
35694section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
35695
35696Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
35697MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
35698&%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
35699
35700
35701
35702.section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
35703.cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
35704If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
35705commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
35706the error response to the last command. The default value for
35707&%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
35708abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
35709circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
35710
35711
35712.section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
35713.cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
35714.cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
35715A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
35716something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
35717address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
35718sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
35719&%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
35720drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
35721default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
35722broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
35723
35724
35725
35726.section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
35727.cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
35728The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
35729DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
35730many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
35731denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
35732client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
35733defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
35734
35735When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
35736allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
35737but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
35738or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
35739starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
35740counted.
35741
35742The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
35743STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
35744RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
35745
35746You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
35747&%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
35748&%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
35749the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
35750specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
35751
35752
35753
35754
35755.section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
35756When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
35757runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
35758appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
35759
35760.cindex "VRFY" "processing"
35761When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
35762setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
35763(with a 252 SMTP response code)
35764in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
35765When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
35766called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
35767SMTP response codes.
35768
35769.cindex "EXPN" "processing"
35770If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
35771When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
35772EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
35773than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
35774as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
35775of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
35776VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
35777RCPT failures.
35778
35779
35780
35781.section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
35782.cindex "ETRN" "processing"
35783RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
35784overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
35785disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
35786the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
35787should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
35788
35789The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
35790delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
35791the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
35792text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
35793specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
35794the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
35795argument. For example,
35796.code
35797ETRN #brigadoon
35798.endd
35799runs the command
35800.code
35801exim -R brigadoon
35802.endd
35803which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
35804containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
35805default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
35806for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
35807a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
35808
35809.cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
35810Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
35811record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
35812the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
35813the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
35814a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
35815left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
35816Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
35817
35818.oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
35819For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
35820used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
35821whatever the form of its argument. For
35822example:
35823.code
35824smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
35825 $sender_host_address
35826.endd
35827.vindex "&$domain$&"
35828The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
35829expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
35830and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
35831wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
35832under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
35833for it to change them before running the command.
35834
35835
35836
35837.section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
35838.cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
35839Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
35840standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
35841line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
35842&%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
35843messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
35844sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
35845an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
35846identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
35847runs for RCPT commands:
35848.code
35849accept hosts = :
35850.endd
35851This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
35852
35853
35854
35855.section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
35856.cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
35857.cindex "batched SMTP output"
35858Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
35859batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
35860be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
35861delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
35862envelope along with the message.
35863
35864The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
35865MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
35866the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
35867HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
35868can be used to specify it.
35869
35870Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
35871one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
35872to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
35873this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
35874chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
35875
35876.vindex "&$host$&"
35877When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
35878sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
35879transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
35880router:
35881.code
35882begin routers
35883route_append:
35884 driver = manualroute
35885 transport = smtp_appendfile
35886 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
35887
35888begin transports
35889smtp_appendfile:
35890 driver = appendfile
35891 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
35892 batch_max = 1000
35893 use_bsmtp
35894 user = exim
35895.endd
35896This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
35897format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
35898message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
35899
35900
35901
35902.section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
35903.cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
35904.cindex "batched SMTP input"
35905The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
35906reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
35907is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
35908sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
35909rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
35910and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
35911as NOOP; QUIT quits.
35912
35913Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
35914ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
35915
35916If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
35917the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
35918standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
35919make some use of automatically, for example:
35920.code
35921554 Unexpected end of file
35922Transaction started in line 10
35923Error detected in line 14
35924.endd
35925It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
35926file, for example:
35927.code
35928An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
35929The error message was:
35930
35931501 '>' missing at end of address
35932
35933The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
35934The error was detected in line 12.
35935The SMTP command at fault was:
35936
35937rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
35938
359391 previous message was successfully processed.
35940The rest of the batch was abandoned.
35941.endd
35942The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
35943messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
35944accepted.
35945.ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
35946.ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
35947
35948
35949
35950. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35951. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35952
35953.chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
35954 "Customizing messages"
35955When a message fails to be delivered, or remains in the queue for more than a
35956configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
35957to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
35958the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
35959string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
35960
35961The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
35962cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
35963option. Exim also adds the line
35964.code
35965Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
35966.endd
35967to all warning and bounce messages,
35968
35969
35970.section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
35971.cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
35972.cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
35973If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
35974message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
35975delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
35976&%bounce_message_file%& is set.
35977
35978When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
35979constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
35980separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
35981opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
35982logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
35983item.
35984
35985.vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
35986.vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
35987Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
35988expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
35989the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
35990&$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
35991option, rounded to a whole number.
35992
35993The items must appear in the file in the following order:
35994
35995.ilist
35996The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
35997&'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
35998.next
35999The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
36000failing addresses with their error messages.
36001.next
36002The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
36003returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
36004.next
36005The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
36006The fields exist for back-compatibility
36007.endlist
36008
36009The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
36010following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
36011other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
36012.code
36013Subject: Mail delivery failed
36014 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
36015 {: returning message to sender}}
36016****
36017This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
36018
36019A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
36020 {that you sent }{sent by
36021
36022<$sender_address>
36023
36024}}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
36025This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
36026****
36027The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
36028****
36029------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
36030 ------
36031****
36032------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
36033 only the first
36034------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
36035****
36036.endd
36037.section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
36038.cindex "customizing" "warning message"
36039.cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
36040The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
36041warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
36042text sections:
36043
36044.ilist
36045The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
36046&'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
36047.next
36048The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
36049the delayed addresses.
36050.next
36051The third item then ends the message.
36052.endlist
36053
36054The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
36055have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
36056.code
36057Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
36058 $warn_message_delay
36059****
36060This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
36061
36062A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
36063{that you sent }{sent by
36064
36065<$sender_address>
36066
36067}}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
36068more than $warn_message_delay in the queue on $primary_hostname.
36069
36070The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
36071The subject of the message is: $h_subject
36072The date of the message is: $h_date
36073
36074The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
36075****
36076No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
36077continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
36078intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
36079mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
36080the message will be returned to you.
36081.endd
36082.vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
36083.vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
36084However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
36085appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
36086&$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
36087minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
36088of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
36089multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
36090handled them.
36091
36092
36093
36094
36095. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36096. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36097
36098.chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
36099This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
36100common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
36101
36102
36103
36104.section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
36105.cindex "smart host" "example router"
36106If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
36107should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
36108routing explicitly:
36109.code
36110send_to_smart_host:
36111 driver = manualroute
36112 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
36113 transport = remote_smtp
36114.endd
36115You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
36116If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
36117receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
36118synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
36119&<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
36120
36121
36122
36123
36124.section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
36125.cindex "mailing lists"
36126Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
36127requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
36128Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
36129
36130The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
36131is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
36132independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
36133lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
36134.code
36135lists:
36136 driver = redirect
36137 domains = lists.example
36138 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
36139 forbid_pipe
36140 forbid_file
36141 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
36142 no_more
36143.endd
36144This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
36145in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
36146such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
36147routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
36148
36149The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
36150expanded into a filename or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
36151a mailing list.
36152
36153.oindex "&%errors_to%&"
36154The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
36155taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
36156original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
36157the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
36158
36159For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
36160&'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
36161&_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
36162&'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
36163There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
36164the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
36165such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
36166or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
36167&%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
36168
36169
36170
36171.section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
36172.cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
36173If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
36174delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
36175list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
36176list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
36177addresses are not rigorously checked.
36178
36179If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
36180entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
36181&%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
36182whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
36183&%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
36184
36185
36186
36187.section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
36188.cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
36189Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
36190in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
36191recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
36192cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
36193delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
36194account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
36195the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
36196message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
36197
36198If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
36199on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
36200router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
36201&"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
36202&"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
36203subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
36204failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
36205pre-existing messages.
36206
36207The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
36208addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
36209addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
36210&%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
36211one level of expansion anyway.
36212
36213
36214
36215.section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
36216.cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
36217The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
36218send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
36219from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
36220&%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
36221
36222The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
36223of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
36224.code
36225lists_request:
36226 driver = redirect
36227 domains = lists.example
36228 local_part_suffix = -request
36229 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
36230 no_more
36231
36232lists_post:
36233 driver = redirect
36234 domains = lists.example
36235 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
36236 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
36237 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
36238 forbid_pipe
36239 forbid_file
36240 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
36241 no_more
36242
36243lists_closed:
36244 driver = redirect
36245 domains = lists.example
36246 allow_fail
36247 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
36248.endd
36249All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
36250they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
36251&%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
36252mailing list.
36253
36254The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
36255checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
36256checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
36257necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
36258because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
36259not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
36260means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
36261&%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
36262&"unrouteable address"& error.
36263
36264The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
36265a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
36266the address, giving a suitable error message.
36267
36268
36269
36270
36271.section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
36272.cindex "VERP"
36273.cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
36274.cindex "envelope from"
36275.cindex "envelope sender"
36276Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(https://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
36277are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
36278address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
36279the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
36280if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
36281original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
36282
36283.oindex &%errors_to%&
36284.oindex &%return_path%&
36285Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
36286facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
36287list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
36288these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
36289host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
36290of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
36291of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
36292.code
36293verp_smtp:
36294 driver = smtp
36295 max_rcpt = 1
36296 return_path = \
36297 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
36298 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
36299.endd
36300This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
36301SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
36302&"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
36303local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
36304example, that a message whose return path has been set to
36305&'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
36306&'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
36307rewritten as
36308.code
36309somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
36310.endd
36311.vindex "&$local_part$&"
36312For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
36313have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
36314achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
36315might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
36316&$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
36317
36318Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
36319probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
36320extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
36321can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
36322.code
36323dnslookup:
36324 driver = dnslookup
36325 domains = ! +local_domains
36326 transport = \
36327 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
36328 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
36329 no_more
36330.endd
36331If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
36332of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
36333routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
36334errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
36335address.
36336
36337On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
36338&(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
36339SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
36340and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
36341of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
36342.code
36343verp_dnslookup:
36344 driver = dnslookup
36345 domains = ! +local_domains
36346 transport = remote_smtp
36347 errors_to = \
36348 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
36349 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
36350 no_more
36351.endd
36352Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
36353configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
36354Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
36355router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
36356them.
36357
36358The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
36359message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
36360host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
36361a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
36362a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
36363than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
36364used).
36365
36366
36367
36368
36369
36370
36371.section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
36372.cindex "virtual domains"
36373.cindex "domain" "virtual"
36374The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
36375meanings:
36376
36377.ilist
36378A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
36379aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
36380top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
36381.next
36382One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
36383with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
36384have login accounts on that host.
36385.endlist
36386
36387The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
36388the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
36389aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
36390virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
36391whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
36392to a router of this form:
36393.code
36394virtual:
36395 driver = redirect
36396 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
36397 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
36398 no_more
36399.endd
36400The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
36401is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
36402domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
36403part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
36404setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
36405string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
36406
36407This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias filenames
36408follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
36409can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
36410a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
36411
36412The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
36413way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
36414valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
36415.code
36416my_domains:
36417 driver = accept
36418 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
36419 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
36420 transport = my_mailboxes
36421.endd
36422The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
36423can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
36424file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
36425option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
36426because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
36427follows:
36428.code
36429my_mailboxes:
36430 driver = appendfile
36431 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
36432 user = mail
36433.endd
36434This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
36435required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
36436
36437The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
36438requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
36439up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
36440information about the domains.
36441
36442
36443
36444.section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
36445.cindex "multiple mailboxes"
36446.cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
36447.cindex "local part" "prefix"
36448.cindex "local part" "suffix"
36449Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
36450incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
36451allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
36452identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
36453parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
36454&%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
36455example, consider this router:
36456.code
36457userforward:
36458 driver = redirect
36459 check_local_user
36460 file = $home/.forward
36461 local_part_suffix = -*
36462 local_part_suffix_optional
36463 allow_filter
36464.endd
36465.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
36466It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
36467&'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
36468cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
36469.code
36470if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
36471save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
36472endif
36473.endd
36474If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
36475fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
36476&%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
36477control over which suffixes are valid.
36478
36479Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
36480&_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
36481another MTA:
36482.code
36483userforward:
36484 driver = redirect
36485 check_local_user
36486 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
36487 local_part_suffix = -*
36488 local_part_suffix_optional
36489 allow_filter
36490.endd
36491If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
36492example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
36493does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
36494subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
36495&_.forward_& file to use as a default.
36496
36497
36498
36499.section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
36500.cindex "vacation processing"
36501The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
36502a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
36503(see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
36504This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
36505that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
36506
36507.ilist
36508A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
36509can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
36510alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
36511&_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
36512.code
36513spqr, vacation-spqr
36514.endd
36515.next
36516The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
36517vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
36518user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
36519ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
36520to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
36521message.
36522.endlist
36523
36524Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
36525use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
36526
36527
36528
36529.section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
36530.cindex "message" "copying every"
36531Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
36532be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
36533command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
36534each day's messages.
36535
36536There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
36537messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
36538delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
36539notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
36540
36541
36542
36543.section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
36544.cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
36545It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
36546Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
36547arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
36548permanently connected.
36549
36550Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
36551particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
36552Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
36553
36554
36555.section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
36556It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
36557host to remain in Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
36558approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
36559being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
36560some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
36561to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
36562resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
36563
36564A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
36565intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
36566into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
36567format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
36568destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
36569in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
36570if required.
36571
36572On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
36573you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
36574intermittent host. For example:
36575.code
36576cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
36577.endd
36578This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
36579which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
36580online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
36581options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
36582causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
36583connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
36584immediately.
36585
36586If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
36587issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
36588mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
36589used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
36590avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
36591Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
36592arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
36593
36594
36595
36596.section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
36597The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
36598increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
36599connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
36600delivered immediately.
36601
36602.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
36603.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
36604.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
36605Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
36606not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
36607possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
36608each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
36609avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
36610&%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
36611first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
36612normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
36613destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
36614single SMTP connection.
36615
36616
36617
36618. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36619. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36620
36621.chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
36622 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
36623.cindex "client, non-queueing"
36624.cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
36625On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
36626email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
36627configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
36628However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
36629configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
36630&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
36631messages this way.
36632
36633If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
36634run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
36635any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
36636continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
36637email is not desirable.
36638
36639There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
36640&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
36641any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
36642host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
36643informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
36644to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
36645to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
36646
36647There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
36648that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
36649ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
36650before sending a message to the smart host.
36651
36652Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
36653tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
36654overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
36655
36656.oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
36657There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
36658Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
36659assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
36660just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
36661compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
36662router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
36663
36664When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
36665following ways:
36666
36667.ilist
36668A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
36669In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
36670.next
36671Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
36672assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
36673&%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
36674does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
36675successful, a zero return code is given.
36676.next
36677Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
36678be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
36679the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
36680must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
36681deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
36682are.
36683.next
36684If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
36685failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
36686successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
36687.next
36688Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
36689is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
36690smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
36691the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
36692there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
36693.next
36694If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
36695connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
36696failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
36697.next
36698When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
36699(as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
36700value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
36701are ever generated.
36702.next
36703No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
36704.next
36705A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
36706true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
36707&%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
36708.endlist
36709
36710The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
36711the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
36712deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
36713privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
36714to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
36715the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
36716
36717
36718
36719
36720. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36721. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36722
36723.chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
36724.scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
36725.cindex "log" "types of"
36726Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
36727and the panic log:
36728
36729.ilist
36730.cindex "main log"
36731The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
36732line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
36733down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
36734out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
36735them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
36736they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
36737analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
36738&<<SECTmailstat>>&).
36739.next
36740.cindex "reject log"
36741The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
36742of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
36743The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
36744the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
36745is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
36746lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
36747reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
36748host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
36749can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
36750false.
36751.next
36752.cindex "panic log"
36753.cindex "system log"
36754When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
36755error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
36756are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
36757other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
36758therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
36759regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
36760panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
36761is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
36762message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
36763.endlist
36764
36765Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
36766example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
36767In the log file, this would be all on one line:
36768.code
367692001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
36770 by QUIT
36771.endd
36772By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
36773ways of changing this:
36774
36775.ilist
36776You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
36777you set
36778.code
36779timezone = UTC
36780.endd
36781the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
36782.next
36783If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
36784example:
36785.code
367862003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
36787.endd
36788.endlist
36789
36790.cindex "log" "process ids in"
36791.cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
36792Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
36793request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
36794&<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
36795brackets, immediately after the time and date.
36796
36797
36798
36799
36800.section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
36801.cindex "log" "destination"
36802.cindex "log" "to file"
36803.cindex "log" "to syslog"
36804.cindex "syslog"
36805The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
36806should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
36807are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
36808arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
36809It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
36810need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
36811Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
36812
36813The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
36814&_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the runtime
36815configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
36816references to the host name:
36817.code
36818log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
36819.endd
36820It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
36821rather than at runtime, because then the setting is available right from the
36822start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
36823before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
36824configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
36825log at all.
36826
36827The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
36828list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
36829facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
36830colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
36831otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
36832point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
36833implying the use of a default path.
36834
36835When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
36836LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
36837&"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
36838mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
36839files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
36840equivalent to the setting:
36841.code
36842log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
36843.endd
36844If you do not specify anything at build time or runtime,
36845or if you unset the option at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
36846that is where the logs are written.
36847
36848A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log filenames
36849are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
36850
36851Here are some examples of possible settings:
36852.display
36853&`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
36854&`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
36855&`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
36856&`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
36857.endd
36858If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
36859error is logged.
36860
36861
36862
36863.section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
36864.cindex "log" "cycling local files"
36865.cindex "cycling logs"
36866.cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
36867.cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
36868Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
36869log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
36870provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
36871main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
36872keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
36873
36874An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
36875and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
36876example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
36877message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
36878that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
36879something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
36880ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
36881&[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
36882does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
36883tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
36884for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
36885renamed.
36886
36887
36888
36889.section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
36890.cindex "log" "datestamped files"
36891Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
36892periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
36893for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
36894&_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
36895the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
36896point where the datestamp is required. For example:
36897.code
36898log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
36899log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
36900log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
36901log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
36902.endd
36903As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
36904examples of names generated by the above examples:
36905.code
36906/var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
36907/var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
36908/var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
36909/var/log/exim/main.200212
36910.endd
36911When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
36912files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
36913will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
36914run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
36915
36916The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
36917is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
36918When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
36919the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
36920non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
36921character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
36922log names:
36923.code
36924/var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
36925/var/log/exim-panic.log
36926/var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
36927/var/log/exim/panic
36928.endd
36929
36930
36931.section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
36932.cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
36933The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
36934except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
36935Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
36936that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
36937&"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
36938by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
36939&%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
36940SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
36941&_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
36942LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
36943the time and host name to each line.
36944The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
36945
36946.ilist
36947&'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
36948.next
36949&'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
36950.next
36951&'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
36952.endlist
36953
36954Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
36955written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
36956these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
36957by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
36958
36959Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
36960entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
36961these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
36962calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
36963870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
36964additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
36965replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
36966RFC 3164, you should set
36967.code
36968SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
36969.endd
36970in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
36971lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
36972
36973To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
36974entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
36975where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
36976components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
36977because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
36978delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
36979870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
36980&'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
36981name, and pid as added by syslog:
36982.code
36983[1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
36984[2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
36985[3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
36986[4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
36987[5/5] mple>)
36988.endd
36989The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
36990(LOG_NOTICE):
36991.code
36992[1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
36993[2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
36994[3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
36995[4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
36996[5\18] .example>)
36997[6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
36998[7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
36999[8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
37000[9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
37001[10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
37002[11\18] 09:43 +0100
37003[12\18] F From: <>
37004[13\18] Subject: this is a test header
37005[18\18] X-something: this is another header
37006[15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
37007[16\18] le>
37008[17\18] B Bcc:
37009[18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
37010.endd
37011Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
37012without modification.
37013
37014If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
37015display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
37016the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
37017where it is.
37018
37019
37020
37021.section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
37022One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
37023successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
37024picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
37025timestamp. The flags are:
37026.display
37027&`<=`& message arrival
37028&`(=`& message fakereject
37029&`=>`& normal message delivery
37030&`->`& additional address in same delivery
37031&`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
37032&`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
37033&`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
37034&`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
37035.endd
37036
37037
37038.section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
37039.cindex "log" "reception line"
37040The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
37041message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
37042several lines in order to fit it on the page:
37043.code
370442002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
37045 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
37046 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
37047.endd
37048The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
37049bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
37050generated, this is followed by an item of the form
37051.code
37052R=<message id>
37053.endd
37054which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
37055
37056.cindex "HELO"
37057.cindex "EHLO"
37058For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
37059record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
37060received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
37061host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
37062above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
37063&%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
37064by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
37065verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
37066EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
37067name in parentheses.
37068
37069Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
37070without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
37071the log containing text like these examples:
37072.code
37073H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
37074H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
37075.endd
37076This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
37077on.
37078
37079For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
37080the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
37081of Exim.
37082
37083.cindex "authentication" "logging"
37084.cindex "AUTH" "logging"
37085For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
37086message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
37087of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
37088extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
37089session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
37090suite that was used.
37091
37092.cindex log protocol
37093The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
37094hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
37095value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
37096there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
37097was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
37098&%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
37099authenticator name.
37100
37101.cindex "size" "of message"
37102The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
37103received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
37104headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
37105message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
37106other).
37107
37108The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
37109data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
37110
37111
37112
37113.section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
37114.cindex "log" "delivery line"
37115The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
37116delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
37117deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
37118to fit it on the page:
37119.code
371202002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
37121 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
371222002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
37123 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
37124 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
37125.endd
37126For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
37127after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
37128intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
37129last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
37130fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
37131
37132If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
37133followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
37134If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
37135option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
37136
37137If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
37138for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
37139.display
37140&`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
37141.endd
37142If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
37143parentheses afterwards.
37144
37145.cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
37146When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
37147SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
37148flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
37149down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
37150lines for the second and subsequent messages.
37151When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
37152DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
37153will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
37154TLS cipher information is still available.
37155
37156.cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
37157.cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
37158When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
37159line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
37160rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
37161
37162The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
37163&"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
37164
37165The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
37166data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
37167
37168
37169.section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
37170.cindex "discarded messages"
37171.cindex "message" "discarded"
37172.cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
37173When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
37174obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
37175.code
371762002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
37177 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
37178.endd
37179is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
37180because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
37181.code
371821999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
37183 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
37184.endd
37185
37186
37187.section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
37188When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
37189.code
371902002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
37191 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
37192.endd
37193In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
37194last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
37195written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
37196.code
371972002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
37198 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
37199.endd
37200When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
37201a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
37202appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
37203
37204
37205
37206.section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
37207.cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
37208If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
37209following form is logged:
37210.code
372111995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
37212 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
37213.endd
37214If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
37215the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
37216.code
372172002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
37218 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
37219 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
37220 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
37221 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
37222.endd
37223The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
37224used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
37225disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
37226flagged with &`**`&.
37227
37228
37229
37230.section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
37231.cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
37232If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
37233used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
37234&"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
37235
37236
37237
37238.section "Completion" "SECID257"
37239A line of the form
37240.code
372412002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
37242.endd
37243is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
37244at the end of its processing.
37245
37246
37247
37248
37249.section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
37250.cindex "log" "summary of fields"
37251A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
37252the following table:
37253.display
37254&`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
37255&`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
37256&` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
37257&`CV `& certificate verification status
37258&`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
37259&`DKIM`& domain verified in incoming message
37260&`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
37261&`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
37262&`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
37263&`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
37264&`H `& host name and IP address
37265&`I `& local interface used
37266&`id `& message id (from header) for incoming message
37267&`K `& CHUNKING extension used
37268&`L `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: PIPELINING extension used
37269&`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
37270&`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
37271&` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
37272&`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
37273&`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
37274&`Q `& alternate queue name
37275&`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
37276&` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
37277&`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
37278&` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
37279&`RT `& on &`<=`& lines: time taken for reception
37280&`S `& size of message in bytes
37281&`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
37282&`ST `& shadow transport name
37283&`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
37284&`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
37285&` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
37286&`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
37287&`X `& TLS cipher suite
37288.endd
37289
37290
37291.section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
37292Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
37293self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
37294
37295.ilist
37296.cindex "retry" "time not reached"
37297&'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
37298during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
37299This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
37300during the first delivery attempt.
37301.next
37302&'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
37303temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
37304for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
37305.next
37306.cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
37307&'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
37308some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
37309common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
37310&'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
37311doing.
37312.next
37313.cindex "error" "ignored"
37314&'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
37315message:
37316.olist
37317Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
37318&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
37319.next
37320A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
37321failed. The delivery was discarded.
37322.next
37323A delivery set up by a router configured with
37324. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
37325. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
37326.code
37327 errors_to = <>
37328.endd
37329failed. The delivery was discarded.
37330.endlist olist
37331.next
37332.cindex DKIM "log line"
37333&'DKIM: d='&&~&~Verbose results of a DKIM verification attempt, if enabled for
37334logging and the message has a DKIM signature header.
37335.endlist ilist
37336
37337
37338
37339
37340
37341.section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
37342.cindex "log" "selectors"
37343By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
37344default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
37345&%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
37346example:
37347.code
37348log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
37349.endd
37350The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
37351selection marked by asterisks:
37352.display
37353&` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
37354&`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
37355&` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
37356&` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
37357&` arguments `& command line arguments
37358&`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
37359&`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
37360&` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
37361&` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
37362&`*dkim `& DKIM verified domain on <= lines
37363&` dkim_verbose `& separate full DKIM verification result line, per signature
37364&`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
37365&` dnssec `& DNSSEC secured lookups
37366&`*etrn `& ETRN commands
37367&`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
37368&` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
37369&` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
37370&` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
37371&`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
37372&` millisec `& millisecond timestamps and RT,QT,DT,D times
37373&`*msg_id `& on <= lines, Message-ID: header value
37374&` msg_id_created `& on <= lines, Message-ID: header value when one had to be added
37375&` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
37376&` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
37377&`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
37378&` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
37379&` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
37380&` pid `& Exim process id
37381&` pipelining `& PIPELINING use, on <= and => lines
37382&` proxy `& proxy address on <= and => lines
37383&` receive_time `& time taken to receive message
37384&` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
37385&` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
37386&`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
37387&`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
37388&` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
37389&` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
37390&`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
37391&`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
37392&`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
37393&`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
37394&` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
37395&` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
37396&` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
37397&` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
37398&` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
37399&` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
37400&` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
37401&`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
37402&`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
37403&` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
37404&` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
37405&` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
37406
37407&` all `& all of the above
37408.endd
37409See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
37410section &<<SECID99>>&
37411
37412More details on each of these items follows:
37413
37414.ilist
37415.cindex "8BITMIME"
37416.cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
37417&%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
37418which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
37419that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
37420&`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
37421&`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
37422.next
37423.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
37424&%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
37425its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
37426this log selector is set.
37427.next
37428.cindex "log" "rewriting"
37429.cindex "rewriting" "logging"
37430&%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
37431rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
37432such users cannot access the log).
37433.next
37434.cindex "log" "full parentage"
37435&%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
37436delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
37437parentheses between them.
37438.next
37439.cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
37440.cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
37441&%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
37442to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
37443feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
37444&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
37445privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
37446that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
37447are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
37448because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
37449only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
37450between the caller and Exim.
37451.next
37452.cindex "log" "connection rejections"
37453&%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
37454connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
37455.next
37456.cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
37457.cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
37458&%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
37459started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
37460messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
37461process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
37462.next
37463.cindex "log" "delivery duration"
37464&%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
37465perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
37466If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37467precision, eg. &`DT=0.304s`&.
37468.next
37469.cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
37470.cindex "size" "of message"
37471&%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
37472the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
37473.next
37474.cindex log "DKIM verification"
37475.cindex DKIM "verification logging"
37476&%dkim%&: For message acceptance log lines, when an DKIM signature in the header
37477verifies successfully a tag of DKIM is added, with one of the verified domains.
37478.next
37479.cindex log "DKIM verification"
37480.cindex DKIM "verification logging"
37481&%dkim_verbose%&: A log entry is written for each attempted DKIM verification.
37482.next
37483.cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
37484.cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
37485.cindex "black list (DNS)"
37486&%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
37487DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
37488.next
37489.cindex log dnssec
37490.cindex dnssec logging
37491&%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
37492dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
37493For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
37494It does not cover helo-name verification.
37495For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
37496.next
37497.cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
37498.cindex "ETRN" "logging"
37499&%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
37500is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
37501command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
37502selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
37503.next
37504.cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
37505&%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
37506any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
37507log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
37508routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
37509.next
37510.cindex "log" "ident timeout"
37511.cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
37512&%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
37513client's ident port times out.
37514.next
37515.cindex "log" "incoming interface"
37516.cindex "log" "local interface"
37517.cindex "log" "local address and port"
37518.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
37519.cindex "interface" "logging"
37520&%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
37521to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
37522followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
37523added to other SMTP log lines, for example, &"SMTP connection from"&, to
37524rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
37525The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
37526.next
37527.cindex log "incoming proxy address"
37528.cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
37529.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
37530&%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
37531of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
37532on a proxied connection
37533or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
37534See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
37535.next
37536.cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
37537.cindex "port" "logging remote"
37538.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
37539.vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
37540.vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
37541&%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
37542added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
37543in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
37544changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
37545&$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
37546important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
37547.next
37548.cindex "log" "dropped connection"
37549&%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
37550connection is unexpectedly dropped.
37551.next
37552.cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
37553.cindex millisecond logging
37554.cindex timestamps "millisecond, in logs"
37555&%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
37556appended to the seconds value.
37557.next
37558.new
37559.cindex "log" "message id"
37560&%msg_id%&: The value of the Message-ID: header.
37561.next
37562&%msg_id_created%&: The value of the Message-ID: header, when one had to be created.
37563This will be either because the message is a bounce, or was submitted locally
37564(submission mode) without one.
37565The field identifier will have an asterix appended: &"id*="&.
37566.wen
37567.next
37568.cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
37569.cindex "log" "local interface"
37570.cindex "log" "local address and port"
37571.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
37572.cindex "interface" "logging"
37573&%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
37574interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
37575followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
37576off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
37577.next
37578.cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
37579.cindex "port" "logging outgoing remote"
37580.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
37581&%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
37582containing => tags) following the IP address.
37583The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
37584&%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
37585This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
37586configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
37587local port is a random ephemeral port.
37588.next
37589.cindex "log" "process ids in"
37590.cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
37591&%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
37592immediately after the time and date.
37593.next
37594.cindex log pipelining
37595.cindex pipelining "logging outgoing"
37596&%pipelining%&: A field is added to delivery and accept
37597log lines when the ESMTP PIPELINING extension was used.
37598The field is a single "L".
37599
37600On accept lines, where PIPELINING was offered but not used by the client,
37601the field has a minus appended.
37602
37603.new
37604.cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
37605If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
37606accept "L" fields have a period appended if the feature was
37607offered but not used, or an asterisk appended if used.
37608Delivery "L" fields have an asterisk appended if used.
37609.wen
37610
37611.next
37612.cindex "log" "queue run"
37613.cindex "queue runner" "logging"
37614&%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
37615.next
37616.cindex "log" "queue time"
37617&%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
37618local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
37619&`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
37620includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
37621This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
37622delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
37623message has been successfully received.
37624If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37625precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
37626.next
37627&%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
37628the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
37629example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
37630message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
37631.next
37632.cindex "log" "receive duration"
37633&%receive_time%&: For each message, the amount of real time it has taken to
37634perform the reception is logged as RT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`RT=1s`&.
37635If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37636precision, eg. &`RT=0.204s`&.
37637.next
37638.cindex "log" "recipients"
37639&%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
37640as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
37641that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
37642addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
37643has taken place.
37644Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
37645in the list.
37646.next
37647.cindex "log" "sender reception"
37648&%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
37649the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
37650&"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
37651.next
37652.cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
37653&%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
37654rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
37655log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
37656rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
37657.next
37658.cindex "log" "retry defer"
37659&%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
37660retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
37661message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
37662attempt.
37663.next
37664.cindex "log" "return path"
37665&%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
37666the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
37667This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
37668or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
37669.next
37670.cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
37671&%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
37672and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
37673This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
37674necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
37675.next
37676.cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
37677&%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
37678gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
37679the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
37680detail is lost.
37681.next
37682.cindex "log" "size rejection"
37683&%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
37684it is too big.
37685.next
37686.cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
37687.cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
37688&%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
37689queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
37690it.
37691.cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
37692The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
37693.next
37694.cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
37695.cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
37696.cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
37697&%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
37698outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
37699A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
37700response.
37701.next
37702.cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
37703.cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
37704&%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
37705established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
37706&%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
37707only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
37708processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
37709dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
37710not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
37711of connections unless this selector is enabled.
37712
37713For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
37714included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
37715reset if the daemon is restarted.
37716Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
37717subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
37718whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
37719match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
37720logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
37721.next
37722.cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
37723.cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
37724&%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
37725RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
37726and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
37727line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
37728.next
37729.cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
37730.cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
37731&%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
37732connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
37733the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
37734does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
37735an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
37736already have their own log lines.
37737
37738The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
37739way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
37740If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
37741an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
37742DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
37743the same logging options.
37744
37745Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
37746is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
37747.code
37748C=EHLO,QUIT
37749.endd
37750shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
37751than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
37752the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
37753setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
37754have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
37755.next
37756&%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
37757colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
37758log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
37759was accepted or used.
37760.next
37761.cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
37762.cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
37763&%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
37764encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
37765because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
37766been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
37767it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
37768received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
37769.next
37770.cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
37771.cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
37772.cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
37773.cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
37774.cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
37775&%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
37776encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
37777external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
37778using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
37779.next
37780.cindex "log" "subject"
37781.cindex "subject, logging"
37782&%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
37783preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
37784Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
37785specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
37786unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
37787.next
37788.cindex "log" "certificate verification"
37789.cindex log DANE
37790.cindex DANE logging
37791&%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
37792when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
37793verified
37794using a CA trust anchor,
37795&`CA=dane`& if using a DNS trust anchor,
37796and &`CV=no`& if not.
37797.next
37798.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
37799.cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
37800&%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
37801connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
37802.next
37803.cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
37804.cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
37805&%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
37806connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
37807added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
37808.next
37809.cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
37810.cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
37811&%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
37812the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
37813added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
37814.next
37815.cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
37816&%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
37817result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
37818.endlist
37819
37820
37821.section "Message log" "SECID260"
37822.cindex "message" "log file for"
37823.cindex "log" "message log; description of"
37824.cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
37825.oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
37826In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
37827that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
37828they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
37829message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
37830makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
37831to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
37832is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
37833only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
37834
37835On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
37836per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
37837&%message_logs%& option false.
37838.ecindex IIDloggen
37839
37840
37841
37842
37843. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37844. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37845
37846.chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
37847.scindex IIDutils "utilities"
37848A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
37849described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
37850the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
37851
37852.itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
37853.irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
37854 "list what Exim processes are doing"
37855.irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
37856.irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
37857.irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
37858.irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
37859 various criteria"
37860.irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
37861.irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
37862 "extract statistics from the log"
37863.irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
37864 "check address acceptance from given IP"
37865.irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
37866.irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
37867.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
37868.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
37869.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
37870.irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
37871.endtable
37872
37873Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
37874&'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
37875&url(https://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
37876
37877
37878
37879
37880.section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
37881.cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
37882.cindex "process, querying"
37883.cindex "SIGUSR1"
37884On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
37885(most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
37886a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
37887Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
37888processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
37889second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
37890order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
37891send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
37892
37893&*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
37894use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
37895script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
37896
37897
37898Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
37899varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
37900but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
37901system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
37902it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
37903options:
37904.display
37905&`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
37906&`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
37907&`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
37908&`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
37909.endd
37910An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
37911.code
37912164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
3791310483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
3791410492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
37915 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
3791610592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
3791710628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
37918.endd
37919The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
37920been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
37921
37922
37923
37924.section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
37925.cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
37926.cindex "queue" "grepping"
37927This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
37928.code
37929exim -bpu
37930.endd
37931or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
37932.code
37933exim -bp
37934.endd
37935The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
37936contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
37937
37938to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
37939that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
37940
37941.vlist
37942.vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
37943Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
37944tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
37945.code
37946exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
37947.endd
37948.vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
37949Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
37950tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
37951
37952.vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
37953Match against the size field.
37954
37955.vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
37956Match messages that are younger than the given time.
37957
37958.vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
37959Match messages that are older than the given time.
37960
37961.vitem &*-z*&
37962Match only frozen messages.
37963
37964.vitem &*-x*&
37965Match only non-frozen messages.
37966
37967.new
37968.vitem &*-G*&&~<&'queuename'&>
37969Match only messages in the given queue. Without this, the default queue is searched.
37970.wen
37971.endlist
37972
37973The following options control the format of the output:
37974
37975.vlist
37976.vitem &*-c*&
37977Display only the count of matching messages.
37978
37979.vitem &*-l*&
37980Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
37981the default.
37982
37983.vitem &*-i*&
37984Display message ids only.
37985
37986.vitem &*-b*&
37987Brief format &-- one line per message.
37988
37989.vitem &*-R*&
37990Display messages in reverse order.
37991
37992.vitem &*-a*&
37993Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
37994.endlist
37995
37996There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
37997
37998
37999
38000.section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
38001.cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
38002.cindex "queue" "summary"
38003The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
38004-bp`& and produces a summary of the messages in the queue. Thus, you use it by
38005running a command such as
38006.code
38007exim -bp | exiqsumm
38008.endd
38009The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
38010it, as in the following example:
38011.code
380123 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
38013.endd
38014Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
38015volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
38016been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
38017number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
38018
38019A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
38020domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
38021the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
38022respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
38023domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
38024separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
38025sender.
38026
38027The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
38028this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
38029generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
38030option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
38031level"& addresses).
38032
38033
38034
38035
38036.section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
38037 "SECTextspeinf"
38038.cindex "&'exigrep'&"
38039.cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
38040The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
38041files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
38042extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
38043match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
38044given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
38045The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
38046If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
38047included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
38048.display
38049&`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
38050.endd
38051If no log filenames are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
38052
38053The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
38054condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
38055they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds in the queue.
38056
38057By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
38058makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
38059large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
38060option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
38061case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
38062
38063The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
38064pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
38065regular expression.
38066
38067The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
38068if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
38069
38070The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
38071that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
38072normally.
38073
38074Example of &%-M%&:
38075user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
38076&'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
38077displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
38078the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
38079when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
38080&"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
38081search term.
38082
38083If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
38084ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
38085whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
38086If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
38087autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
38088
38089
38090.section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
38091.cindex "&'exipick'&"
38092John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
38093lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
38094of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
38095the &%--help%& option.
38096
38097
38098.section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
38099.cindex "log" "cycling local files"
38100.cindex "cycling logs"
38101.cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
38102The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
38103&'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
38104you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
38105&<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
38106for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
38107There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
38108.ilist
38109&%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
38110default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
38111.next
38112&%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
38113&%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
38114overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
38115configuration.
38116.endlist
38117
38118Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the filenames get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
38119the main log filename is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
38120run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
38121&_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
38122&%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
38123logs are handled similarly.
38124
38125If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
38126&_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
38127to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
38128any existing log files.
38129
38130If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
38131the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
38132using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
38133setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
38134root &%crontab%& entry of the form
38135.code
381361 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
38137.endd
38138assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
38139&'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
38140
38141
38142
38143.section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
38144.cindex "statistics"
38145.cindex "&'eximstats'&"
38146A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
38147information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
38148. --- 2018-09-07: LogReport's Lire appears to be dead; website is a Yahoo Japan
38149. --- 404 error and everything else points to that.
38150
38151The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
38152latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
38153lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
38154various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
38155list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
38156.code
38157eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
38158.endd
38159By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
38160messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
38161both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
38162are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
38163addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
38164options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
38165also produced per user.
38166
38167The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
38168histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
38169hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
38170example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
38171as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
38172
38173Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
38174have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
38175messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
38176and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
38177recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
38178an entirely separate message.
38179
38180&'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
38181of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
38182each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
38183not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
38184least one address that failed.
38185
38186The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
38187or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
38188transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
38189(default per hour), information about the time messages spent in the queue,
38190a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
38191senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
38192and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
38193
38194The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
38195came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
38196without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
38197
38198There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
38199outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
38200by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
38201.code
38202perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
38203.endd
38204
38205.section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
38206.cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
38207.cindex "policy control" "checking access"
38208.cindex "checking access"
38209The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
38210debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
38211policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
38212familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
38213sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
38214access?"& without bothering with any further details.
38215
38216The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
38217two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
38218.code
38219exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
38220.endd
38221The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
38222given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
38223connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
38224is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
38225.code
38226Rejected:
38227550 Relay not permitted
38228.endd
38229When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
38230for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
38231options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
38232that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
38233you can use:
38234.code
38235exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
38236 -f himself@there.example
38237.endd
38238Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
38239mandatory arguments.
38240
38241Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
38242while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
38243&%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
38244
38245
38246
38247.section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
38248.cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
38249.cindex "building DBM files"
38250.cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
38251.cindex "lower casing"
38252.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
38253The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
38254the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
38255&<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
38256names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
38257can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
38258
38259A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
38260the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
38261&'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
38262strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
38263files.
38264
38265The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
38266single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
38267It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
38268well.
38269
38270.cindex "USE_DB"
38271If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
38272configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two
38273filenames must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions
38274create a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
38275.code
38276exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
38277.endd
38278reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
38279&_/etc/aliases.db_&.
38280
38281In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
38282Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
38283environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
38284&'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
38285when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
38286recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the filename.
38287
38288If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
38289finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
38290option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
38291this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
38292&%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
38293There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
38294&%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
38295return code is 2.
38296
38297
38298
38299
38300.section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
38301.cindex "retry" "times"
38302.cindex "&'exinext'&"
38303A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
38304fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
38305complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
38306information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
38307is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
38308output. For example:
38309.code
38310$ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
38311kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
38312 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
38313 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
38314 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
38315roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
38316 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
38317 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
38318 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
38319 past final cutoff time
38320.endd
38321You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
38322will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
38323A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
38324message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
38325suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
38326&'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
38327run very often.
38328
38329The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
38330of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
38331passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
38332configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
38333file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
38334environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
38335
38336
38337
38338.section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
38339.cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
38340.cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
38341Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
38342uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
38343arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
38344second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
38345
38346.ilist
38347&'retry'&: the database of retry information
38348.next
38349&'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
38350for remote hosts
38351.next
38352&'callout'&: the callout cache
38353.next
38354&'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
38355.next
38356&'misc'&: other hints data
38357.endlist
38358
38359The &'misc'& database is used for
38360
38361.ilist
38362Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
38363.next
38364Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
38365&(smtp)& transport)
38366.next
38367Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
38368in a transport)
38369.endlist
38370
38371
38372
38373.section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
38374.cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
38375The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
38376&'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
38377spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
38378.code
38379exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
38380.endd
38381Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
38382.code
38383T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
3838431-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
38385.endd
38386The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
38387of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
38388transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
38389a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
38390address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
38391transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
38392to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
38393and a textual description of the error.
38394
38395The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
38396the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
38397ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
38398exceeded.
38399
38400Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
38401consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
38402waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
38403one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
38404may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
38405may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
38406cross-references.
38407
38408
38409
38410.section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
38411.cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
38412The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
38413database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
38414days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
38415updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
38416since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
38417for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
38418updated sufficiently often.
38419
38420The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
38421followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
38422the retry database:
38423.code
38424exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
38425.endd
38426Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
38427message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
38428they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
38429are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
38430types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
38431message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
38432queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
38433&'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
38434For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
38435removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
38436whenever it removes information from the database.
38437
38438Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
38439needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
38440down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
38441first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
38442records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
38443
38444It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
38445hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
38446a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
38447work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
38448but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
38449After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
38450point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
38451tidied.
38452
38453&*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
38454databases is likely to keep on increasing.
38455
38456
38457
38458
38459.section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
38460.cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
38461The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
38462Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
38463getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
38464is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
38465key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
38466displayed.
38467
38468If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
38469except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
38470out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
38471data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
38472by new data, for example:
38473.code
38474> 4 951102:1000
38475.endd
38476resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
38477sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
38478used as optional separators.
38479
38480
38481
38482
38483.section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
38484.cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
38485.cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
38486.cindex "locking mailboxes"
38487The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
38488Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
38489&'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
38490a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
38491the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
38492argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
38493second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
38494is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
38495is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
38496
38497.vlist
38498.vitem &%-fcntl%&
38499Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
38500
38501.vitem &%-flock%&
38502Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
38503supports it.
38504
38505.vitem &%-interval%&
38506This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
38507interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
38508
38509.vitem &%-lockfile%&
38510Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
38511
38512.vitem &%-mbx%&
38513Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
38514
38515.vitem &%-q%&
38516Suppress verification output.
38517
38518.vitem &%-retries%&
38519This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
38520the lock (default 10).
38521
38522.vitem &%-restore_time%&
38523This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
38524locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
38525example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
38526subsequently sees.
38527
38528.vitem &%-timeout%&
38529This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
38530timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
38531default), a non-blocking call is used.
38532
38533.vitem &%-v%&
38534Generate verbose output.
38535.endlist
38536
38537If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
38538default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
38539mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
38540&%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
38541requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
38542file does not last forever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
38543more than 30 minutes old.
38544
38545The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
38546&%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
38547to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
38548&_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
38549number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
38550can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
38551
38552The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
38553&%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
38554suppresses all output except error messages.
38555
38556A command such as
38557.code
38558exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
38559.endd
38560runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
38561.display
38562&`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
38563<&'some commands'&>
38564&`End`&
38565.endd
38566runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
38567suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
38568such as
38569.code
38570exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
38571 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
38572.endd
38573Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
38574second argument &-- hence the quotes.
38575.ecindex IIDutils
38576
38577
38578. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38579. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38580
38581.chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
38582.scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
38583.cindex "X-windows"
38584.cindex "&'eximon'&"
38585.cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
38586.cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
38587The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
38588about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
38589perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
38590such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
38591monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
38592
38593
38594
38595.section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
38596The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
38597script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
38598binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
38599be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
38600&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
38601parameters are for.
38602
38603The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
38604a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
38605preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
38606.code
38607EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
38608.endd
38609(in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
38610the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
38611overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
38612&'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
38613syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
38614
38615X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
38616way. For example, a resource setting of the form
38617.code
38618Eximon*background: gray94
38619.endd
38620changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
38621stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
38622black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
38623data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
38624&"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
38625For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
38626reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
38627.code
38628xrdb -merge <<End
38629Eximon*highlight: gray
38630End
38631.endd
38632.cindex "admin user"
38633In order to see the contents of messages in the queue, and to operate on them,
38634&'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
38635
38636The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
38637contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
38638if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
38639binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
38640versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
38641
38642The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
38643more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
38644main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
38645delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
38646different parts of the display.
38647
38648
38649
38650
38651.section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
38652.cindex "stripchart"
38653The first stripchart is always a count of messages in the queue. Its name can
38654be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
38655&_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
38656configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
38657it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
38658hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
38659received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
38660period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
38661parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
38662
38663The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
38664displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
38665title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
38666For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
38667
38668It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
38669a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
38670to a single partition.
38671
38672.cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
38673This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
38674the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
38675this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
38676100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
38677SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
38678&_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
38679
38680
38681
38682
38683.section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
38684.cindex "size" "of monitor window"
38685.cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
38686.cindex "window size"
38687Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
38688to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
38689shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
38690stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
38691the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
38692in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
38693
38694When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
38695currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
38696size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
38697remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
38698
38699The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
38700stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
38701the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
38702The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
38703&'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
38704the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38705
38706Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
38707built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
38708START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38709
38710
38711
38712.section "The log display" "SECID267"
38713.cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
38714The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
38715the main log is maintained.
38716To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
38717removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
38718The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
38719syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
38720to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
38721
38722The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
38723move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
38724scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
38725LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
38726to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
38727much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
38728a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
38729only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
38730available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
38731normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
38732configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38733
38734Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
38735and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
38736respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
38737It cannot go further back up the log.
38738
38739The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
38740normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
38741by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
38742by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
38743back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
38744the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
38745
38746Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
38747There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
38748the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
38749happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
38750&"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
38751^C is typed the search is cancelled.
38752
38753The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
38754widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
38755&"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
38756eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
38757However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
38758provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
38759come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
38760unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
38761on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
38762window.
38763
38764
38765
38766.section "The queue display" "SECID268"
38767.cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
38768The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
38769are in the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
38770as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
38771parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
38772at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
38773the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
38774there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
38775to force an update of the queue display at any time.
38776
38777When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
38778and this can make it hard to deal with other messages in the queue. To help
38779with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
38780pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
38781type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
38782such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
38783of the texts, the message is not displayed.
38784
38785If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
38786are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
38787example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
38788&'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
38789has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
38790cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
38791a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
38792
38793While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
38794else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
38795queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
38796pressing the &"Hide"& button.
38797
38798The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
38799time it has been in the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
38800message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
38801a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
38802recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
38803listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
38804an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
38805not shown.
38806
38807.cindex "frozen messages" "display"
38808If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
38809
38810The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
38811of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
38812The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
38813available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
38814display is updated.
38815
38816
38817
38818.section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
38819.cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
38820If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
38821pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
38822line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
38823any selected text.
38824
38825If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
38826MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
38827set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
38828value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
38829run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
38830.code
38831EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
38832.endd
38833The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
38834follows:
38835
38836.ilist
38837&'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
38838in a new text window.
38839.next
38840&'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
38841information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
38842&<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
38843.next
38844&'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
38845displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
38846amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
38847option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at runtime.
38848.next
38849&'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
38850delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
38851frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
38852a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
38853up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
38854.next
38855&'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
38856that the message be frozen.
38857.next
38858.cindex "thawing messages"
38859.cindex "unfreezing messages"
38860.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
38861&'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
38862that the message be thawed.
38863.next
38864.cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
38865&'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
38866that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
38867for any remaining undelivered addresses.
38868.next
38869&'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
38870that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
38871message.
38872.next
38873&'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
38874be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
38875is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
38876Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
38877causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
38878additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
38879which case no action is taken.
38880.next
38881&'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
38882can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
38883is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
38884Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
38885causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
38886recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
38887case no action is taken.
38888.next
38889&'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
38890mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
38891.next
38892&'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
38893sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
38894&%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
38895in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
38896bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
38897not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
38898the address is qualified with that domain.
38899.endlist
38900
38901When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
38902other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
38903particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
38904output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
38905from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
38906&_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
38907if no output is generated.
38908
38909The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
38910thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
38911&_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
38912force an update of the display after one of these actions.
38913
38914In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
38915cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
38916and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
38917.ecindex IIDeximon
38918
38919
38920
38921
38922
38923. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38924. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38925
38926.chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
38927.scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
38928This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
38929which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
38930
38931For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
38932Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
38933existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
38934chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
38935security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
38936its security as compared with other MTAs.
38937
38938What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
38939have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
38940absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
38941as soon as possible.
38942
38943
38944.section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
38945.cindex "security" "build-time features"
38946There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
38947to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
38948Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
38949penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
38950
38951.ilist
38952ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
38953start of any filenames used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these
38954filenames are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if
38955the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
38956&_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
38957default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
38958
38959If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
38960which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
38961into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
38962configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
38963.next
38964
38965If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
38966or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
38967file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
38968the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
38969root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
38970right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
38971reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
38972it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
38973privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
38974separate commands.
38975
38976.next
38977The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
38978with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
38979CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
38980requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
38981the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
38982but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
38983previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
38984.next
38985If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
38986is disabled.
38987.next
38988FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
38989never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
38990option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
38991to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
38992is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
38993.endlist
38994
38995
38996
38997.section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
38998.cindex "setuid"
38999.cindex "root privilege"
39000The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
39001privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
39002example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
39003may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
39004discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
39005is required for two things:
39006
39007.ilist
39008To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
39009the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
39010not required.
39011.next
39012To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
39013perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
39014configuration.
39015.endlist
39016
39017It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
39018receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
39019obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
39020For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
39021&_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
39022group"&. Their values can be changed by the runtime configuration, though this
39023is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
39024&'mail'& or another user name altogether.
39025
39026Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
39027abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
39028&[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
39029
39030After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
39031uid and gid in the following cases:
39032
39033.ilist
39034.oindex "&%-C%&"
39035.oindex "&%-D%&"
39036If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
39037the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
39038calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
39039the calling process.
39040However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
39041option may not be used at all.
39042If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
39043can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
39044user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
39045.next
39046.oindex "&%-be%&"
39047.oindex "&%-bf%&"
39048.oindex "&%-bF%&"
39049If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
39050(&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
39051calling process.
39052.next
39053If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
39054process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
39055uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
39056runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
39057testing address verification
39058.oindex "&%-bv%&"
39059.oindex "&%-bh%&"
39060(the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
39061option).
39062.next
39063For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
39064remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
39065.endlist
39066
39067The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
39068
39069.ilist
39070A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
39071user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
39072function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
39073will be used during message reception.
39074.next
39075A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
39076job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
39077.next
39078A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
39079but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
39080subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
39081deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
39082remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
39083subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
39084while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
39085generating bounce and warning messages.
39086
39087While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
39088process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
39089this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
39090gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
39091.next
39092A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
39093the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
39094.endlist
39095
39096
39097
39098
39099.section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
39100.cindex "privilege, running without"
39101.cindex "unprivileged running"
39102.cindex "root privilege" "running without"
39103Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
39104operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
39105by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
39106gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
39107(and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
39108routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
39109to any other uid.
39110
39111.cindex SIGHUP
39112.cindex "daemon" "restarting"
39113Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
39114that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
39115correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
39116
39117An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
39118to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
39119process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
39120when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
39121SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
39122
39123It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
39124stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
39125been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
39126effect.
39127
39128If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
39129set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
39130to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
39131
39132In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
39133those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
39134Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
39135that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
39136discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
39137have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
39138number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
39139address this problem at this time.
39140
39141For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
39142is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
39143&%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
39144be used in the most straightforward way.
39145
39146If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
39147number of restrictions on what you can do:
39148
39149.ilist
39150You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
39151&%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
39152normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
39153work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
39154explicit specification of another user causes an error.
39155.next
39156Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
39157not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
39158.next
39159Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
39160the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
39161and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
39162enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
39163.next
39164Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
39165some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
39166
39167.olist
39168They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
39169implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
39170mode of the mailbox files themselves.
39171.next
39172You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
39173owned by the Exim user.
39174.next
39175You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
39176on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
39177mailboxes need to be created manually.
39178.endlist olist
39179.endlist ilist
39180
39181
39182These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
39183However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
39184gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
39185gives more security at essentially no cost.
39186
39187If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
39188&<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
39189
39190
39191
39192
39193.section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
39194Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
39195are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
39196
39197
39198
39199.section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
39200.cindex "security" "local commands"
39201.cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
39202There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
39203commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
39204configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
39205run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
39206
39207.ilist
39208Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
39209injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
39210be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
39211allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
39212has &%use_shell%& enabled.
39213.next
39214A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
39215&%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
39216&_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
39217hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
39218NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
39219forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
39220need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
39221.next
39222The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
39223administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
39224Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
39225.next
39226Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
39227taint checking might apply to their usage.
39228.next
39229Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
39230administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
39231instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
39232.next
39233Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
39234Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
39235each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
39236of opaque strings.
39237The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
39238real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
39239injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
39240Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
39241.endlist
39242
39243
39244
39245
39246.section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
39247.cindex "security" "data sources"
39248.cindex "security" "regular expressions"
39249.cindex "regular expressions" "security"
39250.cindex "PCRE" "security"
39251If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
39252are some issues to be aware of:
39253
39254.ilist
39255Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
39256.next
39257Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
39258.next
39259Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
39260data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
39261"backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
39262expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
39263when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
39264possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
39265data.
39266.next
39267It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
39268&%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
39269items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
39270.next
39271Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
39272expected to yield one result.
39273.endlist
39274
39275
39276
39277
39278.section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
39279.cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
39280.cindex "IP source routing"
39281Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
39282some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
39283IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
39284IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
39285
39286
39287
39288.section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
39289Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
39290be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
39291
39292
39293
39294
39295.section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
39296.cindex "trusted users"
39297.cindex "admin user"
39298.cindex "privileged user"
39299.cindex "user" "trusted"
39300.cindex "user" "admin"
39301Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
39302able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
39303addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
39304local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
39305permit a remote host to be specified.
39306
39307.oindex "&%-f%&"
39308However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
39309in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
39310message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
39311but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
39312permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
39313the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
39314
39315Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
39316other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
39317the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
39318as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
39319group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
39320
39321Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
39322can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
39323them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
39324the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
39325includes the contents of files on the spool.
39326
39327.oindex "&%-M%&"
39328.oindex "&%-q%&"
39329By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
39330delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
39331restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
39332Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
39333queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
39334setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
39335
39336Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
39337the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
39338the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
39339group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
39340the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
39341unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
39342files.
39343
39344By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
39345introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
39346setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
39347This affects most of the checking options,
39348such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
39349
39350
39351.section "Spool files" "SECID275"
39352.cindex "spool directory" "files"
39353Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
39354set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
39355&_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
39356any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
39357
39358
39359
39360.section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
39361Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
39362of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
39363with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
39364to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
39365this.
39366
39367
39368
39369.section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
39370The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
39371are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
39372Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
39373converted output.
39374
39375
39376
39377.section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
39378Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
39379to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
39380does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
39381arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
39382
39383
39384
39385.section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
39386Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
39387defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
39388loading it.
39389
39390
39391.section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
39392.cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
39393A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
39394&'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
39395The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
39396that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
39397conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
39398
39399The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
39400the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
39401string.
39402
39403
39404
39405.section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
39406Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
39407formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
39408the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
39409
39410
39411
39412.section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
39413These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
39414enough to hold the result.
39415.ecindex IIDsecurcon
39416
39417
39418
39419
39420. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39421. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39422
39423.chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
39424.scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
39425.scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
39426.scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
39427.cindex "spool files" "editing"
39428A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
39429followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
39430the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
39431kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
39432two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
39433is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
39434themselves are recoverable.
39435
39436The file formats may be changed, or new formats added, at any release.
39437Spool files are not intended as an interface to other programs
39438and should not be used as such.
39439
39440Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
39441need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
39442on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
39443
39444.ilist
39445You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
39446fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
39447which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
39448place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
39449lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
39450.next
39451.vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
39452If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
39453&$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
39454cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
39455.next
39456If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
39457.next
39458If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
39459signature.
39460.endlist
39461All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
39462
39463Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
39464its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
39465files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
39466the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
39467the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
39468is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
39469file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
39470-J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
39471attempt.
39472
39473Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
39474These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
39475They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
39476relics of crashes and can be removed.
39477
39478.section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
39479.cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
39480.cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
39481The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
39482process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
39483gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
39484message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
39485normally the Exim user.
39486
39487The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
39488transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
39489empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
39490in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
39491created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
39492&%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
39493leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
39494&"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
39495
39496The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
39497was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
39498start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
39499warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
39500
39501There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
39502order, and are omitted when not relevant:
39503
39504.vlist
39505.vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39506This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
39507&%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
39508recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
39509this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
39510identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
39511the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
39512the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
39513the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
39514newlines.
39515
39516.vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39517A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
39518defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
39519The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
39520starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
39521character. It may contain internal newlines.
39522
39523.vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39524A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
39525Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
39526length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
39527starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
39528character. It may contain internal newlines.
39529
39530.vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
39531This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
39532&$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
39533
39534.vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
39535This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
39536lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
39537transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
39538messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
39539
39540.vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
39541This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
39542(to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
39543time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
39544hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
39545
39546.vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
39547The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
39548&-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
39549
39550.vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
39551The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
39552&$authenticated_sender$& variable.
39553
39554.vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
39555This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
39556present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
39557
39558.vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
39559This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
39560present if the number is greater than zero.
39561
39562.vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
39563This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
39564file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
39565
39566.vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
39567.cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
39568The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
39569
39570.vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
39571This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
39572command.
39573
39574.vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
39575This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
39576the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
39577messages.
39578
39579.vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
39580If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
39581the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
39582&$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
39583
39584.vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
39585This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
39586address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
39587
39588.vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
39589.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
39590.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
39591This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
39592if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
39593received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
39594
39595.vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
39596For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
39597unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
39598ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
39599supplied by the remote host, if any.
39600
39601.vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
39602This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
39603which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
39604generated messages.
39605
39606.vitem &%-local%&
39607The message is from a local sender.
39608
39609.vitem &%-localerror%&
39610The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
39611
39612.vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
39613This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
39614when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
39615variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
39616
39617.vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
39618The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
39619Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
39620
39621.vitem &%-N%&
39622A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
39623actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
39624&%-N%& is assumed.
39625
39626.vitem &%-received_protocol%&
39627This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
39628the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
39629
39630.vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
39631The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
39632to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
39633
39634.vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
39635If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
39636of &$spam_score_int$&.
39637
39638.vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
39639The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
39640rather than Unix-format.
39641The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
39642There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
39643
39644.vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
39645A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
39646certificate was verified by the server.
39647
39648.vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
39649When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
39650name of the cipher suite that was used.
39651
39652.vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
39653When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
39654was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
39655certificate.
39656.endlist
39657
39658.new
39659Any of the above may have an extra hyphen prepended, to indicate the the
39660corresponding data is untrusted.
39661.wen
39662
39663Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
39664is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
39665line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
39666is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
39667the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
39668balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
39669to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
39670original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
39671addresses are complete.
39672
39673If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
39674the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
39675Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
39676tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
39677right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
39678follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
39679.code
39680YY darcy@austen.fict.example
39681NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
39682NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39683.endd
39684After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
39685This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
39686recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
39687delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
39688example:
39689.code
396904
39691editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39692darcy@austen.fict.example
39693rdo@foundation
39694alice@wonderland.fict.example
39695.endd
39696However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
39697result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
39698line is of the following form:
39699.display
39700<&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
39701 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
39702.endd
39703The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
39704the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
39705fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
39706original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
39707envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
39708length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
39709characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
39710that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
39711
39712
39713A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
39714which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
39715when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
39716character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
39717embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
39718following:
39719
39720.table2 50pt
39721.row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
39722.row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
39723.row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
39724.row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
39725.row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
39726.row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
39727.row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
39728.row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
39729.row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
39730.row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
39731.endtable
39732
39733Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
39734purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
39735typical set of headers:
39736.code
39737111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
39738id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
39739049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
39740038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
39741042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
39742049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
39743099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
39744darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39745104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
39746darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39747038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
39748.endd
39749The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
39750&'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
39751unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
39752.ecindex IIDforspo1
39753.ecindex IIDforspo2
39754.ecindex IIDforspo3
39755
39756.section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
39757The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
39758an ASCII newline character.
39759However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
39760can have an alternate format.
39761This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
39762The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
39763suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
39764ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
39765Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
39766There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
39767
39768. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39769. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39770
39771.chapter "DKIM, SPF and DMARC" "CHAPdkim" &&&
39772 "DKIM, SPF and DMARC Support"
39773
39774.section "DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" SECDKIM
39775.cindex "DKIM"
39776
39777DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
39778linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
39779be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
39780DKIM is documented in RFC 6376.
39781
39782As DKIM relies on the message being unchanged in transit, messages handled
39783by a mailing-list (which traditionally adds to the message) will not match
39784any original DKIM signature.
39785
39786DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
39787It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
39788
39789Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
39790.olist
39791Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
39792It can co-exist with all other Exim features
39793(including transport filters)
39794except cutthrough delivery.
39795.next
39796Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
39797ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
39798different signature contexts.
39799.endlist
39800
39801In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
39802default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
39803Exim's standard controls.
39804
39805Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
39806on by default for logging (in the <= line) purposes.
39807
39808Additional log detail can be enabled using the &%dkim_verbose%& log_selector.
39809When set, for each signature in incoming email,
39810exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
39811signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
39812.code
398132009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
39814 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
39815 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
39816 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
39817.endd
39818
39819You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
39820or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
39821control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
39822where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
39823senders).
39824
39825
39826.section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECDKIMSIGN"
39827.cindex "DKIM" "signing"
39828
39829For signing to be usable you must have published a DKIM record in DNS.
39830Note that RFC 8301 (which does not cover EC keys) says:
39831.code
39832rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39833
39834Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
39835Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
39836.endd
39837
39838Note also that the key content (the 'p=' field)
39839in the DNS record is different between RSA and EC keys;
39840for the former it is the base64 of the ASN.1 for the RSA public key
39841(equivalent to the private-key .pem with the header/trailer stripped)
39842but for EC keys it is the base64 of the pure key; no ASN.1 wrapping.
39843
39844Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
39845These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
39846
39847.option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
39848The domain(s) you want to sign with.
39849After expansion, this can be a list.
39850Each element in turn,
39851.new
39852lowercased,
39853.wen
39854is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
39855while expanding the remaining signing options.
39856If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done,
39857and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
39858
39859.option dkim_selector smtp string list&!! unset
39860This sets the key selector string.
39861After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
39862Each element in turn is put in the expansion
39863variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
39864option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
39865If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain,
39866and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
39867
39868.option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
39869This sets the private key to use.
39870You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
39871&%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
39872The result can either
39873.ilist
39874be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor (.pem file), including line breaks
39875.next
39876with GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
39877be a valid Ed25519 private key (same format as above)
39878.next
39879start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
39880the private key
39881.next
39882be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
39883be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
39884is set.
39885.endlist
39886
39887To generate keys under OpenSSL:
39888.code
39889openssl genrsa -out dkim_rsa.private 2048
39890openssl rsa -in dkim_rsa.private -out /dev/stdout -pubout -outform PEM
39891.endd
39892Take the base-64 lines from the output of the second command, concatenated,
39893for the DNS TXT record.
39894See section 3.6 of RFC6376 for the record specification.
39895
39896Under GnuTLS:
39897.code
39898certtool --generate-privkey --rsa --bits=2048 --password='' -8 --outfile=dkim_rsa.private
39899certtool --load-privkey=dkim_rsa.private --pubkey-info
39900.endd
39901
39902Note that RFC 8301 says:
39903.code
39904Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
39905Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
39906.endd
39907
39908.new
39909EC keys for DKIM are defined by RFC 8463.
39910.wen
39911They are considerably smaller than RSA keys for equivalent protection.
39912As they are a recent development, users should consider dual-signing
39913(by setting a list of selectors, and an expansion for this option)
39914for some transition period.
39915The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
39916for EC keys.
39917
39918OpenSSL 1.1.1 and GnuTLS 3.6.0 can create Ed25519 private keys:
39919.code
39920openssl genpkey -algorithm ed25519 -out dkim_ed25519.private
39921certtool --generate-privkey --key-type=ed25519 --outfile=dkim_ed25519.private
39922.endd
39923
39924To produce the required public key value for a DNS record:
39925.code
39926openssl pkey -outform DER -pubout -in dkim_ed25519.private | tail -c +13 | base64
39927certtool --load_privkey=dkim_ed25519.private --pubkey_info --outder | tail -c +13 | base64
39928.endd
39929
39930.new
39931Exim also supports an alternate format
39932of Ed25519 keys in DNS which was a candidate during development
39933of the standard, but not adopted.
39934A future release will probably drop that support.
39935.wen
39936
39937.option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
39938Can be set to any one of the supported hash methods, which are:
39939.ilist
39940&`sha1`& &-- should not be used, is old and insecure
39941.next
39942&`sha256`& &-- the default
39943.next
39944&`sha512`& &-- possibly more secure but less well supported
39945.endlist
39946
39947Note that RFC 8301 says:
39948.code
39949rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39950.endd
39951
39952.option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
39953If set after expansion, the value is used to set an "i=" tag in
39954the signing header. The DKIM standards restrict the permissible
39955syntax of this optional tag to a mail address, with possibly-empty
39956local part, an @, and a domain identical to or subdomain of the "d="
39957tag value. Note that Exim does not check the value.
39958
39959.option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
39960This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
39961The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
39962The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
39963only supports signing with the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
39964
39965.option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
39966This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
39967should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
39968either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
39969unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
39970variables here.
39971
39972.option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "see below"
39973If set, this option must expand to a colon-separated
39974list of header names.
39975Headers with these names, or the absence or such a header, will be included
39976in the message signature.
39977When unspecified, the header names listed in RFC4871 will be used,
39978whether or not each header is present in the message.
39979The default list is available for the expansion in the macro
39980"_DKIM_SIGN_HEADERS".
39981
39982If a name is repeated, multiple headers by that name (or the absence thereof)
39983will be signed. The textually later headers in the headers part of the
39984message are signed first, if there are multiples.
39985
39986A name can be prefixed with either an '=' or a '+' character.
39987If an '=' prefix is used, all headers that are present with this name
39988will be signed.
39989If a '+' prefix if used, all headers that are present with this name
39990will be signed, and one signature added for a missing header with the
39991name will be appended.
39992
39993.option dkim_timestamps smtp integer&!! unset
39994This option controls the inclusion of timestamp information in the signature.
39995If not set, no such information will be included.
39996Otherwise, must be an unsigned number giving an offset in seconds from the current time
39997for the expiry tag
39998(eg. 1209600 for two weeks);
39999both creation (t=) and expiry (x=) tags will be included.
40000
40001RFC 6376 lists these tags as RECOMMENDED.
40002
40003
40004.section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECDKIMVFY"
40005.cindex "DKIM" "verification"
40006
40007Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is done for all
40008messages for which an ACL control &%dkim_disable_verify%& has not been set.
40009.new
40010.cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
40011Individual classes of signature algorithm can be ignored by changing
40012the main options &%dkim_verify_hashes%& or &%dkim_verify_keytypes%&.
40013The &%dkim_verify_minimal%& option can be set to cease verification
40014processing for a message once the first passing signature is found.
40015.wen
40016
40017.cindex authentication "expansion item"
40018Performing verification sets up information used by the
40019&%authresults%& expansion item.
40020
40021.new
40022For most purposes the default option settings suffice and the remainder
40023of this section can be ignored.
40024.wen
40025
40026The results of verification are made available to the
40027&%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL, which can examine and modify them.
40028A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
40029By default, the ACL is called once for each
40030syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
40031If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
40032If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
40033summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
40034
40035To evaluate the verification result in the ACL
40036a large number of expansion variables
40037containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
40038runtime of the ACL.
40039
40040Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
40041more advanced policies. For that reason, the main option
40042&%dkim_verify_signers%&, and an expansion variable
40043&%$dkim_signers%& exist.
40044
40045The main option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
40046list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
40047called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
40048the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
40049list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
40050&%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
40051it defaults as:
40052.code
40053dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
40054.endd
40055This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
40056DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
40057call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
40058.code
40059dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
40060.endd
40061This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
40062and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
40063You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
40064.code
40065dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
40066.endd
40067
40068If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
40069&%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
40070
40071.new
40072Note that if the option is set using untrustworthy data
40073(such as the From: header)
40074care should be taken to force lowercase for domains
40075and for the domain part if identities.
40076The default setting can be regarded as trustworthy in this respect.
40077.wen
40078
40079If multiple signatures match a domain (or identity), the ACL is called once
40080for each matching signature.
40081
40082
40083Inside the DKIM ACL, the following expansion variables are
40084available (from most to least important):
40085
40086
40087.vlist
40088.vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
40089The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
40090an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
40091&%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
40092
40093.vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
40094Within the DKIM ACL,
40095a string describing the general status of the signature. One of
40096.ilist
40097&%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
40098identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40099.next
40100&%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
40101More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
40102.next
40103&%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
40104available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
40105.next
40106&%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
40107.endlist
40108
40109This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
40110This might, for instance, be done to enforce a policy restriction on
40111hash-method or key-size:
40112.code
40113 warn condition = ${if eq {$dkim_verify_status}{pass}}
40114 condition = ${if eq {${length_3:$dkim_algo}}{rsa}}
40115 condition = ${if or {{eq {$dkim_algo}{rsa-sha1}} \
40116 {< {$dkim_key_length}{1024}}}}
40117 logwrite = NOTE: forcing DKIM verify fail (was pass)
40118 set dkim_verify_status = fail
40119 set dkim_verify_reason = hash too weak or key too short
40120.endd
40121
40122So long as a DKIM ACL is defined (it need do no more than accept),
40123after all the DKIM ACL runs have completed, the value becomes a
40124colon-separated list of the values after each run.
40125This is maintained for the mime, prdr and data ACLs.
40126
40127.vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
40128A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
40129"fail" or "invalid". One of
40130.ilist
40131&%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
40132key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
40133.next
40134&%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
40135record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
40136.next
40137&%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
40138body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
40139means that the message body was modified in transit.
40140.next
40141&%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
40142could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
40143re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
40144DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
40145.endlist
40146
40147This variable can be overwritten, with any value, using an ACL 'set' modifier.
40148
40149.vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
40150The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
40151an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
40152reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40153
40154.vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
40155The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
40156if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
40157identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40158
40159.vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
40160The key record selector string.
40161
40162.vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
40163The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
40164If running under GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
40165may also be 'ed25519-sha256'.
40166The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
40167for EC keys.
40168
40169Note that RFC 8301 says:
40170.code
40171rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
40172
40173DKIM signatures identified as having been signed with historic
40174algorithms (currently, rsa-sha1) have permanently failed evaluation
40175.endd
40176
40177To enforce this you must either have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
40178and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above,
40179.new
40180or have set the main option &%dkim_verify_hashes%& to exclude
40181processing of such signatures.
40182.wen
40183
40184.vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
40185The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
40186
40187.vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
40188The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
40189
40190.vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
40191A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
40192(copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
40193Note that RFC6376 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
40194not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
40195strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
40196
40197.vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
40198The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
40199limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
40200that this variable always expands to an integer value.
40201&*Note:*& The presence of the signature tag specifying a signing body length
40202is one possible route to spoofing of valid DKIM signatures.
40203A paranoid implementation might wish to regard signature where this variable
40204shows less than the "no limit" return as being invalid.
40205
40206.vitem &%$dkim_created%&
40207UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
40208When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
40209
40210.vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
40211UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
40212signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
40213signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
40214integer size comparisons against this value.
40215Note that Exim does not check this value.
40216
40217.vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
40218A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
40219
40220.vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
40221"1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
40222
40223.vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
40224"1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
40225
40226.vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
40227Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
40228in the key record.
40229
40230.vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
40231Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
40232in the key record.
40233
40234.vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
40235Notes from the key record (tag n=).
40236
40237.vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
40238Number of bits in the key.
40239
40240Note that RFC 8301 says:
40241.code
40242Verifiers MUST NOT consider signatures using RSA keys of
40243less than 1024 bits as valid signatures.
40244.endd
40245
40246To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
40247and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
40248As EC keys are much smaller, the check should only do this for RSA keys.
40249
40250.endlist
40251
40252In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
40253
40254.vlist
40255.vitem &%dkim_signers%&
40256ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
40257for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
40258(reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
40259verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
40260
40261.code
40262# Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
40263warn log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
40264 sender_domains = gmail.com
40265 dkim_signers = gmail.com
40266 dkim_status = none
40267.endd
40268
40269Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
40270for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
40271
40272.vitem &%dkim_status%&
40273ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
40274results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
40275to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
40276
40277.code
40278deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
40279 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
40280 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
40281 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
40282.endd
40283
40284The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
40285see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
40286for more information of what they mean.
40287.endlist
40288
40289
40290
40291
40292.section "SPF (Sender Policy Framework)" SECSPF
40293.cindex SPF verification
40294
40295SPF is a mechanism whereby a domain may assert which IP addresses may transmit
40296messages with its domain in the envelope from, documented by RFC 7208.
40297For more information on SPF see &url(http://www.openspf.org).
40298. --- 2018-09-07: still not https
40299
40300Messages sent by a system not authorised will fail checking of such assertions.
40301This includes retransmissions done by traditional forwarders.
40302
40303SPF verification support is built into Exim if SUPPORT_SPF=yes is set in
40304&_Local/Makefile_&. The support uses the &_libspf2_& library
40305&url(https://www.libspf2.org/).
40306There is no Exim involvement in the transmission of messages;
40307publishing certain DNS records is all that is required.
40308
40309For verification, an ACL condition and an expansion lookup are provided.
40310.cindex authentication "expansion item"
40311Performing verification sets up information used by the
40312&%authresults%& expansion item.
40313
40314
40315.cindex SPF "ACL condition"
40316.cindex ACL "spf condition"
40317The ACL condition "spf" can be used at or after the MAIL ACL.
40318It takes as an argument a list of strings giving the outcome of the SPF check,
40319and will succeed for any matching outcome.
40320Valid strings are:
40321.vlist
40322.vitem &%pass%&
40323The SPF check passed, the sending host is positively verified by SPF.
40324
40325.vitem &%fail%&
40326The SPF check failed, the sending host is NOT allowed to send mail for the
40327domain in the envelope-from address.
40328
40329.vitem &%softfail%&
40330The SPF check failed, but the queried domain can't absolutely confirm that this
40331is a forgery.
40332
40333.vitem &%none%&
40334The queried domain does not publish SPF records.
40335
40336.vitem &%neutral%&
40337The SPF check returned a "neutral" state. This means the queried domain has
40338published a SPF record, but wants to allow outside servers to send mail under
40339its domain as well. This should be treated like "none".
40340
40341.vitem &%permerror%&
40342This indicates a syntax error in the SPF record of the queried domain.
40343You may deny messages when this occurs.
40344
40345.vitem &%temperror%&
40346This indicates a temporary error during all processing, including Exim's
40347SPF processing. You may defer messages when this occurs.
40348.endlist
40349
40350You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert
40351its meaning, for example "!fail" will match all results but
40352"fail". The string list is evaluated left-to-right, in a
40353short-circuit fashion.
40354
40355Example:
40356.code
40357deny spf = fail
40358 message = $sender_host_address is not allowed to send mail from \
40359 ${if def:sender_address_domain \
40360 {$sender_address_domain}{$sender_helo_name}}. \
40361 Please see http://www.openspf.org/Why?scope=\
40362 ${if def:sender_address_domain {mfrom}{helo}};\
40363 identity=${if def:sender_address_domain \
40364 {$sender_address}{$sender_helo_name}};\
40365 ip=$sender_host_address
40366.endd
40367
40368When the spf condition has run, it sets up several expansion
40369variables:
40370
40371.cindex SPF "verification variables"
40372.vlist
40373.vitem &$spf_header_comment$&
40374.vindex &$spf_header_comment$&
40375 This contains a human-readable string describing the outcome
40376 of the SPF check. You can add it to a custom header or use
40377 it for logging purposes.
40378
40379.vitem &$spf_received$&
40380.vindex &$spf_received$&
40381 This contains a complete Received-SPF: header that can be
40382 added to the message. Please note that according to the SPF
40383 draft, this header must be added at the top of the header
40384 list. Please see section 10 on how you can do this.
40385
40386 Note: in case of "Best-guess" (see below), the convention is
40387 to put this string in a header called X-SPF-Guess: instead.
40388
40389.vitem &$spf_result$&
40390.vindex &$spf_result$&
40391 This contains the outcome of the SPF check in string form,
40392 one of pass, fail, softfail, none, neutral, permerror or
40393 temperror.
40394
40395.vitem &$spf_result_guessed$&
40396.vindex &$spf_result_guessed$&
40397 This boolean is true only if a best-guess operation was used
40398 and required in order to obtain a result.
40399
40400.vitem &$spf_smtp_comment$&
40401.vindex &$spf_smtp_comment$&
40402 This contains a string that can be used in a SMTP response
40403 to the calling party. Useful for "fail".
40404.endlist
40405
40406
40407.cindex SPF "ACL condition"
40408.cindex ACL "spf_guess condition"
40409.cindex SPF "best guess"
40410In addition to SPF, you can also perform checks for so-called
40411"Best-guess". Strictly speaking, "Best-guess" is not standard
40412SPF, but it is supported by the same framework that enables SPF
40413capability.
40414Refer to &url(http://www.openspf.org/FAQ/Best_guess_record)
40415for a description of what it means.
40416. --- 2018-09-07: still not https:
40417
40418To access this feature, simply use the spf_guess condition in place
40419of the spf one. For example:
40420
40421.code
40422deny spf_guess = fail
40423 message = $sender_host_address doesn't look trustworthy to me
40424.endd
40425
40426In case you decide to reject messages based on this check, you
40427should note that although it uses the same framework, "Best-guess"
40428is not SPF, and therefore you should not mention SPF at all in your
40429reject message.
40430
40431When the spf_guess condition has run, it sets up the same expansion
40432variables as when spf condition is run, described above.
40433
40434Additionally, since Best-guess is not standardized, you may redefine
40435what "Best-guess" means to you by redefining the main configuration
40436&%spf_guess%& option.
40437For example, the following:
40438
40439.code
40440spf_guess = v=spf1 a/16 mx/16 ptr ?all
40441.endd
40442
40443would relax host matching rules to a broader network range.
40444
40445
40446.cindex SPF "lookup expansion"
40447.cindex lookup spf
40448A lookup expansion is also available. It takes an email
40449address as the key and an IP address
40450.new
40451(v4 or v6)
40452.wen
40453as the database:
40454
40455.code
40456 ${lookup {username@domain} spf {ip.ip.ip.ip}}
40457.endd
40458
40459The lookup will return the same result strings as can appear in
40460&$spf_result$& (pass,fail,softfail,neutral,none,err_perm,err_temp).
40461
40462
40463
40464
40465
40466.new
40467.section DMARC SECDMARC
40468.cindex DMARC verification
40469
40470DMARC combines feedback from SPF, DKIM, and header From: in order
40471to attempt to provide better indicators of the authenticity of an
40472email. This document does not explain the fundamentals; you
40473should read and understand how it works by visiting the website at
40474&url(http://www.dmarc.org/).
40475
40476If Exim is built with DMARC support,
40477the libopendmarc library is used.
40478
40479For building Exim yourself, obtain the library from
40480&url(http://sourceforge.net/projects/opendmarc/)
40481to obtain a copy, or find it in your favorite rpm package
40482repository. You will need to attend to the local/Makefile feature
40483SUPPORT_DMARC and the associated LDFLAGS addition.
40484This description assumes
40485that headers will be in /usr/local/include, and that the libraries
40486are in /usr/local/lib.
40487
40488. subsection
40489
40490There are three main-configuration options:
40491.cindex DMARC "configuration options"
40492
40493The &%dmarc_tld_file%& option
40494.oindex &%dmarc_tld_file%&
40495defines the location of a text file of valid
40496top level domains the opendmarc library uses
40497during domain parsing. Maintained by Mozilla,
40498the most current version can be downloaded
40499from a link at &url(http://publicsuffix.org/list/).
40500See also util/renew-opendmarc-tlds.sh script.
40501The default for the option is currently
40502/etc/exim/opendmarc.tlds
40503
40504The &%dmarc_history_file%& option, if set
40505.oindex &%dmarc_history_file%&
40506defines the location of a file to log results
40507of dmarc verification on inbound emails. The
40508contents are importable by the opendmarc tools
40509which will manage the data, send out DMARC
40510reports, and expire the data. Make sure the
40511directory of this file is writable by the user
40512exim runs as.
40513The default is unset.
40514
40515The &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& option
40516.oindex &%dmarc_forensic_sender%&
40517defines an alternate email address to use when sending a
40518forensic report detailing alignment failures
40519if a sender domain's dmarc record specifies it
40520and you have configured Exim to send them.
40521If set, this is expanded and used for the
40522From: header line; the address is extracted
40523from it and used for the envelope from.
40524If not set (the default), the From: header is expanded from
40525the dsn_from option, and <> is used for the
40526envelope from.
40527
40528. I wish we had subsections...
40529
40530.cindex DMARC controls
40531By default, the DMARC processing will run for any remote,
40532non-authenticated user. It makes sense to only verify DMARC
40533status of messages coming from remote, untrusted sources. You can
40534use standard conditions such as hosts, senders, etc, to decide that
40535DMARC verification should *not* be performed for them and disable
40536DMARC with a control setting:
40537.code
40538 control = dmarc_disable_verify
40539.endd
40540A DMARC record can also specify a "forensic address", which gives
40541exim an email address to submit reports about failed alignment.
40542Exim does not do this by default because in certain conditions it
40543results in unintended information leakage (what lists a user might
40544be subscribed to, etc). You must configure exim to submit forensic
40545reports to the owner of the domain. If the DMARC record contains a
40546forensic address and you specify the control statement below, then
40547exim will send these forensic emails. It's also advised that you
40548configure a dmarc_forensic_sender because the default sender address
40549construction might be inadequate.
40550.code
40551 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
40552.endd
40553(AGAIN: You can choose not to send these forensic reports by simply
40554not putting the dmarc_enable_forensic control line at any point in
40555your exim config. If you don't tell it to send them, it will not
40556send them.)
40557
40558There are no options to either control. Both must appear before
40559the DATA acl.
40560
40561. subsection
40562
40563DMARC checks cam be run on incoming SMTP messages by using the
40564"dmarc_status" ACL condition in the DATA ACL. You are required to
40565call the "spf" condition first in the ACLs, then the "dmarc_status"
40566condition. Putting this condition in the ACLs is required in order
40567for a DMARC check to actually occur. All of the variables are set
40568up before the DATA ACL, but there is no actual DMARC check that
40569occurs until a "dmarc_status" condition is encountered in the ACLs.
40570
40571The dmarc_status condition takes a list of strings on its
40572right-hand side. These strings describe recommended action based
40573on the DMARC check. To understand what the policy recommendations
40574mean, refer to the DMARC website above. Valid strings are:
40575.display
40576&'accept '& The DMARC check passed and the library recommends accepting the email.
40577&'reject '& The DMARC check failed and the library recommends rejecting the email.
40578&'quarantine '& The DMARC check failed and the library recommends keeping it for further inspection.
40579&'none '& The DMARC check passed and the library recommends no specific action, neutral.
40580&'norecord '& No policy section in the DMARC record for this sender domain.
40581&'nofrom '& Unable to determine the domain of the sender.
40582&'temperror '& Library error or dns error.
40583&'off '& The DMARC check was disabled for this email.
40584.endd
40585You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert its
40586meaning, for example "!accept" will match all results but
40587"accept". The string list is evaluated left-to-right in a
40588short-circuit fashion. When a string matches the outcome of the
40589DMARC check, the condition succeeds. If none of the listed
40590strings matches the outcome of the DMARC check, the condition
40591fails.
40592
40593Of course, you can also use any other lookup method that Exim
40594supports, including LDAP, Postgres, MySQL, etc, as long as the
40595result is a list of colon-separated strings.
40596
40597Performing the check sets up information used by the
40598&%authresults%& expansion item.
40599
40600Several expansion variables are set before the DATA ACL is
40601processed, and you can use them in this ACL. The following
40602expansion variables are available:
40603
40604&$dmarc_status$&
40605.vindex &$dmarc_status$&
40606.cindex DMARC result
40607is a one word status indicating what the DMARC library
40608thinks of the email. It is a combination of the results of
40609DMARC record lookup and the SPF/DKIM/DMARC processing results
40610(if a DMARC record was found). The actual policy declared
40611in the DMARC record is in a separate expansion variable.
40612
40613&$dmarc_status_text$&
40614.vindex &$dmarc_status_text$&
40615is a slightly longer, human readable status.
40616
40617&$dmarc_used_domain$&
40618.vindex &$dmarc_used_domain$&
40619is the domain which DMARC used to look up the DMARC policy record.
40620
40621&$dmarc_domain_policy$&
40622.vindex &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
40623is the policy declared in the DMARC record. Valid values
40624are "none", "reject" and "quarantine". It is blank when there
40625is any error, including no DMARC record.
40626
40627. subsection
40628
40629By default, Exim's DMARC configuration is intended to be
40630non-intrusive and conservative. To facilitate this, Exim will not
40631create any type of logging files without explicit configuration by
40632you, the admin. Nor will Exim send out any emails/reports about
40633DMARC issues without explicit configuration by you, the admin (other
40634than typical bounce messages that may come about due to ACL
40635processing or failure delivery issues).
40636
40637In order to log statistics suitable to be imported by the opendmarc
40638tools, you need to:
40639.ilist
40640Configure the global setting dmarc_history_file
40641.next
40642Configure cron jobs to call the appropriate opendmarc history
40643import scripts and truncating the dmarc_history_file
40644.endlist
40645
40646In order to send forensic reports, you need to:
40647.ilist
40648Configure the global setting dmarc_forensic_sender
40649.next
40650Configure, somewhere before the DATA ACL, the control option to
40651enable sending DMARC forensic reports
40652.endlist
40653
40654. subsection
40655
40656Example usage:
40657.code
40658(RCPT ACL)
40659 warn domains = +local_domains
40660 hosts = +local_hosts
40661 control = dmarc_disable_verify
40662
40663 warn !domains = +screwed_up_dmarc_records
40664 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
40665
40666 warn condition = (lookup if destined to mailing list)
40667 set acl_m_mailing_list = 1
40668
40669(DATA ACL)
40670 warn dmarc_status = accept : none : off
40671 !authenticated = *
40672 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: $dmarc_status $dmarc_used_domain
40673
40674 warn dmarc_status = !accept
40675 !authenticated = *
40676 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: '$dmarc_status' for $dmarc_used_domain
40677
40678 warn dmarc_status = quarantine
40679 !authenticated = *
40680 set $acl_m_quarantine = 1
40681 # Do something in a transport with this flag variable
40682
40683 deny condition = ${if eq{$dmarc_domain_policy}{reject}}
40684 condition = ${if eq{$acl_m_mailing_list}{1}}
40685 message = Messages from $dmarc_used_domain break mailing lists
40686
40687 deny dmarc_status = reject
40688 !authenticated = *
40689 message = Message from $dmarc_used_domain failed sender's DMARC policy, REJECT
40690
40691 warn add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
40692.endd
40693
40694.wen
40695
40696
40697
40698
40699. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40700. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40701
40702.chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
40703 "Proxy support"
40704.cindex "proxy support"
40705.cindex "proxy" "access via"
40706
40707A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
40708Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
40709
40710
40711.section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
40712.cindex proxy inbound
40713.cindex proxy "server side"
40714.cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
40715.cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
40716
40717Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
40718that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
40719To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
40720in Local/Makefile.
40721
40722It was built on the HAProxy specification, found at
40723&url(https://www.haproxy.org/download/1.8/doc/proxy-protocol.txt).
40724
40725The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
40726such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
40727to distribute load.
40728Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
40729the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
40730There is no logging if a host passes or
40731fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
40732recorded in an ACL (example is below).
40733
40734Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
40735main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
40736hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
40737Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
40738automatically determines which version is in use.
40739
40740The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
40741and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
40742negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
40743Exim and the proxy server.
40744
40745The following expansion variables are usable
40746(&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
40747of the proxy):
40748.display
40749&'proxy_external_address '& IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy
40750&'proxy_external_port '& Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy
40751&'proxy_local_address '& IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy
40752&'proxy_local_port '& Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy
40753&'proxy_session '& boolean: SMTP connection via proxy
40754.endd
40755If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
40756there was a protocol error.
40757The variables &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&
40758will have values for the actual client system, not the proxy.
40759
40760Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
40761per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
40762evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
40763handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
40764With the option set so high, you lose the ability
40765to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
40766In order to prevent your server from overload, you
40767need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
40768A possible solution is:
40769.display
40770 # Set max number of connections per host
40771 LIMIT = 5
40772 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
40773 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
40774
40775 defer message = Too many connections from this IP right now
40776 ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
40777.endd
40778
40779
40780
40781.section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
40782.cindex proxy outbound
40783.cindex proxy "client side"
40784.cindex proxy SOCKS
40785.cindex SOCKS proxy
40786Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
40787using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
40788The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
40789Local/Makefile.
40790
40791Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
40792on an smtp transport.
40793The option value is expanded and should then be a list
40794(colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
40795Each proxy specifier is a list
40796(space-separated by default) where the initial element
40797is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
40798
40799Options are a string <name>=<value>.
40800The list of options is in the following table:
40801.display
40802&'auth '& authentication method
40803&'name '& authentication username
40804&'pass '& authentication password
40805&'port '& tcp port
40806&'tmo '& connection timeout
40807&'pri '& priority
40808&'weight '& selection bias
40809.endd
40810
40811More details on each of these options follows:
40812
40813.ilist
40814.cindex authentication "to proxy"
40815.cindex proxy authentication
40816&%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
40817Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
40818for access to the proxy.
40819Default is &"none"&.
40820.next
40821&%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
40822Default is empty.
40823.next
40824&%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
40825Default is empty.
40826.next
40827&%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
40828Default is 1080.
40829.next
40830&%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
40831Default is 5.
40832.next
40833&%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
40834higher values being tried first.
40835The default priority is 1.
40836.next
40837&%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
40838Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
40839weighted by this value.
40840The default value for selection bias is 1.
40841.endlist
40842
40843Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
40844and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
40845overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
40846
40847.section Logging SECTproxyLog
40848To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
40849add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
40850This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
40851
40852. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40853. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40854
40855.chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
40856 "Internationalisation""
40857.cindex internationalisation "email address"
40858.cindex EAI
40859.cindex i18n
40860.cindex utf8 "mail name handling"
40861
40862Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
40863To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
40864Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
40865
40866If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
40867instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
40868requirement, upon libidn2.
40869
40870.section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
40871.cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
40872The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
40873a host list. If this matches the sending host and
40874accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
40875SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
40876
40877If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
40878international handling for the message is enabled and
40879the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
40880
40881The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
40882message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
40883whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
40884when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
40885
40886Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
40887UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
40888require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
40889the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
40890
40891HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
40892components expanded to a-label form,
40893and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
40894form of the name.
40895
40896.cindex log protocol
40897.cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
40898.cindex i18n logging
40899Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
40900prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
40901
40902The following expansion operators can be used:
40903.code
40904${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
40905${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
40906${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
40907${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
40908.endd
40909
40910.cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
40911.cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
40912The RCPT ACL
40913may use the following modifier:
40914.display
40915control = utf8_downconvert
40916control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
40917.endd
40918This sets a flag requiring that addresses are converted to
40919a-label form before smtp delivery, for use in a
40920Message Submission Agent context.
40921If a value is appended it may be:
40922.display
40923&`1 `& (default) mandatory downconversion
40924&`0 `& no downconversion
40925&`-1 `& if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host
40926.endd
40927
40928If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
40929is initially set to -1.
40930
40931The smtp transport has an option &%utf8_downconvert%&.
40932If set it must expand to one of the three values described above,
40933and it overrides any previously set value.
40934
40935
40936There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
40937Configurations supporting these should inspect
40938&$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
40939
40940There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
40941Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
40942for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
40943
40944There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
40945and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
40946
40947
40948
40949.section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
40950To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
40951the following expansion operator can be used:
40952.code
40953${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
40954.endd
40955
40956The string is converted from the charset specified by
40957the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
40958or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
40959to the
40960modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
40961with the following exception: All occurrences of <sep>
40962(which has to be a single character)
40963are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
40964<sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
40965
40966The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
40967The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
40968
40969This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
40970by many other IMAP servers.
40971
40972Examples:
40973.display
40974&`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
40975&`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
40976&`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
40977.endd
40978
40979Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
40980must be representable in UTF-16.
40981
40982
40983. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40984. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40985
40986.chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
40987 "Events"
40988.cindex events
40989
40990The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
40991of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
40992actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
40993processing actions.
40994
40995Most installations will never need to use Events.
40996The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
40997in &_Local/Makefile_&.
40998
40999There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
41000The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
41001a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
41002
41003Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
41004An example might look like:
41005.cindex logging custom
41006.code
41007event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
41008{${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
41009 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
41010 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
41011 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
41012 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
41013 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
41014 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
41015 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
41016} {}}
41017.endd
41018
41019Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
41020The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
41021expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
41022
41023The current list of events is:
41024.display
41025&`dane:fail after transport `& per connection
41026&`msg:complete after main `& per message
41027&`msg:delivery after transport `& per recipient
41028&`msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport `& per recipient per host
41029&`msg:rcpt:defer after transport `& per recipient
41030&`msg:host:defer after transport `& per attempt
41031&`msg:fail:delivery after transport `& per recipient
41032&`msg:fail:internal after main `& per recipient
41033&`tcp:connect before transport `& per connection
41034&`tcp:close after transport `& per connection
41035&`tls:cert before both `& per certificate in verification chain
41036&`smtp:connect after transport `& per connection
41037.endd
41038New event types may be added in future.
41039
41040The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
41041event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
41042or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
41043
41044The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
41045before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
41046can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
41047
41048The third column in the table above says what section of the configuration
41049should define the event action.
41050
41051An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
41052with the event type:
41053.display
41054&`dane:fail `& failure reason
41055&`msg:delivery `& smtp confirmation message
41056&`msg:fail:internal `& failure reason
41057&`msg:fail:delivery `& smtp error message
41058&`msg:rcpt:host:defer `& error string
41059&`msg:rcpt:defer `& error string
41060&`msg:host:defer `& error string
41061&`tls:cert `& verification chain depth
41062&`smtp:connect `& smtp banner
41063.endd
41064
41065The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
41066
41067For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&
41068however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
41069the course of its processing:
41070.ilist
41071variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
41072transport call
41073.next
41074acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
41075and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
41076.endlist
41077Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
41078a useful way of writing to the main log.
41079
41080The expansion of the event_action option should normally
41081return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
41082following will be forced:
41083.display
41084&`tcp:connect `& do not connect
41085&`tls:cert `& refuse verification
41086&`smtp:connect `& close connection
41087.endd
41088All other message types ignore the result string, and
41089no other use is made of it.
41090
41091For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
41092then the address and port variables will be that of the proxy and not
41093the target system.
41094
41095For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
41096chain element received on the connection.
41097For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
41098loaded locally.
41099
41100. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41101. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41102
41103.chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
41104 "Adding drivers or lookups"
41105.cindex "adding drivers"
41106.cindex "new drivers, adding"
41107.cindex "drivers" "adding new"
41108The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
41109authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
41110
41111.olist
41112Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
41113existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
41114.next
41115Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
41116.display
41117<&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
41118.endd
41119where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
41120code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
41121should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
41122.next
41123Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
41124.code
41125#define <type>_NEWDRIVER
41126.endd
41127.next
41128Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
41129and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
41130.next
41131Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
41132near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
41133Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
41134As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
41135simple form that most lookups have.
41136.next
41137Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
41138&_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
41139driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
41140.next
41141Edit &_OS/Makefile-Base_& adding a &_.o_& file for the predefined-macros, to the
41142definition of OBJ_MACRO. Add a set of line to do the compile also.
41143.next
41144Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
41145&_src_&.
41146.next
41147Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
41148as for other drivers and lookups.
41149.endlist
41150
41151Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
41152proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
41153occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
41154options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
41155searched using a binary chop procedure.
41156
41157There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
41158the interface that is expected.
41159
41160
41161
41162
41163. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41164. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41165
41166. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41167. These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
41168. Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
41169. PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
41170. processors.
41171. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41172
41173.literal xml
41174<?sdop
41175 format="newpage"
41176 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
41177 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
41178?>
41179.literal off
41180
41181.makeindex "Options index" "option"
41182.makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
41183.makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
41184
41185
41186. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41187. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////